zshall man page on UnixWare

Man page or keyword search:  
man Server   3616 pages
apropos Keyword Search (all sections)
Output format
UnixWare logo
[printable version]

ZSHALL(1)							     ZSHALL(1)

NAME
       zshall - the Z shell meta-man page

SYNOPSIS
       Because	zsh contains many features, the zsh manual has been split into
       a number of sections.  This manual page includes all the separate  man‐
       ual pages in the following order:

       zshmisc	    Anything not fitting into the other sections
       zshexpn	    Zsh command and parameter expansion
       zshparam	    Zsh parameters
       zshoptions   Zsh options
       zshbuiltins  Zsh built-in functions
       zshzle	    Zsh command line editing
       zshcompwid   Zsh completion widgets
       zshcompsys   Zsh completion system
       zshcompctl   Zsh completion control
       zshmodules   Zsh loadable modules
       zshzftpsys   Zsh built-in FTP client

DESCRIPTION
       Zsh  is	a  UNIX	 command  interpreter (shell) usable as an interactive
       login shell and as a shell script command processor.  Of	 the  standard
       shells,	zsh most closely resembles ksh but includes many enhancements.
       Zsh has command line editing, builtin spelling correction, programmable
       command completion, shell functions (with autoloading), a history mech‐
       anism, and a host of other features.

AUTHOR
       Zsh was originally written by Paul Falstad <pf@zsh.org>.	  Zsh  is  now
       maintained  by  the  members of the zsh-workers mailing list <zsh-work‐
       ers@sunsite.dk>.	 The development is  currently	coordinated  by	 Peter
       Stephenson <pws@zsh.org>.  The coordinator can be contacted at <coordi‐
       nator@zsh.org>, but matters relating to the code should generally go to
       the mailing list.

AVAILABILITY
       Zsh  is available from the following anonymous FTP sites.  These mirror
       sites are kept frequently up to date.  The sites marked with (H) may be
       mirroring ftp.cs.elte.hu instead of the primary site.

       Primary site
	      ftp://ftp.zsh.org/pub/zsh/
	      http://www.zsh.org/pub/zsh/

       Australia
	      ftp://ftp.zsh.org/pub/zsh/
	      http://www.zsh.org/pub/zsh/
	      ftp://ftp.ips.gov.au/pub/packages/zsh/  (H)

       Denmark
	      ftp://sunsite.dk/pub/unix/shells/zsh/

       Finland
	      ftp://ftp.funet.fi/pub/unix/shells/zsh/

       France
	      ftp://ftp.cenatls.cena.dgac.fr/shells/zsh/

       Germany
	      ftp://ftp.fu-berlin.de/pub/unix/shells/zsh/  (H)
	      ftp://ftp.gmd.de/packages/zsh/
	      ftp://ftp.uni-trier.de/pub/unix/shell/zsh/

       Hungary
	      ftp://ftp.cs.elte.hu/pub/zsh/
	      http://www.cs.elte.hu/pub/zsh/
	      ftp://ftp.kfki.hu/pub/packages/zsh/

       Israel
	      ftp://ftp.math.technion.ac.il/pub/zsh/
	      http://www.math.technion.ac.il/pub/zsh/

       Italy
	      ftp://ftp.unina.it/pub/Unix/pkgs/shell/zsh/

       Japan
	      ftp://ftp.nisiq.net/pub/shells/zsh/  (H)
	      ftp://ftp.win.ne.jp/pub/shell/zsh/

       Norway
	      ftp://ftp.uit.no/pub/unix/shells/zsh/

       Poland
	      ftp://sunsite.icm.edu.pl/pub/unix/shells/zsh/

       Romania
	      ftp://ftp.roedu.net/pub/mirrors/ftp.zsh.org/pub/zsh/
	      ftp://ftp.kappa.ro/pub/mirrors/ftp.zsh.org/pub/zsh/

       Slovenia
	      ftp://ftp.siol.net/mirrors/zsh/

       Sweden
	      ftp://ftp.lysator.liu.se/pub/unix/zsh/

       UK
	      ftp://ftp.net.lut.ac.uk/zsh/
	      ftp://sunsite.org.uk/packages/zsh/

       USA
	      ftp://uiarchive.uiuc.edu/pub/packages/shells/zsh/
	      ftp://ftp.rge.com/pub/shells/zsh/
	      ftp://foad.org/pub/zsh/
	      http://foad.org/zsh/

MAILING LISTS
       Zsh has 3 mailing lists:

       <zsh-announce@sunsite.dk>
	      Announcements about releases, major changes in the shell and the
	      monthly posting of the Zsh FAQ.  (moderated)

       <zsh-users@sunsite.dk>
	      User discussions.

       <zsh-workers@sunsite.dk>
	      Hacking, development, bug reports and patches.

       To subscribe or unsubscribe, send mail to the associated administrative
       address for the mailing list.

       <zsh-announce-subscribe@sunsite.dk>
       <zsh-users-subscribe@sunsite.dk>
       <zsh-workers-subscribe@sunsite.dk>
       <zsh-announce-unsubscribe@sunsite.dk>
       <zsh-users-unsubscribe@sunsite.dk>
       <zsh-workers-unsubscribe@sunsite.dk>

       YOU ONLY NEED TO JOIN ONE OF THE MAILING LISTS AS THEY ARE NESTED.  All
       submissions to zsh-announce are automatically forwarded	to  zsh-users.
       All  submissions	 to zsh-users are automatically forwarded to zsh-work‐
       ers.

       If you have problems subscribing/unsubscribing to any  of  the  mailing
       lists,  send mail to <listmaster@zsh.org>.  The mailing lists are main‐
       tained by Karsten Thygesen <karthy@kom.auc.dk>.

       The mailing lists are archived; the archives can be  accessed  via  the
       administrative  addresses  listed above.	 There is also a hypertext ar‐
       chive,  maintained  by	Geoff	Wing   <gcw@zsh.org>,	available   at
       http://www.zsh.org/mla/.

THE ZSH FAQ
       Zsh has a list of Frequently Asked Questions (FAQ), maintained by Peter
       Stephenson <pws@zsh.org>.  It is	 regularly  posted  to	the  newsgroup
       comp.unix.shell	and the zsh-announce mailing list.  The latest version
       can   be	  found	  at   any   of	  the	Zsh   FTP   sites,    or    at
       http://www.zsh.org/FAQ/.	  The  contact address for FAQ-related matters
       is <faqmaster@zsh.org>.

THE ZSH WEB PAGE
       Zsh has a web page which is located at  http://www.zsh.org/.   This  is
       maintained  by  Karsten	Thygesen <karthy@zsh.org>, of SunSITE Denmark.
       The contact address for web-related matters is <webmaster@zsh.org>.

THE ZSH USERGUIDE
       A userguide is currently in preparation.	 It is intended to  complement
       the  manual, with explanations and hints on issues where the manual can
       be cabbalistic, hierographic, or downright mystifying (for example, the
       word  `hierographic'  does not exist).  It can be viewed in its current
       state at http://zsh.sunsite.dk/Guide/.  At the time of  writing,	 chap‐
       ters  dealing with startup files and their contents and the new comple‐
       tion system were essentially complete.

INVOCATION OPTIONS
       The following flags are interpreted by the shell when invoked to deter‐
       mine where the shell will read commands from:

       -c     Take  the	 first	argument  as a command to execute, rather than
	      reading commands from a script or standard input.	 If  any  fur‐
	      ther  arguments  are  given,  the	 first	one is assigned to $0,
	      rather than being used as a positional parameter.

       -i     Force shell to be interactive.

       -s     Force shell to read commands from the standard input.  If the -s
	      flag is not present and an argument is given, the first argument
	      is taken to be the pathname of a script to execute.

       After the  first	 one  or  two  arguments  have	been  appropriated  as
       described above, the remaining arguments are assigned to the positional
       parameters.

       For further options,  which  are	 common	 to  invocation	 and  the  set
       builtin, see zshoptions(1).

       Options	may  be specified by name using the -o option.	-o acts like a
       single-letter option, but takes a following string as the option	 name.
       For example,

	      zsh -x -o shwordsplit scr

       runs  the  script  scr,	setting the XTRACE option by the corresponding
       letter `-x' and the SH_WORD_SPLIT  option  by  name.   Options  may  be
       turned  off  by	name  by using +o instead of -o.  -o can be stacked up
       with preceding single-letter options, so for example `-xo  shwordsplit'
       or `-xoshwordsplit' is equivalent to `-x -o shwordsplit'.

       Options	may  also  be  specified  by  name  in	GNU long option style,
       `--option-name'.	 When this is done, `-' characters in the option  name
       are permitted: they are translated into `_', and thus ignored.  So, for
       example, `zsh  --sh-word-split'	invokes	 zsh  with  the	 SH_WORD_SPLIT
       option  turned  on.   Like other option syntaxes, options can be turned
       off by replacing the initial `-' with a `+'; thus `+-sh-word-split'  is
       equivalent  to  `--no-sh-word-split'.   Unlike  other  option syntaxes,
       GNU-style long options cannot be stacked with any other options, so for
       example	`-x-shwordsplit'  is  an error, rather than being treated like
       `-x --shwordsplit'.

       The special GNU-style option `--version' is handled; it sends to	 stan‐
       dard  output  the shell's version information, then exits successfully.
       `--help' is also handled; it sends to standard output a list of options
       that can be used when invoking the shell, then exits successfully.

       Option  processing  may	be finished, allowing following arguments that
       start with `-' or `+' to be treated as normal arguments, in  two	 ways.
       Firstly,	 a lone `-' (or `+') as an argument by itself ends option pro‐
       cessing.	 Secondly, a special option `--' (or `+-'), which may be spec‐
       ified  on its own (which is the standard POSIX usage) or may be stacked
       with preceding options (so `-x-' is equivalent to  `-x  --').   Options
       are not permitted to be stacked after `--' (so `-x-f' is an error), but
       note the GNU-style option form discussed above,	where  `--shwordsplit'
       is permitted and does not end option processing.

       Except  when  the sh/ksh emulation single-letter options are in effect,
       the option `-b' (or `+b') ends option processing.  `-b' is  like	 `--',
       except that further single-letter options can be stacked after the `-b'
       and will take effect as normal.

COMPATIBILITY
       Zsh tries to emulate sh or ksh when it is invoked as sh or ksh  respec‐
       tively;	more  precisely,  it  looks at the first letter of the name by
       which it was invoked, excluding any initial `r' (assumed to  stand  for
       `restricted'),  and  if	that  is `s' or `k' it will emulate sh or ksh.
       Furthermore, if invoked as su (which happens on	certain	 systems  when
       the shell is executed by the su command), the shell will try to find an
       alternative name from the SHELL environment variable and perform emula‐
       tion based on that.

       In sh and ksh compatibility modes the following parameters are not spe‐
       cial and not initialized by the shell:  ARGC,  argv,  cdpath,  fignore,
       fpath,  HISTCHARS,  mailpath,  MANPATH,	manpath, path, prompt, PROMPT,
       PROMPT2, PROMPT3, PROMPT4, psvar, status, watch.

       The usual zsh startup/shutdown scripts are not executed.	 Login	shells
       source /etc/profile followed by $HOME/.profile.	If the ENV environment
       variable is set on  invocation,	$ENV  is  sourced  after  the  profile
       scripts.	 The value of ENV is subjected to parameter expansion, command
       substitution, and arithmetic expansion before being  interpreted	 as  a
       pathname.   Note	 that the PRIVILEGED option also affects the execution
       of startup files.

       The following options are set if the shell is invoked  as  sh  or  ksh:
       NO_BAD_PATTERN,	  NO_BANG_HIST,	   NO_BG_NICE,	 NO_EQUALS,   NO_FUNC‐
       TION_ARGZERO, GLOB_SUBST,  NO_GLOBAL_EXPORT,  NO_HUP,  INTERACTIVE_COM‐
       MENTS,  KSH_ARRAYS,  NO_MULTIOS, NO_NOMATCH, NO_NOTIFY, POSIX_BUILTINS,
       NO_PROMPT_PERCENT,    RM_STAR_SILENT,	SH_FILE_EXPANSION,    SH_GLOB,
       SH_OPTION_LETTERS,   SH_WORD_SPLIT.    Additionally  the	 BSD_ECHO  and
       IGNORE_BRACES options are set if zsh  is	 invoked  as  sh.   Also,  the
       KSH_OPTION_PRINT,  LOCAL_OPTIONS,  PROMPT_BANG,	PROMPT_SUBST  and SIN‐
       GLE_LINE_ZLE options are set if zsh is invoked as ksh.

RESTRICTED SHELL
       When the basename of the command used to invoke	zsh  starts  with  the
       letter  `r'  or the `-r' command line option is supplied at invocation,
       the shell becomes  restricted.	Emulation  mode	 is  determined	 after
       stripping  the  letter `r' from the invocation name.  The following are
       disabled in restricted mode:

       ·      changing directories with the cd builtin

       ·      changing or unsetting the PATH, path, MODULE_PATH,  module_path,
	      SHELL,  HISTFILE,	 HISTSIZE,  GID,  EGID,	 UID,  EUID, USERNAME,
	      LD_LIBRARY_PATH,	  LD_AOUT_LIBRARY_PATH,	    LD_PRELOAD	   and
	      LD_AOUT_PRELOAD parameters

       ·      specifying command names containing /

       ·      specifying command pathnames using hash

       ·      redirecting output to files

       ·      using the exec builtin command to replace the shell with another
	      command

       ·      using jobs -Z to overwrite the shell process' argument and envi‐
	      ronment space

       ·      using  the ARGV0 parameter to override argv[0] for external com‐
	      mands

       ·      turning off restricted mode with set +r or unsetopt RESTRICTED

       These restrictions are enforced after  processing  the  startup	files.
       The  startup  files  should set up PATH to point to a directory of com‐
       mands which can be safely invoked in the restricted environment.	  They
       may also add further restrictions by disabling selected builtins.

       Restricted  mode	 can  also  be	activated  any	time  by  setting  the
       RESTRICTED option.   This  immediately  enables	all  the  restrictions
       described  above	 even if the shell still has not processed all startup
       files.

STARTUP/SHUTDOWN FILES
       Commands are first read from /etc/zshenv; this  cannot  be  overridden.
       Subsequent behaviour is modified by the RCS and GLOBAL_RCS options; the
       former affects all startup files, while the second only	affects	 those
       in  the	/etc  directory.  If one of the options is unset at any point,
       any subsequent startup file(s) of the corresponding type	 will  not  be
       read.   It  is  also  possible  for  a  file  in	 $ZDOTDIR to re-enable
       GLOBAL_RCS. Both RCS and GLOBAL_RCS are set by default.

       Commands are then read from $ZDOTDIR/.zshenv.  If the shell is a	 login
       shell,  commands	 are  read from /etc/zprofile and then $ZDOTDIR/.zpro‐
       file.  Then, if the  shell  is  interactive,  commands  are  read  from
       /etc/zshrc  and then $ZDOTDIR/.zshrc.  Finally, if the shell is a login
       shell, /etc/zlogin and $ZDOTDIR/.zlogin are read.

       When  a	login  shell  exits,  the  files  $ZDOTDIR/.zlogout  and  then
       /etc/zlogout  are  read.	 This happens with either an explicit exit via
       the exit or logout commands, or an implicit exit by reading end-of-file
       from  the  terminal.   However, if the shell terminates due to exec'ing
       another process, the  logout  files  are	 not  read.   These  are  also
       affected	 by  the  RCS  and GLOBAL_RCS options.	Note also that the RCS
       option affects the saving of history files, i.e. if RCS is  unset  when
       the shell exits, no history file will be saved.

       If ZDOTDIR is unset, HOME is used instead.  Those files listed above as
       being in /etc may be in another directory, depending on	the  installa‐
       tion.

       As /etc/zshenv is run for all instances of zsh, it is important that it
       be kept as small as possible.  In particular, it is a good idea to  put
       code  that does not need to be run for every single shell behind a test
       of the form `if [[ -o rcs ]]; then ...' so that it will not be executed
       when zsh is invoked with the `-f' option.

       Any  of	these files may be pre-compiled with the zcompile builtin com‐
       mand (see zshbuiltins(1)).  If a compiled file exists  (named  for  the
       original	 file plus the .zwc extension) and it is newer than the origi‐
       nal file, the compiled file will be used instead.

ZSHMISC(1)							    ZSHMISC(1)

NAME
       zshmisc - everything and then some

SIMPLE COMMANDS & PIPELINES
       A simple command is a sequence of optional parameter  assignments  fol‐
       lowed  by  blank-separated  words,  with	 optional  redirections inter‐
       spersed.	 The first word is the command to be executed, and the remain‐
       ing  words, if any, are arguments to the command.  If a command name is
       given, the parameter assignments modify the environment of the  command
       when it is executed.  The value of a simple command is its exit status,
       or 128 plus the signal number if terminated by a signal.	 For example,

	      echo foo

       is a simple command with arguments.

       A pipeline is either a simple command, or a sequence  of	 two  or  more
       simple commands where each command is separated from the next by `|' or
       `|&'.  Where commands are separated by `|', the standard output of  the
       first  command is connected to the standard input of the next.  `|&' is
       shorthand for `2>&1 |', which connects both the standard output and the
       standard	 error	of the command to the standard input of the next.  The
       value of a pipeline is the value of the last command, unless the	 pipe‐
       line  is preceded by `!' in which case the value is the logical inverse
       of the value of the last command.  For example,

	      echo foo | sed 's/foo/bar/'

       is a pipeline, where the output (`foo' plus a  newline)	of  the	 first
       command will be passed to the input of the second.

       If a pipeline is preceded by `coproc', it is executed as a coprocess; a
       two-way pipe is established between it and the parent shell.  The shell
       can read from or write to the coprocess by means of the `>&p' and `<&p'
       redirection operators or with `print -p' and  `read  -p'.   A  pipeline
       cannot be preceded by both `coproc' and `!'.  If job control is active,
       the coprocess can be treated in other than input and output as an ordi‐
       nary background job.

       A  sublist  is  either  a single pipeline, or a sequence of two or more
       pipelines separated by `&&' or `||'.  If two pipelines are separated by
       `&&',  the  second  pipeline  is	 executed  only	 if the first succeeds
       (returns a zero value).	If two pipelines are separated	by  `||',  the
       second  is  executed only if the first fails (returns a nonzero value).
       Both operators have equal precedence and	 are  left  associative.   The
       value  of  the sublist is the value of the last pipeline executed.  For
       example,

	      dmesg | grep panic && print yes

       is a sublist consisting of two pipelines, the second just a simple com‐
       mand  which  will be executed if and only if the grep command returns a
       zero value.  If it does not, the value of the sublist  is  that	return
       value,  else  it	 is  the value returned by the print (almost certainly
       zero).

       A list is a sequence of zero or more sublists, in which each sublist is
       terminated  by `;', `&', `&|', `&!', or a newline.  This terminator may
       optionally be omitted from the last sublist in the list when  the  list
       appears	as  a complex command inside `(...)'  or `{...}'.  When a sub‐
       list is terminated by `;' or newline, the shell waits for it to	finish
       before  executing  the  next  sublist.  If a sublist is terminated by a
       `&', `&|', or `&!', the shell executes the last pipeline in it  in  the
       background,  and	 does  not  wait for it to finish (note the difference
       from other shells which execute the whole sublist in  the  background).
       A backgrounded pipeline returns a status of zero.

       More generally, a list can be seen as a set of any shell commands what‐
       soever, including the complex commands below; this is implied  wherever
       the  word  `list' appears in later descriptions.	 For example, the com‐
       mands in a shell function form a special sort of list.

PRECOMMAND MODIFIERS
       A simple command may be preceded by a precommand modifier,  which  will
       alter  how  the	command	 is  interpreted.   These  modifiers are shell
       builtin commands with the exception of nocorrect which  is  a  reserved
       word.

       -      The  command  is	executed  with	a `-' prepended to its argv[0]
	      string.

       noglob Filename generation (globbing) is not performed on  any  of  the
	      words.

       nocorrect
	      Spelling	correction is not done on any of the words.  This must
	      appear before any other precommand modifier,  as	it  is	inter‐
	      preted  immediately,  before  any	 parsing  is  done.  It has no
	      effect in non-interactive shells.

       exec   The command is executed in the parent shell without forking.

       command
	      The command word is taken to be the name of an external command,
	      rather than a shell function or builtin.

       builtin
	      The  command  word is taken to be the name of a builtin command,
	      rather than a shell function or external command.

COMPLEX COMMANDS
       A complex command in zsh is one of the following:

       if list then list [ elif list then list ] ... [ else list ] fi
	      The if list is executed, and if it returns a zero	 exit  status,
	      the then list is executed.  Otherwise, the elif list is executed
	      and if its value is zero, the then list is  executed.   If  each
	      elif list returns nonzero, the else list is executed.

       for name [ in word ... term ] do list done
	      where  term  is  at  least one newline or ;.  Expand the list of
	      words, and set the parameter name to each of them in turn,  exe‐
	      cuting list each time.  If the in word is omitted, use the posi‐
	      tional parameters instead of the words.

       for (( [expr1] ; [expr2] ; [expr3] )) do list done
	      The arithmetic expression expr1 is evaluated first (see the sec‐
	      tion  `Arithmetic Evaluation').  The arithmetic expression expr2
	      is repeatedly evaluated until it	evaluates  to  zero  and  when
	      non-zero,	 list  is executed and the arithmetic expression expr3
	      evaluated.  If any expression is omitted, then it behaves as  if
	      it evaluated to 1.

       while list do list done
	      Execute  the  do	list  as long as the while list returns a zero
	      exit status.

       until list do list done
	      Execute the do list as long as until list returns a nonzero exit
	      status.

       repeat word do list done
	      word  is expanded and treated as an arithmetic expression, which
	      must evaluate to a number n.  list is then executed n times.

       case word in [ [(] pattern [ | pattern ] ... ) list (;;|;&) ] ... esac
	      Execute the list associated with the first pattern that  matches
	      word, if any.  The form of the patterns is the same as that used
	      for filename generation.	See the section `Filename Generation'.
	      If  the  list that is executed is terminated with ;& rather than
	      ;;, the following list is also executed.	This  continues	 until
	      either a list is terminated with ;; or the esac is reached.

       select name [ in word ... term ] do list done
	      where  term  is one or more newline or ; to terminate the words.
	      Print the set of words, each preceded by a number.   If  the  in
	      word  is	omitted,  use  the positional parameters.  The PROMPT3
	      prompt is printed and a line is read from the line editor if the
	      shell is interactive and that is active, or else standard input.
	      If this line consists of the number of one of the listed	words,
	      then the parameter name is set to the word corresponding to this
	      number.  If this line is empty, the selection  list  is  printed
	      again.   Otherwise,  the	value  of the parameter name is set to
	      null.  The contents of the line  read  from  standard  input  is
	      saved  in the parameter REPLY.  list is executed for each selec‐
	      tion until a break or end-of-file is encountered.

       ( list )
	      Execute list in a subshell.  Traps set by the trap  builtin  are
	      reset to their default values while executing list.

       { list }
	      Execute list.

       function word ... [ () ] [ term ] { list }
       word ... () [ term ] { list }
       word ... () [ term ] command
	      where term is one or more newline or ;.  Define a function which
	      is referenced by any one of word.	 Normally, only	 one  word  is
	      provided;	 multiple  words  are  usually only useful for setting
	      traps.  The body of the function is the list between the	{  and
	      }.  See the section `Functions'.

	      If  the  option  SH_GLOB	is  set	 for  compatibility with other
	      shells, then whitespace may appear between between the left  and
	      right  parentheses  when there is a single word;	otherwise, the
	      parentheses will be treated as forming  a	 globbing  pattern  in
	      that case.

       time [ pipeline ]
	      The  pipeline is executed, and timing statistics are reported on
	      the standard error in the form specified by the TIMEFMT  parame‐
	      ter.   If	 pipeline is omitted, print statistics about the shell
	      process and its children.

       [[ exp ]]
	      Evaluates the conditional expression exp and return a zero  exit
	      status if it is true.  See the section `Conditional Expressions'
	      for a description of exp.

ALTERNATE FORMS FOR COMPLEX COMMANDS
       Many of zsh's complex commands have alternate forms.  These  particular
       versions of complex commands should be considered deprecated and may be
       removed in the future.  The versions in the previous section should  be
       preferred instead.

       The short versions below only work if sublist is of the form `{ list }'
       or if the SHORT_LOOPS option is set.  For the if, while and until  com‐
       mands, in both these cases the test part of the loop must also be suit‐
       ably delimited, such as by `[[ ... ]]' or `(( ... ))', else the end  of
       the  test will not be recognized.  For the for, repeat, case and select
       commands no such special form for the arguments is necessary,  but  the
       other  condition (the special form of sublist or use of the SHORT_LOOPS
       option) still applies.

       if list { list } [ elif list { list } ] ... [ else { list } ]
	      An alternate form of if.	The rules mean that

		     if [[ -o ignorebraces ]] {
		       print yes
		     }

	      works, but

		     if true {	# Does not work!
		       print yes
		     }

	      does not, since the test is not suitably delimited.

       if list sublist
	      A short form of the alternate `if'.  The same limitations on the
	      form of list apply as for the previous form.

       for name ( word ... ) sublist
	      A short form of for.

       for name [ in word ... term ] sublist
	      where  term is at least one newline or ;.	 Another short form of
	      for.

       for (( [expr1] ; [expr2] ; [expr3] )) sublist
	      A short form of the arithmetic for command.

       foreach name ( word ... ) list end
	      Another form of for.

       while list { list }
	      An alternative form of while.  Note the limitations on the  form
	      of list mentioned above.

       until list { list }
	      An  alternative form of until.  Note the limitations on the form
	      of list mentioned above.

       repeat word sublist
	      This is a short form of repeat.

       case word { [ [(] pattern [ | pattern ] ... ) list (;;|;&) ] ... }
	      An alternative form of case.

       select name [ in word term ] sublist
	      where term is at least one  newline  or  ;.   A  short  form  of
	      select.

RESERVED WORDS
       The  following  words are recognized as reserved words when used as the
       first word of a command unless quoted or disabled using disable -r:

       do done esac then elif else fi for case if while function  repeat  time
       until select coproc nocorrect foreach end ! [[ { }

       Additionally,  `}'  is  recognized in any position if the IGNORE_BRACES
       option is not set.

COMMENTS
       In noninteractive shells, or in interactive shells  with	 the  INTERAC‐
       TIVE_COMMENTS  option set, a word beginning with the third character of
       the histchars parameter (`#' by default) causes that word and  all  the
       following characters up to a newline to be ignored.

ALIASING
       Every  token  in the shell input is checked to see if there is an alias
       defined for it.	If so, it is replaced by the text of the alias	if  it
       is  in command position (if it could be the first word of a simple com‐
       mand), or if the alias is global.  If the text ends with a  space,  the
       next  word  in  the shell input is treated as though it were in command
       position for purposes of alias expansion.  An alias  is	defined	 using
       the alias builtin; global aliases may be defined using the -g option to
       that builtin.

       Alias expansion is done on the shell input before any  other  expansion
       except  history	expansion.   Therefore, if an alias is defined for the
       word foo, alias expansion may be avoided by quoting part of  the	 word,
       e.g.  \foo.  But there is nothing to prevent an alias being defined for
       \foo as well.

QUOTING
       A character may be quoted (that is, made to stand for itself)  by  pre‐
       ceding it with a `\'.  `\' followed by a newline is ignored.

       A string enclosed between `$'' and `'' is processed the same way as the
       string arguments of the print builtin, and the resulting string is con‐
       sidered to be entirely quoted.  A literal `'' character can be included
       in the string by using the `\'' escape.

       All characters enclosed between a pair of single quotes	('')  that  is
       not  preceded by a `$' are quoted.  A single quote cannot appear within
       single quotes unless the option RC_QUOTES is set, in which case a  pair
       of single quotes are turned into a single quote.	 For example,

	      print ''''

       outputs	nothing	 apart from a newline if RC_QUOTES is not set, but one
       single quote if it is set.

       Inside double quotes (""), parameter and	 command  substitution	occur,
       and `\' quotes the characters `\', ``', `"', and `$'.

REDIRECTION
       If  a  command is followed by & and job control is not active, then the
       default standard input for the command is  the  empty  file  /dev/null.
       Otherwise,  the environment for the execution of a command contains the
       file descriptors of the invoking	 shell	as  modified  by  input/output
       specifications.

       The following may appear anywhere in a simple command or may precede or
       follow a complex command.  Expansion occurs before  word	 or  digit  is
       used except as noted below.  If the result of substitution on word pro‐
       duces more than one filename,  redirection  occurs  for	each  separate
       filename in turn.

       < word Open file word for reading as standard input.

       <> word
	      Open  file  word	for reading and writing as standard input.  If
	      the file does not exist then it is created.

       > word Open file word for writing as standard output.  If the file does
	      not exist then it is created.  If the file exists, and the CLOB‐
	      BER option is unset, this causes	an  error;  otherwise,	it  is
	      truncated to zero length.

       >| word
       >! word
	      Same  as	>, except that the file is truncated to zero length if
	      it exists, even if CLOBBER is unset.

       >> word
	      Open file word for writing in append mode	 as  standard  output.
	      If  the  file  does  not exist, and the CLOBBER option is unset,
	      this causes an error; otherwise, the file is created.

       >>| word
       >>! word
	      Same as >>, except that the file	is  created  if	 it  does  not
	      exist, even if CLOBBER is unset.

       <<[-] word
	      The  shell  input is read up to a line that is the same as word,
	      or to an end-of-file.  No parameter expansion, command substitu‐
	      tion or filename generation is performed on word.	 The resulting
	      document, called a here-document, becomes the standard input.

	      If any character of word is quoted with single or double	quotes
	      or a `\', no interpretation is placed upon the characters of the
	      document.	 Otherwise, parameter and command substitution occurs,
	      `\'  followed  by	 a newline is removed, and `\' must be used to
	      quote the characters `\', `$', ``' and the  first	 character  of
	      word.

	      If <<- is used, then all leading tabs are stripped from word and
	      from the document.

       <<< word
	      Perform shell expansion on word and pass the result to  standard
	      input.  This is known as a here-string.

       <& number
       >& number
	      The  standard  input/output  is  duplicated from file descriptor
	      number (see dup2(2)).

       <& -
       >& -   Close the standard input/output.

       <& p
       >& p   The input/output from/to the coprocess is moved to the  standard
	      input/output.

       >& word
       &> word
	      (Except  where `>& word' matches one of the above syntaxes; `&>'
	      can always be used to avoid  this	 ambiguity.)   Redirects  both
	      standard	output	and  standard error (file descriptor 2) in the
	      manner of `> word'.  Note that  this  does  not  have  the  same
	      effect as `> word 2>&1' in the presence of multios (see the sec‐
	      tion below).

       >&| word
       >&! word
       &>| word
       &>! word
	      Redirects both standard output and standard error (file descrip‐
	      tor 2) in the manner of `>| word'.

       >>& word
       &>> word
	      Redirects both standard output and standard error (file descrip‐
	      tor 2) in the manner of `>> word'.

       >>&| word
       >>&! word
       &>>| word
       &>>! word
	      Redirects both standard output and standard error (file descrip‐
	      tor 2) in the manner of `>>| word'.

       If  one	of  the above is preceded by a digit, then the file descriptor
       referred to is that specified by the digit instead of the default 0  or
       1.   The order in which redirections are specified is significant.  The
       shell evaluates each redirection in  terms  of  the  (file  descriptor,
       file) association at the time of evaluation.  For example:

	      ... 1>fname 2>&1

       first associates file descriptor 1 with file fname.  It then associates
       file descriptor 2 with the file associated with file descriptor 1 (that
       is,  fname).  If the order of redirections were reversed, file descrip‐
       tor 2 would be associated with the terminal (assuming file descriptor 1
       had  been)  and	then  file  descriptor 1 would be associated with file
       fname.

MULTIOS
       If the user tries to open a file descriptor for writing more than once,
       the  shell opens the file descriptor as a pipe to a process that copies
       its input to all the specified outputs, similar to  tee,	 provided  the
       MULTIOS option is set, as it is by default.  Thus:

	      date >foo >bar

       writes  the date to two files, named `foo' and `bar'.  Note that a pipe
       is an implicit redirection; thus

	      date >foo | cat

       writes the date to the file `foo', and also pipes it to cat.

       If the MULTIOS option is set, the word after a redirection operator  is
       also subjected to filename generation (globbing).  Thus

	      : > *

       will  truncate  all files in the current directory, assuming there's at
       least one.  (Without the MULTIOS option, it would create an empty  file
       called `*'.)  Similarly, you can do

	      echo exit 0 >> *.sh

       If the user tries to open a file descriptor for reading more than once,
       the shell opens the file descriptor as a pipe to a process that	copies
       all  the specified inputs to its output in the order specified, similar
       to cat, provided the MULTIOS option is set.  Thus

	      sort <foo <fubar

       or even

	      sort <f{oo,ubar}

       is equivalent to `cat foo fubar | sort'.

       Note that a pipe is an implicit redirection; thus

	      cat bar | sort <foo

       is equivalent to `cat bar foo | sort' (note the order of the inputs).

       If the MULTIOS option is unset, each redirection replaces the  previous
       redirection for that file descriptor.  However, all files redirected to
       are actually opened, so

	      echo foo > bar > baz

       when MULTIOS is unset will truncate bar, and write `foo' into baz.

REDIRECTIONS WITH NO COMMAND
       When a simple command consists of one or more redirection operators and
       zero or more parameter assignments, but no command name, zsh can behave
       in several ways.

       If the parameter NULLCMD is not set or the option CSH_NULLCMD  is  set,
       an error is caused.  This is the csh behavior and CSH_NULLCMD is set by
       default when emulating csh.

       If the option SH_NULLCMD is set, the builtin `:' is inserted as a  com‐
       mand  with  the given redirections.  This is the default when emulating
       sh or ksh.

       Otherwise, if the parameter NULLCMD is set, its value will be used as a
       command	with  the given redirections.  If both NULLCMD and READNULLCMD
       are set, then the value of the latter will be used instead of  that  of
       the  former  when the redirection is an input.  The default for NULLCMD
       is `cat' and for READNULLCMD is `more'. Thus

	      < file

       shows the contents of file on standard output, with paging if that is a
       terminal.  NULLCMD and READNULLCMD may refer to shell functions.

COMMAND EXECUTION
       If a command name contains no slashes, the shell attempts to locate it.
       If there exists a shell function by that name, the function is  invoked
       as  described  in  the  section	`Functions'.   If there exists a shell
       builtin by that name, the builtin is invoked.

       Otherwise, the shell searches each element of  $path  for  a  directory
       containing  an  executable  file by that name.  If the search is unsuc‐
       cessful, the shell prints an error message and returns a	 nonzero  exit
       status.

       If  execution  fails  because the file is not in executable format, and
       the file is not a directory, it	is  assumed  to	 be  a	shell  script.
       /bin/sh	is  spawned to execute it.  If the program is a file beginning
       with `#!', the remainder of the first line specifies an interpreter for
       the program.  The shell will execute the specified interpreter on oper‐
       ating systems that do not handle this executable format in the kernel.

FUNCTIONS
       Shell functions are defined with the function reserved word or the spe‐
       cial  syntax  `funcname	()'.   Shell  functions are read in and stored
       internally.  Alias names are resolved when the function is read.	 Func‐
       tions  are  executed  like  commands with the arguments passed as posi‐
       tional parameters.  (See the section `Command Execution'.)

       Functions execute in the same process as the caller and share all files
       and  present  working  directory	 with  the caller.  A trap on EXIT set
       inside a function is executed after the function completes in the envi‐
       ronment of the caller.

       The return builtin is used to return from function calls.

       Function	 identifiers  can be listed with the functions builtin.	 Func‐
       tions can be undefined with the unfunction builtin.

AUTOLOADING FUNCTIONS
       A function can be marked as undefined using the	autoload  builtin  (or
       `functions  -u'	or `typeset -fu').  Such a function has no body.  When
       the function is first executed, the shell searches for  its  definition
       using the elements of the fpath variable.  Thus to define functions for
       autoloading, a typical sequence is:

	      fpath=(~/myfuncs $fpath)
	      autoload myfunc1 myfunc2 ...

       The usual alias expansion during reading	 will  be  suppressed  if  the
       autoload builtin or its equivalent is given the option -U. This is rec‐
       ommended for the use of functions supplied with the  zsh	 distribution.
       Note  that  for functions precompiled with the zcompile builtin command
       the flag -U must be provided when the .zwc file is created, as the cor‐
       responding information is compiled into the latter.

       For  each  element  in fpath, the shell looks for three possible files,
       the newest of which is used to load the definition for the function:

       element.zwc
	      A file created with  the	zcompile  builtin  command,  which  is
	      expected	to  contain  the  definitions for all functions in the
	      directory named element.	The file is treated in the same manner
	      as  a  directory	containing files for functions and is searched
	      for the definition of the function.   If the definition  is  not
	      found,  the  search for a definition proceeds with the other two
	      possibilities described below.

	      If element already includes a .zwc extension (i.e. the extension
	      was  explicitly  given by the user), element is searched for the
	      definition of the function without comparing its age to that  of
	      other  files;  in	 fact, there does not need to be any directory
	      named element without the suffix.	  Thus	including  an  element
	      such as `/usr/local/funcs.zwc' in fpath will speed up the search
	      for functions, with the  disadvantage  that  functions  included
	      must  be	explicitly recompiled by hand before the shell notices
	      any changes.

       element/function.zwc
	      A file created with zcompile, which is expected to  contain  the
	      definition  for function.	 It may include other function defini‐
	      tions as well, but those are neither loaded nor executed; a file
	      found  in	 this way is searched only for the definition of func‐
	      tion.

       element/function
	      A file of zsh command text, taken to be the definition for func‐
	      tion.

       In  summary, the order of searching is, first, in the parents of direc‐
       tories in fpath for the newer of	 either	 a  compiled  directory	 or  a
       directory  in fpath; second, if more than one of these contains a defi‐
       nition for the function that is sought, the leftmost in	the  fpath  is
       chosen;	and  third, within a directory, the newer of either a compiled
       function or an ordinary function definition is used.

       If the KSH_AUTOLOAD option is set, or the file contains only  a	simple
       definition of the function, the file's contents will be executed.  This
       will normally define the function in question,  but  may	 also  perform
       initialization, which is executed in the context of the function execu‐
       tion, and may therefore define local parameters.	 It is an error if the
       function is not defined by loading the file.

       Otherwise,  the	function body (with no surrounding `funcname() {...}')
       is taken to be the complete contents of the file.  This form allows the
       file  to be used directly as an executable shell script.	 If processing
       of the file results in the  function  being  re-defined,	 the  function
       itself  is  not re-executed.  To force the shell to perform initializa‐
       tion and then call the function defined, the file should	 contain  ini‐
       tialization code (which will be executed then discarded) in addition to
       a complete function definition (which will be retained  for  subsequent
       calls to the function), and a call to the shell function, including any
       arguments, at the end.

       For example, suppose the autoload file func contains

	      func() { print This is func; }
	      print func is initialized

       then `func; func' with KSH_AUTOLOAD set will produce both  messages  on
       the  first  call, but only the message `This is func' on the second and
       subsequent calls.  Without KSH_AUTOLOAD set, it will produce  the  ini‐
       tialization  message  on	 the  first call, and the other message on the
       second and subsequent calls.

       It is also possible  to	create	a  function  that  is  not  marked  as
       autoloaded,  but	 which loads its own definition by searching fpath, by
       using `autoload -X' within a shell function.  For example, the  follow‐
       ing are equivalent:

	      myfunc() {
		autoload -X
	      }
	      myfunc args...

       and

	      unfunction myfunc	  # if myfunc was defined
	      autoload myfunc
	      myfunc args...

       In  fact,  the  functions  command outputs `builtin autoload -X' as the
       body of an autoloaded function.	A  true	 autoloaded  function  can  be
       identified  by  the  presence of the comment `# undefined' in the body,
       because all comments are discarded from	defined	 functions.   This  is
       done so that

	      eval "$(functions)"

       produces a reasonable result.

       To load the definition of an autoloaded function myfunc without execut‐
       ing myfunc, use:

	      autoload +X myfunc

SPECIAL FUNCTIONS
       The following functions, if defined, have special meaning to the shell:

       chpwd  Executed whenever the current working directory is changed.

       periodic
	      If the parameter PERIOD is set, this function is executed	 every
	      $PERIOD seconds, just before a prompt.

       precmd Executed before each prompt.

       preexec
	      Executed	just  after a command has been read and is about to be
	      executed.	 If the history mechanism is active (and the line  was
	      not discarded from the history buffer), the string that the user
	      typed is passed as the first argument, otherwise it is an	 empty
	      string.	The  actual  command  that will be executed (including
	      expanded aliases) is passed in two different forms:  the	second
	      argument	is  a single-line, size-limited version of the command
	      (with things like function bodies elided);  the  third  argument
	      contains the full text what what is being executed.

       TRAPNAL
	      If defined and non-null, this function will be executed whenever
	      the shell catches a signal SIGNAL, where NAL is a signal name as
	      specified	 for  the  kill	 builtin.   The	 signal number will be
	      passed as the first parameter to the function.

	      If a function of this form is defined and null,  the  shell  and
	      processes spawned by it will ignore SIGNAL.

       TRAPDEBUG
	      Executed after each command.

       TRAPEXIT
	      Executed	when  the  shell  exits,  or when the current function
	      exits if defined inside a function.

       TRAPZERR
	      Executed whenever a command has a non-zero  exit	status.	  How‐
	      ever,  the function is not executed if the command occurred in a
	      sublist followed by `&&' or `||'; only the final	command	 in  a
	      sublist of this type causes the trap to be executed.

       The  functions  beginning  `TRAP' may alternatively be defined with the
       trap builtin:  this may be preferable for some uses, as they  are  then
       run in the environment of the calling process, rather than in their own
       function environment.  Apart from the difference in  calling  procedure
       and  the fact that the function form appears in lists of functions, the
       forms

	      TRAPNAL() {
	       # code
	      }

       and

	      trap '
	       # code

       are equivalent.

JOBS
       If the MONITOR option is set, an interactive  shell  associates	a  job
       with  each  pipeline.  It keeps a table of current jobs, printed by the
       jobs command, and assigns them small integer numbers.  When  a  job  is
       started	asynchronously	with  `&', the shell prints a line which looks
       like:

	      [1] 1234

       indicating that the job which was started asynchronously was job number
       1 and had one (top-level) process, whose process ID was 1234.

       If  a  job  is  started with `&|' or `&!', then that job is immediately
       disowned.  After startup, it does not have a place in  the  job	table,
       and is not subject to the job control features described here.

       If  you are running a job and wish to do something else you may hit the
       key ^Z (control-Z) which sends a TSTP signal to the current job:	  this
       key  may	 be redefined by the susp option of the external stty command.
       The shell will then normally indicate  that  the	 job  has  been	 `sus‐
       pended',	 and  print another prompt.  You can then manipulate the state
       of this job, putting it in the background with the bg command,  or  run
       some  other  commands  and  then eventually bring the job back into the
       foreground with the foreground command fg.  A ^Z takes  effect  immedi‐
       ately  and is like an interrupt in that pending output and unread input
       are discarded when it is typed.

       A job being run in the background will suspend if it tries to read from
       the  terminal.  Background jobs are normally allowed to produce output,
       but this can be disabled by giving the command `stty tostop'.   If  you
       set this tty option, then background jobs will suspend when they try to
       produce output like they do when they try to read input.

       When a command is suspended and continued later with  the  fg  or  wait
       builtins,  zsh  restores tty modes that were in effect when it was sus‐
       pended.	This (intentionally) does not apply if the command is  contin‐
       ued via `kill -CONT', nor when it is continued with bg.

       There  are  several  ways  to refer to jobs in the shell.  A job can be
       referred to by the process ID of any process of the job or  by  one  of
       the following:

       %number
	      The job with the given number.
       %string
	      Any job whose command line begins with string.
       %?string
	      Any job whose command line contains string.
       %%     Current job.
       %+     Equivalent to `%%'.
       %-     Previous job.

       The shell learns immediately whenever a process changes state.  It nor‐
       mally informs you whenever a job becomes blocked	 so  that  no  further
       progress	 is possible.  If the NOTIFY option is not set, it waits until
       just before it prints a prompt before it informs you.

       When the monitor mode is on, each background job that  completes	 trig‐
       gers any trap set for CHLD.

       When  you  try  to leave the shell while jobs are running or suspended,
       you will be warned that `You have suspended (running) jobs'.   You  may
       use  the	 jobs command to see what they are.  If you do this or immedi‐
       ately try to exit again, the shell will not warn you a second time; the
       suspended  jobs will be terminated, and the running jobs will be sent a
       SIGHUP signal, if the HUP option is set.

       To avoid having the shell terminate the running jobs,  either  use  the
       nohup command (see nohup(1)) or the disown builtin.

SIGNALS
       The INT and QUIT signals for an invoked command are ignored if the com‐
       mand is followed by `&' and the MONITOR option is not  active.	Other‐
       wise,  signals  have  the values inherited by the shell from its parent
       (but see the TRAPNAL special functions in the section `Functions').

ARITHMETIC EVALUATION
       The shell can perform integer and  floating  point  arithmetic,	either
       using the builtin let, or via a substitution of the form $((...)).  For
       integers, the shell is usually compiled to use 8-byte  precision	 where
       this is available, otherwise precision is 4 bytes.  This can be tested,
       for example, by giving the command `print - $(( 12345678901 ))'; if the
       number  appears unchanged, the precision is at least 8 bytes.  Floating
       point arithmetic is always double precision.

       The let builtin command takes arithmetic expressions as arguments; each
       is  evaluated  separately.   Since many of the arithmetic operators, as
       well as spaces, require quoting, an alternative form is	provided:  for
       any command which begins with a `((', all the characters until a match‐
       ing `))' are treated as a quoted expression  and	 arithmetic  expansion
       performed  as  for  an  argument	 of let.  More precisely, `((...))' is
       equivalent to `let "..."'.  For example, the following statement

	      (( val = 2 + 1 ))

       is equivalent to

	      let "val = 2 + 1"

       both assigning the value 3 to the shell variable var  and  returning  a
       zero status.

       Integers can be in bases other than 10.	A leading `0x' or `0X' denotes
       hexadecimal.  Integers may also be of the form `base#n', where base  is
       a decimal number between two and thirty-six representing the arithmetic
       base and n is a number in that base (for example,  `16#ff'  is  255  in
       hexadecimal).   The base# may also be omitted, in which case base 10 is
       used.  For backwards compatibility the form `[base]n' is also accepted.

       It is also possible to specify a base to be used for output in the form
       `[#base]',  for	example	 `[#16]'.  This is used when outputting arith‐
       metical substitutions or when assigning to scalar  parameters,  but  an
       explicitly  defined  integer  or	 floating  point parameter will not be
       affected.  If an integer variable is implicitly defined	by  an	arith‐
       metic  expression,  any	base  specified in this way will be set as the
       variable's output arithmetic base as if the option  `-i	base'  to  the
       typeset builtin had been used.  The expression has no precedence and if
       it occurs more than once in a mathematical expression, the last encoun‐
       tered  is  used.	  For  clarity it is recommended that it appear at the
       beginning of an expression.  As an example:

	      typeset -i 16 y
	      print $(( [#8] x = 32, y = 32 ))
	      print $x $y

       outputs first `8#40', the rightmost value in the given output base, and
       then  `8#40 16#20', because y has been explicitly declared to have out‐
       put base 16, while x (assuming it does not already exist) is implicitly
       typed  by  the arithmetic evaluation, where it acquires the output base
       8.

       When an output base is specified using the `[#base]' syntax, an	appro‐
       priate  base prefix will be output if necessary, so that the value out‐
       put is valid syntax for input.	If  the	 #  is	doubled,  for  example
       `[##16]', then no base prefix is output.

       Floating	 point	constants  are recognized by the presence of a decimal
       point or an exponent.  The decimal point may be the first character  of
       the  constant, but the exponent character e or E may not, as it will be
       taken for a parameter name.

       An arithmetic expression uses nearly the same syntax,  precedence,  and
       associativity  of  expressions  in C.  The following operators are sup‐
       ported (listed in decreasing order of precedence):

       + - ! ~ ++ --
	      unary plus/minus, logical NOT, complement, {pre,post}{in,de}cre‐
	      ment
       << >>  bitwise shift left, right
       &      bitwise AND
       ^      bitwise XOR
       |      bitwise OR
       **     exponentiation
       * / %  multiplication, division, modulus (remainder)
       + -    addition, subtraction
       < > <= >=
	      comparison
       == !=  equality and inequality
       &&     logical AND
       || ^^  logical OR, XOR
       ? :    ternary operator
       = += -= *= /= %= &= ^= |= <<= >>= &&= ||= ^^= **=
	      assignment
       ,      comma operator

       The  operators  `&&',  `||', `&&=', and `||=' are short-circuiting, and
       only one of the latter two expressions in a ternary operator is	evalu‐
       ated.  Note the precedence of the bitwise AND, OR, and XOR operators.

       Mathematical  functions	can  be	 called	 with the syntax `func(args)',
       where the function decides if the  args	is  used  as  a	 string	 or  a
       comma-separated	list  of  arithmetic  expressions. The shell currently
       defines no mathematical functions by default, but the module  zsh/math‐
       func may be loaded with the zmodload builtin to provide standard float‐
       ing point mathematical functions.

       An expression of the form `##x' where x is any character sequence  such
       as  `a', `^A', or `\M-\C-x' gives the ASCII value of this character and
       an expression of the form `#foo' gives the ASCII	 value	of  the	 first
       character of the value of the parameter foo.  Note that this is differ‐
       ent from the expression	`$#foo',  a  standard  parameter  substitution
       which  gives the length of the parameter foo.  `#\' is accepted instead
       of `##', but its use is deprecated.

       Named parameters and subscripted	 arrays	 can  be  referenced  by  name
       within  an  arithmetic expression without using the parameter expansion
       syntax.	For example,

	      ((val2 = val1 * 2))

       assigns twice the value of $val1 to the parameter named val2.

       An internal integer representation of a named parameter can  be	speci‐
       fied  with  the integer builtin.	 Arithmetic evaluation is performed on
       the value of each assignment to a named parameter declared  integer  in
       this  manner.   Assigning a floating point number to an integer results
       in rounding down to the next integer.

       Likewise, floating  point  numbers  can	be  declared  with  the	 float
       builtin; there are two types, differing only in their output format, as
       described for the typeset builtin.  The output format can  be  bypassed
       by using arithmetic substitution instead of the parameter substitution,
       i.e. `${float}' uses  the  defined  format,  but	 `$((float))'  uses  a
       generic floating point format.

       Promotion of integer to floating point values is performed where neces‐
       sary.  In addition, if any operator which  requires  an	integer	 (`~',
       `&',  `|',  `^', `%', `<<', `>>' and their equivalents with assignment)
       is given a floating point argument, it will be silently rounded down to
       the next integer.

       Scalar variables can hold integer or floating point values at different
       times; there is no memory of the numeric type in this case.

       If a variable is first assigned in a numeric context without previously
       being  declared,	 it  will  be implicitly typed as integer or float and
       retain that type either until the type is explicitly changed  or	 until
       the  end	 of  the  scope.   This can have unforeseen consequences.  For
       example, in the loop

	      for (( f = 0; f < 1; f += 0.1 )); do
	      # use $f
	      done

       if f has not already been declared, the first assignment will cause  it
       to  be created as an integer, and consequently the operation `f += 0.1'
       will always cause the result to be truncated to zero, so that the  loop
       will  fail.  A simple fix would be to turn the initialization into `f =
       0.0'.  It is therefore best to declare numeric variables with  explicit
       types.

CONDITIONAL EXPRESSIONS
       A  conditional  expression is used with the [[ compound command to test
       attributes of files and to compare strings.   Each  expression  can  be
       constructed  from  one or more of the following unary or binary expres‐
       sions:

       -a file
	      true if file exists.

       -b file
	      true if file exists and is a block special file.

       -c file
	      true if file exists and is a character special file.

       -d file
	      true if file exists and is a directory.

       -e file
	      true if file exists.

       -f file
	      true if file exists and is a regular file.

       -g file
	      true if file exists and has its setgid bit set.

       -h file
	      true if file exists and is a symbolic link.

       -k file
	      true if file exists and has its sticky bit set.

       -n string
	      true if length of string is non-zero.

       -o option
	      true if option named option is on.  option may be a single char‐
	      acter,  in  which	 case it is a single letter option name.  (See
	      the section `Specifying Options'.)

       -p file
	      true if file exists and is a FIFO special file (named pipe).

       -r file
	      true if file exists and is readable by current process.

       -s file
	      true if file exists and has size greater than zero.

       -t fd  true if file descriptor number fd is open and associated with  a
	      terminal device.	(note: fd is not optional)

       -u file
	      true if file exists and has its setuid bit set.

       -w file
	      true if file exists and is writable by current process.

       -x file
	      true  if	file  exists and is executable by current process.  If
	      file exists and is a directory, then  the	 current  process  has
	      permission to search in the directory.

       -z string
	      true if length of string is zero.

       -L file
	      true if file exists and is a symbolic link.

       -O file
	      true  if	file  exists  and is owned by the effective user ID of
	      this process.

       -G file
	      true if file exists and its group matches the effective group ID
	      of this process.

       -S file
	      true if file exists and is a socket.

       -N file
	      true  if	file  exists and its access time is not newer than its
	      modification time.

       file1 -nt file2
	      true if file1 exists and is newer than file2.

       file1 -ot file2
	      true if file1 exists and is older than file2.

       file1 -ef file2
	      true if file1 and file2 exist and refer to the same file.

       string = pattern
       string == pattern
	      true if string matches pattern.  The `==' form is the  preferred
	      one.   The  `=' form is for backward compatibility and should be
	      considered obsolete.

       string != pattern
	      true if string does not match pattern.

       string1 < string2
	      true if string1 comes before string2 based  on  ASCII  value  of
	      their characters.

       string1 > string2
	      true  if	string1	 comes	after  string2 based on ASCII value of
	      their characters.

       exp1 -eq exp2
	      true if exp1 is numerically equal to exp2.

       exp1 -ne exp2
	      true if exp1 is numerically not equal to exp2.

       exp1 -lt exp2
	      true if exp1 is numerically less than exp2.

       exp1 -gt exp2
	      true if exp1 is numerically greater than exp2.

       exp1 -le exp2
	      true if exp1 is numerically less than or equal to exp2.

       exp1 -ge exp2
	      true if exp1 is numerically greater than or equal to exp2.

       ( exp )
	      true if exp is true.

       ! exp  true if exp is false.

       exp1 && exp2
	      true if exp1 and exp2 are both true.

       exp1 || exp2
	      true if either exp1 or exp2 is true.

       Normal shell expansion is performed on the  file,  string  and  pattern
       arguments, but the result of each expansion is constrained to be a sin‐
       gle word, similar to the effect of  double  quotes.   However,  pattern
       metacharacters  are  active for the pattern arguments; the patterns are
       the same as those used for filename  generation,	 see  zshexpn(1),  but
       there  is  no  special  behaviour  of `/' nor initial dots, and no glob
       qualifiers are allowed.

       In each of the above expressions, if file is of the  form  `/dev/fd/n',
       where  n	 is  an	 integer, then the test applied to the open file whose
       descriptor number is n, even if the underlying system does not  support
       the /dev/fd directory.

       In  the	forms which do numeric comparison, the expressions exp undergo
       arithmetic expansion as if they were enclosed in $((...)).

       For example, the following:

	      [[ ( -f foo || -f bar ) && $report = y* ]] && print File exists.

       tests if either file foo or file bar exists, and if so, if the value of
       the  parameter  report  begins  with  `y'; if the complete condition is
       true, the message `File exists.' is printed.

PROMPT EXPANSION
       Prompt sequences undergo a special form of  expansion.	This  type  of
       expansion is also available using the -P option to the print builtin.

       If the PROMPT_SUBST option is set, the prompt string is first subjected
       to parameter expansion, command substitution and arithmetic  expansion.
       See zshexpn(1).

       Certain escape sequences may be recognised in the prompt string.

       If  the	PROMPT_BANG  option is set, a `!' in the prompt is replaced by
       the current history event number.  A literal `!'	 may  then  be	repre‐
       sented as `!!'.

       If  the	PROMPT_PERCENT	option	is  set, certain escape sequences that
       start with `%' are expanded.  Some escapes  take	 an  optional  integer
       argument, which should appear between the `%' and the next character of
       the sequence.  The following escape sequences are recognized:

       %%     A `%'.

       %)     A `)'.

       %d
       %/     Present working directory ($PWD).	 If  an	 integer  follows  the
	      `%',  it	specifies  a  number of trailing components of $PWD to
	      show; zero means the whole path.	A negative  integer  specifies
	      leading components, i.e. %-1d specifies the first component.

       %~     As  %d  and %/, but if $PWD has a named directory as its prefix,
	      that part is replaced by a `~'  followed	by  the	 name  of  the
	      directory.   If it starts with $HOME, that part is replaced by a
	      `~'.

       %h
       %!     Current history event number.

       %L     The current value of $SHLVL.

       %M     The full machine hostname.

       %m     The hostname up to the first `.'.	 An integer may follow the `%'
	      to  specify  how	many  components  of the hostname are desired.
	      With a negative integer, trailing components of the hostname are
	      shown.

       %S (%s)
	      Start (stop) standout mode.

       %U (%u)
	      Start (stop) underline mode.

       %B (%b)
	      Start (stop) boldface mode.

       %t
       %@     Current time of day, in 12-hour, am/pm format.

       %T     Current time of day, in 24-hour format.

       %*     Current time of day in 24-hour format, with seconds.

       %n     $USERNAME.

       %N     The name of the script, sourced file, or shell function that zsh
	      is currently executing, whichever was started most recently.  If
	      there is none, this is equivalent to the parameter $0.  An inte‐
	      ger may follow the `%' to specify a number of trailing path com‐
	      ponents  to  show; zero means the full path.  A negative integer
	      specifies leading components.

       %i     The line number currently being executed in the script,  sourced
	      file,  or	 shell	function given by %N.  This is most useful for
	      debugging as part of $PS4.

       %w     The date in day-dd format.

       %W     The date in mm/dd/yy format.

       %D     The date in yy-mm-dd format.

       %D{string}
	      string is formatted using	 the  strftime	function.   See	 strf‐
	      time(3) for more details.	 Three additional codes are available:
	      %f prints the day of the month, like %e but without any  preced‐
	      ing  space if the day is a single digit, and %K/%L correspond to
	      %k/%l for the hour of the day (24/12 hour	 clock)	 in  the  same
	      way.

       %l     The  line	 (tty)	the user is logged in on without /dev/ prefix.
	      If name starts with /dev/tty this is stripped.

       %y     The line (tty) the user is logged in on  without	/dev/  prefix.
	      It does not treat /dev/tty* specially.

       %?     The  return  code	 of  the last command executed just before the
	      prompt.

       %_     The status of the parser, i.e. the shell constructs  (like  `if'
	      and  `for') that have been started on the command line. If given
	      an integer number that many strings will	be  printed;  zero  or
	      negative	or  no integer means print as many as there are.  This
	      is most useful in prompts PS2 for continuation lines and PS4 for
	      debugging	 with  the  XTRACE  option; in the latter case it will
	      also work non-interactively.

       %E     Clears to end of line.

       %#     A `#' if the shell is running with privileges,  a	 `%'  if  not.
	      Equivalent  to `%(!.#.%%)'.  The definition of `privileged', for
	      these purposes, is that either the effective user	 ID  is	 zero,
	      or,  if  POSIX.1e	 capabilities are supported, that at least one
	      capability is raised in  either  the  Effective  or  Inheritable
	      capability vectors.

       %v     The  value  of  the  first element of the psvar array parameter.
	      Following the `%' with an integer	 gives	that  element  of  the
	      array.  Negative integers count from the end of the array.

       %{...%}
	      Include  a  string  as  a	 literal  escape sequence.  The string
	      within the braces should not change the cursor position.	 Brace
	      pairs can nest.

       %(x.true-text.false-text)
	      Specifies	 a  ternary expression.	 The character following the x
	      is arbitrary; the same character is used to  separate  the  text
	      for  the	`true'	result from that for the `false' result.  This
	      separator may not appear in the true-text, except as part	 of  a
	      %-escape	sequence.  A `)' may appear in the false-text as `%)'.
	      true-text and false-text	may  both  contain  arbitrarily-nested
	      escape sequences, including further ternary expressions.

	      The  left	 parenthesis may be preceded or followed by a positive
	      integer n, which defaults to zero.  A negative integer  will  be
	      multiplied  by  -1.  The test character x may be any of the fol‐
	      lowing:

	      c
	      .
	      ~	     True if the current path, with prefix replacement, has at
		     least n elements.
	      /
	      C	     True  if  the  current  absolute path has at least n ele‐
		     ments.
	      t	     True if the time in minutes is equal to n.
	      T	     True if the time in hours is equal to n.
	      d	     True if the day of the month is equal to n.
	      D	     True if the month is equal to n (January = 0).
	      w	     True if the day of the week is equal to n (Sunday = 0).
	      ?	     True if the exit status of the last command was n.
	      #	     True if the effective uid of the current process is n.
	      g	     True if the effective gid of the current process is n.
	      l	     True if at least n characters have already	 been  printed
		     on the current line.
	      L	     True if the SHLVL parameter is at least n.
	      S	     True if the SECONDS parameter is at least n.
	      v	     True if the array psvar has at least n elements.
	      _	     True if at least n shell constructs were started.
	      !	     True if the shell is running with privileges.

       %<string<
       %>string>
       %[xstring]
	      Specifies	 truncation  behaviour for the remainder of the prompt
	      string.	The  third,  deprecated,   form	  is   equivalent   to
	      `%xstringx',  i.e.  x  may be `<' or `>'.	 The numeric argument,
	      which in the third form may appear immediately  after  the  `[',
	      specifies	 the  maximum  permitted length of the various strings
	      that can be displayed in the prompt.  The string	will  be  dis‐
	      played  in  place	 of  the truncated portion of any string; note
	      this does not undergo prompt expansion.

	      The forms with `<' truncate at the left of the string,  and  the
	      forms  with  `>' truncate at the right of the string.  For exam‐
	      ple, if  the  current  directory	is  `/home/pike',  the	prompt
	      `%8<..<%/'  will expand to `..e/pike'.  In this string, the ter‐
	      minating character (`<', `>' or `]'), or in fact any  character,
	      may be quoted by a preceding `\'; note when using print -P, how‐
	      ever, that this must be doubled as the string is also subject to
	      standard	print  processing,  in	addition  to  any  backslashes
	      removed by a double quoted string:  the worst case is  therefore
	      `print -P "%<\\\\<<..."'.

	      If the string is longer than the specified truncation length, it
	      will appear in full, completely replacing the truncated string.

	      The part of the prompt string to be truncated runs to the end of
	      the  string,  or	to  the end of the next enclosing group of the
	      `%(' construct, or to the next  truncation  encountered  at  the
	      same  grouping  level  (i.e. truncations inside a `%(' are sepa‐
	      rate), which ever comes first.  In particular, a truncation with
	      argument	zero  (e.g.  `%<<')  marks the end of the range of the
	      string to be truncated while turning off truncation  from	 there
	      on.  For	example,  the  prompt  '%10<...<%~%<<%# ' will print a
	      truncated representation of the current directory, followed by a
	      `%'  or  `#', followed by a space.  Without the `%<<', those two
	      characters would be included in the string to be truncated.

       %c
       %.
       %C     Trailing component of $PWD.  An integer may follow  the  `%'  to
	      get  more	 than  one component.  Unless `%C' is used, tilde con‐
	      traction is performed first.  These are deprecated as %c and  %C
	      are equivalent to %1~ and %1/, respectively, while explicit pos‐
	      itive integers have the  same  effect  as	 for  the  latter  two
	      sequences.

ZSHEXPN(1)							    ZSHEXPN(1)

NAME
       zshexpn - zsh expansion and substitution

DESCRIPTION
       The  following types of expansions are performed in the indicated order
       in five steps:

       History Expansion
	      This is performed only in interactive shells.

       Alias Expansion
	      Aliases are expanded immediately	before	the  command  line  is
	      parsed as explained under Aliasing in zshmisc(1).

       Process Substitution
       Parameter Expansion
       Command Substitution
       Arithmetic Expansion
       Brace Expansion
	      These  five  are performed in one step in left-to-right fashion.
	      After these expansions, all unquoted occurrences of the  charac‐
	      ters `\', `'' and `"' are removed.

       Filename Expansion
	      If  the  SH_FILE_EXPANSION option is set, the order of expansion
	      is modified for compatibility with sh and	 ksh.	In  that  case
	      filename	expansion  is performed immediately after alias expan‐
	      sion, preceding the set of five expansions mentioned above.

       Filename Generation
	      This expansion, commonly referred to as globbing, is always done
	      last.

       The following sections explain the types of expansion in detail.

HISTORY EXPANSION
       History	expansion  allows you to use words from previous command lines
       in the command line you are typing.  This simplifies  spelling  correc‐
       tions and the repetition of complicated commands or arguments.  Immedi‐
       ately before execution, each command is saved in the history list,  the
       size  of	 which	is controlled by the HISTSIZE parameter.  The one most
       recent command is always retained in any case.  Each saved  command  in
       the  history  list  is called a history event and is assigned a number,
       beginning with 1 (one) when the shell starts up.	  The  history	number
       that you may see in your prompt (see Prompt Expansion in zshmisc(1)) is
       the number that is to be assigned to the next command.

   Overview
       A history expansion begins with the first character  of	the  histchars
       parameter,  which is `!' by default, and may occur anywhere on the com‐
       mand line; history expansions do not nest.  The `!' can be escaped with
       `\' or can be enclosed between a pair of single quotes ('') to suppress
       its special meaning.  Double quotes will not work for this.   Following
       this history character is an optional event designator (see the section
       `Event Designators') and then an optional word designator (the  section
       `Word  Designators');  if  neither  of these designators is present, no
       history expansion occurs.

       Input lines  containing	history	 expansions  are  echoed  after	 being
       expanded,  but  before  any  other expansions take place and before the
       command is executed.  It is this expanded form that is recorded as  the
       history event for later references.

       By  default, a history reference with no event designator refers to the
       same event as any preceding history reference on that command line;  if
       it  is the only history reference in a command, it refers to the previ‐
       ous command.  However, if the option CSH_JUNKIE_HISTORY	is  set,  then
       every  history  reference  with no event specification always refers to
       the previous command.

       For example, `!' is the event designator for the previous  command,  so
       `!!:1'  always  refers  to  the first word of the previous command, and
       `!!$' always refers to the last word of	the  previous  command.	  With
       CSH_JUNKIE_HISTORY set, then `!:1' and `!$' function in the same manner
       as `!!:1' and `!!$', respectively.  Conversely,	if  CSH_JUNKIE_HISTORY
       is  unset,  then	 `!:1'	and  `!$'  refer  to the first and last words,
       respectively, of the same event referenced by the nearest other history
       reference  preceding them on the current command line, or to the previ‐
       ous command if there is no preceding reference.

       The character sequence `^foo^bar' (where `^'  is	 actually  the	second
       character of the histchars parameter) repeats the last command, replac‐
       ing the string foo with bar.  More precisely, the sequence  `^foo^bar^'
       is synonymous with `!!:s^foo^bar^', hence other modifiers (see the sec‐
       tion `Modifiers') may follow the final `^'.

       If the shell encounters the character sequence `!"'  in the input,  the
       history	mechanism  is temporarily disabled until the current list (see
       zshmisc(1)) is fully parsed.  The `!"' is removed from the  input,  and
       any subsequent `!' characters have no special significance.

       A  less convenient but more comprehensible form of command history sup‐
       port is provided by the fc builtin.

   Event Designators
       An event designator is a reference to a command-line entry in the  his‐
       tory  list.   In	 the list below, remember that the initial `!' in each
       item may be changed to  another	character  by  setting	the  histchars
       parameter.

       !      Start a history expansion, except when followed by a blank, new‐
	      line, `=' or `('.	 If followed immediately by a word  designator
	      (see  the section `Word Designators'), this forms a history ref‐
	      erence with no event designator (see the section `Overview').

       !!     Refer to	the  previous  command.	  By  itself,  this  expansion
	      repeats the previous command.

       !n     Refer to command-line n.

       !-n    Refer to the current command-line minus n.

       !str   Refer to the most recent command starting with str.

       !?str[?]
	      Refer  to	 the most recent command containing str.  The trailing
	      `?' is necessary if this reference is to be followed by a	 modi‐
	      fier  or	followed by any text that is not to be considered part
	      of str.

       !#     Refer to the current command line typed in so far.  The line  is
	      treated  as  if  it  were	 complete up to and including the word
	      before the one with the `!#' reference.

       !{...} Insulate a history reference from adjacent characters (if neces‐
	      sary).

   Word Designators
       A word designator indicates which word or words of a given command line
       are to be included in a history reference.  A `:' usually separates the
       event  specification  from the word designator.	It may be omitted only
       if the word designator begins with a `^', `$', `*', `-' or  `%'.	  Word
       designators include:

       0      The first input word (command).
       n      The nth argument.
       ^      The first argument.  That is, 1.
       $      The last argument.
       %      The word matched by (the most recent) ?str search.
       x-y    A range of words; x defaults to 0.
       *      All the arguments, or a null value if there are none.
       x*     Abbreviates `x-$'.
       x-     Like `x*' but omitting word $.

       Note  that  a  `%' word designator works only when used in one of `!%',
       `!:%' or `!?str?:%', and only when used after a !? expansion  (possibly
       in  an  earlier	command).  Anything else results in an error, although
       the error may not be the most obvious one.

   Modifiers
       After the optional word designator, you can add a sequence  of  one  or
       more  of	 the following modifiers, each preceded by a `:'.  These modi‐
       fiers also work on the result  of  filename  generation	and  parameter
       expansion, except where noted.

       h      Remove  a	 trailing  pathname component, leaving the head.  This
	      works like `dirname'.

       r      Remove a filename extension of the form `.xxx', leaving the root
	      name.

       e      Remove all but the extension.

       t      Remove  all leading pathname components, leaving the tail.  This
	      works like `basename'.

       p      Print the new command but do not execute it.   Only  works  with
	      history expansion.

       q      Quote  the  substituted  words,  escaping further substitutions.
	      Works with history expansion and parameter expansion, though for
	      parameters  it  is  only	useful	if the resulting text is to be
	      re-evaluated such as by eval.

       Q      Remove one level of quotes from the substituted words.

       x      Like q, but break into words at whitespace.  Does not work  with
	      parameter expansion.

       l      Convert the words to all lowercase.

       u      Convert the words to all uppercase.

       s/l/r[/]
	      Substitute  r for l as described below.  Unless preceded immedi‐
	      ately by a g, with no colon between, the	substitution  is  done
	      only  for	 the  first string that matches l.  For arrays and for
	      filename generation, this applies to each word of	 the  expanded
	      text.

       &      Repeat  the  previous  s	substitution.  Like s, may be preceded
	      immediately by a g.  In parameter expansion the  &  must	appear
	      inside braces, and in filename generation it must be quoted with
	      a backslash.

       The s/l/r/ substitution works as follows.  The left-hand side  of  sub‐
       stitutions  are	not  regular  expressions, but character strings.  Any
       character can be used as the delimiter in place of  `/'.	  A  backslash
       quotes	the   delimiter	  character.	The   character	 `&',  in  the
       right-hand-side r, is replaced by the text from the  left-hand-side  l.
       The  `&'	 can  be  quoted with a backslash.  A null l uses the previous
       string either from the previous l or from the contextual scan string  s
       from  `!?s'.  You can omit the rightmost delimiter if a newline immedi‐
       ately follows r; the rightmost `?' in a context scan can	 similarly  be
       omitted.	 Note the same record of the last l and r is maintained across
       all forms of expansion.

       The following f, F, w and W modifiers work only with  parameter	expan‐
       sion and filename generation.  They are listed here to provide a single
       point of reference for all modifiers.

       f      Repeats the immediately (without	a  colon)  following  modifier
	      until the resulting word doesn't change any more.

       F:expr:
	      Like  f,	but repeats only n times if the expression expr evalu‐
	      ates to n.  Any character can be used instead  of	 the  `:';  if
	      `(',  `[',  or `{' is used as the opening delimiter, the closing
	      delimiter should be ')', `]', or `}', respectively.

       w      Makes the immediately following modifier work on	each  word  in
	      the string.

       W:sep: Like  w  but  words are considered to be the parts of the string
	      that are separated by sep. Any character can be used instead  of
	      the `:'; opening parentheses are handled specially, see above.

PROCESS SUBSTITUTION
       Each  command argument of the form `<(list)', `>(list)' or `=(list)' is
       subject to process substitution.	 In the case of the < or > forms,  the
       shell  runs  process  list  asynchronously.  If the system supports the
       /dev/fd mechanism, the command argument is the name of the device  file
       corresponding  to  a file descriptor; otherwise, if the system supports
       named pipes (FIFOs), the command argument will be a named pipe.	If the
       form  with > is selected then writing on this special file will provide
       input for list.	If < is used, then the file passed as an argument will
       be connected to the output of the list process.	For example,

	      paste <(cut -f1 file1) <(cut -f3 file2) |
	      tee >(process1) >(process2) >/dev/null

       cuts fields 1 and 3 from the files file1 and file2 respectively, pastes
       the results together, and  sends	 it  to	 the  processes	 process1  and
       process2.

       Both  the /dev/fd and the named pipe implementation have drawbacks.  In
       the former case, some  programmes  may  automatically  close  the  file
       descriptor  in  question before examining the file on the command line,
       particularly if this is necessary for security reasons such as when the
       programme is running setuid.  In the second case, if the programme does
       not actually open the file, the subshell attempting  to	read  from  or
       write  to the pipe will (in a typical implementation, different operat‐
       ing systems may have different behaviour) block for ever and have to be
       killed  explicitly.   In	 both  cases,  the shell actually supplies the
       information using a pipe, so that programmes that expect to lseek  (see
       lseek(2)) on the file will not work.

       Also  note  that	 the  previous example can be more compactly and effi‐
       ciently written (provided the MULTIOS option is set) as:

	      paste <(cut -f1 file1) <(cut -f3 file2) \
	      > >(process1) > >(process2)

       The shell uses pipes instead of	FIFOs  to  implement  the  latter  two
       process substitutions in the above example.

       If = is used, then the file passed as an argument will be the name of a
       temporary file containing the output of the list process.  This may  be
       used  instead  of  the  < form for a program that expects to lseek (see
       lseek(2)) on the input file.

PARAMETER EXPANSION
       The character `$' is used to introduce parameter expansions.  See  zsh‐
       param(1) for a description of parameters, including arrays, associative
       arrays, and subscript notation to access individual array elements.

       In the expansions discussed below that require a pattern, the  form  of
       the  pattern  is the same as that used for filename generation; see the
       section `Filename Generation'.  Note that these	patterns,  along  with
       the  replacement	 text  of any substitutions, are themselves subject to
       parameter expansion, command substitution,  and	arithmetic  expansion.
       In  addition to the following operations, the colon modifiers described
       in the section `Modifiers' in the section `History  Expansion'  can  be
       applied:	  for example, ${i:s/foo/bar/} performs string substitution on
       the expansion of parameter $i.

       ${name}
	      The value, if any, of the parameter name	is  substituted.   The
	      braces are required if the expansion is to be followed by a let‐
	      ter, digit, or underscore that is not to be interpreted as  part
	      of  name.	  In  addition, more complicated forms of substitution
	      usually require the braces to be present; exceptions, which only
	      apply  if	 the  option  KSH_ARRAYS is not set, are a single sub‐
	      script or any colon modifiers appearing after the name,  or  any
	      of the characters `^', `=', `~', `#' or `+' appearing before the
	      name, all of which work with or without braces.

	      If name is an array parameter, and the KSH_ARRAYS option is  not
	      set,  then the value of each element of name is substituted, one
	      element per word.	 Otherwise, the expansion results in one  word
	      only;  with  KSH_ARRAYS,	this is the first element of an array.
	      No  field	 splitting  is	done  on   the	 result	  unless   the
	      SH_WORD_SPLIT option is set.

       ${+name}
	      If  name is the name of a set parameter `1' is substituted, oth‐
	      erwise `0' is substituted.

       ${name:-word}
	      If name is set and is non-null then substitute its value; other‐
	      wise substitute word. If name is missing, substitute word.

       ${name:=word}
       ${name::=word}
	      In  the  first  form, if name is unset or is null then set it to
	      word; in the second form, unconditionally set name to word.   In
	      both forms, the value of the parameter is then substituted.

       ${name:?word}
	      If name is set and is non-null then substitute its value; other‐
	      wise, print word and exit from the  shell.   Interactive	shells
	      instead  return to the prompt.  If word is omitted, then a stan‐
	      dard message is printed.

       ${name:+word}
	      If name is set and is non-null then substitute  word;  otherwise
	      substitute nothing.

       If  the colon is omitted from one of the above expressions containing a
       colon, then the shell only checks whether name is set, not whether  its
       value is null.

       In  the	following expressions, when name is an array and the substitu‐
       tion is not quoted, or if the `(@)' flag or the name[@] syntax is used,
       matching and replacement is performed on each array element separately.

       ${name#pattern}
       ${name##pattern}
	      If  the pattern matches the beginning of the value of name, then
	      substitute the value of name with the matched  portion  deleted;
	      otherwise,  just	substitute  the	 value	of name.  In the first
	      form, the smallest matching pattern is preferred; in the	second
	      form, the largest matching pattern is preferred.

       ${name%pattern}
       ${name%%pattern}
	      If  the  pattern matches the end of the value of name, then sub‐
	      stitute the value of name with the matched portion deleted; oth‐
	      erwise,  just  substitute the value of name.  In the first form,
	      the smallest matching pattern is preferred; in the second	 form,
	      the largest matching pattern is preferred.

       ${name:#pattern}
	      If  the  pattern	matches the value of name, then substitute the
	      empty string; otherwise, just substitute the value of name.   If
	      name  is	an  array the matching array elements are removed (use
	      the `(M)' flag to remove the non-matched elements).

       ${name/pattern/repl}
       ${name//pattern/repl}
	      Replace the longest possible match of pattern in	the  expansion
	      of  parameter name by string repl.  The first form replaces just
	      the first occurrence, the second	form  all  occurrences.	  Both
	      pattern  and  repl are subject to double-quoted substitution, so
	      that expressions like ${name/$opat/$npat} will  work,  but  note
	      the  usual rule that pattern characters in $opat are not treated
	      specially unless either the option GLOB_SUBST is set,  or	 $opat
	      is instead substituted as ${~opat}.

	      The pattern may begin with a `#', in which case the pattern must
	      match at the start of the string, or `%', in which case it  must
	      match  at	 the  end  of  the  string.   The repl may be an empty
	      string, in which case the final `/' may  also  be	 omitted.   To
	      quote  the final `/' in other cases it should be preceded by two
	      backslashes (i.e., a quoted backslash); this is not necessary if
	      the  `/'	occurs inside a substituted parameter.	Note also that
	      the `#' and `%' are not active if they occur  inside  a  substi‐
	      tuted parameter, even at the start.

	      The  first `/' may be preceded by a `:', in which case the match
	      will only succeed if it matches the entire word.	Note also  the
	      effect  of the I and S parameter expansion flags below; however,
	      the flags M, R, B, E and N are not useful.

	      For example,

		     foo="twinkle twinkle little star" sub="t*e" rep="spy"
		     print ${foo//${~sub}/$rep}
		     print ${(S)foo//${~sub}/$rep}

	      Here, the `~' ensures that the text of $sub is treated as a pat‐
	      tern rather than a plain string.	In the first case, the longest
	      match for t*e is substituted and the result is `spy star', while
	      in  the  second  case,  the  shortest  matches are taken and the
	      result is `spy spy lispy star'.

       ${#spec}
	      If spec is one of the above substitutions, substitute the length
	      in  characters  of  the result instead of the result itself.  If
	      spec is an array expression, substitute the number  of  elements
	      of  the result.  Note that `^', `=', and `~', below, must appear
	      to the left of `#' when these forms are combined.

       ${^spec}
	      Turn on the RC_EXPAND_PARAM option for the evaluation  of	 spec;
	      if  the  `^'  is doubled, turn it off.  When this option is set,
	      array expansions of the form foo${xx}bar, where the parameter xx
	      is  set  to  (a  b  c),  are  substituted	 with `fooabar foobbar
	      foocbar' instead of the default `fooa b cbar'.

	      Internally, each such expansion is converted into the equivalent
	      list    for    brace    expansion.     E.g.,   ${^var}   becomes
	      {$var[1],$var[2],...}, and is processed as described in the sec‐
	      tion  `Brace  Expansion'	below.	 If  word splitting is also in
	      effect the $var[N] may themselves be split into  different  list
	      elements.

       ${=spec}
	      Perform  word splitting using the rules for SH_WORD_SPLIT during
	      the evaluation of spec, but regardless of whether the  parameter
	      appears  in  double  quotes; if the `=' is doubled, turn it off.
	      This forces parameter expansions to be split into separate words
	      before  substitution, using IFS as a delimiter.  This is done by
	      default in most other shells.

	      Note that splitting is applied to word in the  assignment	 forms
	      of  spec	before	the  assignment	 to  name  is performed.  This
	      affects the result of array assignments with the A flag.

       ${~spec}
	      Turn on the GLOB_SUBST option for the evaluation of spec; if the
	      `~'  is  doubled,	 turn  it  off.	  When this option is set, the
	      string resulting from the expansion will	be  interpreted	 as  a
	      pattern anywhere that is possible, such as in filename expansion
	      and filename generation and pattern-matching contexts  like  the
	      right hand side of the `=' and `!=' operators in conditions.

       If  a ${...} type parameter expression or a $(...) type command substi‐
       tution is used in place of name above, it is  expanded  first  and  the
       result is used as if it were the value of name.	Thus it is possible to
       perform nested operations:  ${${foo#head}%tail} substitutes  the	 value
       of  $foo	 with both `head' and `tail' deleted.  The form with $(...) is
       often useful in combination with the  flags  described  next;  see  the
       examples	 below.	  Each	name or nested ${...} in a parameter expansion
       may also be followed by a subscript expression as  described  in	 Array
       Parameters in zshparam(1).

       Note  that double quotes may appear around nested expressions, in which
       case  only  the	part  inside  is  treated  as  quoted;	for   example,
       ${(f)"$(foo)"}  quotes  the  result  of $(foo), but the flag `(f)' (see
       below) is applied using the rules for unquoted expansions.   Note  fur‐
       ther that quotes are themselves nested in this context; for example, in
       "${(@f)"$(foo)"}", there are two sets of quotes,	 one  surrounding  the
       whole  expression,  the	other  (redundant)  surrounding	 the $(foo) as
       before.

   Parameter Expansion Flags
       If the opening brace is directly followed by  an	 opening  parenthesis,
       the  string  up	to the matching closing parenthesis will be taken as a
       list of flags.  In cases where repeating a flag is meaningful, the rep‐
       etitions need not be consecutive; for example, `(q%q%q)' means the same
       thing as the more readable `(%%qqq)'.  The  following  flags  are  sup‐
       ported:

       %      Expand  all  % escapes in the resulting words in the same way as
	      in in prompts (see the section `Prompt Expansion'). If this flag
	      is  given	 twice, full prompt expansion is done on the resulting
	      words,  depending	 on  the  setting   of	 the   PROMPT_PERCENT,
	      PROMPT_SUBST and PROMPT_BANG options.

       @      In  double  quotes,  array elements are put into separate words.
	      E.g.,  `"${(@)foo}"'  is	 equivalent   to   `"${foo[@]}"'   and
	      `"${(@)foo[1,2]}"'  is  the same as `"$foo[1]" "$foo[2]"'.  This
	      is distinct from field splitting by the the f,  s	 or  z	flags,
	      which still applies within each array element.

       A      Create  an  array	 parameter with `${...=...}', `${...:=...}' or
	      `${...::=...}'.  If this flag is repeated (as in	`AA'),	create
	      an associative array parameter.  Assignment is made before sort‐
	      ing or padding.  The name part may be a  subscripted  range  for
	      ordinary	arrays;	 the  word part must be converted to an array,
	      for example by using `${(AA)=name=...}' to activate field split‐
	      ting, when creating an associative array.

       c      With ${#name}, count the total number of characters in an array,
	      as if the elements were concatenated with spaces between them.

       C      Capitalize the resulting words.  `Words' in this case refers  to
	      sequences	 of  alphanumeric characters separated by non-alphanu‐
	      merics, not to words that result from field splitting.

       e      Perform parameter expansion, command substitution and arithmetic
	      expansion	 on  the result. Such expansions can be nested but too
	      deep recursion may have unpredictable effects.

       f      Split the result of the expansion to lines. This is a  shorthand
	      for `ps:\n:'.

       F      Join  the words of arrays together using newline as a separator.
	      This is a shorthand for `pj:\n:'.

       i      With o or O, sort case-independently.

       k      If name refers to an  associative	 array,	 substitute  the  keys
	      (element	names)	rather	than the values of the elements.  Used
	      with subscripts (including ordinary arrays),  force  indices  or
	      keys to be substituted even if the subscript form refers to val‐
	      ues.  However, this flag may  not	 be  combined  with  subscript
	      ranges.

       L      Convert all letters in the result to lower case.

       o      Sort the resulting words in ascending order.

       O      Sort the resulting words in descending order.

       P      This forces the value of the parameter name to be interpreted as
	      a further parameter name, whose value will be used where	appro‐
	      priate. If used with a nested parameter or command substitution,
	      the result of that will be taken as a parameter name in the same
	      way.   For  example,  if	you  have `foo=bar' and `bar=baz', the
	      strings ${(P)foo}, ${(P)${foo}}, and ${(P)$(echo bar)}  will  be
	      expanded to `baz'.

       q      Quote  the  resulting  words  with  backslashes. If this flag is
	      given twice, the resulting words are quoted in single quotes and
	      if  it  is  given	 three	times,	the words are quoted in double
	      quotes. If it is given four times, the words are quoted in  sin‐
	      gle quotes preceded by a $.

       Q      Remove one level of quotes from the resulting words.

       t      Use  a  string  describing  the  type of the parameter where the
	      value of the parameter would usually appear.  This  string  con‐
	      sists  of keywords separated by hyphens (`-'). The first keyword
	      in the string  describes	the  main  type,  it  can  be  one  of
	      `scalar',	 `array',  `integer',  `float'	or  `association'. The
	      other keywords describe the type in more detail:

	      local  for local parameters

	      left   for left justified parameters

	      right_blanks
		     for right justified parameters with leading blanks

	      right_zeros
		     for right justified parameters with leading zeros

	      lower  for parameters whose value is converted to all lower case
		     when it is expanded

	      upper  for parameters whose value is converted to all upper case
		     when it is expanded

	      readonly
		     for readonly parameters

	      tag    for tagged parameters

	      export for exported parameters

	      unique for arrays which keep only the first occurrence of dupli‐
		     cated values

	      hide   for parameters with the `hide' flag

	      special
		     for special parameters defined by the shell

       U      Convert all letters in the result to upper case.

       v      Used  with k, substitute (as two consecutive words) both the key
	      and the value of each associative array element.	Used with sub‐
	      scripts,	force  values  to be substituted even if the subscript
	      form refers to indices or keys.

       V      Make any special characters in the resulting words visible.

       w      With ${#name}, count words in arrays or strings; the s flag  may
	      be used to set a word delimiter.

       W      Similar  to  w  with  the	 difference  that  empty words between
	      repeated delimiters are also counted.

       X      With this flag parsing errors occurring with the Q and  e	 flags
	      or  the  pattern	matching  forms	 such as `${name#pattern}' are
	      reported. Without the flag they are silently ignored.

       z      Split the result of the expansion into words using shell parsing
	      to  find	the words, i.e. taking into account any quoting in the
	      value.

	      Note that this is done very late, as for the `(s)' flag.	So  to
	      access  single words in the result, one has to use nested expan‐
	      sions as in `${${(z)foo}[2]}'. Likewise, to remove the quotes in
	      the resulting words one would do: `${(Q)${(z)foo}}'.

       The following flags (except p) are followed by one or more arguments as
       shown.  Any character, or the matching pairs `(...)', `{...}', `[...]',
       or  `<...>',  may  be  used in place of a colon as delimiters, but note
       that when a flag takes more than one argument, a matched pair of delim‐
       iters must surround each argument.

       p      Recognize	 the  same  escape  sequences  as the print builtin in
	      string arguments to any of the flags described below.

       j:string:
	      Join the words of arrays together using string as	 a  separator.
	      Note   that   this   occurs   before   field  splitting  by  the
	      SH_WORD_SPLIT option.

       l:expr::string1::string2:
	      Pad the resulting words on the left.  Each word  will  be	 trun‐
	      cated  if	 required  and placed in a field expr characters wide.
	      The space to the left will be filled with string1	 (concatenated
	      as  often as needed) or spaces if string1 is not given.  If both
	      string1 and string2 are given,  this  string  is	inserted  once
	      directly to the left of each word, before padding.

       r:expr::string1::string2:
	      As  l,  but pad the words on the right and insert string2 on the
	      right.

       s:string:
	      Force field splitting (see the option SH_WORD_SPLIT) at the sep‐
	      arator  string.	Note  that  a string of two or more characters
	      means all must all match in  sequence;  this  differs  from  the
	      treatment of two or more characters in the IFS parameter.

       The  following  flags  are meaningful with the ${...#...} or ${...%...}
       forms.  The S and I flags may also be used with the ${.../...} forms.

       S      Search substrings as well as beginnings or ends;	with  #	 start
	      from  the beginning and with % start from the end of the string.
	      With  substitution  via  ${.../...}  or  ${...//...},  specifies
	      non-greedy matching, i.e. that the shortest instead of the long‐
	      est match should be replaced.

       I:expr:
	      Search the exprth match (where  expr  evaluates  to  a  number).
	      This only applies when searching for substrings, either with the
	      S flag, or with ${.../...} (only the  exprth  match  is  substi‐
	      tuted)  or  ${...//...} (all matches from the exprth on are sub‐
	      stituted).  The default is to take the first match.

	      The exprth match is counted such that there  is  either  one  or
	      zero matches from each starting position in the string, although
	      for global substitution matches  overlapping  previous  replace‐
	      ments  are  ignored.  With the ${...%...} and ${...%%...} forms,
	      the starting position for the match moves backwards from the end
	      as the index increases, while with the other forms it moves for‐
	      ward from the start.

	      Hence with the string
		     which switch is the right switch for Ipswich?
	      substitutions of the form ${(SI:N:)string#w*ch} as  N  increases
	      from  1  will  match  and	 remove	 `which', `witch', `witch' and
	      `wich'; the form using `##' will match and remove `which	switch
	      is the right switch for Ipswich', `witch is the right switch for
	      Ipswich', `witch for Ipswich' and `wich'.	 The  form  using  `%'
	      will  remove  the same matches as for `#', but in reverse order,
	      and the form using `%%' will remove the same matches as for `##'
	      in reverse order.

       B      Include the index of the beginning of the match in the result.

       E      Include the index of the end of the match in the result.

       M      Include the matched portion in the result.

       N      Include the length of the match in the result.

       R      Include the unmatched portion in the result (the Rest).

   Rules
       Here  is	 a  summary  of	 the rules for substitution; this assumes that
       braces are present around the substitution, i.e. ${...}.	 Some particu‐
       lar  examples  are  given  below.   Note that the Zsh Development Group
       accepts no responsibility for any brain damage which may	 occur	during
       the reading of the following rules.

       1. Nested Substitution
	      If  multiple  nested  ${...}  forms are present, substitution is
	      performed from the inside outwards.  At each level, the  substi‐
	      tution takes account of whether the current value is a scalar or
	      an array, whether the whole substitution is  in  double  quotes,
	      and  what	 flags	are supplied to the current level of substitu‐
	      tion, just as if the nested  substitution	 were  the  outermost.
	      The  flags are not propagated up to enclosing substitutions; the
	      nested substitution will return either a scalar or an  array  as
	      determined by the flags, possibly adjusted for quoting.  All the
	      following steps take place where applicable  at  all  levels  of
	      substitution.   Note that, unless the `(P)' flag is present, the
	      flags and any subscripts apply directly  to  the	value  of  the
	      nested   substitution;  for  example,  the  expansion  ${${foo}}
	      behaves exactly the same as ${foo}.

       2. Parameter Subscripting
	      If the value is a raw parameter reference with a subscript, such
	      as  ${var[3]}, the effect of subscripting is applied directly to
	      the parameter.  Subscripts are evaluated left to	right;	subse‐
	      quent  subscripts	 apply to the scalar or array value yielded by
	      the previous subscript.  Thus if var is an  array,  ${var[1][2]}
	      is the second character of the first word, but ${var[2,4][2]} is
	      the entire third word (the second word of the range of words two
	      through  four  of the original array).  Any number of subscripts
	      may appear.

       3. Parameter Name Replacement
	      The effect of any (P) flag, which treats the value so far	 as  a
	      parameter	 name and replaces it with the corresponding value, is
	      applied.

       4. Double-Quoted Joining
	      If the value after this process is an array, and	the  substitu‐
	      tion appears in double quotes, and no (@) flag is present at the
	      current level, the words of the value are joined with the	 first
	      character	 of  the  parameter  $IFS, by default a space, between
	      each word (single word arrays are not  modified).	  If  the  (j)
	      flag is present, that is used for joining instead of $IFS.

       5. Nested Subscripting
	      Any  remaining  subscripts  (i.e.	 of a nested substitution) are
	      evaluated at this point, based on whether the value is an	 array
	      or  a scalar.  As with 2., multiple subscripts can appear.  Note
	      that ${foo[2,4][2]} is thus equivalent to ${${foo[2,4]}[2]}  and
	      also  to "${${(@)foo[2,4]}[2]}" (the nested substitution returns
	      an array in both cases), but  not	 to  "${${foo[2,4]}[2]}"  (the
	      nested substitution returns a scalar because of the quotes).

       6. Modifiers
	      Any  modifiers, as specified by a trailing `#', `%', `/' (possi‐
	      bly doubled) or by a set of modifiers of the form :... (see  the
	      section  `Modifiers'  in	the  section `History Expansion'), are
	      applied to the words of the value at this level.

       7. Forced Joining
	      If the `(j)' flag is present, or no `(j)' flag  is  present  but
	      the  string is to be split as given by rules 8. or 9., and join‐
	      ing did not take place at step 4., any words in  the  value  are
	      joined together using the given string or the first character of
	      $IFS if none.  Note that the `(F)' flag  implicitly  supplies  a
	      string for joining in this manner.

       8. Forced Splitting
	      If  one  of  the `(s)', `(f)' or `(z)' flags are present, or the
	      `=' specifier was present (e.g. ${=var}), the word is  split  on
	      occurrences  of  the specified string, or (for = with neither of
	      the two flags present) any of the characters in $IFS.

       9. Shell Word Splitting
	      If no `(s)', `(f)' or `=' was given, but the word is not	quoted
	      and the option SH_WORD_SPLIT is set, the word is split on occur‐
	      rences of any of the characters in $IFS.	Note this  step,  too,
	      takes place at all levels of a nested substitution.

       10. Re-Evaluation
	      Any  `(e)'  flag	is  applied  to	 the  value,  forcing it to be
	      re-examined for new parameter substitutions, but also  for  com‐
	      mand and arithmetic substitutions.

       11. Padding
	      Any padding of the value by the `(l.fill.)' or `(r.fill.)' flags
	      is applied.

       12. Semantic Joining
	      In contexts where expansion semantics requires a single word  to
	      result,  all  words are rejoined with the first character of IFS
	      between.	So in `${(P)${(f)lines}}' the  value  of  ${lines}  is
	      split  at	 newlines,  but then must be joined again before the P
	      flag can be applied.

	      If a single word is not required, this rule is skipped.

   Examples
       The flag f is useful to split  a	 double-quoted	substitution  line  by
       line.   For  example, ${(f)"$(<file)"} substitutes the contents of file
       divided so that each line is an element of the resulting	 array.	  Com‐
       pare  this with the effect of $(<file) alone, which divides the file up
       by words, or the same inside double quotes, which makes the entire con‐
       tent of the file a single string.

       The  following  illustrates  the rules for nested parameter expansions.
       Suppose that $foo contains the array (bar baz):

       "${(@)${foo}[1]}"
	      This produces the	 result	 b.   First,  the  inner  substitution
	      "${foo}",	 which	has  no array (@) flag, produces a single word
	      result "bar baz".	 The outer substitution "${(@)...[1]}" detects
	      that this is a scalar, so that (despite the `(@)' flag) the sub‐
	      script picks the first character.

       "${${(@)foo}[1]}"
	      This produces the result `bar'.  In this case, the inner substi‐
	      tution  "${(@)foo}"  produces  the array `(bar baz)'.  The outer
	      substitution "${...[1]}" detects that this is an array and picks
	      the first word.  This is similar to the simple case "${foo[1]}".

       As an example of the rules for word splitting and joining, suppose $foo
       contains the array `(ax1 bx1)'.	Then

       ${(s/x/)foo}
	      produces the words `a', `1 b' and `1'.

       ${(j/x/s/x/)foo}
	      produces `a', `1', `b' and `1'.

       ${(s/x/)foo%%1*}
	      produces `a' and ` b' (note the extra space).   As  substitution
	      occurs  before either joining or splitting, the operation	 first
	      generates the modified array (ax bx), which is  joined  to  give
	      "ax  bx",	 and  then  split to give `a', ` b' and `'.  The final
	      empty string will then be elided, as it is not in double quotes.

COMMAND SUBSTITUTION
       A command enclosed in parentheses  preceded  by	a  dollar  sign,  like
       `$(...)',  or quoted with grave accents, like ``...`', is replaced with
       its standard output, with any trailing newlines deleted.	 If  the  sub‐
       stitution  is  not enclosed in double quotes, the output is broken into
       words using the IFS parameter.  The substitution `$(cat	foo)'  may  be
       replaced	 by  the  equivalent but faster `$(<foo)'.  In either case, if
       the option GLOB_SUBST is set, the output is eligible for filename  gen‐
       eration.

ARITHMETIC EXPANSION
       A  string  of  the  form `$[exp]' or `$((exp))' is substituted with the
       value of the arithmetic expression exp.	exp is subjected to  parameter
       expansion,  command  substitution and arithmetic expansion before it is
       evaluated.  See the section `Arithmetic Evaluation'.

BRACE EXPANSION
       A string of the form `foo{xx,yy,zz}bar' is expanded to  the  individual
       words  `fooxxbar',  `fooyybar'  and `foozzbar'.	Left-to-right order is
       preserved.  This construct may be nested.   Commas  may	be  quoted  in
       order to include them literally in a word.

       An  expression of the form `{n1..n2}', where n1 and n2 are integers, is
       expanded to every number between n1 and n2 inclusive.  If either number
       begins with a zero, all the resulting numbers will be padded with lead‐
       ing zeroes to that minimum width.  If the  numbers  are	in  decreasing
       order the resulting sequence will also be in decreasing order.

       If  a  brace  expression	 matches  none	of the above forms, it is left
       unchanged, unless the BRACE_CCL option is set.  In  that	 case,	it  is
       expanded	 to  a	sorted	list  of the individual characters between the
       braces, in the manner of a search set.  `-' is treated specially as  in
       a  search  set,	but  `^' or `!' as the first character is treated nor‐
       mally.

       Note that brace expansion is not part  of  filename  generation	(glob‐
       bing);  an  expression  such  as */{foo,bar} is split into two separate
       words */foo and */bar before filename generation takes place.  In  par‐
       ticular,	 note  that  this  is  liable to produce a `no match' error if
       either of the two expressions does not match; this is to be  contrasted
       with  */(foo|bar),  which  is treated as a single pattern but otherwise
       has similar effects.

FILENAME EXPANSION
       Each word is checked to see if it begins with an unquoted `~'.	If  it
       does,  then the word up to a `/', or the end of the word if there is no
       `/', is checked to see if it can be substituted	in  one	 of  the  ways
       described  here.	  If  so,  then	 the  `~'  and the checked portion are
       replaced with the appropriate substitute value.

       A `~' by itself is replaced by the value of $HOME.  A `~' followed by a
       `+' or a `-' is replaced by the value of $PWD or $OLDPWD, respectively.

       A  `~'  followed by a number is replaced by the directory at that posi‐
       tion in the directory stack.  `~0' is equivalent to `~+', and  `~1'  is
       the  top	 of  the  stack.  `~+' followed by a number is replaced by the
       directory at that position in the directory stack.  `~+0' is equivalent
       to  `~+', and `~+1' is the top of the stack.  `~-' followed by a number
       is replaced by the directory that many positions from the bottom of the
       stack.	`~-0'  is  the	bottom	of  the stack.	The PUSHD_MINUS option
       exchanges the effects of `~+' and `~-' where they  are  followed	 by  a
       number.

       A  `~' followed by anything not already covered is looked up as a named
       directory, and replaced by the value of that named directory if	found.
       Named  directories are typically home directories for users on the sys‐
       tem.  They may also be defined if the text after the `~' is the name of
       a  string  shell	 parameter  whose value begins with a `/'.  It is also
       possible to define directory names using the  -d	 option	 to  the  hash
       builtin.

       In  certain  circumstances  (in	prompts, for instance), when the shell
       prints a path, the path is checked to see if it has a  named  directory
       as  its	prefix.	 If so, then the prefix portion is replaced with a `~'
       followed by the name of the directory.  The shortest way	 of  referring
       to  the	directory is used, with ties broken in favour of using a named
       directory, except when the directory is / itself.  The parameters  $PWD
       and $OLDPWD are never abbreviated in this fashion.

       If a word begins with an unquoted `=' and the EQUALS option is set, the
       remainder of the word is taken as the name of a command or alias.  If a
       command	exists by that name, the word is replaced by the full pathname
       of the command.	If an alias exists by that name, the word is  replaced
       with the text of the alias.

       Filename	 expansion  is performed on the right hand side of a parameter
       assignment, including those appearing after  commands  of  the  typeset
       family.	 In  this  case,  the  right  hand  side  will be treated as a
       colon-separated list in the manner of the PATH parameter, so that a `~'
       or  an  `=' following a `:' is eligible for expansion.  All such behav‐
       iour can be disabled by quoting the `~', the `=', or the whole  expres‐
       sion (but not simply the colon); the EQUALS option is also respected.

       If  the option MAGIC_EQUAL_SUBST is set, any unquoted shell argument in
       the form `identifier=expression' becomes eligible for file expansion as
       described  in  the  previous  paragraph.	  Quoting  the	first `=' also
       inhibits this.

FILENAME GENERATION
       If a word contains an unquoted instance of one of the  characters  `*',
       `(',  `|',  `<',	 `[', or `?', it is regarded as a pattern for filename
       generation, unless the GLOB option  is  unset.	If  the	 EXTENDED_GLOB
       option is set, the `^' and `#' characters also denote a pattern; other‐
       wise they are not treated specially by the shell.

       The word is replaced with a list of sorted  filenames  that  match  the
       pattern.	  If  no  matching  pattern is found, the shell gives an error
       message, unless the NULL_GLOB option is set, in which case the word  is
       deleted;	 or unless the NOMATCH option is unset, in which case the word
       is left unchanged.

       In filename generation, the character `/' must be  matched  explicitly;
       also, a `.' must be matched explicitly at the beginning of a pattern or
       after a `/', unless the GLOB_DOTS option is set.	 No  filename  genera‐
       tion pattern matches the files `.' or `..'.  In other instances of pat‐
       tern matching, the `/' and `.' are not treated specially.

   Glob Operators
       *      Matches any string, including the null string.

       ?      Matches any character.

       [...]  Matches any of the enclosed characters.	Ranges	of  characters
	      can  be  specified by separating two characters by a `-'.	 A `-'
	      or `]' may be matched by including it as the first character  in
	      the  list.   There are also several named classes of characters,
	      in the form `[:name:]' with the following meanings:  `[:alnum:]'
	      alphanumeric,  `[:alpha:]' alphabetic, `[:blank:]' space or tab,
	      `[:cntrl:]'  control  character,	`[:digit:]'   decimal	digit,
	      `[:graph:]'  printable  character except whitespace, `[:lower:]'
	      lowercase letter, `[:print:]' printable  character,  `[:punct:]'
	      printable	  character   neither	alphanumeric  nor  whitespace,
	      `[:space:]' whitespace character, `[:upper:]' uppercase  letter,
	      `[:xdigit:]'  hexadecimal	 digit.	 These use the macros provided
	      by the operating system to test for the given character combina‐
	      tions,  including	 any  modifications due to local language set‐
	      tings:  see ctype(3).  Note that the square brackets  are	 addi‐
	      tional  to  those	 enclosing  the whole set of characters, so to
	      test for a single alphanumeric character you need `[[:alnum:]]'.
	      Named  character	sets  can  be used alongside other types, e.g.
	      `[[:alpha:]0-9]'.

       [^...]
       [!...] Like [...], except that it matches any character which is not in
	      the given set.

       <[x]-[y]>
	      Matches  any  number  in the range x to y, inclusive.  Either of
	      the numbers may be omitted to make the range  open-ended;	 hence
	      `<->' matches any number.	 To match individual digits, the [...]
	      form is more efficient.

	      Be careful when using other wildcards adjacent  to  patterns  of
	      this  form;  for	example, <0-9>* will actually match any number
	      whatsoever at the start of the string, since  the	 `<0-9>'  will
	      match  the first digit, and the `*' will match any others.  This
	      is a trap for the unwary, but is in fact	an  inevitable	conse‐
	      quence  of  the rule that the longest possible match always suc‐
	      ceeds.  Expressions such as  `<0-9>[^[:digit:]]*'	 can  be  used
	      instead.

       (...)  Matches  the  enclosed  pattern.	This is used for grouping.  If
	      the KSH_GLOB option is set, then a `@', `*',  `+',  `?'  or  `!'
	      immediately  preceding the `(' is treated specially, as detailed
	      below. The option SH_GLOB prevents bare parentheses  from	 being
	      used in this way, though the KSH_GLOB option is still available.

	      Note  that  grouping cannot extend over multiple directories: it
	      is an error to have a `/' within a group (this only applies  for
	      patterns	used in filename generation).  There is one exception:
	      a group of the form (pat/)# appearing as a complete path segment
	      can match a sequence of directories.  For example, foo/(a*/)#bar
	      matches foo/bar, foo/any/bar, foo/any/anyother/bar, and so on.

       x|y    Matches either x or y.  This operator has lower precedence  than
	      any  other.   The	 `|'  character must be within parentheses, to
	      avoid interpretation as a pipeline.

       ^x     (Requires EXTENDED_GLOB to be set.)  Matches anything except the
	      pattern x.  This has a higher precedence than `/', so `^foo/bar'
	      will search directories in `.' except `./foo' for a  file	 named
	      `bar'.

       x~y    (Requires EXTENDED_GLOB to be set.)  Match anything that matches
	      the pattern x but does not match y.  This has  lower  precedence
	      than  any	 operator except `|', so `*/*~foo/bar' will search for
	      all files in all directories in `.'  and then exclude  `foo/bar'
	      if there was such a match.  Multiple patterns can be excluded by
	      `foo~bar~baz'.  In the exclusion pattern (y), `/'	 and  `.'  are
	      not treated specially the way they usually are in globbing.

       x#     (Requires EXTENDED_GLOB to be set.)  Matches zero or more occur‐
	      rences of the pattern x.	This  operator	has  high  precedence;
	      `12#'  is	 equivalent to `1(2#)', rather than `(12)#'.  It is an
	      error for an unquoted `#' to follow something  which  cannot  be
	      repeated;	 this includes an empty string, a pattern already fol‐
	      lowed by `##', or parentheses when part of  a  KSH_GLOB  pattern
	      (for  example,  `!(foo)#'	 is  invalid  and  must be replaced by
	      `*(!(foo))').

       x##    (Requires EXTENDED_GLOB to be set.)  Matches one or more	occur‐
	      rences  of  the  pattern	x.  This operator has high precedence;
	      `12##' is equivalent to `1(2##)', rather than `(12)##'.  No more
	      than two active `#' characters may appear together.

   ksh-like Glob Operators
       If  the KSH_GLOB option is set, the effects of parentheses can be modi‐
       fied by a preceding `@', `*', `+', `?' or `!'.  This character need not
       be unquoted to have special effects, but the `(' must be.

       @(...) Match the pattern in the parentheses.  (Like `(...)'.)

       *(...) Match any number of occurrences.	(Like `(...)#'.)

       +(...) Match at least one occurrence.  (Like `(...)##'.)

       ?(...) Match zero or one occurrence.  (Like `(|...)'.)

       !(...) Match   anything	but  the  expression  in  parentheses.	 (Like
	      `(^(...))'.)

   Precedence
       The precedence of the operators given above is (highest) `^', `/', `~',
       `|'  (lowest);  the remaining operators are simply treated from left to
       right as part of a string, with `#' and `##' applying to	 the  shortest
       possible	 preceding unit (i.e. a character, `?', `[...]', `<...>', or a
       parenthesised expression).  As mentioned above, a `/' used as a	direc‐
       tory  separator	may not appear inside parentheses, while a `|' must do
       so; in patterns used in other contexts than  filename  generation  (for
       example,	 in  case statements and tests within `[[...]]'), a `/' is not
       special; and `/' is also not special  after  a  `~'  appearing  outside
       parentheses in a filename pattern.

   Globbing Flags
       There  are various flags which affect any text to their right up to the
       end of the enclosing group or to the end of the pattern;	 they  require
       the  EXTENDED_GLOB  option. All take the form (#X) where X may have one
       of the following forms:

       i      Case insensitive:	 upper or lower case characters in the pattern
	      match upper or lower case characters.

       l      Lower  case  characters in the pattern match upper or lower case
	      characters; upper case characters	 in  the  pattern  still  only
	      match upper case characters.

       I      Case  sensitive:	locally negates the effect of i or l from that
	      point on.

       b      Activate backreferences for parenthesised groups in the pattern;
	      this  does not work in filename generation.  When a pattern with
	      a set of active parentheses is matched, the strings  matched  by
	      the  groups  are	stored in the array $match, the indices of the
	      beginning of the matched parentheses in the array	 $mbegin,  and
	      the  indices  of the end in the array $mend, with the first ele‐
	      ment of each array  corresponding	 to  the  first	 parenthesised
	      group, and so on.	 These arrays are not otherwise special to the
	      shell.  The indices use the same convention  as  does  parameter
	      substitution,  so that elements of $mend and $mbegin may be used
	      in subscripts; the KSH_ARRAYS  option  is	 respected.   Sets  of
	      globbing flags are not considered parenthesised groups; only the
	      first nine active parentheses can be referenced.

	      For example,

		     foo="a string with a message"
		     if [[ $foo = (a|an)' '(#b)(*)' '* ]]; then
		       print ${foo[$mbegin[1],$mend[1]]}
		     fi

	      prints `string with a'.  Note  that  the	first  parenthesis  is
	      before the (#b) and does not create a backreference.

	      Backreferences  work  with  all  forms of pattern matching other
	      than filename generation, but note that when performing  matches
	      on  an  entire array, such as ${array#pattern}, or a global sub‐
	      stitution, such as ${param//pat/repl}, only  the	data  for  the
	      last  match  remains  available.	In the case of global replace‐
	      ments this may still be useful.  See the example for the m  flag
	      below.

	      The  numbering  of  backreferences strictly follows the order of
	      the opening parentheses  from  left  to  right  in  the  pattern
	      string,  although	 sets of parentheses may be nested.  There are
	      special rules for parentheses followed by `#' or `##'.  Only the
	      last match of the parenthesis is remembered: for example, in `[[
	      abab =  (#b)([ab])#  ]]',	 only  the  final  `b'	is  stored  in
	      match[1].	  Thus extra parentheses may be necessary to match the
	      complete segment: for example, use  `X((ab|cd)#)Y'  to  match  a
	      whole  string  of either `ab' or `cd' between `X' and `Y', using
	      the value of $match[1] rather than $match[2].

	      If the match fails none of the parameters is altered, so in some
	      cases  it	 may  be  necessary to initialise them beforehand.  If
	      some of the backreferences fail to match ---  which  happens  if
	      they are in an alternate branch which fails to match, or if they
	      are followed by # and matched zero times ---  then  the  matched
	      string is set to the empty string, and the start and end indices
	      are set to -1.

	      Pattern matching with backreferences  is	slightly  slower  than
	      without.

       B      Deactivate  backreferences,  negating  the  effect of the b flag
	      from that point on.

       m      Set references to the match data for the entire string  matched;
	      this is similar to backreferencing and does not work in filename
	      generation.  The flag must be in effect at the end of  the  pat‐
	      tern, i.e. not local to a group. The parameters $MATCH,  $MBEGIN
	      and $MEND will be set to the string matched and to  the  indices
	      of  the  beginning and end of the string, respectively.  This is
	      most useful in parameter substitutions, as otherwise the	string
	      matched is obvious.

	      For example,

		     arr=(veldt jynx grimps waqf zho buck)
		     print ${arr//(#m)[aeiou]/${(U)MATCH}}

	      forces  all the matches (i.e. all vowels) into uppercase, print‐
	      ing `vEldt jynx grImps wAqf zhO bUck'.

	      Unlike backreferences, there is no speed penalty for using match
	      references,  other than the extra substitutions required for the
	      replacement strings in cases such as the example shown.

       M      Deactivate the m flag, hence no references to match data will be
	      created.

       anum   Approximate  matching:  num  errors  are	allowed	 in the string
	      matched by the pattern.  The rules for this are described in the
	      next subsection.

       s, e   Unlike the other flags, these have only a local effect, and each
	      must appear on its own:  `(#s)' and `(#e)' are  the  only	 valid
	      forms.   The  `(#s)' flag succeeds only at the start of the test
	      string, and the `(#e)' flag succeeds only at the end of the test
	      string;  they  correspond	 to  `^'  and  `$' in standard regular
	      expressions.  They are useful for matching path segments in pat‐
	      terns  other  than those in filename generation (where path seg‐
	      ments  are  in  any  case	 treated  separately).	 For  example,
	      `*((#s)|/)test((#e)|/)*' matches a path segment `test' in any of
	      the  following  strings:	 test,	 test/at/start,	  at/end/test,
	      in/test/middle.

	      Another	use   is   in	parameter  substitution;  for  example
	      `${array/(#s)A*Z(#e)}' will remove only  elements	 of  an	 array
	      which match the complete pattern `A*Z'.  There are other ways of
	      performing many operations of this type, however the combination
	      of  the substitution operations `/' and `//' with the `(#s)' and
	      `(#e)' flags provides a single simple and memorable method.

	      Note that assertions of the form `(^(#s))' also work, i.e. match
	      anywhere	except at the start of the string, although this actu‐
	      ally means `anything except a zero-length portion at  the	 start
	      of  the  string';	 you  need  to	use  `(""~(#s))'  to  match  a
	      zero-length portion of the string not at the start.

       For example, the test string  fooxx  can	 be  matched  by  the  pattern
       (#i)FOOXX,  but	not  by	 (#l)FOOXX, (#i)FOO(#I)XX or ((#i)FOOX)X.  The
       string (#ia2)readme specifies case-insensitive matching of readme  with
       up to two errors.

       When  using the ksh syntax for grouping both KSH_GLOB and EXTENDED_GLOB
       must be set and the left parenthesis should be  preceded	 by  @.	  Note
       also that the flags do not affect letters inside [...] groups, in other
       words (#i)[a-z] still matches only lowercase  letters.	Finally,  note
       that when examining whole paths case-insensitively every directory must
       be searched for all files which match, so that a pattern	 of  the  form
       (#i)/foo/bar/... is potentially slow.

   Approximate Matching
       When  matching  approximately,  the  shell  keeps a count of the errors
       found, which cannot exceed the number specified in the  (#anum)	flags.
       Four types of error are recognised:

       1.     Different characters, as in fooxbar and fooybar.

       2.     Transposition of characters, as in banana and abnana.

       3.     A	 character  missing  in the target string, as with the pattern
	      road and target string rod.

       4.     An extra character appearing in the target string, as with stove
	      and strove.

       Thus,  the pattern (#a3)abcd matches dcba, with the errors occurring by
       using the first rule twice and the second once, grouping the string  as
       [d][cb][a] and [a][bc][d].

       Non-literal  parts of the pattern must match exactly, including charac‐
       ters in character ranges: hence (#a1)???	  matches  strings  of	length
       four,  by  applying  rule  4  to	 an empty part of the pattern, but not
       strings of length two, since all the ? must  match.   Other  characters
       which  must  match  exactly  are	 initial dots in filenames (unless the
       GLOB_DOTS option is set), and all slashes in filenames, so that a/bc is
       two errors from ab/c (the slash cannot be transposed with another char‐
       acter).	Similarly, errors are counted  separately  for	non-contiguous
       strings in the pattern, so that (ab|cd)ef is two errors from aebf.

       When  using  exclusion  via  the	 ~  operator,  approximate matching is
       treated entirely separately for the excluded part and must be activated
       separately.  Thus, (#a1)README~READ_ME matches READ.ME but not READ_ME,
       as the trailing READ_ME is  matched  without  approximation.   However,
       (#a1)README~(#a1)READ_ME does not match any pattern of the form READ?ME
       as all such forms are now excluded.

       Apart from exclusions, there is only one overall error count;  however,
       the  maximum  errors  allowed  may  be altered locally, and this can be
       delimited by grouping.  For example, (#a1)cat((#a0)dog)fox  allows  one
       error in total, which may not occur in the dog section, and the pattern
       (#a1)cat(#a0)dog(#a1)fox is equivalent.	Note that the point  at	 which
       an  error is first found is the crucial one for establishing whether to
       use  approximation;  for	 example,  (#a1)abc(#a0)xyz  will  not	 match
       abcdxyz,	 because  the  error occurs at the `x', where approximation is
       turned off.

       Entire  path  segments  may   be	  matched   approximately,   so	  that
       `(#a1)/foo/d/is/available/at/the/bar' allows one error in any path seg‐
       ment.  This is much less efficient than	without	 the  (#a1),  however,
       since  every  directory	in  the	 path  must  be scanned for a possible
       approximate match.  It is best to place the (#a1) after any  path  seg‐
       ments which are known to be correct.

   Recursive Globbing
       A pathname component of the form `(foo/)#' matches a path consisting of
       zero or more directories matching the pattern foo.

       As a shorthand, `**/' is equivalent to `(*/)#'; note that  this	there‐
       fore  matches files in the current directory as well as subdirectories.
       Thus:

	      ls (*/)#bar

       or

	      ls **/bar

       does a recursive directory search for files  named  `bar'  (potentially
       including the file `bar' in the current directory).  This form does not
       follow symbolic links; the alternative form `***/' does, but is	other‐
       wise  identical.	  Neither of these can be combined with other forms of
       globbing within the same path segment; in that case, the `*'  operators
       revert to their usual effect.

   Glob Qualifiers
       Patterns	 used  for filename generation may end in a list of qualifiers
       enclosed in parentheses.	 The qualifiers specify which  filenames  that
       otherwise  match	 the  given  pattern  will be inserted in the argument
       list.

       If the option BARE_GLOB_QUAL is set, then a trailing set of parentheses
       containing  no `|' or `(' characters (or `~' if it is special) is taken
       as a set of glob qualifiers.  A glob subexpression that would  normally
       be  taken  as  glob qualifiers, for example `(^x)', can be forced to be
       treated as part of the glob pattern by  doubling	 the  parentheses,  in
       this case producing `((^x))'.

       A qualifier may be any one of the following:

       /      directories

       .      plain files

       @      symbolic links

       =      sockets

       p      named pipes (FIFOs)

       *      executable plain files (0100)

       %      device files (character or block special)

       %b     block special files

       %c     character special files

       r      owner-readable files (0400)

       w      owner-writable files (0200)

       x      owner-executable files (0100)

       A      group-readable files (0040)

       I      group-writable files (0020)

       E      group-executable files (0010)

       R      world-readable files (0004)

       W      world-writable files (0002)

       X      world-executable files (0001)

       s      setuid files (04000)

       S      setgid files (02000)

       t      files with the sticky bit (01000)

       fspec  files with access rights matching spec. This spec may be a octal
	      number optionally preceded by a `=', a `+', or a `-'. If none of
	      these  characters is given, the behavior is the same as for `='.
	      The octal number describes the mode bits to be expected, if com‐
	      bined  with  a  `=',  the	 value given must match the file-modes
	      exactly, with a `+', at least the bits in the given number  must
	      be set in the file-modes, and with a `-', the bits in the number
	      must not be set. Giving a `?' instead of a octal digit  anywhere
	      in  the  number  ensures	that  the  corresponding  bits	in the
	      file-modes are not checked, this is only useful  in  combination
	      with `='.

	      If the qualifier `f' is followed by any other character anything
	      up to the next matching character (`[', `{', and `<' match  `]',
	      `}',  and	 `>' respectively, any other character matches itself)
	      is taken as a list of comma-separated sub-specs.	Each  sub-spec
	      may be either a octal number as described above or a list of any
	      of the characters `u', `g', `o', and `a', followed by a  `=',  a
	      `+',  or a `-', followed by a list of any of the characters `r',
	      `w', `x', `s', and `t', or a octal  digit.  The  first  list  of
	      characters  specify  which access rights are to be checked. If a
	      `u' is given, those for the owner of the file are used, if a `g'
	      is  given,  those	 of the group are checked, a `o' means to test
	      those of other users, and the `a' says to test all three groups.
	      The `=', `+', and `-' again says how the modes are to be checked
	      and have the same meaning as described for the first form above.
	      The  second  list of characters finally says which access rights
	      are to be expected: `r' for read access, `w' for	write  access,
	      `x'  for	the  right  to execute the file (or to search a direc‐
	      tory), `s' for the setuid and  setgid  bits,  and	 `t'  for  the
	      sticky bit.

	      Thus,  `*(f70?)'	gives  the files for which the owner has read,
	      write, and execute permission, and for which other group members
	      have  no rights, independent of the permissions for other users.
	      The pattern `*(f-100)' gives all files for which the owner  does
	      not  have	 execute  permission,  and `*(f:gu+w,o-rx:)' gives the
	      files for which the owner and the other  members	of  the	 group
	      have  at least write permission, and for which other users don't
	      have read or execute permission.

       estring
	      The string will be executed as shell code.  The filename will be
	      included in the list if and only if the code returns a zero sta‐
	      tus (usually the status of the last command).  The first charac‐
	      ter after the `e' will be used as a separator and anything up to
	      the next matching separator will be taken	 as the	 string;  `[',
	      `{',  and	 `<'  match `]', `}', and `>', respectively, while any
	      other character matches itself. Note  that  expansions  must  be
	      quoted  in the string to prevent them from being expanded before
	      globbing is done.

	      During the execution of  string  the  filename  currently	 being
	      tested is available in the parameter REPLY; the parameter may be
	      altered to a string to be inserted into the list instead of  the
	      original	filename.  In addition, the parameter reply may be set
	      to an array or a string, which overrides the value of REPLY.  If
	      set  to  an  array, the latter is inserted into the command line
	      word by word.

	      For  example,  suppose  a	 directory  contains  a	 single	  file
	      `lonely'.	  Then	the expression `*(e:'reply=(${REPLY}{1,2})':)'
	      will cause the words `lonely1 lonely2' to be inserted  into  the
	      command line.  Note the quotation marks.

       ddev   files on the device dev

       l[-|+]ct
	      files having a link count less than ct (-), greater than ct (+),
	      or equal to ct

       U      files owned by the effective user ID

       G      files owned by the effective group ID

       uid    files owned by user ID id if it is a number, if  not,  than  the
	      character	 after	the  `u'  will	be used as a separator and the
	      string between it and the next matching separator (`[', `{', and
	      `<'  match  `]',	`}', and `>' respectively, any other character
	      matches itself) will be taken as a user name, and the user ID of
	      this  user  will	be  taken  (e.g. `u:foo:' or `u[foo]' for user
	      `foo')

       gid    like uid but with group IDs or names

       a[Mwhms][-|+]n
	      files accessed exactly n days ago.  Files	 accessed  within  the
	      last  n  days  are  selected  using a negative value for n (-n).
	      Files accessed more than n days ago are selected by a positive n
	      value  (+n).  Optional unit specifiers `M', `w', `h', `m' or `s'
	      (e.g. `ah5') cause the check to be performed with months (of  30
	      days), weeks, hours, minutes or seconds instead of days, respec‐
	      tively.  For instance, `echo *(ah-5)' would echo files  accessed
	      within the last five hours.

       m[Mwhms][-|+]n
	      like  the	 file  access  qualifier, except that it uses the file
	      modification time.

       c[Mwhms][-|+]n
	      like the file access qualifier, except that  it  uses  the  file
	      inode change time.

       L[+|-]n
	      files less than n bytes (-), more than n bytes (+), or exactly n
	      bytes in length. If this flag is	directly  followed  by	a  `k'
	      (`K'),  `m' (`M'), or `p' (`P') (e.g. `Lk-50') the check is per‐
	      formed with kilobytes,  megabytes,  or  blocks  (of  512	bytes)
	      instead.

       ^      negates all qualifiers following it

       -      toggles  between	making	the  qualifiers work on symbolic links
	      (the default) and the files they point to

       M      sets the MARK_DIRS option for the current pattern

       T      appends a trailing qualifier mark to the filenames, analogous to
	      the LIST_TYPES option, for the current pattern (overrides M)

       N      sets the NULL_GLOB option for the current pattern

       D      sets the GLOB_DOTS option for the current pattern

       n      sets the NUMERIC_GLOB_SORT option for the current pattern

       oc     specifies how the names of the files should be sorted. If c is n
	      they are sorted by name (the default);  if  it  is  L  they  are
	      sorted  depending	 on  the size (length) of the files; if l they
	      are sorted by the number of links; if a, m, or c they are sorted
	      by  the  time  of the last access, modification, or inode change
	      respectively; if d, files in subdirectories appear before	 those
	      in the current directory at each level of the search --- this is
	      best combined with other criteria, for example `odon' to sort on
	      names  for files within the same directory.  Note that a, m, and
	      c compare the age against the current time, hence the first name
	      in the list is the youngest file. Also note that the modifiers ^
	      and - are used, so `*(^-oL)' gives a list of all files sorted by
	      file size in descending order, following any symbolic links.

       Oc     like  `o',  but  sorts in descending order; i.e. `*(^oc)' is the
	      same as `*(Oc)' and `*(^Oc)' is the same as `*(oc)';  `Od'  puts
	      files in the current directory before those in subdirectories at
	      each level of the search.

       [beg[,end]]
	      specifies which of the matched filenames should be  included  in
	      the  returned  list.  The	 syntax	 is the same as for array sub‐
	      scripts. beg and the optional end may  be	 mathematical  expres‐
	      sions. As in parameter subscripting they may be negative to make
	      them count from the last	match  backward.  E.g.:	 `*(-OL[1,3])'
	      gives a list of the names of the three largest files.

       More  than one of these lists can be combined, separated by commas. The
       whole list matches if at least one of the sublists  matches  (they  are
       `or'ed,	the qualifiers in the sublists are `and'ed).  Some qualifiers,
       however, affect all matches generated, independent of  the  sublist  in
       which  they  are	 given.	  These are the qualifiers `M', `T', `N', `D',
       `n', `o', `O' and the subscripts given in brackets (`[...]').

       If a `:' appears in a qualifier list, the remainder of  the  expression
       in  parenthesis	is  interpreted	 as a modifier (see the section `Modi‐
       fiers' in the section `History Expansion').  Note  that	each  modifier
       must  be introduced by a separate `:'.  Note also that the result after
       modification does not have to be an existing file.   The	 name  of  any
       existing file can be followed by a modifier of the form `(:..)' even if
       no actual filename generation is performed.  Thus:

	      ls *(-/)

       lists all directories and symbolic links that point to directories, and

	      ls *(%W)

       lists all world-writable device files in the current directory, and

	      ls *(W,X)

       lists all files in the current directory	 that  are  world-writable  or
       world-executable, and

	      echo /tmp/foo*(u0^@:t)

       outputs	the basename of all root-owned files beginning with the string
       `foo' in /tmp, ignoring symlinks, and

	      ls *.*~(lex|parse).[ch](^D^l1)

       lists all files having a link count of one whose names  contain	a  dot
       (but  not  those	 starting  with	 a  dot, since GLOB_DOTS is explicitly
       switched off) except for lex.c, lex.h, parse.c and parse.h.

ZSHPARAM(1)							   ZSHPARAM(1)

NAME
       zshparam - zsh parameters

DESCRIPTION
       A parameter has a name, a value, and a number of	 attributes.   A  name
       may  be any sequence of alphanumeric characters and underscores, or the
       single characters `*', `@', `#', `?', `-', `$', or `!'.	The value  may
       be  a scalar (a string), an integer, an array (indexed numerically), or
       an associative array (an unordered set of name-value pairs, indexed  by
       name).	To  declare  the type of a parameter, or to assign a scalar or
       integer value to a parameter, use the typeset builtin.

       The value of a scalar or integer parameter  may	also  be  assigned  by
       writing:

	      name=value

       If  the integer attribute, -i, is set for name, the value is subject to
       arithmetic evaluation.  See the section `Array  Parameters'  for	 addi‐
       tional forms of assignment.

       To  refer to the value of a parameter, write `$name' or `${name}'.  See
       Parameter Expansion in zshexpn(1) for complete details.

       In the parameter lists that follow, the mark `<S>' indicates  that  the
       parameter  is  special.	 Special  parameters  cannot  have  their type
       changed, and they stay special even if unset.  `<Z>' indicates that the
       parameter does not exist when the shell initializes in sh or ksh emula‐
       tion mode.

ARRAY PARAMETERS
       To assign an array value, write one of:

	      set -A name value ...
	      name=(value ...)

       If no parameter name exists, an ordinary array  parameter  is  created.
       If  the	parameter name exists and is a scalar, it is replaced by a new
       array.  Ordinary array parameters may also be explicitly declared with:

	      typeset -a name

       Associative arrays must be declared before assignment, by using:

	      typeset -A name

       When name refers to an associative array, the list in an assignment  is
       interpreted as alternating keys and values:

	      set -A name key value ...
	      name=(key value ...)

       Every  key  must	 have a value in this case.  Note that this assigns to
       the entire array, deleting any elements that do not appear in the list.

       To create an empty array (including associative arrays), use one of:

	      set -A name
	      name=()

   Array Subscripts
       Individual elements of an array may be selected using a	subscript.   A
       subscript of the form `[exp]' selects the single element exp, where exp
       is an arithmetic expression which will be subject to arithmetic	expan‐
       sion as if it were surrounded by `$((...))'.  The elements are numbered
       beginning with 1, unless the KSH_ARRAYS option is  set  in  which  case
       they are numbered from zero.

       Subscripts  may be used inside braces used to delimit a parameter name,
       thus `${foo[2]}' is equivalent to `$foo[2]'.  If the KSH_ARRAYS	option
       is  set,	 the  braced  form  is	the  only one that works, as bracketed
       expressions otherwise are not treated as subscripts.

       The same subscripting syntax is used  for  associative  arrays,	except
       that  no	 arithmetic expansion is applied to exp.  However, the parsing
       rules for arithmetic expressions still apply,  which  affects  the  way
       that  certain special characters must be protected from interpretation.
       See Subscript Parsing below for details.

       A subscript of the form `[*]' or `[@]' evaluates to all elements of  an
       array;  there  is no difference between the two except when they appear
       within double  quotes.	`"$foo[*]"'  evaluates	to  `"$foo[1]  $foo[2]
       ..."', whereas `"$foo[@]"' evaluates to `"$foo[1]" "$foo[2]" ...'.  For
       associative arrays, `[*]' or `[@]' evaluate to all the values (not  the
       keys,  but see Subscript Flags below), in no particular order.  When an
       array parameter is referenced as `$name' (with no subscript) it	evalu‐
       ates  to	 `$name[*]', unless the KSH_ARRAYS option is set in which case
       it evaluates to `${name[0]}' (for an associative array, this means  the
       value  of the key `0', which may not exist even if there are values for
       other keys).

       A subscript of the form `[exp1,exp2]' selects all elements in the range
       exp1  to	 exp2, inclusive. (Associative arrays are unordered, and so do
       not support ranges.) If one of the subscripts evaluates to  a  negative
       number, say -n, then the nth element from the end of the array is used.
       Thus `$foo[-3]' is the third element from the end of the array foo, and
       `$foo[1,-1]' is the same as `$foo[*]'.

       Subscripting  may  also be performed on non-array values, in which case
       the subscripts specify a substring to be extracted.   For  example,  if
       FOO is set to `foobar', then `echo $FOO[2,5]' prints `ooba'.

   Array Element Assignment
       A subscript may be used on the left side of an assignment like so:

	      name[exp]=value

       In  this	 form  of  assignment the element or range specified by exp is
       replaced by the expression on the right side.  An  array	 (but  not  an
       associative  array) may be created by assignment to a range or element.
       Arrays do not nest, so assigning a parenthesized list of values	to  an
       element	or range changes the number of elements in the array, shifting
       the other elements to accommodate the new values.  (This	 is  not  sup‐
       ported for associative arrays.)

       This syntax also works as an argument to the typeset command:

	      typeset "name[exp]"=value

       The  value  may	not  be	 a  parenthesized list in this case; only sin‐
       gle-element assignments may be made with typeset.  Note that quotes are
       necessary  in  this case to prevent the brackets from being interpreted
       as filename generation operators.  The noglob precommand modifier could
       be used instead.

       To delete an element of an ordinary array, assign `()' to that element.
       To delete an element of an associative array, use the unset command:

	      unset "name[exp]"

   Subscript Flags
       If the opening bracket, or the comma  in	 a  range,  in	any  subscript
       expression  is  directly followed by an opening parenthesis, the string
       up to the matching closing one is considered to be a list of flags,  as
       in `name[(flags)exp]'.  The flags currently understood are:

       w      If  the  parameter  subscripted is a scalar than this flag makes
	      subscripting work on words instead of characters.	  The  default
	      word separator is whitespace.

       s:string:
	      This  gives  the string that separates words (for use with the w
	      flag).

       p      Recognize the same escape sequences as the print builtin in  the
	      string argument of a subsequent `s' flag.

       f      If  the  parameter  subscripted is a scalar than this flag makes
	      subscripting work on lines instead of characters, i.e. with ele‐
	      ments separated by newlines.  This is a shorthand for `pws:\n:'.

       r      Reverse subscripting: if this flag is given, the exp is taken as
	      a pattern and the result is the first  matching  array  element,
	      substring	 or  word  (if	the  parameter is an array, if it is a
	      scalar, or if it is a scalar and the `w' flag is given,  respec‐
	      tively).	 The subscript used is the number of the matching ele‐
	      ment, so that pairs of subscripts such  as  `$foo[(r)??,3]'  and
	      `$foo[(r)??,(r)f*]'  are possible.  If the parameter is an asso‐
	      ciative array, only the value part of each pair is  compared  to
	      the  pattern,  and the result is that value.  Reverse subscripts
	      may be used for assigning to ordinary array  elements,  but  not
	      for assigning to associative arrays.

       R      Like  `r',  but  gives  the last match.  For associative arrays,
	      gives all possible matches.

       i      Like `r', but gives the index of the match instead; this may not
	      be  combined  with  a  second  argument.	On the left side of an
	      assignment, behaves like `r'.  For associative arrays,  the  key
	      part  of	each  pair  is	compared to the pattern, and the first
	      matching key found is the result.

       I      Like `i', but gives the index of the last match, or all possible
	      matching keys in an associative array.

       k      If used in a subscript on an associative array, this flag causes
	      the keys to be interpreted as patterns, and  returns  the	 value
	      for  the	first key found where exp is matched by the key.  This
	      flag does not work on the left side of an assignment to an asso‐
	      ciative  array  element.	 If used on another type of parameter,
	      this behaves like `r'.

       K      On an associative array this is like `k' but returns all	values
	      where  exp is matched by the keys.  On other types of parameters
	      this has the same effect as `R'.

       n:expr:
	      If combined with `r', `R', `i' or `I', makes them give  the  nth
	      or  nth  last  match  (if	 expr  evaluates  to n).  This flag is
	      ignored when the array is associative.

       b:expr:
	      If combined with `r', `R', `i' or `I', makes them begin  at  the
	      nth  or  nth last element, word, or character (if expr evaluates
	      to n).  This flag is ignored when the array is associative.

       e      This flag has no effect and for ordinary arrays is retained  for
	      backward	compatibility only.  For associative arrays, this flag
	      can be used to force * or @ to be interpreted as	a  single  key
	      rather than as a reference to all values.	 This flag may be used
	      on the left side of an assignment.

       See Parameter Expansion	Flags  (zshexpn(1))  for  additional  ways  to
       manipulate the results of array subscripting.

   Subscript Parsing
       This  discussion applies mainly to associative array key strings and to
       patterns used for reverse subscripting (the `r', `R', `i', etc. flags),
       but  it	may also affect parameter substitutions that appear as part of
       an arithmetic expression in an ordinary subscript.

       The basic rule to remember when writing a subscript expression is  that
       all  text between the opening `[' and the closing `]' is interpreted as
       if it were in double quotes (see zshmisc(1)).  However,	unlike	double
       quotes  which  normally	cannot	nest, subscript expressions may appear
       inside double-quoted strings or inside other subscript expressions  (or
       both!), so the rules have two important differences.

       The first difference is that brackets (`[' and `]') must appear as bal‐
       anced pairs in a subscript expression unless they  are  preceded	 by  a
       backslash  (`\').  Therefore, within a subscript expression (and unlike
       true double-quoting) the sequence `\[' becomes `[', and similarly  `\]'
       becomes	`]'.  This applies even in cases where a backslash is not nor‐
       mally required; for example, the pattern `[^[]' (to match any character
       other than an open bracket) should be written `[^\[]' in a reverse-sub‐
       script pattern.	However, note that `\[^\[\]' and even `\[^[]' mean the
       same  thing,  because  backslashes are always stripped when they appear
       before brackets!

       The same rule applies to parentheses (`(' and `)') and braces (`{'  and
       `}'):  they must appear either in balanced pairs or preceded by a back‐
       slash, and backslashes that protect parentheses or braces  are  removed
       during parsing.	This is because parameter expansions may be surrounded
       balanced braces, and subscript flags are introduced by balanced	paren‐
       thesis.

       The  second  difference is that a double-quote (`"') may appear as part
       of a subscript expression without being preceded by  a  backslash,  and
       therefore  that the two characters `\"' remain as two characters in the
       subscript (in true double-quoting, `\"' becomes `"').  However, because
       of the standard shell quoting rules, any double-quotes that appear must
       occur in balanced pairs unless preceded by a backslash.	This makes  it
       more  difficult	to  write  a subscript expression that contains an odd
       number of double-quote characters, but the reason for  this  difference
       is  so  that  when  a  subscript	 expression  appears  inside true dou‐
       ble-quotes, one can still write `\"' (rather than `\\\"') for `"'.

       To use an odd number of double quotes as a key in  an  assignment,  use
       the typeset builtin and an enclosing pair of double quotes; to refer to
       the value of that key, again use double quotes:

	      typeset -A aa
	      typeset "aa[one\"two\"three\"quotes]"=QQQ
	      print "$aa[one\"two\"three\"quotes]"

       It is important to note that the quoting rules do  not  change  when  a
       parameter expansion with a subscript is nested inside another subscript
       expression.  That is, it is not necessary to use additional backslashes
       within the inner subscript expression; they are removed only once, from
       the innermost subscript outwards.  Parameters are  also	expanded  from
       the innermost subscript first, as each expansion is encountered left to
       right in the outer expression.

       A further complication arises from a way in which subscript parsing  is
       not  different  from  double quote parsing.  As in true double-quoting,
       the sequences `\*', and `\@' remain as two characters when they	appear
       in  a subscript expression.  To use a literal `*' or `@' as an associa‐
       tive array key, the `e' flag must be used:

	      typeset -A aa
	      aa[(e)*]=star
	      print $aa[(e)*]

       A last detail must be considered	 when  reverse	subscripting  is  per‐
       formed.	 Parameters  appearing	in  the subscript expression are first
       expanded and then the complete expression is interpreted as a  pattern.
       This has two effects: first, parameters behave as if GLOB_SUBST were on
       (and it cannot be turned	 off);	second,	 backslashes  are  interpreted
       twice, once when parsing the array subscript and again when parsing the
       pattern.	 In a reverse subscript, it's  necessary  to  use  four	 back‐
       slashes	to cause a single backslash to match literally in the pattern.
       For complex patterns, it is often easiest to assign the desired pattern
       to  a  parameter	 and  then  refer  to that parameter in the subscript,
       because then the backslashes, brackets,	parentheses,  etc.,  are  seen
       only  when the complete expression is converted to a pattern.  To match
       the value of a parameter literally in a reverse subscript, rather  than
       as  a  pattern, use `${(q)name}' (see zshexpn(1)) to quote the expanded
       value.

       Note that the `k' and `K' flags are reverse subscripting for  an	 ordi‐
       nary  array, but are not reverse subscripting for an associative array!
       (For an associative array, the keys in the array itself are interpreted
       as  patterns  by	 those	flags; the subscript is a plain string in that
       case.)

       One final note, not directly related to subscripting: the numeric names
       of positional parameters (described below) are parsed specially, so for
       example `$2foo' is equivalent to `${2}foo'.   Therefore,	 to  use  sub‐
       script  syntax  to extract a substring from a positional parameter, the
       expansion must be surrounded by braces; for example, `${2[3,5]}' evalu‐
       ates  to	 the  third  through fifth characters of the second positional
       parameter, but `$2[3,5]' is the entire  second  parameter  concatenated
       with the filename generation pattern `[3,5]'.

POSITIONAL PARAMETERS
       The  positional parameters provide access to the command-line arguments
       of a shell function, shell script, or the shell itself; see the section
       `Invocation', and also the section `Functions'.	The parameter n, where
       n is a number, is the nth positional parameter.	The  parameters	 *,  @
       and  argv  are  arrays  containing  all the positional parameters; thus
       `$argv[n]', etc., is equivalent to simply `$n'.

       Positional parameters may be changed after the shell or function starts
       by  using the set builtin, by assigning to the argv array, or by direct
       assignment of the form `n=value' where n is the	number	of  the	 posi‐
       tional  parameter to be changed.	 This also creates (with empty values)
       any of the positions from 1 to n that do not already have values.  Note
       that, because the positional parameters form an array, an array assign‐
       ment of the form `n=(value ...)' is allowed,  and  has  the  effect  of
       shifting	 all  the  values at positions greater than n by as many posi‐
       tions as necessary to accommodate the new values.

LOCAL PARAMETERS
       Shell function executions delimit scopes for shell parameters.  (Param‐
       eters  are  dynamically scoped.)	 The typeset builtin, and its alterna‐
       tive forms declare, integer, local and readonly (but not	 export),  can
       be used to declare a parameter as being local to the innermost scope.

       When a parameter is read or assigned to, the innermost existing parame‐
       ter of that name is used.  (That is,  the  local	 parameter  hides  any
       less-local parameter.)  However, assigning to a non-existent parameter,
       or declaring a new parameter with export, causes it to  be  created  in
       the outermost scope.

       Local parameters disappear when their scope ends.  unset can be used to
       delete a parameter while it is still in scope; any outer	 parameter  of
       the same name remains hidden.

       Special	parameters  may	 also be made local; they retain their special
       attributes unless either the existing or	 the  newly-created  parameter
       has  the	 -h (hide) attribute.  This may have unexpected effects: there
       is no default value, so if there is no  assignment  at  the  point  the
       variable	 is  made  local, it will be set to an empty value (or zero in
       the case of integers).  The following:

	      typeset PATH=/new/directory:$PATH

       is valid for temporarily allowing the shell or programmes  called  from
       it to find the programs in /new/directory inside a function.

       Note  that  the restriction in older versions of zsh that local parame‐
       ters were never exported has been removed.

PARAMETERS SET BY THE SHELL
       The following parameters are automatically set by the shell:

       ! <S>  The process ID of the last background command invoked.

       # <S>  The number of positional parameters in decimal.  Note that  some
	      confusion	 may  occur  with the syntax $#param which substitutes
	      the length of param.  Use ${#} to resolve ambiguities.  In  par‐
	      ticular,	the  sequence  `$#-...' in an arithmetic expression is
	      interpreted as the length of the parameter -, q.v.

       ARGC <S> <Z>
	      Same as #.

       $ <S>  The process ID of this shell.

       - <S>  Flags supplied to the shell on  invocation  or  by  the  set  or
	      setopt commands.

       * <S>  An array containing the positional parameters.

       argv <S> <Z>
	      Same  as	*.   Assigning	to  argv  changes the local positional
	      parameters, but argv is not itself a local parameter.   Deleting
	      argv  with unset in any function deletes it everywhere, although
	      only the innermost positional parameter array is deleted	(so  *
	      and @ in other scopes are not affected).

       @ <S>  Same as argv[@], even when argv is not set.

       ? <S>  The exit value returned by the last command.

       0 <S>  The  name	 used  to  invoke  the	current	 shell.	  If the FUNC‐
	      TION_ARGZERO option is set, this is  set	temporarily  within  a
	      shell function to the name of the function, and within a sourced
	      script to the name of the script.

       status <S> <Z>
	      Same as ?.

       pipestatus <S> <Z>
	      An array containing the exit values returned by all commands  in
	      the last pipeline.

       _ <S>  The last argument of the previous command.  Also, this parameter
	      is set in the environment of every command executed to the  full
	      pathname of the command.

       CPUTYPE
	      The  machine  type  (microprocessor  class or machine model), as
	      determined at run time.

       EGID <S>
	      The effective group ID of the shell process.  If you have suffi‐
	      cient  privileges,  you may change the effective group ID of the
	      shell process by assigning to this  parameter.   Also  (assuming
	      sufficient  privileges),	you  may start a single command with a
	      different effective group ID by `(EGID=gid; command)'

       EUID <S>
	      The effective user ID of the shell process.  If you have	suffi‐
	      cient  privileges,  you  may change the effective user ID of the
	      shell process by assigning to this  parameter.   Also  (assuming
	      sufficient  privileges),	you  may start a single command with a
	      different effective user ID by `(EUID=uid; command)'

       ERRNO <S>
	      The value of errno (see errno(3)) as set by  the	most  recently
	      failed  system  call.   This  value  is  system dependent and is
	      intended for debugging purposes.

       GID <S>
	      The real group ID of the shell process.  If you have  sufficient
	      privileges,  you may change the group ID of the shell process by
	      assigning to this parameter.  Also (assuming  sufficient	privi‐
	      leges),  you  may start a single command under a different group
	      ID by `(GID=gid; command)'

       HOST   The current hostname.

       LINENO <S>
	      The line number of the current line within the  current  script,
	      sourced  file,  or  shell function being executed, whichever was
	      started most recently.  Note that in the case of shell functions
	      the  line	 number	 refers	 to the function as it appeared in the
	      original definition, not necessarily as displayed by  the	 func‐
	      tions builtin.

       LOGNAME
	      If  the  corresponding variable is not set in the environment of
	      the shell, it is initialized to the login name corresponding  to
	      the current login session. This parameter is exported by default
	      but this can be disabled using the typeset builtin.

       MACHTYPE
	      The machine type (microprocessor class  or  machine  model),  as
	      determined at compile time.

       OLDPWD The previous working directory.  This is set when the shell ini‐
	      tializes and whenever the directory changes.

       OPTARG <S>
	      The value of the last option argument processed by  the  getopts
	      command.

       OPTIND <S>
	      The  index  of the last option argument processed by the getopts
	      command.

       OSTYPE The operating system, as determined at compile time.

       PPID <S>
	      The process ID of the parent of the shell.

       PWD    The present working directory.  This is set when the shell  ini‐
	      tializes and whenever the directory changes.

       RANDOM <S>
	      A random integer from 0 to 32767, newly generated each time this
	      parameter is referenced.	The random  number  generator  can  be
	      seeded by assigning a numeric value to RANDOM.

       SECONDS <S>
	      The number of seconds since shell invocation.  If this parameter
	      is assigned a value, then the value returned upon reference will
	      be  the value that was assigned plus the number of seconds since
	      the assignment.

       SHLVL <S>
	      Incremented by one each time a new shell is started.

       signals
	      An array containing the names of the signals.

       TTY    The name of the tty associated with the shell, if any.

       TTYIDLE <S>
	      The idle time of the tty associated with the shell in seconds or
	      -1 if there is no such tty.

       UID <S>
	      The  real	 user ID of the shell process.	If you have sufficient
	      privileges, you may change the user ID of the shell by assigning
	      to  this	parameter.  Also (assuming sufficient privileges), you
	      may start	 a  single  command  under  a  different  user	ID  by
	      `(UID=uid; command)'

       USERNAME <S>
	      The  username  corresponding  to	the  real user ID of the shell
	      process.	If you have sufficient privileges, you may change  the
	      username	(and  also  the	 user ID and group ID) of the shell by
	      assigning to this parameter.  Also (assuming  sufficient	privi‐
	      leges),  you  may start a single command under a different user‐
	      name (and user ID and group  ID)	by  `(USERNAME=username;  com‐
	      mand)'

       VENDOR The vendor, as determined at compile time.

       ZSH_NAME
	      Expands  to  the	basename  of  the  command used to invoke this
	      instance of zsh.

       ZSH_VERSION
	      The version number of this zsh.

PARAMETERS USED BY THE SHELL
       The following parameters are used by the shell.

       In cases where there are two parameters with an	upper-	and  lowercase
       form  of the same name, such as path and PATH, the lowercase form is an
       array and the uppercase form is a scalar with the elements of the array
       joined  together	 by colons.  These are similar to tied parameters cre‐
       ated via `typeset -T'.  The normal use for the colon-separated form  is
       for  exporting  to  the	environment, while the array form is easier to
       manipulate within the shell.  Note that unsetting either	 of  the  pair
       will  unset the other; they retain their special properties when recre‐
       ated, and recreating one of the pair will recreate the other.

       ARGV0  If exported, its value is used as the argv[0] of	external  com‐
	      mands.  Usually used in constructs like `ARGV0=emacs nethack'.

       BAUD   The  baud rate of the current connection.	 Used by the line edi‐
	      tor update mechanism to compensate for a slow terminal by delay‐
	      ing  updates  until  necessary.  This may be profitably set to a
	      lower value in some circumstances, e.g.  for slow modems dialing
	      into  a communications server which is connected to a host via a
	      fast link; in this case, this variable would be set  by  default
	      to  the speed of the fast link, and not the modem.  This parame‐
	      ter should be set to the baud rate of the slowest	 part  of  the
	      link  for	 best  performance.  The compensation mechanism can be
	      turned off by setting the variable to zero.

       cdpath <S> <Z> (CDPATH <S>)
	      An array (colon-separated list) of  directories  specifying  the
	      search path for the cd command.

       COLUMNS <S>
	      The  number  of  columns	for  this  terminal session.  Used for
	      printing select lists and for the line editor.

       DIRSTACKSIZE
	      The maximum size of the directory	 stack.	  If  the  stack  gets
	      larger  than  this, it will be truncated automatically.  This is
	      useful with the AUTO_PUSHD option.

       FCEDIT The default editor for the fc builtin.

       fignore <S> <Z> (FIGNORE <S>)
	      An array (colon separated list) containing the suffixes of files
	      to  be ignored during filename completion.  However, if the com‐
	      pletion generates only files which would match if this  variable
	      would be ignored, than these files are completed anyway.

       fpath <S> <Z> (FPATH <S>)
	      An  array	 (colon	 separated list) of directories specifying the
	      search path for function definitions.   This  path  is  searched
	      when a function with the -u attribute is referenced.  If an exe‐
	      cutable file is found, then it is read and executed in the  cur‐
	      rent environment.

       histchars <S>
	      Three  characters used by the shell's history and lexical analy‐
	      sis mechanism.  The first character signals the start of a  his‐
	      tory  expansion (default `!').  The second character signals the
	      start of a quick history substitution (default `^').  The	 third
	      character is the comment character (default `#').

       HISTCHARS <S> <Z>
	      Same as histchars.  (Deprecated.)

       HISTFILE
	      The file to save the history in when an interactive shell exits.
	      If unset, the history is not saved.

       HISTSIZE <S>
	      The maximum number of events  stored  in	the  internal  history
	      list.   If  you  use  the HIST_EXPIRE_DUPS_FIRST option, setting
	      this value larger than the SAVEHIST size will give you the  dif‐
	      ference as a cushion for saving duplicated history events.

       HOME <S>
	      The default argument for the cd command.

       IFS <S>
	      Internal	field  separators  (by default space, tab, newline and
	      NUL), that are used to separate words which result from  command
	      or  parameter expansion and words read by the read builtin.  Any
	      characters from the set space, tab and newline  that  appear  in
	      the IFS are called IFS white space.  One or more IFS white space
	      characters or one non-IFS white space  character	together  with
	      any  adjacent  IFS white space character delimit a field.	 If an
	      IFS white space character appears	 twice	consecutively  in  the
	      IFS,  this  character  is treated as if it were not an IFS white
	      space character.

       KEYTIMEOUT
	      The time the shell waits, in hundredths of seconds, for  another
	      key to be pressed when reading bound multi-character sequences.

       LANG <S>
	      This  variable  determines  the locale category for any category
	      not specifically selected via a variable starting with `LC_'.

       LC_ALL <S>
	      This variable overrides the value of the `LANG' variable and the
	      value of any of the other variables starting with `LC_'.

       LC_COLLATE <S>
	      This  variable determines the locale category for character col‐
	      lation information within ranges in glob brackets and for	 sort‐
	      ing.

       LC_CTYPE <S>
	      This  variable determines the locale category for character han‐
	      dling functions.

       LC_MESSAGES <S>
	      This variable determines the language in which  messages	should
	      be written.  Note that zsh does not use message catalogs.

       LC_NUMERIC <S>
	      This  variable affects the decimal point character and thousands
	      separator character for the formatted input/output functions and
	      string conversion functions.  Note that zsh ignores this setting
	      when parsing floating point mathematical expressions.

       LC_TIME <S>
	      This variable determines the locale category for date  and  time
	      formatting in prompt escape sequences.

       LINES <S>
	      The  number of lines for this terminal session.  Used for print‐
	      ing select lists and for the line editor.

       LISTMAX
	      In the line editor, the number of matches to list without asking
	      first.  If  the  value is negative, the list will be shown if it
	      spans at most as many lines as given by the absolute value.   If
	      set to zero, the shell asks only if the top of the listing would
	      scroll off the screen.

       LOGCHECK
	      The interval in seconds between checks for login/logout activity
	      using the watch parameter.

       MAIL   If  this	parameter  is  set  and mailpath is not set, the shell
	      looks for mail in the specified file.

       MAILCHECK
	      The interval in seconds between checks for new mail.

       mailpath <S> <Z> (MAILPATH <S>)
	      An array (colon-separated list) of filenames to  check  for  new
	      mail.  Each filename can be followed by a `?' and a message that
	      will be printed.	The message will undergo parameter  expansion,
	      command  substitution and arithmetic expansion with the variable
	      $_ defined as the name  of  the  file  that  has	changed.   The
	      default  message	is  `You  have	new mail'.  If an element is a
	      directory instead of a file the  shell  will  recursively	 check
	      every file in every subdirectory of the element.

       manpath <S> <Z> (MANPATH <S> <Z>)
	      An  array	 (colon-separated list) whose value is not used by the
	      shell.  The manpath array can be useful, however, since  setting
	      it also sets MANPATH, and vice versa.

       module_path <S> <Z> (MODULE_PATH <S>)
	      An  array	 (colon-separated  list)  of directories that zmodload
	      searches for dynamically loadable modules.  This is  initialized
	      to  a  standard  pathname, usually `/usr/local/lib/zsh/$ZSH_VER‐
	      SION'.  (The `/usr/local/lib' part varies from  installation  to
	      installation.)  For security reasons, any value set in the envi‐
	      ronment when the shell is started will be ignored.

	      These parameters only exist if the installation supports dynamic
	      module loading.

       NULLCMD <S>
	      The command name to assume if a redirection is specified with no
	      command.	Defaults to cat.  For sh/ksh behavior, change this  to
	      :.   For csh-like behavior, unset this parameter; the shell will
	      print an error message if null commands are entered.

       path <S> <Z> (PATH <S>)
	      An array (colon-separated list) of  directories  to  search  for
	      commands.	 When this parameter is set, each directory is scanned
	      and all files found are put in a hash table.

       POSTEDIT <S>
	      This string is output whenever the line editor exits.   It  usu‐
	      ally contains termcap strings to reset the terminal.

       PROMPT <S> <Z>
       PROMPT2 <S> <Z>
       PROMPT3 <S> <Z>
       PROMPT4 <S> <Z>
	      Same as PS1, PS2, PS3 and PS4, respectively.

       prompt <S> <Z>
	      Same as PS1.

       PS1 <S>
	      The  primary  prompt  string,  printed before a command is read.
	      the default is `%m%# '.  It undergoes a special form  of	expan‐
	      sion before being displayed; see the section `Prompt Expansion'.

       PS2 <S>
	      The secondary prompt, printed when the shell needs more informa‐
	      tion to complete a command.  It is expanded in the same  way  as
	      PS1.  The default is `%_> ', which displays any shell constructs
	      or quotation marks which are currently being processed.

       PS3 <S>
	      Selection prompt used within a select loop.  It is  expanded  in
	      the same way as PS1.  The default is `?# '.

       PS4 <S>
	      The  execution  trace prompt.  Default is `+%N:%i> ', which dis‐
	      plays the name of the current shell structure and the line  num‐
	      ber within it.  In sh or ksh emulation, the default is `+ '.

       psvar <S> <Z> (PSVAR <S>)
	      An  array	 (colon-separated list) whose first nine values can be
	      used in PROMPT strings.  Setting psvar also sets PSVAR, and vice
	      versa.

       READNULLCMD <S>
	      The  command  name  to  assume  if a single input redirection is
	      specified with no command.  Defaults to more.

       REPORTTIME
	      If nonnegative, commands whose combined user and	system	execu‐
	      tion  times  (measured  in  seconds) are greater than this value
	      have timing statistics printed for them.

       REPLY  This parameter is reserved by convention to pass	string	values
	      between  shell  scripts and shell builtins in situations where a
	      function call or redirection are impossible or undesirable.  The
	      read  builtin  and the select complex command may set REPLY, and
	      filename generation both sets and examines its value when evalu‐
	      ating  certain  expressions.  Some modules also employ REPLY for
	      similar purposes.

       reply  As REPLY, but for array values rather than strings.

       RPROMPT <S>
       RPS1 <S>
	      This prompt is displayed on the right-hand side  of  the	screen
	      when  the	 primary  prompt is being displayed on the left.  This
	      does not work  if	 the  SINGLELINEZLE  option  is	 set.	It  is
	      expanded in the same way as PS1.

       SAVEHIST
	      The  maximum  number  of	history	 events to save in the history
	      file.

       SPROMPT <S>
	      The prompt used for  spelling  correction.   The	sequence  `%R'
	      expands  to  the	string which presumably needs spelling correc‐
	      tion, and `%r' expands to the proposed  correction.   All	 other
	      prompt escapes are also allowed.

       STTY   If  this	parameter is set in a command's environment, the shell
	      runs the stty command with the value of this parameter as	 argu‐
	      ments  in order to set up the terminal before executing the com‐
	      mand. The modes apply only to the command, and are reset when it
	      finishes	or  is suspended. If the command is suspended and con‐
	      tinued later with the fg or wait builtins it will see the	 modes
	      specified	 by  STTY,  as if it were not suspended.  This (inten‐
	      tionally) does not apply if the command is continued  via	 `kill
	      -CONT'.	STTY  is  ignored  if  the command is run in the back‐
	      ground, or if it is in the environment  of  the  shell  but  not
	      explicitly  assigned  to	in the input line. This avoids running
	      stty at every external command  by  accidentally	exporting  it.
	      Also  note that STTY should not be used for window size specifi‐
	      cations; these will not be local to the command.

       TERM <S>
	      The type of terminal in use.  This is used when looking up term‐
	      cap  sequences.  An assignment to TERM causes zsh to re-initial‐
	      ize the terminal, even if	 the  value  does  not	change	(e.g.,
	      `TERM=$TERM').   It is necessary to make such an assignment upon
	      any change to the terminal definition database or terminal  type
	      in order for the new settings to take effect.

       TIMEFMT
	      The  format  of process time reports with the time keyword.  The
	      default is `%E real  %U user  %S system  %P %J'.	Recognizes the
	      following escape sequences:

	      %%     A `%'.
	      %U     CPU seconds spent in user mode.
	      %S     CPU seconds spent in kernel mode.
	      %E     Elapsed time in seconds.
	      %P     The CPU percentage, computed as (%U+%S)/%E.
	      %J     The name of this job.

	      A star may be inserted between the percent sign and flags print‐
	      ing time.	 This cause the time to be printed  in	`hh:mm:ss.ttt'
	      format  (hours  and  minutes  are	 only  printed if they are not
	      zero).

       TMOUT  If this parameter is nonzero, the shell  will  receive  an  ALRM
	      signal  if  a command is not entered within the specified number
	      of seconds after issuing	a  prompt.  If	there  is  a  trap  on
	      SIGALRM,	it will be executed and a new alarm is scheduled using
	      the value of the TMOUT parameter after executing the  trap.   If
	      no  trap	is  set, and the idle time of the terminal is not less
	      than the value of the TMOUT parameter, zsh  terminates.	Other‐
	      wise  a  new  alarm is scheduled to TMOUT seconds after the last
	      keypress.

       TMPPREFIX
	      A pathname prefix which the shell will  use  for	all  temporary
	      files.   Note  that  this should include an initial part for the
	      file name as well	 as  any  directory  names.   The  default  is
	      `/tmp/zsh'.

       watch <S> <Z> (WATCH <S>)
	      An  array	 (colon-separated  list)  of  login/logout  events  to
	      report.	If  it	contains  the  single  word  `all',  then  all
	      login/logout  events  are	 reported.   If it contains the single
	      word `notme', then all events are reported as with `all'	except
	      $USERNAME.   An entry in this list may consist of a username, an
	      `@' followed by a remote hostname, and a `%' followed by a  line
	      (tty).   Any  or	all  of	 these components may be present in an
	      entry; if a login/logout	event  matches	all  of	 them,	it  is
	      reported.

       WATCHFMT
	      The  format  of  login/logout  reports if the watch parameter is
	      set.  Default is `%n has %a %l from %m'.	Recognizes the follow‐
	      ing escape sequences:

	      %n     The name of the user that logged in/out.

	      %a     The observed action, i.e. "logged on" or "logged off".

	      %l     The line (tty) the user is logged in on.

	      %M     The full hostname of the remote host.

	      %m     The hostname up to the first `.'.	If only the IP address
		     is available or the utmp field contains the  name	of  an
		     X-windows display, the whole name is printed.

		     NOTE:  The	 `%m' and `%M' escapes will work only if there
		     is a host name field in the utmp on your machine.	Other‐
		     wise they are treated as ordinary strings.

	      %S (%s)
		     Start (stop) standout mode.

	      %U (%u)
		     Start (stop) underline mode.

	      %B (%b)
		     Start (stop) boldface mode.

	      %t
	      %@     The time, in 12-hour, am/pm format.

	      %T     The time, in 24-hour format.

	      %w     The date in `day-dd' format.

	      %W     The date in `mm/dd/yy' format.

	      %D     The date in `yy-mm-dd' format.

	      %(x:true-text:false-text)
		     Specifies	a ternary expression.  The character following
		     the x is arbitrary; the same character is used  to	 sepa‐
		     rate  the	text  for  the "true" result from that for the
		     "false" result.  Both the separator and the right	paren‐
		     thesis  may be escaped with a backslash.  Ternary expres‐
		     sions may be nested.

		     The test character x may be any one of `l', `n',  `m'  or
		     `M',  which indicate a `true' result if the corresponding
		     escape sequence would return a non-empty value; or it may
		     be	 `a',  which  indicates a `true' result if the watched
		     user has logged in, or `false'  if	 he  has  logged  out.
		     Other  characters evaluate to neither true nor false; the
		     entire expression is omitted in this case.

		     If the result is `true', then the true-text is  formatted
		     according	to  the	 rules	above  and  printed,  and  the
		     false-text is skipped.   If  `false',  the	 true-text  is
		     skipped  and  the	false-text  is	formatted and printed.
		     Either or both of the branches may	 be  empty,  but  both
		     separators must be present in any case.

       WORDCHARS <S>
	      A	 list of non-alphanumeric characters considered part of a word
	      by the line editor.

       ZBEEP  If set, this gives a string of characters, which can use all the
	      same  codes  as  the bindkey command as described in the zsh/zle
	      module entry in zshmodules(1), that will be output to the termi‐
	      nal  instead  of beeping.	 This may have a visible instead of an
	      audible effect; for example,  the	 string	 `\e[?5h\e[?5l'	 on  a
	      vt100 or xterm will have the effect of flashing reverse video on
	      and off (if you usually use reverse video, you  should  use  the
	      string  `\e[?5l\e[?5h' instead).	This takes precedence over the
	      NOBEEP option.

       ZDOTDIR
	      The directory to search for shell startup files  (.zshrc,	 etc),
	      if not $HOME.

ZSHOPTIONS(1)							 ZSHOPTIONS(1)

NAME
       zshoptions - zsh options

SPECIFYING OPTIONS
       Options are primarily referred to by name.  These names are case insen‐
       sitive and underscores are ignored.  For example, `allexport' is equiv‐
       alent to `A__lleXP_ort'.

       The  sense of an option name may be inverted by preceding it with `no',
       so `setopt No_Beep' is equivalent to `unsetopt beep'.   This  inversion
       can only be done once, so `nonobeep' is not a synonym for `beep'.  Sim‐
       ilarly, `tify' is not  a	 synonym  for  `nonotify'  (the	 inversion  of
       `notify').

       Some  options also have one or more single letter names.	 There are two
       sets of single letter options: one used by default, and another used to
       emulate	sh/ksh	(used  when the SH_OPTION_LETTERS option is set).  The
       single letter options can be used on the shell command  line,  or  with
       the  set, setopt and unsetopt builtins, as normal Unix options preceded
       by `-'.

       The sense of the single letter options may be  inverted	by  using  `+'
       instead	of  `-'.   Some	 of the single letter option names refer to an
       option being off, in which case the inversion of that  name  refers  to
       the  option  being  on.	For example, `+n' is the short name of `exec',
       and `-n' is the short name of its inversion, `noexec'.

       In strings of single letter options supplied to the shell  at  startup,
       trailing	 whitespace  will  be ignored; for example the string `-f    '
       will be treated just as `-f', but the string `-f i' is an error.	  This
       is  because many systems which implement the `#!' mechanism for calling
       scripts do not strip trailing whitespace.

DESCRIPTION OF OPTIONS
       In the following list, options set by default  in  all  emulations  are
       marked  <D>;  those  set by default only in csh, ksh, sh, or zsh emula‐
       tions are marked <C>, <K>,  <S>,	 <Z>  as  appropriate.	 When  listing
       options	(by  `setopt', `unsetopt', `set -o' or `set +o'), those turned
       on by default appear in the list prefixed  with	`no'.	Hence  (unless
       KSH_OPTION_PRINT is set), `setopt' shows all options whose settings are
       changed from the default.

       ALIASES <D>
	      Expand aliases.

       ALL_EXPORT (-a, ksh: -a)
	      All parameters subsequently defined are automatically exported.

       ALWAYS_LAST_PROMPT <D>
	      If unset, key functions that list completions try to  return  to
	      the  last prompt if given a numeric argument. If set these func‐
	      tions try to return to the last prompt if given no numeric argu‐
	      ment.

       ALWAYS_TO_END
	      If  a completion is performed with the cursor within a word, and
	      a full completion is inserted, the cursor is moved to the end of
	      the  word.   That is, the cursor is moved to the end of the word
	      if either a single match is inserted or menu completion is  per‐
	      formed.

       APPEND_HISTORY <D>
	      If  this	is set, zsh sessions will append their history list to
	      the history file, rather than overwrite it. Thus, multiple  par‐
	      allel  zsh  sessions  will all have their history lists added to
	      the history file, in the order they are killed.

       AUTO_CD (-J)
	      If a command is issued that can't be executed as a  normal  com‐
	      mand, and the command is the name of a directory, perform the cd
	      command to that directory.

       AUTO_LIST (-9) <D>
	      Automatically list choices on an ambiguous completion.

       AUTO_MENU <D>
	      Automatically use menu completion after the  second  consecutive
	      request  for  completion,	 for  example  by pressing the tab key
	      repeatedly. This option is overridden by MENU_COMPLETE.

       AUTO_NAME_DIRS
	      Any parameter that is set to the absolute name  of  a  directory
	      immediately becomes a name for that directory, that will be used
	      by the `%~' and related prompt sequences, and will be  available
	      when completion is performed on a word starting with `~'.	 (Oth‐
	      erwise, the parameter must be used in the form `~param' first.)

       AUTO_PARAM_KEYS <D>
	      If a parameter name was  completed  and  a  following  character
	      (normally	 a space) automatically inserted, and the next charac‐
	      ter typed is one of those that have to come directly  after  the
	      name (like `}', `:', etc.), the automatically added character is
	      deleted, so that the character typed comes immediately after the
	      parameter	 name.	 Completion  in	 a brace expansion is affected
	      similarly: the added character is a `,', which will  be  removed
	      if `}' is typed next.

       AUTO_PARAM_SLASH <D>
	      If  a  parameter	is  completed  whose  content is the name of a
	      directory, then add a trailing slash instead of a space.

       AUTO_PUSHD (-N)
	      Make cd push the old directory onto the directory stack.

       AUTO_REMOVE_SLASH <D>
	      When the last character resulting from a completion is  a	 slash
	      and  the next character typed is a word delimiter, a slash, or a
	      character that ends a command (such as a semicolon or an	amper‐
	      sand), remove the slash.

       AUTO_RESUME (-W)
	      Treat  single word simple commands without redirection as candi‐
	      dates for resumption of an existing job.

       BAD_PATTERN (+2) <C> <Z>
	      If a pattern for filename generation is badly formed,  print  an
	      error  message.	(If  this option is unset, the pattern will be
	      left unchanged.)

       BANG_HIST (+K) <C> <Z>
	      Perform textual history expansion, csh-style, treating the char‐
	      acter `!' specially.

       BARE_GLOB_QUAL <Z>
	      In  a  glob  pattern,  treat  a trailing set of parentheses as a
	      qualifier list, if it contains no `|', `(' or (if	 special)  `~'
	      characters.  See the section `Filename Generation'.

       BASH_AUTO_LIST
	      On  an ambiguous completion, automatically list choices when the
	      completion function is called twice in succession.   This	 takes
	      precedence  over	AUTO_LIST.   The  setting of LIST_AMBIGUOUS is
	      respected.  If AUTO_MENU is set, the menu	 behaviour  will  then
	      start  with  the third press.  Note that this will not work with
	      MENU_COMPLETE, since repeated completion calls immediately cycle
	      through the list in that case.

       BEEP (+B) <D>
	      Beep on error in ZLE.

       BG_NICE (-6) <C> <Z>
	      Run all background jobs at a lower priority.  This option is set
	      by default.

       BRACE_CCL
	      Expand expressions in braces which would not  otherwise  undergo
	      brace  expansion	to a lexically ordered list of all the charac‐
	      ters.  See the section `Brace Expansion'.

       BSD_ECHO <S>
	      Make the echo builtin compatible with the BSD  echo(1)  command.
	      This  disables  backslashed  escape  sequences  in  echo strings
	      unless the -e option is specified.

       C_BASES
	      Output hexadecimal numbers in the standard C format, for example
	      `0xFF' instead of the usual `16#FF'.  If the option OCTAL_ZEROES
	      is also set (it is  not  by  default),  octal  numbers  will  be
	      treated  similarly  and hence appear as `077' instead of `8#77'.
	      This option has no effect on the choice of the output base,  nor
	      on  the  output of bases other than hexadecimal and octal.  Note
	      that these formats will be understood on input  irrespective  of
	      the setting of C_BASES.

       CDABLE_VARS (-T)
	      If  the  argument	 to  a	cd  command (or an implied cd with the
	      AUTO_CD option set) is not a directory, and does not begin  with
	      a	 slash, try to expand the expression as if it were preceded by
	      a `~' (see the section `Filename Expansion').

       CHASE_DOTS
	      When changing to a directory  containing	a  path	 segment  `..'
	      which  would otherwise be treated as canceling the previous seg‐
	      ment in the path (in other words, `foo/..' would be removed from
	      the  path,  or  if  `..' is the first part of the path, the last
	      part of $PWD would be deleted), instead resolve the path to  the
	      physical directory.  This option is overridden by CHASE_LINKS.

	      For  example,  suppose  /foo/bar	is  a  link  to	 the directory
	      /alt/rod.	 Without this option set, `cd /foo/bar/..' changes  to
	      /foo;  with it set, it changes to /alt.  The same applies if the
	      current directory is /foo/bar and `cd ..' is  used.   Note  that
	      all other symbolic links in the path will also be resolved.

       CHASE_LINKS (-w)
	      Resolve symbolic links to their true values when changing direc‐
	      tory.  This also has the effect of CHASE_DOTS, i.e. a `..'  path
	      segment  will  be	 treated  as referring to the physical parent,
	      even if the preceding path segment is a symbolic link.

       CHECK_JOBS <Z>
	      Report the status of background and suspended jobs before	 exit‐
	      ing a shell with job control; a second attempt to exit the shell
	      will succeed.  NO_CHECK_JOBS is best used	 only  in  combination
	      with NO_HUP, else such jobs will be killed automatically.

	      The  check is omitted if the commands run from the previous com‐
	      mand line included a `jobs' command, since  it  is  assumed  the
	      user  is	aware  that there are background or suspended jobs.  A
	      `jobs' command run from the precmd function is not  counted  for
	      this purpose.

       CLOBBER (+C, ksh: +C) <D>
	      Allows  `>'  redirection to truncate existing files, and `>>' to
	      create files.  Otherwise `>!' or `>|' must be used to truncate a
	      file, and `>>!' or `>>|' to create a file.

       COMPLETE_ALIASES
	      Prevents	aliases on the command line from being internally sub‐
	      stituted before completion is attempted.	The effect is to  make
	      the alias a distinct command for completion purposes.

       COMPLETE_IN_WORD
	      If unset, the cursor is set to the end of the word if completion
	      is started. Otherwise it stays there and completion is done from
	      both ends.

       CORRECT (-0)
	      Try to correct the spelling of commands.

       CORRECT_ALL (-O)
	      Try to correct the spelling of all arguments in a line.

       CSH_JUNKIE_HISTORY <C>
	      A history reference without an event specifier will always refer
	      to the previous command.	Without this option,  such  a  history
	      reference	 refers to the same event as the previous history ref‐
	      erence, defaulting to the previous command.

       CSH_JUNKIE_LOOPS <C>
	      Allow loop bodies to take the form `list; end'  instead  of  `do
	      list; done'.

       CSH_JUNKIE_QUOTES <C>
	      Changes  the  rules  for single- and double-quoted text to match
	      that of csh.  These require that embedded newlines  be  preceded
	      by  a backslash; unescaped newlines will cause an error message.
	      In double-quoted strings, it is made impossible to  escape  `$',
	      ``'  or  `"' (and `\' itself no longer needs escaping).  Command
	      substitutions are only expanded once, and cannot be nested.

       CSH_NULLCMD <C>
	      Do not use the values of NULLCMD and  READNULLCMD	 when  running
	      redirections  with no command.  This make such redirections fail
	      (see the section `Redirection').

       CSH_NULL_GLOB <C>
	      If a pattern for filename generation has no matches, delete  the
	      pattern  from  the  argument list; do not report an error unless
	      all the patterns	in  a  command	have  no  matches.   Overrides
	      NOMATCH.

       DVORAK Use  the Dvorak keyboard instead of the standard qwerty keyboard
	      as a basis for examining spelling mistakes for the  CORRECT  and
	      CORRECT_ALL options and the spell-word editor command.

       EQUALS <Z>
	      Perform = filename expansion.  (See the section `Filename Expan‐
	      sion'.)

       ERR_EXIT (-e, ksh: -e)
	      If a command has a non-zero exit status, execute the ZERR	 trap,
	      if set, and exit.	 This is disabled while running initialization
	      scripts.

       EXEC (+n, ksh: +n) <D>
	      Do execute commands.  Without this option, commands are read and
	      checked for syntax errors, but not executed.  This option cannot
	      be turned off in an interactive shell, except when `-n' is  sup‐
	      plied to the shell at startup.

       EXTENDED_GLOB
	      Treat  the  `#',	`~' and `^' characters as part of patterns for
	      filename generation, etc.	 (An initial unquoted `~' always  pro‐
	      duces named directory expansion.)

       EXTENDED_HISTORY <C>
	      Save  each  command's  beginning timestamp (in seconds since the
	      epoch) and the duration (in seconds) to the history  file.   The
	      format of this prefixed data is:

	      `:<beginning time>:<elapsed seconds>:<command>'.

       FLOW_CONTROL <D>
	      If  this	option	is  unset,  output flow control via start/stop
	      characters (usually  assigned  to	 ^S/^Q)	 is  disabled  in  the
	      shell's editor.

       FUNCTION_ARGZERO <C> <Z>
	      When  executing  a  shell	 function or sourcing a script, set $0
	      temporarily to the name of the function/script.

       GLOB (+F, ksh: +f) <D>
	      Perform filename generation (globbing).  (See the section `File‐
	      name Generation'.)

       GLOBAL_EXPORT (<Z>)
	      If  this	option	is  set,  passing  the -x flag to the builtins
	      declare, float, integer, readonly and typeset  (but  not	local)
	      will  also  set  the  -g flag;  hence parameters exported to the
	      environment will not be made local to  the  enclosing  function,
	      unless they were already or the flag +g is given explicitly.  If
	      the option is unset, exported parameters will be made  local  in
	      just the same way as any other parameter.

	      This  option is set by default for backward compatibility; it is
	      not recommended that its behaviour be relied  upon.   Note  that
	      the  builtin  export  always  sets both the -x and -g flags, and
	      hence its effect extends beyond the scope of the enclosing func‐
	      tion; this is the most portable way to achieve this behaviour.

       GLOBAL_RCS (-d) <D>
	      If  this	option	is  unset,  the	 startup  files /etc/zprofile,
	      /etc/zshrc, /etc/zlogin and /etc/zlogout will not	 be  run.   It
	      can  be  disabled	 and  re-enabled at any time, including inside
	      local startup files (.zshrc, etc.).

       GLOB_ASSIGN <C>
	      If this option is set, filename generation  (globbing)  is  per‐
	      formed on the right hand side of scalar parameter assignments of
	      the form `name=pattern (e.g. `foo=*').  If the result  has  more
	      than  one	 word  the  parameter  will become an array with those
	      words as arguments. This option is provided for  backwards  com‐
	      patibility  only: globbing is always performed on the right hand
	      side of array  assignments  of  the  form	 `name=(value)'	 (e.g.
	      `foo=(*)')  and  this form is recommended for clarity; with this
	      option set, it is not possible to	 predict  whether  the	result
	      will be an array or a scalar.

       GLOB_COMPLETE
	      When  the current word has a glob pattern, do not insert all the
	      words resulting from the expansion but generate matches  as  for
	      completion  and  cycle  through  them  like  MENU_COMPLETE.  The
	      matches are generated as if a `*' was added to the  end  of  the
	      word,  or	 inserted  at the cursor when COMPLETE_IN_WORD is set.
	      This actually uses pattern matching, not globbing, so  it	 works
	      not only for files but for any completion, such as options, user
	      names, etc.

       GLOB_DOTS (-4)
	      Do not require a leading `.' in a filename to be matched explic‐
	      itly.

       GLOB_SUBST <C> <K> <S>
	      Treat any characters resulting from parameter expansion as being
	      eligible for file expansion and  filename	 generation,  and  any
	      characters resulting from command substitution as being eligible
	      for filename generation.	Braces (and commas in between) do  not
	      become eligible for expansion.

       HASH_CMDS <D>
	      Note the location of each command the first time it is executed.
	      Subsequent invocations of the same command will  use  the	 saved
	      location,	 avoiding  a path search.  If this option is unset, no
	      path hashing is done at all.  However, when CORRECT is set, com‐
	      mands whose names do not appear in the functions or aliases hash
	      tables are hashed in order to avoid reporting them  as  spelling
	      errors.

       HASH_DIRS <D>
	      Whenever a command name is hashed, hash the directory containing
	      it, as well as all directories that occur earlier in  the	 path.
	      Has no effect if neither HASH_CMDS nor CORRECT is set.

       HASH_LIST_ALL <D>
	      Whenever a command completion is attempted, make sure the entire
	      command path is hashed first.  This makes the  first  completion
	      slower.

       HIST_ALLOW_CLOBBER
	      Add `|' to output redirections in the history.  This allows his‐
	      tory references to clobber files even when CLOBBER is unset.

       HIST_BEEP <D>
	      Beep when an attempt is made to access  a	 history  entry	 which
	      isn't there.

       HIST_EXPIRE_DUPS_FIRST
	      If  the  internal history needs to be trimmed to add the current
	      command line, setting this option will cause the oldest  history
	      event  that  has	a  duplicate to be lost before losing a unique
	      event from the list.  You should be sure to  set	the  value  of
	      HISTSIZE	to  a larger number than SAVEHIST in order to give you
	      some room for the duplicated events, otherwise this option  will
	      behave  just like HIST_IGNORE_ALL_DUPS once the history fills up
	      with unique events.

       HIST_FIND_NO_DUPS
	      When searching for history entries in the line  editor,  do  not
	      display  duplicates  of  a  line	previously  found, even if the
	      duplicates are not contiguous.

       HIST_IGNORE_ALL_DUPS
	      If a new command line being added to the history list duplicates
	      an  older	 one, the older command is removed from the list (even
	      if it is not the previous event).

       HIST_IGNORE_DUPS (-h)
	      Do not enter command lines into the history  list	 if  they  are
	      duplicates of the previous event.

       HIST_IGNORE_SPACE (-g)
	      Remove  command lines from the history list when the first char‐
	      acter on the line is a  space,  or  when	one  of	 the  expanded
	      aliases contains a leading space.	 Note that the command lingers
	      in the internal history until the next command is entered before
	      it vanishes, allowing you to briefly reuse or edit the line.  If
	      you want to make it vanish right away without  entering  another
	      command, type a space and press return.

       HIST_NO_FUNCTIONS
	      Remove  function	definitions  from the history list.  Note that
	      the function lingers in the internal history until the next com‐
	      mand  is entered before it vanishes, allowing you to briefly re‐
	      use or edit the definition.

       HIST_NO_STORE
	      Remove the history (fc -l) command from the  history  list  when
	      invoked.	 Note that the command lingers in the internal history
	      until the next command is entered before it  vanishes,  allowing
	      you to briefly reuse or edit the line.

       HIST_REDUCE_BLANKS
	      Remove  superfluous blanks from each command line being added to
	      the history list.

       HIST_SAVE_NO_DUPS
	      When writing out the history file, older commands that duplicate
	      newer ones are omitted.

       HIST_VERIFY
	      Whenever	the  user  enters a line with history expansion, don't
	      execute the line directly; instead,  perform  history  expansion
	      and reload the line into the editing buffer.

       HUP <Z>
	      Send the HUP signal to running jobs when the shell exits.

       IGNORE_BRACES (-I) <S>
	      Do not perform brace expansion.

       IGNORE_EOF (-7)
	      Do  not  exit on end-of-file.  Require the use of exit or logout
	      instead.	However, ten consecutive EOFs will cause the shell  to
	      exit anyway, to avoid the shell hanging if its tty goes away.

	      Also,  if	 this  option  is set and the Zsh Line Editor is used,
	      widgets implemented by shell functions can be bound to EOF (nor‐
	      mally  Control-D)	 without  printing the normal warning message.
	      This works only for normal widgets, not for completion widgets.

       INC_APPEND_HISTORY
	      This options works like APPEND_HISTORY except that  new  history
	      lines  are added to the $HISTFILE incrementally (as soon as they
	      are entered), rather than waiting until  the  shell  is  killed.
	      The  file	 is periodically trimmed to the number of lines speci‐
	      fied by $SAVEHIST, but can exceed this value between trimmings.

       INTERACTIVE (-i, ksh: -i)
	      This is an interactive shell.  This option is set upon initiali‐
	      sation  if  the  standard	 input is a tty and commands are being
	      read from standard input.	 (See the discussion  of  SHIN_STDIN.)
	      This  heuristic may be overridden by specifying a state for this
	      option on the command line.  The value of this option cannot  be
	      changed anywhere other than the command line.

       INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS (-k) <K> <S>
	      Allow comments even in interactive shells.

       KSH_ARRAYS <K> <S>
	      Emulate  ksh  array  handling  as	 closely as possible.  If this
	      option is set, array elements are numbered from zero,  an	 array
	      parameter	 without subscript refers to the first element instead
	      of the whole array, and braces are required to  delimit  a  sub‐
	      script (`${path[2]}' rather than just `$path[2]').

       KSH_AUTOLOAD <K> <S>
	      Emulate  ksh function autoloading.  This means that when a func‐
	      tion is autoloaded, the corresponding file is  merely  executed,
	      and  must define the function itself.  (By default, the function
	      is defined to the contents of the file.  However, the most  com‐
	      mon  ksh-style case - of the file containing only a simple defi‐
	      nition of the function - is always handled in the ksh-compatible
	      manner.)

       KSH_GLOB <K>
	      In  pattern  matching,  the  interpretation  of  parentheses  is
	      affected by a preceding `@', `*', `+', `?' or `!'.  See the sec‐
	      tion `Filename Generation'.

       KSH_OPTION_PRINT <K>
	      Alters the way options settings are printed: instead of separate
	      lists of set and unset options, all options  are	shown,	marked
	      `on' if they are in the non-default state, `off' otherwise.

       KSH_TYPESET <K>
	      Alters  the  way	arguments  to  the typeset family of commands,
	      including declare, export, float, integer, local	and  readonly,
	      are  processed.	Without	 this  option, zsh will perform normal
	      word splitting after command and parameter  expansion  in	 argu‐
	      ments  of	 an  assignment; with it, word splitting does not take
	      place in those cases.

       LIST_AMBIGUOUS <D>
	      This option works when AUTO_LIST or BASH_AUTO_LIST is also  set.
	      If there is an unambiguous prefix to insert on the command line,
	      that is done without a completion list being displayed; in other
	      words,  auto-listing  behaviour  only  takes  place when nothing
	      would be inserted.  In the case of  BASH_AUTO_LIST,  this	 means
	      that the list will be delayed to the third call of the function.

       LIST_BEEP <D>
	      Beep  on	an ambiguous completion.  More accurately, this forces
	      the completion widgets to return status 1 on an  ambiguous  com‐
	      pletion,	which  causes  the shell to beep if the option BEEP is
	      also set; this may be modified if completion is  called  from  a
	      user-defined widget.

       LIST_PACKED
	      Try  to  make the completion list smaller (occupying less lines)
	      by printing the matches in columns with different widths.

       LIST_ROWS_FIRST
	      Lay out the matches in  completion  lists	 sorted	 horizontally,
	      that  is, the second match is to the right of the first one, not
	      under it as usual.

       LIST_TYPES (-X) <D>
	      When listing files that are possible completions, show the  type
	      of each file with a trailing identifying mark.

       LOCAL_OPTIONS <K>
	      If  this option is set at the point of return from a shell func‐
	      tion, all the options (including this one) which were  in	 force
	      upon  entry  to the function are restored.  Otherwise, only this
	      option and the XTRACE and PRINT_EXIT_VALUE options are restored.
	      Hence  if this is explicitly unset by a shell function the other
	      options in force at the point of return will remain so.  A shell
	      function	can  also guarantee itself a known shell configuration
	      with a formulation like  `emulate	 -L  zsh';  the	 -L  activates
	      LOCAL_OPTIONS.

       LOCAL_TRAPS <K>
	      If  this	option is set when a signal trap is set inside a func‐
	      tion, then the previous status of the trap for that signal  will
	      be restored when the function exits.  Note that this option must
	      be set prior to altering	the  trap  behaviour  in  a  function;
	      unlike  LOCAL_OPTIONS,  the  value  on exit from the function is
	      irrelevant.  However, it does not need  to  be  set  before  any
	      global  trap  for	 that  to be correctly restored by a function.
	      For example,

		     unsetopt localtraps
		     trap - INT
		     fn() { setopt localtraps; trap '' INT; sleep 3; }

	      will restore normally handling  of  SIGINT  after	 the  function
	      exits.

       LOGIN (-l, ksh: -l)
	      This  is	a  login shell.	 If this option is not explicitly set,
	      the shell is a login shell if the first character of the argv[0]
	      passed to the shell is a `-'.

       LONG_LIST_JOBS (-R)
	      List jobs in the long format by default.

       MAGIC_EQUAL_SUBST
	      All unquoted arguments of the form `anything=expression' appear‐
	      ing after the command name have  filename	 expansion  (that  is,
	      where  expression has a leading `~' or `=') performed on expres‐
	      sion as if it were a parameter assignment.  The argument is  not
	      otherwise	 treated  specially;  it is passed to the command as a
	      single argument, and not used as an actual parameter assignment.
	      For  example,  in	 echo  foo=~/bar:~/rod,	 both occurrences of ~
	      would be replaced.  Note that this happens anyway	 with  typeset
	      and similar statements.

	      This  option respects the setting of the KSH_TYPESET option.  In
	      other words, if both options are in  effect,  arguments  looking
	      like assignments will not undergo wordsplitting.

       MAIL_WARNING (-U)
	      Print  a	warning message if a mail file has been accessed since
	      the shell last checked.

       MARK_DIRS (-8, ksh: -X)
	      Append a trailing `/' to	all  directory	names  resulting  from
	      filename generation (globbing).

       MENU_COMPLETE (-Y)
	      On  an ambiguous completion, instead of listing possibilities or
	      beeping, insert the first match immediately.  Then when  comple‐
	      tion  is	requested again, remove the first match and insert the
	      second match, etc.  When there are no more matches, go  back  to
	      the  first one again.  reverse-menu-complete may be used to loop
	      through the list in the other direction. This  option  overrides
	      AUTO_MENU.

       MONITOR (-m, ksh: -m)
	      Allow job control.  Set by default in interactive shells.

       MULTIOS <Z>
	      Perform  implicit	 tees  or  cats when multiple redirections are
	      attempted (see the section `Redirection').

       NOMATCH (+3) <C> <Z>
	      If a pattern for filename generation has no  matches,  print  an
	      error,  instead  of  leaving  it unchanged in the argument list.
	      This also applies to file expansion of an initial `~' or `='.

       NOTIFY (-5, ksh: -b) <Z>
	      Report the status of background jobs  immediately,  rather  than
	      waiting until just before printing a prompt.

       NULL_GLOB (-G)
	      If  a pattern for filename generation has no matches, delete the
	      pattern from the argument list instead of	 reporting  an	error.
	      Overrides NOMATCH.

       NUMERIC_GLOB_SORT
	      If  numeric  filenames are matched by a filename generation pat‐
	      tern, sort the filenames numerically rather  than	 lexicographi‐
	      cally.

       OCTAL_ZEROES <S>
	      Interpret	 any integer constant beginning with a 0 as octal, per
	      IEEE Std 1003.2-1992 (ISO 9945-2:1993).  This is not enabled  by
	      default as it causes problems with parsing of, for example, date
	      and time strings with leading zeroes.

       OVERSTRIKE
	      Start up the line editor in overstrike mode.

       PATH_DIRS (-Q)
	      Perform a path search even on  command  names  with  slashes  in
	      them.  Thus if `/usr/local/bin' is in the user's path, and he or
	      she types `X11/xinit',  the  command  `/usr/local/bin/X11/xinit'
	      will  be	executed  (assuming  it	 exists).  Commands explicitly
	      beginning with `/', `./' or `../' are not subject	 to  the  path
	      search.  This also applies to the . builtin.

	      Note  that  subdirectories  of  the current directory are always
	      searched for executables specified in  this  form.   This	 takes
	      place before any search indicated by this option, and regardless
	      of whether `.' or the current directory appear  in  the  command
	      search path.

       POSIX_BUILTINS <K> <S>
	      When  this option is set the command builtin can be used to exe‐
	      cute shell builtin commands.   Parameter	assignments  specified
	      before  shell  functions and special builtins are kept after the
	      command completes unless the special builtin  is	prefixed  with
	      the  command  builtin.   Special	builtins are ., :, break, con‐
	      tinue, declare, eval, exit, export,  integer,  local,  readonly,
	      return, set, shift, source, times, trap and unset.

       PRINT_EIGHT_BIT
	      Print  eight  bit characters literally in completion lists, etc.
	      This option is not necessary if your  system  correctly  returns
	      the printability of eight bit characters (see ctype(3)).

       PRINT_EXIT_VALUE (-1)
	      Print the exit value of programs with non-zero exit status.

       PRIVILEGED (-p, ksh: -p)
	      Turn  on	privileged  mode.  This	 is  enabled  automatically on
	      startup if the effective user (group) ID is  not	equal  to  the
	      real user (group) ID.  Turning this option off causes the effec‐
	      tive user and group IDs to be set to the	real  user  and	 group
	      IDs.  This  option disables sourcing user startup files.	If zsh
	      is invoked as `sh' or `ksh' with this option set, /etc/suid_pro‐
	      file  is	sourced	 (after	 /etc/profile  on interactive shells).
	      Sourcing ~/.profile is disabled and  the	contents  of  the  ENV
	      variable	is ignored. This option cannot be changed using the -m
	      option of setopt and unsetopt, and changing it inside a function
	      always  changes  it  globally  regardless	 of  the LOCAL_OPTIONS
	      option.

       PROMPT_BANG <K>
	      If set, `!' is treated specially in prompt expansion.   See  the
	      section `Prompt Expansion'.

       PROMPT_CR (+V) <D>
	      Print  a	carriage  return  just before printing a prompt in the
	      line editor.  This is on by default  as  multi-line  editing  is
	      only  possible  if  the editor knows where the start of the line
	      appears.

       PROMPT_PERCENT <C> <Z>
	      If set, `%' is treated specially in prompt expansion.   See  the
	      section `Prompt Expansion'.

       PROMPT_SUBST <K>
	      If set, parameter expansion, command substitution and arithmetic
	      expansion are performed in prompts.

       PUSHD_IGNORE_DUPS
	      Don't push multiple copies of the same directory onto the direc‐
	      tory stack.

       PUSHD_MINUS
	      Exchanges the meanings of `+' and `-' when used with a number to
	      specify a directory in the stack.

       PUSHD_SILENT (-E)
	      Do not print the directory stack after pushd or popd.

       PUSHD_TO_HOME (-D)
	      Have pushd with no arguments act like `pushd $HOME'.

       RC_EXPAND_PARAM (-P)
	      Array expansions of the form `foo${xx}bar', where the  parameter
	      xx  is  set  to  (a  b c), are substituted with `fooabar foobbar
	      foocbar' instead of the default `fooa b cbar'.

       RC_QUOTES
	      Allow the character sequence `'''	 to  signify  a	 single	 quote
	      within  singly  quoted  strings.	 Note  this  does not apply in
	      quoted strings using the format $'...', where a backslashed sin‐
	      gle quote can be used.

       RCS (+f) <D>
	      After  /etc/zshenv  is  sourced  on startup, source the .zshenv,
	      /etc/zprofile, .zprofile, /etc/zshrc, .zshrc, /etc/zlogin, .zlo‐
	      gin,  and	 .zlogout  files, as described in the section `Files'.
	      If this option is unset, the /etc/zshenv file is still  sourced,
	      but  any of the others will not be; it can be set at any time to
	      prevent the remaining startup files after the currently  execut‐
	      ing one from being sourced.

       REC_EXACT (-S)
	      In  completion, recognize exact matches even if they are ambigu‐
	      ous.

       RESTRICTED (-r)
	      Enables restricted mode.	This option cannot  be	changed	 using
	      unsetopt,	 and  setting  it  inside a function always changes it
	      globally regardless of the LOCAL_OPTIONS option.	See  the  sec‐
	      tion `Restricted Shell'.

       RM_STAR_SILENT (-H) <K> <S>
	      Do not query the user before executing `rm *' or `rm path/*'.

       RM_STAR_WAIT
	      If  querying  the	 user  before executing `rm *' or `rm path/*',
	      first wait ten seconds and ignore anything typed in  that	 time.
	      This  avoids  the	 problem of reflexively answering `yes' to the
	      query when one didn't really mean it.  The wait  and  query  can
	      always be avoided by expanding the `*' in ZLE (with tab).

       SHARE_HISTORY <K>

	      This option both imports new commands from the history file, and
	      also causes your typed commands to be appended  to  the  history
	      file  (the  latter  is like specifying INC_APPEND_HISTORY).  The
	      history lines are also output with timestamps ala	 EXTENDED_HIS‐
	      TORY  (which  makes it easier to find the spot where we left off
	      reading the file after it gets re-written).

	      By default, history movement commands visit the  imported	 lines
	      as  well	as the local lines, but you can toggle this on and off
	      with the set-local-history zle binding.  It is also possible  to
	      create a zle widget that will make some commands ignore imported
	      commands, and some include them.

	      If you find that you want more control over  when	 commands  get
	      imported,	   you	 may   wish   to   turn	  SHARE_HISTORY	  off,
	      INC_APPEND_HISTORY on, and then manually import  commands	 when‐
	      ever you need them using `fc -RI'.

       SH_FILE_EXPANSION <K> <S>
	      Perform  filename expansion (e.g., ~ expansion) before parameter
	      expansion, command substitution, arithmetic expansion and	 brace
	      expansion.  If this option is unset, it is performed after brace
	      expansion, so things like `~$USERNAME' and `~{pfalstad,rc}' will
	      work.

       SH_GLOB <K> <S>
	      Disables	the special meaning of `(', `|', `)' and '<' for glob‐
	      bing the result of parameter and command substitutions,  and  in
	      some other places where the shell accepts patterns.  This option
	      is set by default if zsh is invoked as sh or ksh.

       SHIN_STDIN (-s, ksh: -s)
	      Commands are being read from the standard input.	 Commands  are
	      read  from standard input if no command is specified with -c and
	      no file of commands is specified.	 If SHIN_STDIN is set  explic‐
	      itly on the command line, any argument that would otherwise have
	      been taken as a file to run will instead be treated as a	normal
	      positional  parameter.   Note  that  setting  or	unsetting this
	      option on the command line does not necessarily affect the state
	      the option will have while the shell is running - that is purely
	      an indicator of whether on not commands are actually being  read
	      from standard input.  The value of this option cannot be changed
	      anywhere other than the command line.

       SH_NULLCMD <K> <S>
	      Do not use the values of	NULLCMD	 and  READNULLCMD  when	 doing
	      redirections, use `:' instead (see the section `Redirection').

       SH_OPTION_LETTERS <K> <S>
	      If this option is set the shell tries to interpret single letter
	      options (which are used with set	and  setopt)  like  ksh	 does.
	      This also affects the value of the - special parameter.

       SHORT_LOOPS <C> <Z>
	      Allow  the  short	 forms	of  for, select, if, and function con‐
	      structs.

       SH_WORD_SPLIT (-y) <K> <S>
	      Causes field splitting to be  performed  on  unquoted  parameter
	      expansions.   Note  that this option has nothing to do with word
	      splitting.  (See the section `Parameter Expansion'.)

       SINGLE_COMMAND (-t, ksh: -t)
	      If the shell is reading from standard input, it  exits  after  a
	      single  command  has  been  executed.  This also makes the shell
	      non-interactive, unless the INTERACTIVE option is explicitly set
	      on the command line.  The value of this option cannot be changed
	      anywhere other than the command line.

       SINGLE_LINE_ZLE (-M) <K>
	      Use single-line command line editing instead of multi-line.

       SUN_KEYBOARD_HACK (-L)
	      If a line ends with a backquote, and there are an odd number  of
	      backquotes  on the line, ignore the trailing backquote.  This is
	      useful on some keyboards where the return key is too small,  and
	      the backquote key lies annoyingly close to it.

       UNSET (+u, ksh: +u) <K> <S> <Z>
	      Treat  unset parameters as if they were empty when substituting.
	      Otherwise they are treated as an error.

       VERBOSE (-v, ksh: -v)
	      Print shell input lines as they are read.

       XTRACE (-x, ksh: -x)
	      Print commands and their arguments as they are executed.

       ZLE (-Z)
	      Use the zsh line editor.	Set by default in  interactive	shells
	      connected to a terminal.

OPTION ALIASES
       Some  options have alternative names.  These aliases are never used for
       output, but can be used just like normal option names  when  specifying
       options to the shell.

       BRACE_EXPAND
	      NO_IGNORE_BRACES (ksh and bash compatibility)

       DOT_GLOB
	      GLOB_DOTS (bash compatibility)

       HASH_ALL
	      HASH_CMDS (bash compatibility)

       HIST_APPEND
	      APPEND_HISTORY (bash compatibility)

       HIST_EXPAND
	      BANG_HIST (bash compatibility)

       LOG    NO_HIST_NO_FUNCTIONS (ksh compatibility)

       MAIL_WARN
	      MAIL_WARNING (bash compatibility)

       ONE_CMD
	      SINGLE_COMMAND (bash compatibility)

       PHYSICAL
	      CHASE_LINKS (ksh and bash compatibility)

       PROMPT_VARS
	      PROMPT_SUBST (bash compatibility)

       STDIN  SHIN_STDIN (ksh compatibility)

       TRACK_ALL
	      HASH_CMDS (ksh compatibility)

SINGLE LETTER OPTIONS
   Default set
       -0     CORRECT
       -1     PRINT_EXIT_VALUE
       -2     NO_BAD_PATTERN
       -3     NO_NOMATCH
       -4     GLOB_DOTS
       -5     NOTIFY
       -6     BG_NICE
       -7     IGNORE_EOF
       -8     MARK_DIRS
       -9     AUTO_LIST
       -B     NO_BEEP
       -C     NO_CLOBBER
       -D     PUSHD_TO_HOME
       -E     PUSHD_SILENT
       -F     NO_GLOB
       -G     NULL_GLOB
       -H     RM_STAR_SILENT
       -I     IGNORE_BRACES
       -J     AUTO_CD
       -K     NO_BANG_HIST
       -L     SUN_KEYBOARD_HACK
       -M     SINGLE_LINE_ZLE
       -N     AUTO_PUSHD
       -O     CORRECT_ALL
       -P     RC_EXPAND_PARAM
       -Q     PATH_DIRS
       -R     LONG_LIST_JOBS
       -S     REC_EXACT
       -T     CDABLE_VARS
       -U     MAIL_WARNING
       -V     NO_PROMPT_CR
       -W     AUTO_RESUME
       -X     LIST_TYPES
       -Y     MENU_COMPLETE
       -Z     ZLE
       -a     ALL_EXPORT
       -e     ERR_EXIT
       -f     NO_RCS
       -g     HIST_IGNORE_SPACE
       -h     HIST_IGNORE_DUPS
       -i     INTERACTIVE
       -k     INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS
       -l     LOGIN
       -m     MONITOR
       -n     NO_EXEC
       -p     PRIVILEGED
       -r     RESTRICTED
       -s     SHIN_STDIN
       -t     SINGLE_COMMAND
       -u     NO_UNSET
       -v     VERBOSE
       -w     CHASE_LINKS
       -x     XTRACE
       -y     SH_WORD_SPLIT

   sh/ksh emulation set
       -C     NO_CLOBBER
       -X     MARK_DIRS
       -a     ALL_EXPORT
       -b     NOTIFY
       -e     ERR_EXIT
       -f     NO_GLOB
       -i     INTERACTIVE
       -l     LOGIN
       -m     MONITOR
       -n     NO_EXEC
       -p     PRIVILEGED
       -r     RESTRICTED
       -s     SHIN_STDIN
       -t     SINGLE_COMMAND
       -u     NO_UNSET
       -v     VERBOSE
       -x     XTRACE

   Also note
       -A     Used by set for setting arrays
       -b     Used on the command line to specify end of option processing
       -c     Used on the command line to specify a single command
       -m     Used by setopt for pattern-matching option setting
       -o     Used in all places to allow use of long option names
       -s     Used by set to sort positional parameters

ZSHBUILTINS(1)							ZSHBUILTINS(1)

NAME
       zshbuiltins - zsh built-in commands

SHELL BUILTIN COMMANDS
       - simple command
	      See the section `Precommand Modifiers'.

       . file [ arg ... ]
	      Read  commands  from  file and execute them in the current shell
	      environment.

	      If file does not contain a slash, or if PATH_DIRS	 is  set,  the
	      shell  looks  in	the  components of $path to find the directory
	      containing file.	Files in the current directory	are  not  read
	      unless  `.'  appears  somewhere  in  $path.   If	a  file	 named
	      `file.zwc' is found, is newer than file,	and  is	 the  compiled
	      form  (created with the zcompile builtin) of file, then commands
	      are read from that file instead of file.

	      If any arguments arg  are	 given,	 they  become  the  positional
	      parameters;  the old positional parameters are restored when the
	      file is done executing.  The exit status is the exit  status  of
	      the last command executed.

       : [ arg ... ]
	      This  command  does nothing, although normal argument expansions
	      is performed which may have effects on shell parameters.	A zero
	      exit code is returned.

       alias [ {+|-}gmrL ] [ name[=value] ... ]
	      For  each	 name with a corresponding value, define an alias with
	      that value.  A trailing space in value causes the next  word  to
	      be  checked  for	alias  expansion.   If the -g flag is present,
	      define a global alias; global aliases are expanded even if  they
	      do not occur in command position.

	      For  each	 name  with no value, print the value of name, if any.
	      With no arguments, print all currently defined aliases.  If  the
	      -m  flag	is  given  the	arguments  are taken as patterns (they
	      should be quoted to preserve them from being interpreted as glob
	      patterns),  and the aliases matching these patterns are printed.
	      When printing aliases and the -g or -r flags are	present,  then
	      restrict	the  printing  to  global  or regular aliases, respec‐
	      tively.  Using `+' instead of `-', or  ending  the  option  list
	      with a single `+', prevents the values of the aliases from being
	      printed.

	      If the -L flag is present, then print each  alias	 in  a	manner
	      suitable	for  putting  in a startup script.  The exit status is
	      nonzero if a name (with no value) is given for  which  no	 alias
	      has been defined.

       autoload [ {+|-}UXmt ] [ -wkz ] [ name ... ]
	      Equivalent  to functions -u, with the exception of -X/+X, -w, -k
	      and -z.

	      The flag -X may be used only inside a shell  function,  and  may
	      not be followed by a name.  It causes the calling function to be
	      marked for autoloading and then immediately loaded and executed,
	      with  the	 current  array of positional parameters as arguments.
	      This replaces the previous definition of the  function.	If  no
	      function	definition is found, an error is printed and the func‐
	      tion remains undefined and marked for autoloading.

	      The flag +X attempts to load each name as	 an  autoloaded	 func‐
	      tion,  but  does	not execute it.	 The exit status is zero (suc‐
	      cess) if the function was not previously defined and  a  defini‐
	      tion for it was found.  This does not replace any existing defi‐
	      nition of the function.  The exit status is nonzero (failure) if
	      the  function  was  already  defined  or	when no definition was
	      found.  In the latter case the function  remains	undefined  and
	      marked for autoloading.

	      The  flag	 +X  may  be combined with either -k or -z to make the
	      function be loaded using	ksh-style  or  zsh-style  autoloading,
	      respectively.  If	 neither  is given, the current setting of the
	      KSH_AUTOLOAD options determines how the function is loaded. With
	      ksh-style autoloading, the contents of the file will not be exe‐
	      cuted immediately. Instead, the function	created	 will  contain
	      the  contents  of	 the  file  plus a call to the function itself
	      appended to it, thus given normal ksh autoloading	 behaviour  on
	      the first call to the function.

	      With the -w flag, the names are taken as names of files compiled
	      with the zcompile builtin, and all functions defined in them are
	      marked for autoloading.

       bg [ job ... ]
       job ... &
	      Put  each specified job in the background, or the current job if
	      none is specified.

       bindkey
	      See the section `Zle Builtins' in zshzle(1).

       break [ n ]
	      Exit from an enclosing for, while, until, select or repeat loop.
	      If n is specified, then break n levels instead of just one.

       builtin name [ args ... ]
	      Executes the builtin name, with the given args.

       bye    Same as exit.

       cap    See the section `The zsh/cap Module' in zshmodules(1).

       cd [ -sLP ] [ arg ]
       cd [ -sLP ] old new
       cd [ -sLP ] {+|-}n
	      Change  the  current  directory.	 In the first form, change the
	      current directory to arg, or to the value of $HOME if arg is not
	      specified.   If  arg is `-', change to the value of $OLDPWD, the
	      previous directory.  Otherwise, if a directory named arg is  not
	      found  in	 the  current  directory and arg does not begin with a
	      slash, search each component of the shell parameter cdpath.   If
	      no  directory  is found and the option CDABLE_VARS is set, and a
	      parameter named arg exists whose	value  begins  with  a	slash,
	      treat  its  value as the directory.  In that case, the parameter
	      is added to the named directory hash table.

	      The second form of cd substitutes the string new for the	string
	      old in the name of the current directory, and tries to change to
	      this new directory.

	      The third form of cd extracts an entry from the directory stack,
	      and  changes  to	that  directory.  An argument of the form `+n'
	      identifies a stack entry by counting from the left of  the  list
	      shown  by	 the dirs command, starting with zero.	An argument of
	      the form `-n' counts from the right.  If the PUSHD_MINUS	option
	      is set, the meanings of `+' and `-' in this context are swapped.

	      If  the -s option is specified, cd refuses to change the current
	      directory if the given pathname contains symlinks.   If  the  -P
	      option is given or the CHASE_LINKS option is set, symbolic links
	      are resolved to their true values.  If the -L  option  is	 given
	      symbolic	links  are  followed  regardless  of  the state of the
	      CHASE_LINKS option.

       chdir  Same as cd.

       clone  See the section `The zsh/clone Module' in zshmodules(1).

       command simple command
	      See the section `Precommand Modifiers'.

       comparguments
	      See the section `The zsh/computil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       compcall
	      See the section `The zsh/compctl Module' in zshmodules(1).

       compctl
	      See the section `The zsh/compctl Module' in zshmodules(1).

       compdescribe
	      See the section `The zsh/computil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       compfiles
	      See the section `The zsh/computil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       compgroups
	      See the section `The zsh/computil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       compquote
	      See the section `The zsh/computil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       comptags
	      See the section `The zsh/computil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       comptry
	      See the section `The zsh/computil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       compvalues
	      See the section `The zsh/computil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       continue [ n ]
	      Resume the next iteration of the enclosing  for,	while,	until,
	      select  or  repeat  loop.	  If  n is specified, break out of n-1
	      loops and resume at the nth enclosing loop.

       declare
	      Same as typeset.

       dirs [ -v ] [ arg ... ]
	      With no arguments, print the contents of	the  directory	stack.
	      If  the  -v option is given, number the directories in the stack
	      when printing.  Directories are added to	this  stack  with  the
	      pushd  command,  and  removed  with the cd or popd commands.  If
	      arguments are specified, load them  onto	the  directory	stack,
	      replacing	 anything  that was there, and push the current direc‐
	      tory onto the stack.

       disable [ -afmr ] name ...
	      Temporarily disable the named hash table elements.  The  default
	      is  to  disable  builtin	commands.   This  allows you to use an
	      external command with the same name as a builtin	command.   The
	      -a  option  causes  disable  to  act  on aliases.	 The -f option
	      causes disable to act on shell functions.	 The -r options causes
	      disable  to  act	on reserved words.  Without arguments all dis‐
	      abled hash table elements from the corresponding hash table  are
	      printed.	 With  the -m flag the arguments are taken as patterns
	      (which should be quoted to prevent them from undergoing filename
	      expansion),  and	all hash table elements from the corresponding
	      hash table  matching  these  patterns  are  disabled.   Disabled
	      objects can be enabled with the enable command.

       disown [ job ... ]
       job ... &|
       job ... &!
	      Remove  the specified jobs from the job table; the shell will no
	      longer report their status, and will not complain if you try  to
	      exit  an	interactive shell with them running or stopped.	 If no
	      job is specified, disown the current job.

       echo [ -neE ] [ arg ... ]
	      Write each arg on the standard output, with a  space  separating
	      each one.	 If the -n flag is not present, print a newline at the
	      end.  echo recognizes the following escape sequences:

	      \a     bell character
	      \b     backspace
	      \c     suppress final newline
	      \e     escape
	      \f     form feed
	      \n     linefeed (newline)
	      \r     carriage return
	      \t     horizontal tab
	      \v     vertical tab
	      \\     backslash
	      \0NNN  character code in octal
	      \xNN   character code in hexadecimal

	      The -E flag, or the BSD_ECHO option,  can	 be  used  to  disable
	      these escape sequences.  In the latter case, -e flag can be used
	      to enable them.

       echotc See the section `The zsh/termcap Module' in zshmodules(1).

       echoti See the section `The zsh/terminfo Module' in zshmodules(1).

       emulate [ -LR ] {zsh|sh|ksh|csh}
	      Set up zsh options to emulate the specified  shell  as  much  as
	      possible.	 csh will never be fully emulated.  If the argument is
	      not one of the shells listed  above,  zsh	 will  be  used	 as  a
	      default; more precisely, the tests performed on the argument are
	      the same as those used to determine  the	emulation  at  startup
	      based on the shell name, see the section `Compatibility' in zsh‐
	      misc(1) .	 If the -R option is given, all options are  reset  to
	      their  default  value  corresponding  to the specified emulation
	      mode, except for	certain	 options  describing  the  interactive
	      environment;  otherwise,	only  those  options  likely  to cause
	      portability problems in scripts and functions are	 altered.   If
	      the   -L	 option	  is  given,  the  options  LOCAL_OPTIONS  and
	      LOCAL_TRAPS will be set as well, causing the effects of the emu‐
	      late command and any setopt and trap commands to be local to the
	      immediately surrounding shell function, if any;  normally	 these
	      options are turned off in all emulation modes except ksh.

       enable [ -afmr ] name ...
	      Enable  the  named hash table elements, presumably disabled ear‐
	      lier with disable.  The default is to enable  builtin  commands.
	      The  -a  option  causes enable to act on aliases.	 The -f option
	      causes enable to act on shell functions.	The -r	option	causes
	      enable  to act on reserved words.	 Without arguments all enabled
	      hash table  elements  from  the  corresponding  hash  table  are
	      printed.	 With  the -m flag the arguments are taken as patterns
	      (should be quoted) and all hash table elements from  the	corre‐
	      sponding	 hash  table  matching	these  patterns	 are  enabled.
	      Enabled objects can be disabled with the	disable	 builtin  com‐
	      mand.

       eval [ arg ... ]
	      Read the arguments as input to the shell and execute the result‐
	      ing command in the current shell process.

       exec simple command
	      See the section `Precommand Modifiers'.

       exit [ n ]
	      Exit the shell with the exit code specified by  n;  if  none  is
	      specified, use the exit code from the last command executed.  An
	      EOF condition will also cause the	 shell	to  exit,  unless  the
	      IGNORE_EOF option is set.

       export [ name[=value] ... ]
	      The specified names are marked for automatic export to the envi‐
	      ronment of subsequently executed commands.  Equivalent to	 type‐
	      set -gx.	If a parameter specified does not already exist, it is
	      created in the global scope.

       false [ arg ... ]
	      Do nothing and return an exit code of 1.

       fc [ -e ename ] [ -nlrdDfEim ] [ old=new ... ] [ first [ last ] ]
       fc -ARWI [ filename ]
	      Select a range of commands from first to last from  the  history
	      list.  The arguments first and last may be specified as a number
	      or as a string.  A negative number is used as an offset  to  the
	      current  history	event  number.	 A  string  specifies the most
	      recent event beginning with the given string.  All substitutions
	      old=new, if any, are then performed on the commands.

	      If  the  -l  flag is given, the resulting commands are listed on
	      standard output.	If the -m flag is also given the  first	 argu‐
	      ment  is taken as a pattern (should be quoted) and only the his‐
	      tory events matching this pattern will be shown.	Otherwise  the
	      editor  program ename is invoked on a file containing these his‐
	      tory events.  If ename is not given, the value of the  parameter
	      FCEDIT  is  used.	  If ename is `-', no editor is invoked.  When
	      editing is complete, the edited command is executed.

	      If first is not specified, it will be set to -1 (the most recent
	      event), or to -16 if the -l flag is given.  If last is not spec‐
	      ified, it will be set to first, or to  -1	 if  the  -l  flag  is
	      given.

	      The  flag	 -r reverses the order of the commands and the flag -n
	      suppresses command numbers when listing.	Also when listing,  -d
	      prints timestamps for each command, and -f prints full time-date
	      stamps.  Adding the -E flag causes the dates to  be  printed  as
	      `dd.mm.yyyy',  instead  of the default `mm/dd/yyyy'.  Adding the
	      -i flag causes the dates to be printed in	 ISO8601  `yyyy-mm-dd'
	      format.  With the -D flag, fc prints elapsed times.

	      `fc  -R'	reads  the history from the given file, `fc -W' writes
	      the history out to the given file, and `fc -A' appends the  his‐
	      tory  out	 to  the given file.  If no filename is specified, the
	      $HISTFILE is assumed.  If the -I option is  added	 to  -R,  only
	      those  events that are not already contained within the internal
	      history list are added.  If the -I option is added to -A or  -W,
	      only   those   events   that  are	 new  since  last  incremental
	      append/write to the history file are appended/written.   In  any
	      case, the created file will have no more than $SAVEHIST entries.

       fg [ job ... ]
       job ...
	      Bring  each  specified job in turn to the foreground.  If no job
	      is specified, resume the current job.

       float [ {+|-}EFghlrtux ] [ name[=value] ... ]
	      Equivalent to typeset -E,	 except	 that  options	irrelevant  to
	      floating point numbers are not permitted.

       functions [ {+|-}UXmtu ] [ name ... ]
	      Equivalent to typeset -f.

       getcap See the section `The zsh/cap Module' in zshmodules(1).

       getln [ -AclneE ] name ...
	      Read the top value from the buffer stack and put it in the shell
	      parameter name.  Equivalent to read -zr.

       getopts optstring name [ arg ... ]
	      Checks the args for legal options.  If the args are omitted, use
	      the  positional parameters.  A valid option argument begins with
	      a `+' or a `-'.  An argument not beginning with a `+' or a  `-',
	      or  the argument `--', ends the options.	optstring contains the
	      letters that getopts recognizes.	If a letter is followed	 by  a
	      `:',  that  option is expected to have an argument.  The options
	      can be separated from the argument by blanks.

	      Each time it is invoked, getopts places  the  option  letter  it
	      finds in the shell parameter name, prepended with a `+' when arg
	      begins with a `+'.  The index of	the  next  arg	is  stored  in
	      OPTIND.  The option argument, if any, is stored in OPTARG.

	      The  first  option  to  be examined may be changed by explicitly
	      assigning to OPTIND.  OPTIND has an initial value of 1,  and  is
	      normally	reset to 1 upon exit from a shell function.  OPTARG is
	      not reset and retains its value from the	most  recent  call  to
	      getopts.	 If either of OPTIND or OPTARG is explicitly unset, it
	      remains unset, and the index or option argument is  not  stored.
	      The option itself is still stored in name in this case.

	      A leading `:' in optstring causes getopts to store the letter of
	      any invalid option in OPTARG, and to set	name  to  `?'  for  an
	      unknown  option  and  to	`:' when a required option is missing.
	      Otherwise, getopts sets name to `?' and prints an error  message
	      when  an	option	is  invalid.   The exit status is nonzero when
	      there are no more options.

       hash [ -Ldfmrv ] [ name[=value] ] ...
	      hash can be used to directly modify the contents of the  command
	      hash  table,  and	 the named directory hash table.  Normally one
	      would modify these tables by modifying one's PATH (for the  com‐
	      mand  hash  table)  or  by creating appropriate shell parameters
	      (for the named directory hash table).  The choice of hash	 table
	      to  work	on  is determined by the -d option; without the option
	      the command hash table is used, and with the  option  the	 named
	      directory hash table is used.

	      Given  no	 arguments,  and  neither  the	-r  or -f options, the
	      selected hash table will be listed in full.

	      The -r option causes the selected hash table to be emptied.   It
	      will  be	subsequently  rebuilt  in  the normal fashion.	The -f
	      option causes the selected hash table to be fully rebuilt	 imme‐
	      diately.	 For  the command hash table this hashes all the abso‐
	      lute directories in the PATH, and for the named  directory  hash
	      table  this adds all users' home directories.  These two options
	      cannot be used with any arguments.

	      The -m option causes the	arguments  to  be  taken  as  patterns
	      (which  should  be  quoted)  and	the elements of the hash table
	      matching those patterns are printed.  This is the	 only  way  to
	      display a limited selection of hash table elements.

	      For  each	 name  with  a	corresponding value, put `name' in the
	      selected hash table, associating it with the  pathname  `value'.
	      In  the  command	hash table, this means that whenever `name' is
	      used as a command argument, the shell will try  to  execute  the
	      file  given by `value'.  In the named directory hash table, this
	      means that `value' may be referred to as `~name'.

	      For each name with no corresponding value, attempt to  add  name
	      to the hash table, checking what the appropriate value is in the
	      normal manner for that hash  table.   If	an  appropriate	 value
	      can't be found, then the hash table will be unchanged.

	      The -v option causes hash table entries to be listed as they are
	      added by explicit specification.	If has no effect if used  with
	      -f.

	      If the -L flag is present, then each hash table entry is printed
	      in the form of a call to hash.

       history
	      Same as fc -l.

       integer [ {+|-}ghilrtux ] [ name[=value] ... ]
	      Equivalent to typeset -i,	 except	 that  options	irrelevant  to
	      integers are not permitted.

       jobs [ -dlprs ] [ job ... ]
       jobs -Z string
	      Lists  information  about	 each given job, or all jobs if job is
	      omitted.	The -l flag lists process IDs, and the -p  flag	 lists
	      process  groups.	 If the -r flag is specified only running jobs
	      will be listed and if the -s flag is given only stopped jobs are
	      shown.   If  the	-d flag is given, the directory from which the
	      job was started (which may not be the current directory  of  the
	      job) will also be shown.

	      The  -Z  option  replaces	 the  shell's argument and environment
	      space with the given string,  truncated  if  necessary  to  fit.
	      This will normally be visible in ps (ps(1)) listings.  This fea‐
	      ture is typically used by daemons, to indicate their state.

       kill [ -s signal_name ] job ...
       kill [ -sig ] job ...
       kill -l [ sig ... ]
	      Sends either SIGTERM or the specified signal to the  given  jobs
	      or  processes.  Signals are given by number or by names, without
	      the `SIG' prefix.	 If the signal being sent  is  not  `KILL'  or
	      `CONT',  then  the  job  will  be	 sent a `CONT' signal if it is
	      stopped.	The argument job can be the process ID of a job not in
	      the  job list.  In the third form, kill -l, if sig is not speci‐
	      fied the signal names are listed.	 Otherwise, for each sig  that
	      is  a name, the corresponding signal number is listed.  For each
	      sig that is a signal number or a number  representing  the  exit
	      status  of a process which was terminated or stopped by a signal
	      the name of the signal is printed.

       let arg ...
	      Evaluate each arg as an arithmetic expression.  See the  section
	      `Arithmetic  Evaluation' for a description of arithmetic expres‐
	      sions.  The exit status is 0 if the value of the last expression
	      is nonzero, and 1 otherwise.

       limit [ -hs ] [ resource [ limit ] ] ...
	      Set  or  display	resource limits.  Unless the -s flag is given,
	      the limit applies only the children of  the  shell.   If	-s  is
	      given  without  other arguments, the resource limits of the cur‐
	      rent shell is set to the previously set resource limits  of  the
	      children.

	      If  limit	 is  not  specified, print the current limit placed on
	      resource, otherwise set the limit to the	specified  value.   If
	      the  -h  flag  is given, use hard limits instead of soft limits.
	      If no resource is given, print all limits.

	      resource can be one of:

	      addressspace
		     Maximum amount of address space used.
	      aiomemorylocked
		     Maximum amount of memory locked in	 RAM  for  AIO	opera‐
		     tions.
	      aiooperations
		     Maximum number of AIO operations.
	      cachedthreads
		     Maximum number of cached threads.
	      coredumpsize
		     Maximum size of a core dump.
	      cputime
		     Maximum CPU seconds per process.
	      datasize
		     Maximum data size (including stack) for each process.
	      descriptors
		     Maximum value for a file descriptor.
	      filesize
		     Largest single file allowed.
	      maxproc
		     Maximum number of processes.
	      maxpthreads
		     Maximum number of threads per process.
	      memorylocked
		     Maximum amount of memory locked in RAM.
	      memoryuse
		     Maximum resident set size.
	      resident
		     Maximum resident set size.
	      sockbufsize
		     Maximum size of all socket buffers.
	      stacksize
		     Maximum stack size for each process.
	      vmemorysize
		     Maximum amount of virtual memory.

	      Which of these resource limits are available depends on the sys‐
	      tem.  resource can be abbreviated to any unambiguous prefix.

	      limit is a number, with an optional scaling factor, as follows:

	      nh     hours
	      nk     kilobytes (default)
	      nm     megabytes or minutes
	      [mm:]ss
		     minutes and seconds

       local [ {+|-}AEFLRUZahilrtux [n]] [ name[=value] ] ...
	      Same as typeset, except that the options -g, and -f are not per‐
	      mitted.	In  this  case the -x option does not force the use of
	      -g, i.e. exported variables will be local to functions.

       log    List all users currently logged in who are affected by the  cur‐
	      rent setting of the watch parameter.

       logout [ n ]
	      Same as exit, except that it only works in a login shell.

       noglob simple command
	      See the section `Precommand Modifiers'.

       popd [ {+|-}n ]
	      Remove  an  entry	 from the directory stack, and perform a cd to
	      the new top directory.  With no argument, the current top	 entry
	      is  removed.   An	 argument  of the form `+n' identifies a stack
	      entry by counting from the left of the list shown	 by  the  dirs
	      command,	starting with zero.  An argument of the form -n counts
	      from the right.  If the PUSHD_MINUS option is set, the  meanings
	      of `+' and `-' in this context are swapped.

       print [ -bnrslzpNDPoOicm ] [ -un ] [ -R [ -en ]] [ arg ... ]
	      With no flags or with flag `-', the arguments are printed on the
	      standard output as described by echo, with the following differ‐
	      ences: the escape sequence `\M-x' metafies the character x (sets
	      the highest bit), `\C-x' produces a  control  character  (`\C-@'
	      and  `\C-?'  give	 the characters NUL and delete), and `\E' is a
	      synonym for `\e'.	 Finally, if not in an	escape	sequence,  `\'
	      escapes the following character and is not printed.

	      -r     Ignore the escape conventions of echo.

	      -R     Emulate  the  BSD	echo  command,	which does not process
		     escape sequences unless the -e flag  is  given.   The  -n
		     flag suppresses the trailing newline.  Only the -e and -n
		     flags are recognized after -R; all	 other	arguments  and
		     options are printed.

	      -b     Recognize	all the escape sequences defined for the bind‐
		     key command, see zshzle(1).

	      -m     Take the first argument as a pattern (should be  quoted),
		     and remove it from the argument list together with subse‐
		     quent arguments that do not match this pattern.

	      -s     Place the results in the history list instead of  on  the
		     standard output.

	      -n     Do not add a newline to the output.

	      -l     Print the arguments separated by newlines instead of spa‐
		     ces.

	      -N     Print the arguments separated and terminated by nulls.

	      -o     Print the arguments sorted in ascending order.

	      -O     Print the arguments sorted in descending order.

	      -i     If given together with -o or  -O,	sorting	 is  performed
		     case-independently.

	      -c     Print the arguments in columns.

	      -un    Print the arguments to file descriptor n.

	      -p     Print the arguments to the input of the coprocess.

	      -z     Push  the	arguments onto the editing buffer stack, sepa‐
		     rated by spaces.

	      -D     Treat the arguments as directory  names,  replacing  pre‐
		     fixes with ~ expressions, as appropriate.

	      -P     Perform prompt expansion (see zshmisc(1)).

       pushd [ arg ]
       pushd old new
       pushd {+|-}n
	      Change the current directory, and push the old current directory
	      onto the directory stack.	 In the first form, change the current
	      directory to arg.	 If arg is not specified, change to the second
	      directory on the stack (that is, exchange the top two  entries),
	      or  change  to  $HOME  if	 the PUSHD_TO_HOME option is set or if
	      there is only one entry on the stack.  Otherwise, arg is	inter‐
	      preted  as it would be by cd.  The meaning of old and new in the
	      second form is also the same as for cd.

	      The third form of pushd changes directory by rotating the direc‐
	      tory  list.   An	argument  of  the form `+n' identifies a stack
	      entry by counting from the left of the list shown	 by  the  dirs
	      command,	starting  with	zero.	An  argument  of the form `-n'
	      counts from the right.  If the PUSHD_MINUS option	 is  set,  the
	      meanings of `+' and `-' in this context are swapped.

	      If  the option PUSHD_SILENT is not set, the directory stack will
	      be printed after a pushd is performed.

       pushln [ arg ... ]
	      Equivalent to print -nz.

       pwd [ -rLP ]
	      Print the absolute pathname of the  current  working  directory.
	      If the -r or the -P flag is specified, or the CHASE_LINKS option
	      is set and the -L flag is not given, the printed path  will  not
	      contain symbolic links.

       r      Same as fc -e -.

       read [ -rzpqAclneEt ] [ -k [ num ] ]
	[ -un ] [ name[?prompt] ] [ name ...  ]
	      Read  one	 line and break it into fields using the characters in
	      $IFS as separators, except as noted below.  The first  field  is
	      assigned to the first name, the second field to the second name,
	      etc., with leftover fields assigned to the last name.   If  name
	      is omitted then REPLY is used for scalars and reply for arrays.

	      -r     Raw  mode:	 a  `\'	 at the end of a line does not signify
		     line continuation and backslashes in the line don't quote
		     the following character and are not removed.

	      -q     Read only one character from the terminal and set name to
		     `y' if this character was `y' or `Y' and  to  `n'	other‐
		     wise.   With  this flag set the return value is zero only
		     if the character was `y' or `Y'.  Note that  this	always
		     reads  from  the terminal, even if used with the -p or -u
		     or -z flags or with redirected input.   This  option  may
		     also be used within zle widgets.

	      -k [ num ]
		     Read  only	 one (or num) characters.  All are assigned to
		     the first name, without word  splitting.	This  flag  is
		     ignored  when -q is present.  Input is read from the ter‐
		     minal unless one of -u or -p is present.  This option may
		     also be used within zle widgets.

		     Note  that	 num must be in the argument word that follows
		     -k, not in the same word.	See -u.

	      -z     Read one entry from the editor buffer stack and assign it
		     to	 the  first  name,  without  word  splitting.  Text is
		     pushed onto the stack with `print -z' or  with  push-line
		     from  the	line  editor  (see  zshzle(1)).	  This flag is
		     ignored when the -k or -q flags are present.

	      -e
	      -E     The input read is printed (echoed) to the	standard  out‐
		     put.  If the -e flag is used, no input is assigned to the
		     parameters.

	      -A     The first name is taken as the name of an array  and  all
		     words are assigned to it.

	      -c
	      -l     These  flags are allowed only if called inside a function
		     used for completion (specified with the -K flag  to  com‐
		     pctl).  If the -c flag is given, the words of the current
		     command are read. If the -l flag is given, the whole line
		     is	 assigned  as a scalar.	 If both flags are present, -l
		     is used and -c is ignored.

	      -n     Together with -c, the number of the word the cursor is on
		     is	 read.	With -l, the index of the character the cursor
		     is on is read.  Note that the command name is word number
		     1,	 not word 0, and that when the cursor is at the end of
		     the line, its character index is the length of  the  line
		     plus one.

	      -un    Input is read from file descriptor n, where n is a single
		     digit and must not be separated from  -u  by  any	white‐
		     space.

	      -p     Input is read from the coprocess.

	      -t     Test  if input is available before attempting to read; if
		     none is, return status 1 and do not  set  any  variables.
		     This is not available when reading from the editor buffer
		     with -z, when called from within completion  with	-c  or
		     -l,  with -q which clears the input queue before reading,
		     or within zle where other mechanisms should  be  used  to
		     test for input.

		     Note  that	 read does not attempt to alter the input pro‐
		     cessing mode.  The default mode is	 canonical  input,  in
		     which  an entire line is read at a time, so usually `read
		     -t' will not read anything until an entire line has  been
		     typed.   However,	when reading from the terminal with -k
		     this is automatically handled; note that only  availabil‐
		     ity  of the first character is tested, so that e.g. `read
		     -t -k 2' can still block on the second character.	If the
		     first argument contains a `?', the remainder of this word
		     is used as a prompt on standard error when the  shell  is
		     interactive.

	      The  value  (exit	 status)  of  read is 1 when an end-of-file is
	      encountered, or when -c or -l is present and the command is  not
	      called  from a compctl function, or as described for -q.	Other‐
	      wise the value is 0.

	      The behavior of some combinations of the -k, -p, -q, -u  and  -z
	      flags  is	 undefined.   Presently	 -q cancels all the others, -p
	      cancels -u, -k cancels -z, and otherwise -z cancels both -p  and
	      -u.

	      The -c or -l flags cancel any and all of -kpquz.

       readonly
	      Same as typeset -r.

       rehash Same as hash -r.

       return [ n ]
	      Causes  a	 shell	function or . script to return to the invoking
	      script with the return status specified by n.  If n is  omitted,
	      the return status is that of the last command executed.

	      If  return  was  executed from a trap in a TRAPNAL function, the
	      effect is different for zero and non-zero return	status.	  With
	      zero  status  (or	 after	an  implicit  return at the end of the
	      trap), the shell will return to whatever it was previously  pro‐
	      cessing; with a non-zero status, the shell will behave as inter‐
	      rupted except that the return status of the  trap	 is  retained.
	      Note  that the numeric value of the signal which caused the trap
	      is passed as  the	 first	argument,  so  the  statement  `return
	      $((128+$1))'  will  return  the same status as if the signal had
	      not been trapped.

       sched  See the section `The zsh/sched Module' in zshmodules(1).

       set [ {+|-}options | {+|-}o option_name ] ... [ {+|-}A [ name ] ] [ arg
       ... ]
	      Set  the options for the shell and/or set the positional parame‐
	      ters, or declare and set an array.  If the -s option  is	given,
	      it  causes the specified arguments to be sorted before assigning
	      them to the positional parameters (or to the array name if -A is
	      used).   With  +s	 sort  arguments in descending order.  For the
	      meaning of the other flags, see  zshoptions(1).	Flags  may  be
	      specified by name using the -o option.

	      If  the -A flag is specified, name is set to an array containing
	      the given args. if +A is used and name is an  array,  the	 given
	      arguments will replace the initial elements of that array; if no
	      name is specified, all arrays are printed.  Otherwise the	 posi‐
	      tional  parameters are set.  If no arguments are given, then the
	      names and values of all parameters are printed on	 the  standard
	      output.	If  the only argument is `+', the names of all parame‐
	      ters are printed.

       setcap See the section `The zsh/cap Module' in zshmodules(1).

       setopt [ {+|-}options | {+|-}o option_name ] [ name ... ]
	      Set the options for the shell.   All  options  specified	either
	      with  flags  or  by name are set.	 If no arguments are supplied,
	      the names of all options currently set are printed.  If  the  -m
	      flag  is given the arguments are taken as patterns (which should
	      be quoted to protect them	 from  filename	 expansion),  and  all
	      options with names matching these patterns are set.

       shift [ n ] [ name ... ]
	      The  positional  parameters  ${n+1}  ...	are renamed to $1 ...,
	      where n is an arithmetic expression that defaults to 1.  If  any
	      names  are  given	 then  the arrays with these names are shifted
	      instead of the positional parameters.

       source file [ arg ... ]
	      Same as ., except that the current directory is always  searched
	      and is always searched first, before directories in $path.

       stat   See the section `The zsh/stat Module' in zshmodules(1).

       suspend [ -f ]
	      Suspend  the execution of the shell (send it a SIGTSTP) until it
	      receives a SIGCONT.  Unless the -f option is  given,  this  will
	      refuse to suspend a login shell.

       test [ arg ... ]
       [ [ arg ... ] ]
	      Like  the	 system version of test.  Added for compatibility; use
	      conditional expressions instead (see  the	 section  `Conditional
	      Expressions').

       times  Print  the  accumulated  user and system times for the shell and
	      for processes run from the shell.

       trap [ arg [ sig ... ] ]
	      arg is a series of commands (usually quoted to protect  it  from
	      immediate	 evaluation by the shell) to be read and executed when
	      the shell receives sig.  Each sig can be given as a number or as
	      the  name	 of  a	signal.	 If arg is `-', then all traps sig are
	      reset to their default values.  If arg is the empty string, then
	      this  signal  is	ignored	 by  the  shell and by the commands it
	      invokes.

	      If sig is ZERR then arg will be executed after each command with
	      a	 nonzero  exit	status.	 If sig is DEBUG then arg will be exe‐
	      cuted after each command.	 If sig is 0  or  EXIT	and  the  trap
	      statement	 is  executed  inside the body of a function, then the
	      command arg is executed after the function completes.  If sig is
	      0 or EXIT and the trap statement is not executed inside the body
	      of a function, then the command arg is executed when  the	 shell
	      terminates.

	      The  trap	 command  with	no arguments prints a list of commands
	      associated with each signal.

	      Note that traps defined with the trap builtin are slightly  dif‐
	      ferent from those defined as `TRAPNAL () { ... }', as the latter
	      have their own function environment (line numbers,  local	 vari‐
	      ables, etc.) while the former use the environment of the command
	      in which they were called.  For example,

		     trap 'print $LINENO' DEBUG

	      will print the line number of a command executed	after  it  has
	      run, while

		     TRAPDEBUG() { print $LINENO; }

	      will always print the number zero.

       true [ arg ... ]
	      Do nothing and return an exit code of 0.

       ttyctl -fu
	      The  -f  option  freezes the tty, and -u unfreezes it.  When the
	      tty is frozen, no changes made to the tty settings  by  external
	      programs will be honored by the shell, except for changes in the
	      size of the screen; the shell will simply reset the settings  to
	      their  previous  values as soon as each command exits or is sus‐
	      pended.  Thus, stty and similar programs have no effect when the
	      tty  is frozen.  Without options it reports whether the terminal
	      is frozen or not.

       type [ -wfpams ] name ...
	      Equivalent to whence -v.

       typeset [ {+|-}AEFLRUZafghilrtuxm [n]] [ name[=value] ... ]
       typeset -T [ {+|-}LRUZrux ] SCALAR[=value] array
	      Set or display attributes and values for shell parameters.

	      A parameter is created for each name that does not already refer
	      to  one.	When inside a function, a new parameter is created for
	      every name (even those that already exist), and is  unset	 again
	      when  the	 function  completes.	See `Local Parameters' in zsh‐
	      param(1).	 The same rules apply  to  special  shell  parameters,
	      which retain their special attributes when made local.

	      For  each	 name=value  assignment,  the parameter name is set to
	      value.  Note that arrays currently cannot be assigned in typeset
	      expressions, only scalars and integers.

	      For  each remaining name that refers to a parameter that is set,
	      the name and value of the parameter are printed in the  form  of
	      an assignment.  Nothing is printed for newly-created parameters,
	      or when any attribute flags listed below are  given  along  with
	      the  name.  Using `+' instead of minus to introduce an attribute
	      turns it off.

	      If the -T option is given, exactly two (or zero) name  arguments
	      must  be present.	 They represent a scalar and an array (in that
	      order) that will be tied together in the	manner	of  $PATH  and
	      $path.   In other words, an array present in the latter variable
	      appears as a scalar with the elements of	the  array  joined  by
	      colons  in  the  former.	 Only  the  scalar may have an initial
	      value.  Both the scalar and the array may otherwise  be  manipu‐
	      lated  as normal.	 If one is unset, the other will automatically
	      be unset too.  There is no way of untying the variables  without
	      unsetting	 them,	or  converting	the  type  of one of them with
	      another typeset command; +T does not work, assigning an array to
	      SCALAR  is  an error, and assigning a scalar to array sets it to
	      be a single-element array.  Note that both `typeset -xT ...' and
	      `export  -T  ...'	 work,	but only the scalar will be marked for
	      export.

	      The -g (global) flag is treated specially:  it  means  that  any
	      resulting parameter will not be restricted to local scope.  Note
	      that this does not necessarily mean that the parameter  will  be
	      global,  as  the flag will apply to any existing parameter (even
	      if unset) from an enclosing function.  This flag does not affect
	      the  parameter after creation, hence it has no effect when list‐
	      ing existing parameters, nor does the flag +g  have  any	effect
	      except in combination with -m (see below).

	      If  no  name  is present, the names and values of all parameters
	      are printed.  In this case the attribute flags restrict the dis‐
	      play   to	  only	 those	parameters  that  have	the  specified
	      attributes, and using `+' rather than `-' to introduce the  flag
	      suppresses printing of the values of parameters when there is no
	      parameter name.  Also, if the last option is the word `+',  then
	      names are printed but values are not.

	      If the -m flag is given the name arguments are taken as patterns
	      (which should be quoted).	 With no attribute flags, all  parame‐
	      ters  (or	 functions  with  the -f flag) with matching names are
	      printed.	Note that -m is ignored if no patterns are given.   If
	      the  +g  flag is combined with -m, a new local parameter is cre‐
	      ated for every matching parameter that  is  not  already	local.
	      Otherwise	 -m  applies  all  other  flags	 or assignments to the
	      existing parameters.  Except  when  assignments  are  made  with
	      name=value,  using  +m  forces  the  matching  parameters	 to be
	      printed, even inside a function.

	      If no attribute flags are given and either no -m flag is present
	      or the +m form was used, each parameter name printed is preceded
	      by a list of the attributes of that parameter  (array,  associa‐
	      tion,   exported,	 integer,  readonly).	If  +m	is  used  with
	      attribute flags, and all those flags are introduced with +,  the
	      matching parameter names are printed but their values are not.

	      The following attribute flags may be specified:

	      -A     The  names	 refer	to  associative	 array parameters; see
		     `Array Parameters' in zshparam(1).

	      -L     Left justify and remove leading blanks from value.	 If  n
		     is	 nonzero, it defines the width of the field; otherwise
		     it is determined by the width of the value of  the	 first
		     assignment.  When the parameter is expanded, it is filled
		     on the right with blanks or truncated if necessary to fit
		     the  field.   Leading zeros are removed if the -Z flag is
		     also set.

	      -R     Right justify and fill with  leading  blanks.   If	 n  is
		     nonzero  if  defines the width of the field; otherwise it
		     is determined by the width of  the	 value	of  the	 first
		     assignment.  When the parameter is expanded, the field is
		     left filled with blanks or truncated from the end.

	      -U     For arrays (but not for associative  arrays),  keep  only
		     the  first occurrence of each duplicated value.  This may
		     also be set for colon-separated special  parameters  like
		     PATH  or FIGNORE, etc.  This flag has a different meaning
		     when used with -f; see below.

	      -Z     Right justify and fill with leading zeros	if  the	 first
		     non-blank	character  is  a digit and the -L flag has not
		     been set.	If n is nonzero it defines the	width  of  the
		     field;  otherwise	it  is	determined by the width of the
		     value of the first assignment.

	      -a     The names refer to array parameters.  An array  parameter
		     may be created this way, but it may not be assigned to in
		     the typeset statement.  When displaying, both normal  and
		     associative arrays are shown.

	      -f     The  names refer to functions rather than parameters.  No
		     assignments can be made, and the only other  valid	 flags
		     are  -t, -u and -U.  The flag -t turns on execution trac‐
		     ing for this function.  The -u and	 -U  flags  cause  the
		     function  to  be  marked  for autoloading; -U also causes
		     alias expansion to be suppressed  when  the  function  is
		     loaded.  The fpath parameter will be searched to find the
		     function definition when the  function  is	 first	refer‐
		     enced; see the section `Functions'.

	      -h     Hide:  only  useful  for special parameters (those marked
		     `<S>' in the table in zshparams(1)), and for local param‐
		     eters  with  the same name as a special parameter, though
		     harmless for  others.   A	special	 parameter  with  this
		     attribute	will  not  retain its special effect when made
		     local.  Thus after `typeset -h PATH', a function contain‐
		     ing  `typeset PATH' will create an ordinary local parame‐
		     ter without the usual behaviour of PATH.	Alternatively,
		     the  local	 parameter may itself be given this attribute;
		     hence inside a function  `typeset	-h  PATH'  creates  an
		     ordinary  local  parameter and the special PATH parameter
		     is not altered in any way.	 It is also possible to create
		     a	local  parameter using `typeset +h special', where the
		     local copy of special will retain its special  properties
		     regardless	 of  having  the -h attribute.	Global special
		     parameters loaded from shell modules (currently those  in
		     zsh/mapfile  and  zsh/parameter)  are automatically given
		     the -h attribute to avoid name clashes.

	      -H     Hide value: specifies that typeset will not  display  the
		     value  of the parameter when listing parameters; the dis‐
		     play for such parameters is always as if the `+' flag had
		     been  given.   Use	 of the parameter is in other respects
		     normal, and the option does not apply if the parameter is
		     specified	by  name,  or  by  pattern with the -m option.
		     This  is  on  by  default	for  the  parameters  in   the
		     zsh/parameter  and	 zsh/mapfile  modules.	Note, however,
		     that unlike the -h flag this is also useful for  non-spe‐
		     cial parameters.

	      -i     Use  an internal integer representation.  If n is nonzero
		     it defines the output arithmetic base,  otherwise	it  is
		     determined by the first assignment.

	      -E     Use an internal double-precision floating point represen‐
		     tation.  On output the variable will be converted to sci‐
		     entific  notation.	 If n is nonzero it defines the number
		     of significant figures to display; the default is ten.

	      -F     Use an internal double-precision floating point represen‐
		     tation.   On  output  the	variable  will be converted to
		     fixed-point decimal notation.  If n is nonzero it defines
		     the  number of digits to display after the decimal point;
		     the default is ten.

	      -l     Convert the result to lower case whenever	the  parameter
		     is expanded.  The value is not converted when assigned.

	      -r     The given names are marked readonly.

	      -t     Tags  the named parameters.  Tags have no special meaning
		     to the shell.  This flag has  a  different	 meaning  when
		     used with -f; see above.

	      -u     Convert  the  result to upper case whenever the parameter
		     is expanded.  The value is not converted  when  assigned.
		     This  flag has a different meaning when used with -f; see
		     above.

	      -x     Mark for automatic export to the  environment  of	subse‐
		     quently  executed	commands.  If the option GLOBAL_EXPORT
		     is set, this implies the option -g,  unless  +g  is  also
		     explicitly	 given;	 in  other  words the parameter is not
		     made local to the enclosing function.  This is  for  com‐
		     patibility with previous versions of zsh.

       ulimit [ -SHacdflmnpstv [ limit ] ... ]
	      Set  or  display	resource limits of the shell and the processes
	      started by the shell.  The value of limit can be a number in the
	      unit  specified  below or the value `unlimited'.	If the -H flag
	      is given use hard limits instead of soft limits.	If the -S flag
	      is  given	 together with the -H flag set both hard and soft lim‐
	      its.  If no options are  used,  the  file	 size  limit  (-f)  is
	      assumed.	If limit is omitted the current value of the specified
	      resources are printed.  When more than one resource  values  are
	      printed the limit name and unit is printed before each value.

	      -a     Lists all of the current resource limits.
	      -c     512-byte blocks on the size of core dumps.
	      -d     K-bytes on the size of the data segment.
	      -f     512-byte blocks on the size of files written.
	      -l     K-bytes on the size of locked-in memory.
	      -m     K-bytes on the size of physical memory.
	      -n     open file descriptors.
	      -s     K-bytes on the size of the stack.
	      -t     CPU seconds to be used.
	      -u     processes available to the user.
	      -v     K-bytes on the size of virtual memory.

       umask [ -S ] [ mask ]
	      The umask is set to mask.	 mask can be either an octal number or
	      a symbolic value as described in chmod(1).  If mask is  omitted,
	      the  current value is printed.  The -S option causes the mask to
	      be printed as a symbolic value.  Otherwise, the mask is  printed
	      as  an octal number.  Note that in the symbolic form the permis‐
	      sions you specify are those which are to be allowed (not denied)
	      to the users specified.

       unalias
	      Same as unhash -a.

       unfunction
	      Same as unhash -f.

       unhash [ -adfm ] name ...
	      Remove  the element named name from an internal hash table.  The
	      default is remove elements from the command hash table.  The  -a
	      option  causes  unhash  to remove aliases.  The -f option causes
	      unhash to remove shell functions.	 The -d options causes	unhash
	      to  remove named directories.  If the -m flag is given the argu‐
	      ments are taken as patterns (should be quoted) and all  elements
	      of  the  corresponding  hash  table  with matching names will be
	      removed.

       unlimit [ -hs ] resource ...
	      The resource limit for each resource is set to the  hard	limit.
	      If  the  -h  flag	 is given and the shell has appropriate privi‐
	      leges, the hard resource limit for  each	resource  is  removed.
	      The  resources  of  the shell process are only changed if the -s
	      flag is given.

       unset [ -fm ] name ...
	      Each named parameter is unset.  Local  parameters	 remain	 local
	      even  if unset; they appear unset within scope, but the previous
	      value will still reappear when the scope ends.

	      Individual elements of associative array parameters may be unset
	      by  using	 subscript  syntax on name, which should be quoted (or
	      the entire command prefixed with noglob)	to  protect  the  sub‐
	      script from filename generation.

	      If  the -m flag is specified the arguments are taken as patterns
	      (should be quoted) and all parameters with  matching  names  are
	      unset.  Note that this cannot be used when unsetting associative
	      array elements, as the subscript will be treated as part of  the
	      pattern.

	      unset -f is equivalent to unfunction.

       unsetopt [ {+|-}options | {+|-}o option_name ] [ name ... ]
	      Unset  the  options for the shell.  All options specified either
	      with flags or by name are unset.	If no arguments are  supplied,
	      the names of all options currently unset are printed.  If the -m
	      flag is given the arguments are taken as patterns (which	should
	      be  quoted  to preserve them from being interpreted as glob pat‐
	      terns), and all options with names matching these	 patterns  are
	      unset.

       vared  See the section `Zle Builtins' in zshzle(1).

       wait [ job ... ]
	      Wait  for	 the specified jobs or processes.  If job is not given
	      then all currently active child processes are waited for.	  Each
	      job can be either a job specification or the process ID of a job
	      in the job table.	 The exit status from this command is that  of
	      the job waited for.

       whence [ -vcwfpams ] name ...
	      For each name, indicate how it would be interpreted if used as a
	      command name.

	      -v     Produce a more verbose report.

	      -c     Print the results	in  a  csh-like	 format.   This	 takes
		     precedence over -v.

	      -w     For  each	name,  print `name: word' where word is one of
		     alias, builtin, command, function,	 hashed,  reserved  or
		     none,  according  as  name	 corresponds  to  an  alias, a
		     built-in command, an external command, a shell  function,
		     a command defined with the hash builtin, a reserved word,
		     or is not recognised.  This takes precedence over -v  and
		     -c.

	      -f     Causes  the contents of a shell function to be displayed,
		     which would otherwise not happen unless the -c flag  were
		     used.

	      -p     Do	 a  path  search  for  name  even  if  it is an alias,
		     reserved word, shell function or builtin.

	      -a     Do a search for all occurrences of	 name  throughout  the
		     command  path.   Normally	only  the  first occurrence is
		     printed.

	      -m     The arguments are taken as patterns (should  be  quoted),
		     and  the information is displayed for each command match‐
		     ing one of these patterns.

	      -s     If a pathname contains symlinks, print  the  symlink-free
		     pathname as well.

       where [ -wpms ] name ...
	      Equivalent to whence -ca.

       which [ -wpams ] name ...
	      Equivalent to whence -c.

       zcompile [ -U ] [ -z | -k ] [ -R | -M ] file [ name ... ]
       zcompile -ca [ -m ] [ -R | -M ] file [ name ... ]
       zcompile -t file [ name ... ]
	      This  builtin  command  can  be  used  to	 compile  functions or
	      scripts, storing the compiled form in a  file,  and  to  examine
	      files   containing   the	compiled  form.	  This	allows	faster
	      autoloading of functions and execution of	 scripts  by  avoiding
	      parsing of the text when the files are read.

	      The first form (without the -c, -a or -t options) creates a com‐
	      piled file.  If only the file argument is given, the output file
	      has the name `file.zwc' and will be placed in the same directory
	      as the file.  The shell will load the compiled file  instead  of
	      the  normal  function  file when the function is autoloaded; see
	      the section `Autoloading Functions' in zshfunc(1) for a descrip‐
	      tion  of	how  autoloaded functions are searched.	 The extension
	      .zwc stands for `zsh word code'.

	      If there is at least one name argument, all the named files  are
	      compiled	into  the output file given as the first argument.  If
	      file does not end	 in  .zwc,  this  extension  is	 automatically
	      appended.	  Files	 containing  multiple  compiled	 functions are
	      called `digest' files, and are intended to be used  as  elements
	      of the FPATH/fpath special array.

	      The  second form, with the -c or -a options, writes the compiled
	      definitions for all the named functions into file.  For -c,  the
	      names  must  be  functions  currently  defined in the shell, not
	      those marked for	autoloading.   Undefined  functions  that  are
	      marked for autoloading may be written by using the -a option, in
	      which case the fpath is searched and the contents of the defini‐
	      tion  files  for	those  functions,  if found, are compiled into
	      file.  If both -c and -a are given, names of both defined	 func‐
	      tions  and  functions  marked  for autoloading may be given.  In
	      either case, the functions in files written with the  -c	or  -a
	      option  will  be	autoloaded  as if the KSH_AUTOLOAD option were
	      unset.

	      The reason for handling loaded and not-yet-loaded functions with
	      different	 options is that some definition files for autoloading
	      define multiple functions, including the function with the  same
	      name  as the file, and, at the end, call that function.  In such
	      cases the output of `zcompile -c' does  not  include  the	 addi‐
	      tional  functions defined in the file, and any other initializa‐
	      tion code in the file is lost.  Using `zcompile -a' captures all
	      this extra information.

	      If  the  -m option is combined with -c or -a, the names are used
	      as patterns and all functions whose names	 match	one  of	 these
	      patterns	will  be written. If no name is given, the definitions
	      of all functions currently defined or marked as autoloaded  will
	      be written.

	      The  third  form,	 with the -t option, examines an existing com‐
	      piled file.  Without further arguments, the names of the	origi‐
	      nal files compiled into it are listed.  The first line of output
	      shows the version of the shell which compiled the file  and  how
	      the file will be used (i.e. by reading it directly or by mapping
	      it into memory).	With arguments,	 nothing  is  output  and  the
	      return  value  is	 set to zero if definitions for all names were
	      found in the compiled file, and non-zero if the  definition  for
	      at least one name was not found.

	      Other options:

	      -U     Aliases are not expanded when compiling the named files.

	      -R     When  the	compiled file is read, its contents are copied
		     into the shell's memory, rather than  memory-mapped  (see
		     -M).   This  happens automatically on systems that do not
		     support memory mapping.

		     When compiling scripts instead of autoloadable functions,
		     it	 is  often desirable to use this option; otherwise the
		     whole file, including the code to define functions	 which
		     have  already  been  defined,  will remain mapped, conse‐
		     quently wasting memory.

	      -M     The compiled file is mapped into the shell's memory  when
		     read.  This is done in such a way that multiple instances
		     of the shell running on the same  host  will  share  this
		     mapped file.  If neither -R nor -M is given, the zcompile
		     builtin decides what to do based on the size of the  com‐
		     piled file.

	      -k
	      -z     These  options  are  used when the compiled file contains
		     functions which are to be autoloaded. If -z is given, the
		     function will be autoloaded as if the KSH_AUTOLOAD option
		     is not set, even if it is set at the  time	 the  compiled
		     file is read, while if the -k is given, the function will
		     be loaded as if KSH_AUTOLOAD is set.  If neither of these
		     options  is  given, the function will be loaded as deter‐
		     mined by the setting of the KSH_AUTOLOAD  option  at  the
		     time the compiled file is read.

		     These  options may also appear as many times as necessary
		     between the listed names to specify the loading style  of
		     all following functions, up to the next -k or -z.

		     The created file always contains two versions of the com‐
		     piled format, one for big-endian  machines	 and  one  for
		     small-endian  machines.   The  upshot of this is that the
		     compiled file is machine independent and if it is read or
		     mapped,  only  one half of the file is actually used (and
		     mapped).

       zformat
	      See the section `The zsh/zutil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       zftp   See the section `The zsh/zftp Module' in zshmodules(1).

       zle    See the section `Zle Builtins' in zshzle(1).

       zmodload [ -dL ] [ ... ]
       zmodload -e [ -A ] [ ... ]
       zmodload [ -a [ -bcpf [ -I ] ] ] [ -iL ] ...
       zmodload -u [ -abcdpf [ -I ] ] [ -iL ] ...
       zmodload -A [ -L ] [ modalias[=module] ... ]
       zmodload -R modalias ...
	      Performs operations relating to zsh's loadable modules.  Loading
	      of  modules  while the shell is running (`dynamical loading') is
	      not available on all operating systems, or on all	 installations
	      on  a particular operating system, although the zmodload command
	      itself is always available and can be used to manipulate modules
	      built  into  versions  of the shell executable without dynamical
	      loading.

	      Without arguments the names of all currently loaded binary  mod‐
	      ules  are	 printed.  The -L option causes this list to be in the
	      form of a series of zmodload  commands.	Forms  with  arguments
	      are:

	      zmodload [ -i ] name ...
	      zmodload -u [ -i ] name ...
		     In	 the  simplest	case,  zmodload loads a binary module.
		     The module must be in a file with a  name	consisting  of
		     the specified name followed by a standard suffix, usually
		     `.so' (`.sl' on HPUX).  If the module  to	be  loaded  is
		     already  loaded and the -i option is given, the duplicate
		     module is ignored.	 Otherwise zmodload  prints  an	 error
		     message.

		     The  named	 module is searched for in the same way a com‐
		     mand is, using $module_path instead of  $path.   However,
		     the  path	search	is performed even when the module name
		     contains a `/', which it usually does.  There is  no  way
		     to prevent the path search.

		     With -u, zmodload unloads modules.	 The same name must be
		     given that was given when the module was loaded,  but  it
		     is	 not necessary for the module to exist in the filesys‐
		     tem.  The -i option suppresses the error if the module is
		     already unloaded (or was never loaded).

		     Each  module has a boot and a cleanup function.  The mod‐
		     ule will not be loaded if its boot function fails.	 Simi‐
		     larly  a module can only be unloaded if its cleanup func‐
		     tion runs successfully.

	      zmodload -d [ -L ] [ name ]
	      zmodload -d name dep ...
	      zmodload -ud name [ dep ... ]
		     The -d option can be used to specify module dependencies.
		     The  modules named in the second and subsequent arguments
		     will be loaded before the module named in the first argu‐
		     ment.

		     With  -d and one argument, all dependencies for that mod‐
		     ule are listed.  With -d and  no  arguments,  all	module
		     dependencies are listed.  This listing is by default in a
		     Makefile-like format.  The -L option changes this	format
		     to a list of zmodload -d commands.

		     If -d and -u are both used, dependencies are removed.  If
		     only one argument is given,  all  dependencies  for  that
		     module are removed.

	      zmodload -ab [ -L ]
	      zmodload -ab [ -i ] name [ builtin ... ]
	      zmodload -ub [ -i ] builtin ...
		     The  -ab  option defines autoloaded builtins.  It defines
		     the specified builtins.  When any of  those  builtins  is
		     called,  the  module  specified  in the first argument is
		     loaded.  If only  the  name  is  given,  one  builtin  is
		     defined, with the same name as the module.	 -i suppresses
		     the  error	 if  the  builtin  is	already	  defined   or
		     autoloaded, regardless of which module it came from.

		     With  -ab	and  no arguments, all autoloaded builtins are
		     listed, with the module  name  (if	 different)  shown  in
		     parentheses  after	 the  builtin  name.   The  -L	option
		     changes this format to a list of zmodload -a commands.

		     If -b is used together with the  -u  option,  it  removes
		     builtins  previously defined with -ab.  This is only pos‐
		     sible if the builtin is not yet  loaded.	-i  suppresses
		     the  error	 if  the  builtin is already removed (or never
		     existed).

	      zmodload -ac [ -IL ]
	      zmodload -ac [ -iI ] name [ cond ... ]
	      zmodload -uc [ -iI ] cond ...
		     The -ac option is used  to	 define	 autoloaded  condition
		     codes.  The cond strings give the names of the conditions
		     defined by the module. The optional -I option is used  to
		     define  infix condition names. Without this option prefix
		     condition names are defined.

		     If given no condition names, all defined names are listed
		     (as  a  series  of	 zmodload commands if the -L option is
		     given).

		     The -uc option removes definitions for autoloaded	condi‐
		     tions.

	      zmodload -ap [ -L ]
	      zmodload -ap [ -i ] name [ parameter ... ]
	      zmodload -up [ -i ] parameter ...
		     The  -p  option  is like the -b and -c options, but makes
		     zmodload work on autoloaded parameters instead.

	      zmodload -af [ -L ]
	      zmodload -af [ -i ] name [ function ... ]
	      zmodload -uf [ -i ] function ...
		     The -f option is like the -b, -p,	and  -c	 options,  but
		     makes zmodload work on autoloaded math functions instead.

	      zmodload -a [ -L ]
	      zmodload -a [ -i ] name [ builtin ... ]
	      zmodload -ua [ -i ] builtin ...
		     Equivalent to -ab and -ub.

	      zmodload -e [ -A ] [ string ... ]
		     The -e option without arguments lists all loaded modules;
		     if the -A option is also  given,  module  aliases	corre‐
		     sponding  to  loaded  modules are also shown.  With argu‐
		     ments only the return  status  is	set  to	 zero  if  all
		     strings  given  as	 arguments are names of loaded modules
		     and to one if at least on string is not  the  name	 of  a
		     loaded  module.   This can be used to test for the avail‐
		     ability of things implemented by modules.	In this	 case,
		     any aliases are automatically resolved and the -A flag is
		     not used.

	      zmodload -A [ -L ] [ modalias[=module] ... ]
		     For each argument, if both modalias and module are given,
		     define modalias to be an alias for the module module.  If
		     the  module  modalias  is	ever  subsequently  requested,
		     either  via  a  call to zmodload or implicitly, the shell
		     will attempt to load module instead.  If  module  is  not
		     given,  show the definition of modalias.  If no arguments
		     are given, list all defined module aliases.   When	 list‐
		     ing,  if  the -L flag was also given, list the definition
		     as a zmodload command to recreate the alias.

		     The existence of aliases for modules is completely	 inde‐
		     pendent  of  whether the name resolved is actually loaded
		     as a module: while the alias exists, loading and  unload‐
		     ing  the  module  under  any  alias  has exactly the same
		     effect as using the resolved name, and  does  not	affect
		     the  connection  between  the alias and the resolved name
		     which can be removed either by zmodload -R or by redefin‐
		     ing  the  alias.  Chains of aliases (i.e. where the first
		     resolved name is itself an alias) are valid  so  long  as
		     these  are	 not  circular.	  As the aliases take the same
		     format as module names, they may include path separators:
		     in this case, there is no requirement for any part of the
		     path named to exist as the alias will be resolved	first.
		     For example, `any/old/alias' is always a valid alias.

		     Dependencies  added to aliased modules are actually added
		     to the resolved module; these  remain  if	the  alias  is
		     removed.	It  is	valid to create an alias whose name is
		     one of the standard shell modules and which resolves to a
		     different module.	However, if a module has dependencies,
		     it will not be possible to use  the  module  name	as  an
		     alias  as the module will already be marked as a loadable
		     module in its own right.

		     Apart from the above, aliases can be used in the zmodload
		     command  anywhere	module	names  are required.  However,
		     aliases will not be shown in lists of loaded modules with
		     a bare `zmodload'.

	      zmodload -R modalias ...
		     For each modalias argument that was previously defined as
		     a module alias via zmodload -A, delete the alias.	If any
		     was  not defined, an error is caused and the remainder of
		     the line is ignored.

	      Note that zsh makes no distinction  between  modules  that  were
	      linked  into  the shell and modules that are loaded dynamically.
	      In both cases this builtin command has to be used to make avail‐
	      able  the	 builtins  and other things defined by modules (unless
	      the module is autoloaded on these	 definitions).	This  is  true
	      even for systems that don't support dynamic loading of modules.

       zparseopts
	      See the section `The zsh/zutil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       zprof  See the section `The zsh/zprof Module' in zshmodules(1).

       zpty   See the section `The zsh/zpty Module' in zshmodules(1).

       zregexparse
	      See the section `The zsh/zutil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       zstyle See the section `The zsh/zutil Module' in zshmodules(1).

ZSHZLE(1)							     ZSHZLE(1)

NAME
       zshzle - zsh command line editor

DESCRIPTION
       If the ZLE option is set (which it is by default in interactive shells)
       and the shell input is attached to the terminal, the user  is  able  to
       edit command lines.

       There  are  two	display	 modes.	  The  first,  multiline  mode, is the
       default.	 It only works if the TERM parameter is set to a valid	termi‐
       nal type that can move the cursor up.  The second, single line mode, is
       used if TERM is invalid or incapable of moving the cursor up, or if the
       SINGLE_LINE_ZLE	option	is set.	 This mode is similar to ksh, and uses
       no termcap sequences.  If TERM is "emacs", the ZLE option will be unset
       by default.

       The  parameters BAUD, COLUMNS, and LINES are also used by the line edi‐
       tor.  See Parameters Used By The Shell in zshparam(1).

KEYMAPS
       A keymap in ZLE contains a set of bindings between  key	sequences  and
       ZLE commands.  The empty key sequence cannot be bound.

       There can be any number of keymaps at any time, and each keymap has one
       or more names.  If all of a keymap's names are deleted, it  disappears.
       bindkey can be used to manipulate keymap names.

       Initially, there are four keymaps:

       emacs  EMACS emulation
       viins  vi emulation - insert mode
       vicmd  vi emulation - command mode
       .safe  fallback keymap

       The  `.safe'  keymap is special.	 It can never be altered, and the name
       can never be removed.  However, it can be linked to other names,	 which
       can  be	removed.   In  the  future other special keymaps may be added;
       users should avoid  using  names	 beginning  with  `.'  for  their  own
       keymaps.

       In  addition  to	 these	four  names, either `emacs' or `viins' is also
       linked to the name `main'.  If one of the VISUAL or EDITOR  environment
       variables contain the string `vi' when the shell starts up then it will
       be `viins', otherwise it will be `emacs'.  bindkey's -e and -v  options
       provide a convenient way to override this default choice.

       When  the  editor starts up, it will select the `main' keymap.  If that
       keymap doesn't exist, it will use `.safe' instead.

       In the `.safe' keymap, each single key is bound to self-insert,	except
       for  ^J	(line  feed)  and  ^M (return) which are bound to accept-line.
       This is deliberately not pleasant to use; if you are using it, it means
       you deleted the main keymap, and you should put it back.

   Reading Commands
       When ZLE is reading a command from the terminal, it may read a sequence
       that is bound to some command and is also a prefix of  a	 longer	 bound
       string.	In this case ZLE will wait a certain time to see if more char‐
       acters are typed, and if not (or they don't match any longer string) it
       will  execute  the  binding.  This timeout is defined by the KEYTIMEOUT
       parameter; its default is 0.4 sec.  There is no timeout if  the	prefix
       string is not itself bound to a command.

       As  well	 as ZLE commands, key sequences can be bound to other strings,
       by using `bindkey -s'.  When such a sequence is read,  the  replacement
       string  is pushed back as input, and the command reading process starts
       again using these fake keystrokes.  This input can itself  invoke  fur‐
       ther replacement strings, but in order to detect loops the process will
       be stopped if there are twenty such replacements without a real command
       being read.

ZLE BUILTINS
       The  ZLE	 module	 contains  three related builtin commands. The bindkey
       command manipulates keymaps and key bindings; the vared command invokes
       ZLE  on the value of a shell parameter; and the zle command manipulates
       editing widgets and allows command line access  to  ZLE	commands  from
       within shell functions.

       bindkey [ options ] -l
       bindkey [ options ] -d
       bindkey [ options ] -D keymap ...
       bindkey [ options ] -A old-keymap new-keymap
       bindkey [ options ] -N new-keymap [ old-keymap ]
       bindkey [ options ] -m
       bindkey [ options ] -r in-string ...
       bindkey [ options ] -s in-string out-string ...
       bindkey [ options ] in-string command ...
       bindkey [ options ] [ in-string ]
	      bindkey's	 options  can be divided into three categories: keymap
	      selection, operation selection, and others.  The	keymap	selec‐
	      tion options are:

	      -e     Selects keymap `emacs', and also links it to `main'.

	      -v     Selects keymap `viins', and also links it to `main'.

	      -a     Selects keymap `vicmd'.

	      -M     The  first	 non-option argument is used as a keymap name,
		     and does not otherwise count as an argument.

	      If a keymap selection is required and none of the options	 above
	      are  used,  the  `main'  keymap is used.	Some operations do not
	      permit a keymap to be selected, namely:

	      -l     List all existing keymap names.  If the -L option is also
		     used,  list in the form of bindkey commands to create the
		     keymaps.

	      -d     Delete all existing keymaps  and  reset  to  the  default
		     state.

	      -D keymap ...
		     Delete the named keymaps.

	      -A old-keymap new-keymap
		     Make the new-keymap name an alias for old-keymap, so that
		     both names refer to the  same  keymap.   The  names  have
		     equal  standing; if either is deleted, the other remains.
		     If there is already a keymap with the new-keymap name, it
		     is deleted.

	      -N new-keymap [ old-keymap ]
		     Create  a	new  keymap,  named  new-keymap.   If a keymap
		     already has that name, it is deleted.  If	an  old-keymap
		     name  is  given,  the  new	 keymap is initialized to be a
		     duplicate of it, otherwise the new keymap will be empty.

	      To use a newly created keymap, it	 should	 be  linked  to	 main.
	      Hence  the  sequence  of commands to create and use a new keymap
	      `mymap'  initialized  from  the  emacs  keymap  (which   remains
	      unchanged) is:

		     bindkey -N mymap emacs
		     bindkey -A mymap main

	      Note  that  while `bindkey -A newmap main' will work when newmap
	      is emacs or viins, it will not work for vicmd, as switching from
	      vi insert to command mode becomes impossible.

	      The  following  operations act on the `main' keymap if no keymap
	      selection option was given:

	      -m     Add the built-in set of meta-key bindings to the selected
		     keymap.	Only   keys  that  are	unbound	 or  bound  to
		     self-insert are affected.

	      -r in-string ...
		     Unbind the specified in-strings in the  selected  keymap.
		     This  is  exactly	equivalent  to	binding the strings to
		     undefined-key.

		     When -R is also used, interpret the in-strings as ranges.

		     When -p is also used, the	in-strings  specify  prefixes.
		     Any binding that has the given in-string as a prefix, not
		     including the binding for the in-string itself,  if  any,
		     will be removed.  For example,

			    bindkey -rpM viins '^['

		     will  remove  all bindings in the vi-insert keymap begin‐
		     ning with an escape character (probably cursor keys), but
		     leave the binding for the escape character itself (proba‐
		     bly vi-cmd-mode).	This is incompatible with  the	option
		     -R.

	      -s in-string out-string ...
		     Bind  each	 in-string to each out-string.	When in-string
		     is typed, out-string will be pushed back and  treated  as
		     input  to	the line editor.  When -R is also used, inter‐
		     pret the in-strings as ranges.

	      in-string command ...
		     Bind each in-string to each command.  When	 -R  is	 used,
		     interpret the in-strings as ranges.

	      [ in-string ]
		     List  key	bindings.   If	an in-string is specified, the
		     binding of that string in the  selected  keymap  is  dis‐
		     played.   Otherwise,  all	key  bindings  in the selected
		     keymap are displayed.  (As a special case, if the	-e  or
		     -v	 option	 is  used alone, the keymap is not displayed -
		     the implicit linking of keymaps is the  only  thing  that
		     happens.)

		     When  the	option	-p  is	used,  the  in-string  must be
		     present.  The listing shows all bindings which  have  the
		     given  key	 sequence as a prefix, not including any bind‐
		     ings for the key sequence itself.

		     When the -L option is used, the list is in	 the  form  of
		     bindkey commands to create the key bindings.

       When  the  -R  option is used as noted above, a valid range consists of
       two characters, with an optional	 `-'  between  them.   All  characters
       between the two specified, inclusive, are bound as specified.

       For  either in-string or out-string, the following escape sequences are
       recognised:

       \a     bell character
       \b     backspace
       \e, \E escape
       \f     form feed
       \n     linefeed (newline)
       \r     carriage return
       \t     horizontal tab
       \v     vertical tab
       \NNN   character code in octal
       \xNN   character code in hexadecimal
       \M[-]X character with meta bit set
       \C[-]X control character
       ^X     control character

       In all other cases, `\' escapes the  following  character.   Delete  is
       written	as  `^?'.   Note  that `\M^?' and `^\M?' are not the same, and
       that (unlike emacs), the bindings `\M-X' and `\eX'  are	entirely  dis‐
       tinct,  although	 they are initialized to the same bindings by `bindkey
       -m'.

       vared [ -Aache ] [ -p prompt ] [ -r rprompt ] name
	      The value of the parameter name is loaded into the edit  buffer,
	      and  the line editor is invoked.	When the editor exits, name is
	      set to the string value returned by the  editor.	 When  the  -c
	      flag  is	given,	the parameter is created if it doesn't already
	      exist.  The -a flag may be given with  -c	 to  create  an	 array
	      parameter,  or  the  -A flag to create an associative array.  If
	      the type of an existing parameter does not match the type to  be
	      created, the parameter is unset and recreated.

	      If an array or array slice is being edited, separator characters
	      as defined in $IFS will be shown quoted  with  a	backslash,  as
	      will  backslashes	 themselves.  Conversely, when the edited text
	      is split into an array, a backslash quotes an  immediately  fol‐
	      lowing  separator	 character or backslash; no other special han‐
	      dling of backslashes, or any handling of quotes, is performed.

	      Individual elements  of  existing	 array	or  associative	 array
	      parameters may be edited by using subscript syntax on name.  New
	      elements are created automatically, even without -c.

	      If the -p flag is given, the following string will be  taken  as
	      the prompt to display at the left.  If the -r flag is given, the
	      following string gives the prompt to display at the  right.   If
	      the  -h flag is specified, the history can be accessed from ZLE.
	      If the -e flag is given, typing ^D (Control-D) on an empty  line
	      causes vared to exit immediately with a non-zero return value.

       zle -l [ -L | -a ] [ string ... ]
       zle -D widget ...
       zle -A old-widget new-widget
       zle -N widget [ function ]
       zle -C widget completion-widget function
       zle -R [ -c ] [ display-string ] [ string ... ]
       zle -M string
       zle -U string
       zle -I
       zle widget [ -n num ] [ -N ] args ...
       zle    The  zle builtin performs a number of different actions concern‐
	      ing ZLE.	Which operation it performs depends on its options:

	      -l [ -L | -a ]
		     List all existing user-defined widgets.  If the -L option
		     is	 used,	list in the form of zle commands to create the
		     widgets.

		     When combined with the -a option, all  widget  names  are
		     listed,  including	 the builtin ones. In this case the -L
		     option is ignored.

		     If at least one string is given, nothing will be  printed
		     but  the  return  status  will be zero if all strings are
		     names of existing widgets (or of user-defined widgets  if
		     the  -a  flag  is not given) and non-zero if at least one
		     string is not a name of an defined widget.

	      -D widget ...
		     Delete the named widgets.

	      -A old-widget new-widget
		     Make the new-widget name an alias for old-widget, so that
		     both  names  refer	 to  the  same widget.	The names have
		     equal standing; if either is deleted, the other  remains.
		     If there is already a widget with the new-widget name, it
		     is deleted.

	      -N widget [ function ]
		     Create a user-defined widget.  If there is already a wid‐
		     get with the specified name, it is overwritten.  When the
		     new widget is invoked from within the editor, the	speci‐
		     fied  shell  function  is called.	If no function name is
		     specified, it defaults to the same name  as  the  widget.
		     For  further information, see the section Widgets in zsh‐
		     zle(1).

	      -C widget completion-widget function
		     Create a user-defined completion widget named widget. The
		     completion	 widget	 will behave like the built-in comple‐
		     tion-widget whose name is given as completion-widget.  To
		     generate  the  completions,  the  shell function function
		     will be called.  For further  information,	 see  zshcomp‐
		     wid(1).

	      -R [ -c ] [ display-string ] [ string ... ]
		     Redisplay	the  command  line;  this is to be called from
		     within a user-defined widget to allow changes  to	become
		     visible.	If  a  display-string  is given and not empty,
		     this is shown in the status line (immediately  below  the
		     line being edited).

		     If	 the  optional strings are given they are listed below
		     the prompt in  the	 same  way  as	completion  lists  are
		     printed.  If  no  strings	are given but the -c option is
		     used such a list is cleared.

		     Note that this option is only useful for widgets that  do
		     not  exit	immediately after using it because the strings
		     displayed will be erased immediately  after  return  from
		     the widget.

		     This  command  can	 safely be called outside user defined
		     widgets; if zle is active, the display will be refreshed,
		     while  if	zle  is not active, the command has no effect.
		     In this case there will usually be	 no  other  arguments.
		     The status is zero if zle was active, else one.

	      -M string
		     As with the -R option, the string will be displayed below
		     the command line; unlike the -R option, the  string  will
		     not  be  put  into	 the  status  line but will instead be
		     printed normally below the prompt.	 This means  that  the
		     string  will  still be displayed after the widget returns
		     (until it is overwritten by subsequent commands).

	      -U string
		     This pushes the characters in the string onto  the	 input
		     stack  of	ZLE.  After the widget currently executed fin‐
		     ishes ZLE will behave as if the characters in the	string
		     were typed by the user.

		     As	 ZLE  uses  a stack, if this option is used repeatedly
		     the last string pushed onto the stack will	 be  processed
		     first.   However,	the  characters in each string will be
		     processed in the  order  in  which	 they  appear  in  the
		     string.

	      -I     Unusually,	 this  option  is only useful outside ordinary
		     widget functions.	It invalidates the current zle display
		     in	 preparation  for  output; usually this will be from a
		     trap function.  It has no effect if zle  is  not  active.
		     When a trap exits, the shell checks to see if the display
		     needs restoring, hence the following will print output in
		     such a way as not to disturb the line being edited:

			    TRAPUSR1() {
				# Invalidate zle display
			      zle -I
				# Show output
			      print Hello
			    }

		     Note  that there are better ways of manipulating the dis‐
		     play from within zle widgets.  In general, the trap func‐
		     tion  may need to test whether zle is loaded before using
		     this method; if it is not, there is no point  in  loading
		     it specially since the line editor will not be active.

		     The status is zero if zle was active, else one.

	      widget [ -n num ] [ -N ] args ...
		     Invoke  the specified widget.  This can only be done when
		     ZLE  is  active;  normally	 this	will   be   within   a
		     user-defined widget.

		     With  the	options -n and -N, the current numerical argu‐
		     ment will be saved and then restored after	 the  call  to
		     widget;  `-n num' sets the numerical argument temporarily
		     to num, while `-N' sets it to the	default,  i.e.	as  if
		     there were none.

		     Any  further  arguments will be passed to the widget.  If
		     it is a shell function, these are passed  down  as	 posi‐
		     tional  parameters;  for  builtin widgets it is up to the
		     widget in question what it	 does  with  them.   Currently
		     arguments are only handled by the incremental-search com‐
		     mands, the history-search-forward and -backward  and  the
		     corresponding  functions  prefixed by vi-, and by univer‐
		     sal-argument.  No error is flagged if  the	 command  does
		     not use the arguments, or only uses some of them.

		     The  return status reflects the success or failure of the
		     operation carried out by  the  widget,  or	 if  it	 is  a
		     user-defined  widget the return status of the shell func‐
		     tion.

		     A non-zero return status causes the shell	to  beep  when
		     the  widget  exits,  unless the BEEP options was unset or
		     the widget was called via the zle	command.   Thus	 if  a
		     user defined widget requires an immediate beep, it should
		     call the beep widget directly.

       With no options and no arguments, only the return status will  be  set.
       It  is  zero  if	 ZLE  is currently active and widgets could be invoked
       using this builtin command and non-zero if ZLE is not active.

WIDGETS
       All actions in the editor are performed by `widgets'.  A	 widget's  job
       is  simply  to  perform	some  small action.  The ZLE commands that key
       sequences in keymaps are bound to are in fact widgets.  Widgets can  be
       user-defined or built in.

       The  standard  widgets  built  in to ZLE are listed in Standard Widgets
       below.  Other built-in widgets can be defined  by  other	 modules  (see
       zshmodules(1)).	Each built-in widget has two names: its normal canoni‐
       cal name, and the same name preceded by a `.'.  The `.'	name  is  spe‐
       cial: it can't be rebound to a different widget.	 This makes the widget
       available even when its usual name has been redefined.

       User-defined widgets are defined using `zle  -N',  and  implemented  as
       shell  functions.  When the widget is executed, the corresponding shell
       function is executed, and can perform editing (or other)	 actions.   It
       is recommended that user-defined widgets should not have names starting
       with `.'.

USER-DEFINED WIDGETS
       User-defined widgets, being implemented as shell functions, can execute
       any  normal  shell  command.   They can also run other widgets (whether
       built-in or user-defined) using the zle builtin command.	 The  standard
       input of the function is closed to prevent external commands from unin‐
       tentionally blocking ZLE by reading from the terminal, but read	-k  or
       read  -q can be used to read characters.	 Finally, they can examine and
       edit the ZLE buffer being edited by reading  and	 setting  the  special
       parameters described below.

       These  special parameters are always available in widget functions, but
       are not in any way special outside ZLE.	If they have some normal value
       outside	ZLE,  that  value is temporarily inaccessible, but will return
       when the widget function exits.	These special parameters in fact  have
       local scope, like parameters created in a function using local.

       Inside  completion  widgets and traps called while ZLE is active, these
       parameters are available read-only.

       BUFFER (scalar)
	      The entire contents of the edit buffer.  If it  is  written  to,
	      the  cursor remains at the same offset, unless that would put it
	      outside the buffer.

       BUFFERLINES
	      The number of screen lines needed for the edit buffer  currently
	      displayed	 on  screen (i.e. without any changes to the preceding
	      parameters done after the last redisplay).

       CURSOR (integer)
	      The offset of the cursor, within the edit buffer.	  This	is  in
	      the  range  0  to	 $#BUFFER,  and	 is  by	 definition  equal  to
	      $#LBUFFER.  Attempts to move the cursor outside the buffer  will
	      result  in  the cursor being moved to the appropriate end of the
	      buffer.

       HISTNO (integer)
	      The current history number.

       KEYS (scalar)
	      The keys typed to invoke this widget, as a literal string.

       LASTWIDGET (scalar)
	      The name of the last widget that was executed.

       LBUFFER (scalar)
	      The part of the buffer that lies to the left of the cursor posi‐
	      tion.   If  it  is  assigned to, only that part of the buffer is
	      replaced, and the cursor remains between the  new	 $LBUFFER  and
	      the old $RBUFFER.

       MARK (integer)
	      Like CURSOR, but for the mark.

       NUMERIC (integer)
	      The  numeric  argument.  If  no numeric argument was given, this
	      parameter is unset. When this is set inside a  widget  function,
	      builtin widgets called with the zle builtin command will use the
	      value assigned. If it is unset inside a widget function, builtin
	      widgets called behave as if no numeric argument was given.

       PENDING (integer)
	      The  number of bytes pending for input, i.e. the number of bytes
	      which have already been typed and can immediately	 be  read.  On
	      systems  where  the  shell  is not able to get this information,
	      this parameter will always have a value of zero.

       PREBUFFER (scalar)
	      In a multi-line input at the secondary  prompt,  this  read-only
	      parameter	 contains the contents of the lines before the one the
	      cursor is currently in.

       RBUFFER (scalar)
	      The part of the buffer that lies to  the	right  of  the	cursor
	      position.	 If it is assigned to, only that part of the buffer is
	      replaced, and the cursor remains between the  old	 $LBUFFER  and
	      the new $RBUFFER.

       WIDGET (scalar)
	      The name of the widget currently being executed.

STANDARD WIDGETS
       The  following is a list of all the standard widgets, and their default
       bindings in emacs mode,	vi  command  mode  and	vi  insert  mode  (the
       `emacs', `vicmd' and `viins' keymaps, respectively).

       Note  that cursor keys are bound to movement keys in all three keymaps;
       the shell assumes that the cursor keys send the key sequences  reported
       by  the	terminal-handling  library  (termcap  or  terminfo).   The key
       sequences shown in the list are those based on  the  VT100,  common  on
       many modern terminals, but in fact these are not necessarily bound.  In
       the case of the viins keymap,  the  initial  escape  character  of  the
       sequences  serves also to return to the vicmd keymap: whether this hap‐
       pens is determined by the KEYTIMEOUT parameter, see zshparam(1).

   Movement
       vi-backward-blank-word (unbound) (B) (unbound)
	      Move backward one word, where a word is defined as a  series  of
	      non-blank characters.

       backward-char (^B ESC-[D) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Move backward one character.

       vi-backward-char (unbound) (^H h ^?) (ESC-[D)
	      Move backward one character, without changing lines.

       backward-word (ESC-B ESC-b) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Move to the beginning of the previous word.

       emacs-backward-word
	      Move to the beginning of the previous word.

       vi-backward-word (unbound) (b) (unbound)
	      Move to the beginning of the previous word, vi-style.

       beginning-of-line (^A) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Move  to the beginning of the line.  If already at the beginning
	      of the line, move to the beginning of the previous line, if any.

       vi-beginning-of-line
	      Move to the beginning of the line, without changing lines.

       end-of-line (^E) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Move to the end of the line.  If already at the end of the line,
	      move to the end of the next line, if any.

       vi-end-of-line (unbound) ($) (unbound)
	      Move  to	the  end of the line.  If an argument is given to this
	      command, the cursor will be moved to the end of the line	(argu‐
	      ment - 1) lines down.

       vi-forward-blank-word (unbound) (W) (unbound)
	      Move  forward  one  word, where a word is defined as a series of
	      non-blank characters.

       vi-forward-blank-word-end (unbound) (E) (unbound)
	      Move to the end of the current word, or, if at the  end  of  the
	      current  word,  to  the  end  of	the next word, where a word is
	      defined as a series of non-blank characters.

       forward-char (^F ESC-[C) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Move forward one character.

       vi-forward-char (unbound) (space l) (ESC-[C)
	      Move forward one character.

       vi-find-next-char (^X^F) (f) (unbound)
	      Read a character from the keyboard, and move to the next	occur‐
	      rence of it in the line.

       vi-find-next-char-skip (unbound) (t) (unbound)
	      Read  a  character  from	the keyboard, and move to the position
	      just before the next occurrence of it in the line.

       vi-find-prev-char (unbound) (F) (unbound)
	      Read a character from the keyboard, and  move  to	 the  previous
	      occurrence of it in the line.

       vi-find-prev-char-skip (unbound) (T) (unbound)
	      Read  a  character  from	the keyboard, and move to the position
	      just after the previous occurrence of it in the line.

       vi-first-non-blank (unbound) (^) (unbound)
	      Move to the first non-blank character in the line.

       vi-forward-word (unbound) (w) (unbound)
	      Move forward one word, vi-style.

       forward-word (ESC-F ESC-f) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Move to the beginning of the next word.  The editor's idea of  a
	      word is specified with the WORDCHARS parameter.

       emacs-forward-word
	      Move to the end of the next word.

       vi-forward-word-end (unbound) (e) (unbound)
	      Move to the end of the next word.

       vi-goto-column (ESC-|) (|) (unbound)
	      Move to the column specified by the numeric argument.

       vi-goto-mark (unbound) (`) (unbound)
	      Move to the specified mark.

       vi-goto-mark-line (unbound) (') (unbound)
	      Move to beginning of the line containing the specified mark.

       vi-repeat-find (unbound) (;) (unbound)
	      Repeat the last vi-find command.

       vi-rev-repeat-find (unbound) (,) (unbound)
	      Repeat the last vi-find command in the opposite direction.

   History Control
       beginning-of-buffer-or-history (ESC-<) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Move  to	the beginning of the buffer, or if already there, move
	      to the first event in the history list.

       beginning-of-line-hist
	      Move to the beginning of the line.  If already at the  beginning
	      of the buffer, move to the previous history line.

       beginning-of-history
	      Move to the first event in the history list.

       down-line-or-history (^N ESC-[B) (j) (ESC-[B)
	      Move  down  a  line  in  the buffer, or if already at the bottom
	      line, move to the next event in the history list.

       vi-down-line-or-history (unbound) (+) (unbound)
	      Move down a line in the buffer, or  if  already  at  the	bottom
	      line,  move to the next event in the history list.  Then move to
	      the first non-blank character on the line.

       down-line-or-search
	      Move down a line in the buffer, or  if  already  at  the	bottom
	      line,  search  forward  in the history for a line beginning with
	      the first word in the buffer.

	      If called from a function by the zle command with arguments, the
	      first  argument  is  taken  as  the  string for which to search,
	      rather than the first word in the buffer.

       down-history (unbound) (^N) (unbound)
	      Move to the next event in the history list.

       history-beginning-search-backward
	      Search backward in the history for a  line  beginning  with  the
	      current  line  up	 to the cursor.	 This leaves the cursor in its
	      original position.

       end-of-buffer-or-history (ESC->) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Move to the end of the buffer, or if already there, move to  the
	      last event in the history list.

       end-of-line-hist
	      Move  to the end of the line.  If already at the end of the buf‐
	      fer, move to the next history line.

       end-of-history
	      Move to the last event in the history list.

       vi-fetch-history (unbound) (G) (unbound)
	      Fetch the history line specified by the numeric argument.	  This
	      defaults	to  the	 current history line (i.e. the one that isn't
	      history yet).

       history-incremental-search-backward (^R ^Xr) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Search backward  incrementally  for  a  specified	 string.   The
	      search  is  case-insensitive  if the search string does not have
	      uppercase letters and no numeric argument was given.  The string
	      may  begin with `^' to anchor the search to the beginning of the
	      line.

	      A restricted set	of  editing  functions	is  available  in  the
	      mini-buffer.   An	 interrupt signal, as defined by the stty set‐
	      ting, will stop the search and go back to the original line.  An
	      undefined key will have the same effect. The supported functions
	      are:	 backward-delete-char,	      vi-backward-delete-char,
	      clear-screen,    redisplay,   quoted-insert,   vi-quoted-insert,
	      accept-and-hold, accept-and-infer-next-history, accept-line  and
	      accept-line-and-down-history.

	      magic-space  just	 inserts a space.  vi-cmd-mode toggles between
	      the `main' and `vicmd' keymaps; the `main' keymap (insert	 mode)
	      will be selected initially.  history-incremental-search-backward
	      will get the next occurrence of the contents of the mini-buffer.
	      history-incremental-search-forward  inverts  the	sense  of  the
	      search.  vi-repeat-search and vi-rev-repeat-search are similarly
	      supported.   The	direction  of  the  search is indicated in the
	      mini-buffer.

	      Any multi-character string that is not bound to one of the above
	      functions	 will  beep and interrupt the search, leaving the last
	      found line in the buffer. Any single character that is not bound
	      to   one	 of   the   above   functions,	 or   self-insert   or
	      self-insert-unmeta, will have the same effect but	 the  function
	      will be executed.

	      When  called  from  a  widget  function  by the zle command, the
	      incremental search commands can take a  string  argument.	  This
	      will  be	treated	 as  a string of keys, as for arguments to the
	      bindkey command, and used as initial input for the command.  Any
	      characters  in  the  string  which are unused by the incremental
	      search will be silently ignored.	For example,

		     zle history-incremental-search-backward forceps

	      will search backwards for forceps, leaving the  minibuffer  con‐
	      taining the string `forceps'.

       history-incremental-search-forward (^S ^Xs) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Search forward incrementally for a specified string.  The search
	      is case-insensitive if the search string does not have uppercase
	      letters and no numeric argument was given.  The string may begin
	      with `^' to anchor the search to the beginning of the line.  The
	      functions	 available in the mini-buffer are the same as for his‐
	      tory-incremental-search-backward.

       history-search-backward (ESC-P ESC-p) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Search backward in the history for a  line  beginning  with  the
	      first word in the buffer.

	      If called from a function by the zle command with arguments, the
	      first argument is taken as  the  string  for  which  to  search,
	      rather than the first word in the buffer.

       vi-history-search-backward (unbound) (/) (unbound)
	      Search  backward	in  the	 history  for a specified string.  The
	      string may begin with `^' to anchor the search to the  beginning
	      of the line.

	      A	 restricted  set  of  editing  functions  is  available in the
	      mini-buffer.  An interrupt signal, as defined by the  stty  set‐
	      ting,   will  stop  the  search.	The functions available in the
	      mini-buffer  are:	 accept-line,  backward-delete-char,  vi-back‐
	      ward-delete-char,	  backward-kill-word,	vi-backward-kill-word,
	      clear-screen, redisplay, quoted-insert and vi-quoted-insert.

	      vi-cmd-mode is treated the same as accept-line, and  magic-space
	      is treated as a space.  Any other character that is not bound to
	      self-insert or self-insert-unmeta will beep and be  ignored.  If
	      the function is called from vi command mode, the bindings of the
	      current insert mode will be used.

	      If called from a function by the zle command with arguments, the
	      first  argument  is  taken  as  the  string for which to search,
	      rather than the first word in the buffer.

       history-search-forward (ESC-N ESC-n) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Search forward in the history for	 a  line  beginning  with  the
	      first word in the buffer.

	      If called from a function by the zle command with arguments, the
	      first argument is taken as  the  string  for  which  to  search,
	      rather than the first word in the buffer.

       vi-history-search-forward (unbound) (?) (unbound)
	      Search  forward  in  the	history	 for  a specified string.  The
	      string may begin with `^' to anchor the search to the  beginning
	      of  the line. The functions available in the mini-buffer are the
	      same as for vi-history-search-backward.	Argument  handling  is
	      also the same as for that command.

       infer-next-history (^X^N) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Search  in  the history list for a line matching the current one
	      and fetch the event following it.

       insert-last-word (ESC-_ ESC-.) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Insert the last word from the previous history event at the cur‐
	      sor  position.   If a positive numeric argument is given, insert
	      that word from the end of the previous history  event.   If  the
	      argument	is  zero  or  negative	insert that word from the left
	      (zero inserts the previous command word).	 Repeating  this  com‐
	      mand replaces the word just inserted with the last word from the
	      history event prior to the one just used; numeric arguments  can
	      be used in the same way to pick a word from that event.

       vi-repeat-search (unbound) (n) (unbound)
	      Repeat the last vi history search.

       vi-rev-repeat-search (unbound) (N) (unbound)
	      Repeat the last vi history search, but in reverse.

       up-line-or-history (^P ESC-[A) (k) (ESC-[A)
	      Move  up	a  line	 in the buffer, or if already at the top line,
	      move to the previous event in the history list.

       vi-up-line-or-history (unbound) (-) (unbound)
	      Move up a line in the buffer, or if already  at  the  top	 line,
	      move  to	the  previous event in the history list.  Then move to
	      the first non-blank character on the line.

       up-line-or-search
	      Move up a line in the buffer, or if already  at  the  top	 line,
	      search  backward	in  the	 history for a line beginning with the
	      first word in the buffer.

	      If called from a function by the zle command with arguments, the
	      first  argument  is  taken  as  the  string for which to search,
	      rather than the first word in the buffer.

       up-history (unbound) (^P) (unbound)
	      Move to the previous event in the history list.

       history-beginning-search-forward
	      Search forward in the history for a line beginning with the cur‐
	      rent line up to the cursor.  This leaves the cursor in its orig‐
	      inal position.

   Modifying Text
       vi-add-eol (unbound) (A) (unbound)
	      Move to the end of the line and enter insert mode.

       vi-add-next (unbound) (a) (unbound)
	      Enter insert mode after the  current  cursor  position,  without
	      changing lines.

       backward-delete-char (^H ^?) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Delete the character behind the cursor.

       vi-backward-delete-char (unbound) (X) (^H)
	      Delete  the character behind the cursor, without changing lines.
	      If in insert mode, this won't delete past the point where insert
	      mode was last entered.

       backward-delete-word
	      Delete the word behind the cursor.

       backward-kill-line
	      Kill from the beginning of the line to the cursor position.

       backward-kill-word (^W ESC-^H ESC-^?) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Kill the word behind the cursor.

       vi-backward-kill-word (unbound) (unbound) (^W)
	      Kill  the	 word  behind the cursor, without going past the point
	      where insert mode was last entered.

       capitalize-word (ESC-C ESC-c) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Capitalize the current word and move past it.

       vi-change (unbound) (c) (unbound)
	      Read a movement command from the keyboard,  and  kill  from  the
	      cursor  position	to  the	 endpoint of the movement.  Then enter
	      insert mode.  If the command is vi-change,  change  the  current
	      line.

       vi-change-eol (unbound) (C) (unbound)
	      Kill to the end of the line and enter insert mode.

       vi-change-whole-line (unbound) (S) (unbound)
	      Kill the current line and enter insert mode.

       copy-region-as-kill (ESC-W ESC-w) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Copy the area from the cursor to the mark to the kill buffer.

       copy-prev-word (ESC-^_) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Duplicate the word to the left of the cursor.

       copy-prev-shell-word (ESC-^_) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Like  copy-prev-word, but the word is found by using shell pars‐
	      ing, whereas copy-prev-word looks for blanks. This makes a  dif‐
	      ference when the word is quoted and contains spaces.

       vi-delete (unbound) (d) (unbound)
	      Read  a  movement	 command  from the keyboard, and kill from the
	      cursor position to the endpoint of the movement.	If the command
	      is vi-delete, kill the current line.

       delete-char
	      Delete the character under the cursor.

       vi-delete-char (unbound) (x) (unbound)
	      Delete  the  character  under the cursor, without going past the
	      end of the line.

       delete-word
	      Delete the current word.

       down-case-word (ESC-L ESC-l) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Convert the current word to all lowercase and move past it.

       kill-word (ESC-D ESC-d) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Kill the current word.

       gosmacs-transpose-chars
	      Exchange the two characters behind the cursor.

       vi-indent (unbound) (>) (unbound)
	      Indent a number of lines.

       vi-insert (unbound) (i) (unbound)
	      Enter insert mode.

       vi-insert-bol (unbound) (I) (unbound)
	      Move to the first non-blank character  on	 the  line  and	 enter
	      insert mode.

       vi-join (^X^J) (J) (unbound)
	      Join the current line with the next one.

       kill-line (^K) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Kill  from the cursor to the end of the line.  If already on the
	      end of the line, kill the newline character.

       vi-kill-line (unbound) (unbound) (^U)
	      Kill from the cursor back	 to  wherever  insert  mode  was  last
	      entered.

       vi-kill-eol (unbound) (D) (unbound)
	      Kill from the cursor to the end of the line.

       kill-region
	      Kill from the cursor to the mark.

       kill-buffer (^X^K) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Kill the entire buffer.

       kill-whole-line (^U) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Kill the current line.

       vi-match-bracket (^X^B) (%) (unbound)
	      Move to the bracket character (one of {}, () or []) that matches
	      the one under the cursor.	 If the cursor is  not	on  a  bracket
	      character,  move	forward without going past the end of the line
	      to find one, and then go to the matching bracket.

       vi-open-line-above (unbound) (O) (unbound)
	      Open a line above the cursor and enter insert mode.

       vi-open-line-below (unbound) (o) (unbound)
	      Open a line below the cursor and enter insert mode.

       vi-oper-swap-case
	      Read a movement command from the keyboard, and swap the case  of
	      all  characters  from the cursor position to the endpoint of the
	      movement.	 If the movement command  is  vi-oper-swap-case,  swap
	      the case of all characters on the current line.

       overwrite-mode (^X^O) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Toggle between overwrite mode and insert mode.

       vi-put-before (unbound) (P) (unbound)
	      Insert  the  contents  of the kill buffer before the cursor.  If
	      the kill buffer contains a sequence  of  lines  (as  opposed  to
	      characters), paste it above the current line.

       vi-put-after (unbound) (p) (unbound)
	      Insert the contents of the kill buffer after the cursor.	If the
	      kill buffer contains a sequence of lines (as opposed to  charac‐
	      ters), paste it below the current line.

       quoted-insert (^V) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Insert  the  next character typed into the buffer literally.  An
	      interrupt character will not be inserted.

       vi-quoted-insert (unbound) (unbound) (^Q ^V)
	      Display a `^' at the cursor position, and insert the next	 char‐
	      acter  typed  into the buffer literally.	An interrupt character
	      will not be inserted.

       quote-line (ESC-') (unbound) (unbound)
	      Quote the current line; that is, put  a  `''  character  at  the
	      beginning and the end, and convert all `'' characters to `'\'''.

       quote-region (ESC-") (unbound) (unbound)
	      Quote the region from the cursor to the mark.

       vi-replace (unbound) (R) (unbound)
	      Enter overwrite mode.

       vi-repeat-change (unbound) (.) (unbound)
	      Repeat  the last vi mode text modification.  If a count was used
	      with the modification, it is remembered.	If a count is given to
	      this  command,  it overrides the remembered count, and is remem‐
	      bered for future uses of this command.  The cut buffer  specifi‐
	      cation is similarly remembered.

       vi-replace-chars (unbound) (r) (unbound)
	      Replace  the  character  under  the cursor with a character read
	      from the keyboard.

       self-insert (printable characters) (unbound) (printable characters  and
       some control characters)
	      Insert a character into the buffer at the cursor position.

       self-insert-unmeta (ESC-^I ESC-^J ESC-^M) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Insert  a character into the buffer after stripping the meta bit
	      and converting ^M to ^J.

       vi-substitute (unbound) (s) (unbound)
	      Substitute the next character(s).

       vi-swap-case (unbound) (~) (unbound)
	      Swap the case of the character under the cursor  and  move  past
	      it.

       transpose-chars (^T) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Exchange	the two characters to the left of the cursor if at end
	      of line, else exchange the character under the cursor  with  the
	      character to the left.

       transpose-words (ESC-T ESC-t) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Exchange the current word with the one before it.

       vi-unindent (unbound) (<) (unbound)
	      Unindent a number of lines.

       up-case-word (ESC-U ESC-u) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Convert the current word to all caps and move past it.

       yank (^Y) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Insert the contents of the kill buffer at the cursor position.

       yank-pop (ESC-y) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Remove  the text just yanked, rotate the kill-ring, and yank the
	      new top.	Only works following yank or yank-pop.

       vi-yank (unbound) (y) (unbound)
	      Read a movement command from the keyboard, and copy  the	region
	      from  the	 cursor	 position to the endpoint of the movement into
	      the kill buffer.	If the command is vi-yank,  copy  the  current
	      line.

       vi-yank-whole-line (unbound) (Y) (unbound)
	      Copy the current line into the kill buffer.

       vi-yank-eol
	      Copy  the region from the cursor position to the end of the line
	      into the kill buffer.  Arguably, this is what Y should do in vi,
	      but it isn't what it actually does.

   Arguments
       digit-argument (ESC-0..ESC-9) (1-9) (unbound)
	      Start  a	new  numeric argument, or add to the current one.  See
	      also vi-digit-or-beginning-of-line.  This only works if bound to
	      a key sequence ending in a decimal digit.

	      Inside  a	 widget	 function,  a call to this function treats the
	      last key of the key sequence which  called  the  widget  as  the
	      digit.

       neg-argument (ESC--) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Changes the sign of the following argument.

       universal-argument
	      Multiply	the argument of the next command by 4.	Alternatively,
	      if this command is followed by an	 integer  (positive  or	 nega‐
	      tive), use that as the argument for the next command.  Thus dig‐
	      its cannot be repeated using this command.  For example, if this
	      command occurs twice, followed immediately by forward-char, move
	      forward sixteen spaces; if instead it is followed	 by  -2,  then
	      forward-char, move backward two spaces.

	      Inside  a widget function, if passed an argument, i.e. `zle uni‐
	      versal-argument num', the numerical argument will be set to num;
	      this is equivalent to `NUMERIC=num'.

   Completion
       accept-and-menu-complete
	      In  a  menu  completion,	insert the current completion into the
	      buffer, and advance to the next possible completion.

       complete-word
	      Attempt completion on the current word.

       delete-char-or-list (^D) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Delete the character under the cursor.  If the cursor is at  the
	      end of the line, list possible completions for the current word.

       expand-cmd-path
	      Expand the current command to its full pathname.

       expand-or-complete (TAB) (unbound) (TAB)
	      Attempt  shell  expansion	 on  the current word.	If that fails,
	      attempt completion.

       expand-or-complete-prefix
	      Attempt shell expansion on the current word up to cursor.

       expand-history (ESC-space ESC-!) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Perform history expansion on the edit buffer.

       expand-word (^X*) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Attempt shell expansion on the current word.

       list-choices (ESC-^D) (^D =) (^D)
	      List possible completions for the current word.

       list-expand (^Xg ^XG) (^G) (^G)
	      List the expansion of the current word.

       magic-space
	      Perform history expansion and insert a space  into  the  buffer.
	      This is intended to be bound to space.

       menu-complete
	      Like  complete-word,  except  that menu completion is used.  See
	      the MENU_COMPLETE option.

       menu-expand-or-complete
	      Like expand-or-complete, except that menu completion is used.

       reverse-menu-complete
	      Perform menu completion, like menu-complete, except  that	 if  a
	      menu  completion	is  already  in progress, move to the previous
	      completion rather than the next.

       end-of-list
	      When a previous completion displayed a list  below  the  prompt,
	      this widget can be used to move the prompt below the list.

   Miscellaneous
       accept-and-hold (ESC-A ESC-a) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Push  the contents of the buffer on the buffer stack and execute
	      it.

       accept-and-infer-next-history
	      Execute the contents of the buffer.   Then  search  the  history
	      list for a line matching the current one and push the event fol‐
	      lowing onto the buffer stack.

       accept-line (^J ^M) (^J ^M) (^J ^M)
	      Finish editing the buffer.  Normally this causes the  buffer  to
	      be executed as a shell command.

       accept-line-and-down-history (^O) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Execute the current line, and push the next history event on the
	      the buffer stack.

       beep   Beep, unless the BEEP option is unset.

       vi-cmd-mode (^X^V) (unbound) (^[)
	      Enter command mode; that is, select the  `vicmd'	keymap.	  Yes,
	      this is bound by default in emacs mode.

       vi-caps-lock-panic
	      Hang  until  any lowercase key is pressed.  This is for vi users
	      without the mental capacity to keep track of their caps lock key
	      (like the author).

       clear-screen (^L ESC-^L) (^L) (^L)
	      Clear the screen and redraw the prompt.

       describe-key-briefly
	      Reads  a	key  sequence,	then prints the function bound to that
	      sequence.

       exchange-point-and-mark (^X^X) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Exchange the cursor position with the position of the mark.

       execute-named-cmd (ESC-x) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Read the name of an editor command and execute it.  A restricted
	      set  of  editing	functions is available in the mini-buffer.  An
	      interrupt signal, as defined by the stty setting, will abort the
	      function.	  The  allowed	functions  are:	 backward-delete-char,
	      vi-backward-delete-char, clear-screen, redisplay, quoted-insert,
	      vi-quoted-insert,	  backward-kill-word,	vi-backward-kill-word,
	      kill-whole-line, vi-kill-line, backward-kill-line, list-choices,
	      delete-char-or-list,  complete-word, accept-line, expand-or-com‐
	      plete and expand-or-complete-prefix.

	      kill-region kills the last word, and vi-cmd-mode is treated  the
	      same as accept-line.  The space and tab characters, if not bound
	      to one of these functions, will complete the name and then  list
	      the  possibilities  if  the  AUTO_LIST option is set.  Any other
	      character that is not bound to self-insert or self-insert-unmeta
	      will  beep  and  be ignored.  The bindings of the current insert
	      mode will be used.

       execute-last-named-cmd (ESC-z) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Redo the last function executed with execute-named-cmd.

       get-line (ESC-G ESC-g) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Pop the top line off the buffer stack and insert it at the  cur‐
	      sor position.

       pound-insert (unbound) (#) (unbound)
	      If  there	 is no # character at the beginning of the buffer, add
	      one to the beginning of each line.  If there is one, remove a  #
	      from each line that has one.  In either case, accept the current
	      line.  The INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS option must be set for  this  to
	      have any usefulness.

       vi-pound-insert
	      If there is no # character at the beginning of the current line,
	      add one.	If there is one, remove it.  The  INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS
	      option must be set for this to have any usefulness.

       push-input
	      Push  the	 entire	 current  multiline  construct onto the buffer
	      stack and return to the top-level (PS1) prompt.  If the  current
	      parser  construct	 is  only  a single line, this is exactly like
	      push-line.  Next time the editor starts up  or  is  popped  with
	      get-line, the construct will be popped off the top of the buffer
	      stack and loaded into the editing buffer.

       push-line (^Q ESC-Q ESC-q) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Push the current buffer onto the buffer stack and clear the buf‐
	      fer.   Next time the editor starts up, the buffer will be popped
	      off the top of the buffer stack and loaded into the editing buf‐
	      fer.

       push-line-or-edit
	      At  the  top-level  (PS1) prompt, equivalent to push-line.  At a
	      secondary (PS2) prompt, move the entire current  multiline  con‐
	      struct  into  the	 editor	 buffer.   The latter is equivalent to
	      push-input followed by get-line.

       redisplay (unbound) (^R) (^R)
	      Redisplays the edit buffer.

       send-break (^G ESC-^G) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Abort the current editor function,  e.g.	execute-named-command,
	      or  the editor itself, e.g. if you are in vared. Otherwise abort
	      the parsing of the current line.

       run-help (ESC-H ESC-h) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Push the buffer onto the buffer stack, and execute  the  command
	      `run-help	 cmd',	where cmd is the current command.  run-help is
	      normally aliased to man.

       vi-set-buffer (unbound) (") (unbound)
	      Specify a buffer to be used in the following command.  There are
	      35  buffers  that can be specified: the 26 `named' buffers "a to
	      "z and the nine `queued' buffers "1 to "9.   The	named  buffers
	      can also be specified as "A to "Z.

	      When a buffer is specified for a cut command, the text being cut
	      replaces the previous contents of the specified  buffer.	 If  a
	      named buffer is specified using a capital, the newly cut text is
	      appended to the buffer instead of overwriting it.

	      If no buffer is specified for a cut command, "1 is used, and the
	      contents of "1 to "8 are each shifted along one buffer; the con‐
	      tents of "9 is lost.

       vi-set-mark (unbound) (m) (unbound)
	      Set the specified mark at the cursor position.

       set-mark-command (^@) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Set the mark at the cursor position.

       spell-word (ESC-$ ESC-S ESC-s) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Attempt spelling correction on the current word.

       undefined-key
	      This command is executed when a key sequence that is  not	 bound
	      to any command is typed.	By default it beeps.

       undo (^_ ^Xu ^X^U) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Incrementally undo the last text modification.

       redo   Incrementally redo undone text modifications.

       vi-undo-change (unbound) (u) (unbound)
	      Undo  the last text modification.	 If repeated, redo the modifi‐
	      cation.

       what-cursor-position (^X=) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Print the character under the cursor, its code as an octal, dec‐
	      imal  and hexadecimal number, the current cursor position within
	      the buffer and the column of the cursor in the current line.

       where-is
	      Read the name of an editor command and and print the listing  of
	      key sequences that invoke the specified command.

       which-command (ESC-?) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Push  the	 buffer onto the buffer stack, and execute the command
	      `which-command  cmd'.  where  cmd	 is   the   current   command.
	      which-command is normally aliased to whence.

       vi-digit-or-beginning-of-line (unbound) (0) (unbound)
	      If the last command executed was a digit as part of an argument,
	      continue the argument.  Otherwise, execute vi-beginning-of-line.

ZSHCOMPWID(1)							 ZSHCOMPWID(1)

NAME
       zshcompwid - zsh completion widgets

DESCRIPTION
       The shell's programmable completion mechanism can be manipulated in two
       ways;  here the low-level features supporting the newer, function-based
       mechanism are defined.  A complete set  of  shell  functions  based  on
       these  features is described in zshcompsys(1), and users with no inter‐
       est in adding to that system (or, potentially, writing  their  own  ---
       see dictionary entry for `hubris') should skip this section.  The older
       system based on the compctl builtin command  is	described  in  zshcom‐
       pctl(1).

       Completion widgets are defined by the -C option to the zle builtin com‐
       mand provided by the zsh/zle module (see zshzle(1)). For example,

	      zle -C complete expand-or-complete completer

       defines a widget named `complete'.  The second argument is the name  of
       any  of	the  builtin  widgets  that handle completions: complete-word,
       expand-or-complete,	expand-or-complete-prefix,	menu-complete,
       menu-expand-or-complete,	   reverse-menu-complete,   list-choices,   or
       delete-char-or-list.  Note that this will still work even if the widget
       in question has been re-bound.

       When  this  newly  defined  widget  is bound to a key using the bindkey
       builtin command defined in the zsh/zle module (see  zshzle(1)),	typing
       that  key  will	call  the shell function `completer'. This function is
       responsible for generating the  possible	 matches  using	 the  builtins
       described  below.   As  with  other ZLE widgets, the function is called
       with its standard input closed.

       Once the function returns, the completion code takes over control again
       and treats the matches in the same manner as the specified builtin wid‐
       get, in this case expand-or-complete.

SPECIAL PARAMETERS
       Inside completion widgets, and any functions  called  from  them,  some
       parameters  have	 special meaning; outside these functions they are not
       special to the shell in any way.	 These parameters  are	used  to  pass
       information between the completion code and the completion widget. Some
       of the builtin commands and the condition codes use or change the  cur‐
       rent  values  of	 these parameters.  Any existing values will be hidden
       during execution of  completion	widgets;  except  for  compstate,  the
       parameters  are	reset on each function exit (including nested function
       calls from within the completion widget) to the values  they  had  when
       the function was entered.

       CURRENT
	      This is the number of the current word, i.e. the word the cursor
	      is currently on in the words array.  Note	 that  this  value  is
	      only correct if the ksharrays option is not set.

       IPREFIX
	      Initially	 this will be set to the empty string.	This parameter
	      functions like PREFIX; it contains a string which	 precedes  the
	      one in PREFIX and is not considered part of the list of matches.
	      Typically, a string is transferred from the beginning of	PREFIX
	      to the end of IPREFIX, for example:

		     IPREFIX=${PREFIX%%\=*}=
		     PREFIX=${PREFIX#*=}

	      causes  the  part	 of  the  prefix up to and including the first
	      equal sign not to be treated as part of a matched string.	  This
	      can be done automatically by the compset builtin, see below.

       ISUFFIX
	      As  IPREFIX, but for a suffix that should not be considered part
	      of the matches; note that the ISUFFIX string follows the	SUFFIX
	      string.

       PREFIX Initially	 this will be set to the part of the current word from
	      the beginning of the word up to the position of the  cursor;  it
	      may be altered to give a common prefix for all matches.

       QIPREFIX
	      This parameter is read-only and contains the quoted string up to
	      the word being completed.	 E.g.  when  completing	 `"foo',  this
	      parameter contains the double quote. If the -q option of compset
	      is used (see below), and the original string was `"foo bar' with
	      the cursor on the `bar', this parameter contains `"foo '.

       QISUFFIX
	      Like QIPREFIX, but containing the suffix.

       SUFFIX Initially	 this will be set to the part of the current word from
	      the cursor position to the end; it may be altered to give a com‐
	      mon  suffix  for all matches.  It is most useful when the option
	      COMPLETE_IN_WORD is set, as otherwise the whole word on the com‐
	      mand line is treated as a prefix.

       compstate
	      This  is	an associative array with various keys and values that
	      the completion code uses to exchange information with  the  com‐
	      pletion widget.  The keys are:

	      all_quotes
		     The  -q option of the compset builtin command (see below)
		     allows a quoted string to be broken into separate	words;
		     if the cursor is on one of those words, that word will be
		     completed, possibly invoking  `compset  -q'  recursively.
		     With  this key it is possible to test the types of quoted
		     strings which are currently broken	 into  parts  in  this
		     fashion.  Its value contains one character for each quot‐
		     ing level.	 The characters are a single quote or a double
		     quote  for	 strings  quoted  with	these characters and a
		     backslash for strings not starting with a	quote  charac‐
		     ter.  The first character in the value always corresponds
		     to the innermost quoting level.

	      context
		     This will be set by the completion code  to  the  overall
		     context in which completion is attempted. Possible values
		     are:

		     array_value
			    when completing  inside  the  value	 of  an	 array
			    parameter assignment; in this case the words array
			    contains the words inside the parentheses.

		     brace_parameter
			    when completing the	 name  of  a  parameter	 in  a
			    parameter expansion beginning with ${.

		     command
			    when  completing  for  a normal command (either in
			    command position or for an argument	 of  the  com‐
			    mand).

		     condition
			    when  completing  inside  a	 `[[...]]' conditional
			    expression; in this case the words array  contains
			    only the words inside the conditional expression.

		     math   when completing in a mathematical environment such
			    as a `((...))' construct.

		     parameter
			    when completing the	 name  of  a  parameter	 in  a
			    parameter expansion beginning with $ but not ${.

		     redirect
			    when completing after a redirection operator.

		     subscript
			    when completing inside a parameter subscript.

		     value  when  completing  the value of a parameter assign‐
			    ment.

	      exact  Controls the behaviour when the REC_EXACT option is  set.
		     It	 will  be  set	to  accept  if an exact match would be
		     accepted, and will be unset otherwise.

		     If it was set when at least one match equal to the string
		     on the line was generated, the match is accepted.

	      exact_string
		     The  string of an exact match if one was found, otherwise
		     unset.

	      ignored
		     The number	 of  words  that  were	ignored	 because  they
		     matched  one  of the patterns given with the -F option to
		     the compadd builtin command.

	      insert This controls the manner in which	a  match  is  inserted
		     into  the command line.  On entry to the widget function,
		     if it is unset the command line is not to be changed;  if
		     set  to  unambiguous, any prefix common to all matches is
		     to be inserted; if set to automenu-unambiguous, the  com‐
		     mon  prefix  is to be inserted and the next invocation of
		     the completion code may start menu completion (due to the
		     AUTO_MENU	option	being set); if set to menu or automenu
		     menu completion will be started for the matches currently
		     generated	(in  the  latter case this will happen because
		     the AUTO_MENU is set). The value  may  also  contain  the
		     string  `tab' when the completion code would normally not
		     really do completion, but only insert the TAB character.

		     On exit it may be set to any of the values	 above	(where
		     setting  it  to the empty string is the same as unsetting
		     it), or to a number, in which case the match whose number
		     is	 given	will be inserted into the command line.	 Nega‐
		     tive numbers count backward from  the  last  match	 (with
		     `-1'  selecting  the  last match) and out-of-range values
		     are wrapped around, so that a value of zero  selects  the
		     last  match and a value one more than the maximum selects
		     the first. Unless the value of this key ends in a	space,
		     the match is inserted as in a menu completion, i.e. with‐
		     out automatically appending a space.

		     Both menu and automenu may also specify the the number of
		     the  match	 to insert, given after a colon.  For example,
		     `menu:2' says to start menu  completion,  beginning  with
		     the second match.

		     Note  that	 a  value containing the substring `tab' makes
		     the matches generated be ignored  and  only  the  TAB  be
		     inserted.

		     Finally,  it  may	also  be  set  to all, which makes all
		     matches generated be inserted into the line.

	      insert_positions
		     When the completion system inserts an unambiguous	string
		     into the line, there may be multiple places where charac‐
		     ters are missing or where the character inserted  differs
		     from  at least one match.	The value of this key contains
		     a colon separated list of all these positions, as indexes
		     into the command line.

	      last_prompt
		     If	 this  is  set	to  a non-empty string for every match
		     added, the completion code will move the cursor  back  to
		     the  previous  prompt  after  the list of completions has
		     been displayed.  Initially this is set or unset according
		     to the ALWAYS_LAST_PROMPT option.

	      list   This  controls whether or how the list of matches will be
		     displayed.	 If it is unset or empty they  will  never  be
		     listed;  if  its value begins with list, they will always
		     be listed; if it begins with autolist or ambiguous,  they
		     will  be  listed  when  the  AUTO_LIST  or LIST_AMBIGUOUS
		     options respectively would normally cause them to be.

		     If the substring force appears in the value,  this	 makes
		     the  list	be shown even if there is only one match. Nor‐
		     mally, the list would be shown only if there are at least
		     two matches.

		     The   value   contains   the   substring  packed  if  the
		     LIST_PACKED option is set. If this substring is given for
		     all  matches  added  to a group, this group will show the
		     LIST_PACKED  behavior.  The  same	 is   done   for   the
		     LIST_ROWS_FIRST option with the substring rows.

		     Finally,  if  the value contains the string explanations,
		     only the explanation strings, if any, will be listed  and
		     if	 it  contains  messages, only the messages (added with
		     the -x option of compadd) will be listed.	If it contains
		     both  explanations and messages both kinds of explanation
		     strings will be listed.  It will be set appropriately  on
		     entry to a completion widget and may be changed there.

	      list_lines
		     This gives the number of lines that are needed to display
		     the full list of completions.  Note that to calculate the
		     total number of lines to display you need to add the num‐
		     ber of lines needed for the command line to  this	value,
		     this is available as the value of the BUFFERLINES special
		     parameter.

	      list_max
		     Initially this is set to the value of the LISTMAX parame‐
		     ter.   It	may be set to any other value; when the widget
		     exits this value will be used in  the  same  way  as  the
		     value of LISTMAX.

	      nmatches
		     The  number of matches generated and accepted by the com‐
		     pletion code so far.

	      old_insert
		     On entry to the widget this will be set to the number  of
		     the match of an old list of completions that is currently
		     inserted into the command line.  If  no  match  has  been
		     inserted, this is unset.

		     As with old_list, the value of this key will only be used
		     if it is the string keep. If it was set to this value  by
		     the  widget  and there was an old match inserted into the
		     command line, this match will be kept and if the value of
		     the  insert  key  specifies  that another match should be
		     inserted, this will be inserted after the old one.

	      old_list
		     This is set to yes if there is still a valid list of com‐
		     pletions  from a previous completion at the time the wid‐
		     get is invoked.  This will usually be  the	 case  if  and
		     only  if  the previous editing operation was a completion
		     widget or one of the builtin  completion  functions.   If
		     there  is	a valid list and it is also currently shown on
		     the screen, the value of this key is shown.

		     After the widget has exited the value of this key is only
		     used  if it was set to keep.  In this case the completion
		     code will continue to use this old list.  If  the	widget
		     generated new matches, they will not be used.

	      parameter
		     The  name of the parameter when completing in a subscript
		     or in the value of a parameter assignment.

	      pattern_insert
		     Normally this is set to menu, which specifies  that  menu
		     completion	 will  be  used	 whenever a set of matches was
		     generated using pattern matching.	If it is  set  to  any
		     other non-empty string by the user and menu completion is
		     not selected by other  option  settings,  the  code  will
		     instead  insert  any  common  prefix  for	the  generated
		     matches as with normal completion.

	      pattern_match
		     Locally controls the behaviour given by the GLOB_COMPLETE
		     option.   Initially  it  is set to `*' if and only if the
		     option is set.  The completion widget may set it to  this
		     value,  to	 an empty string (which has the same effect as
		     unsetting it), or to any other non-empty string.	If  it
		     is non-empty, unquoted metacharacters on the command line
		     will be treated as patterns; if it is `*', then addition‐
		     ally a wildcard `*' is assumed at the cursor position; if
		     it is empty or unset, metacharacters will be treated lit‐
		     erally.

		     Note that the matcher specifications given to the compadd
		     builtin command  are  not	used  if  this	is  set	 to  a
		     non-empty string.

	      quote  When  completing  inside quotes, this contains the quota‐
		     tion character (i.e. either  a  single  quote,  a	double
		     quote, or a backtick).  Otherwise it is unset.

	      quoting
		     When  completing inside single quotes, this is set to the
		     string single; inside double quotes, the  string  double;
		     inside  backticks,	 the string backtick.  Otherwise it is
		     unset.

	      redirect
		     The redirection operator when completing in a redirection
		     position, i.e. one of <, >, etc.

	      restore
		     This  is  set to auto before a function is entered, which
		     forces the special	 parameters  mentioned	above  (words,
		     CURRENT,  PREFIX,	IPREFIX,  SUFFIX,  and	ISUFFIX) to be
		     restored to  their	 previous  values  when	 the  function
		     exits.    If a function unsets it or sets it to any other
		     string, they will not be restored.

	      to_end Specifies the occasions on which the cursor is  moved  to
		     the  end  of a string when a match is inserted.  On entry
		     to a widget function, it may be single if this will  hap‐
		     pen when a single unambiguous match was inserted or match
		     if it will happen any time a match is inserted (for exam‐
		     ple,  by menu completion; this is likely to be the effect
		     of the ALWAYS_TO_END option).

		     On exit, it may be set to single as above.	 It  may  also
		     be	 set  to  always,  or to the empty string or unset; in
		     those cases the cursor will be moved to the  end  of  the
		     string always or never respectively.  Any other string is
		     treated as match.

	      unambiguous
		     This key is read-only and will always be set to the  com‐
		     mon  (unambiguous)	 prefix the completion code has gener‐
		     ated for all matches added so far.

	      unambiguous_cursor
		     This gives the position the cursor would be placed at  if
		     the  common  prefix in the unambiguous key were inserted,
		     relative to the value of that key. The  cursor  would  be
		     placed  before the character whose index is given by this
		     key.

	      unambiguous_positions
		     This contains all positions where characters in the unam‐
		     biguous   string  are  missing  or	 where	the  character
		     inserted differs from at least one of the	matches.   The
		     positions	are  given as indexes into the string given by
		     the value of the unambiguous key.

	      vared  If completion is called while editing a  line  using  the
		     vared  builtin,  the value of this key is set to the name
		     of the parameter given as an argument to vared.  This key
		     is only set while a vared command is active.

       words  This  array  contains the words present on the command line cur‐
	      rently being edited.

BUILTIN COMMANDS
       compadd [ -akqQfenUl12C ] [ -F array ]
       [ -P prefix ] [ -S suffix ]
       [ -p hidden-prefix ] [ -s hidden-suffix ]
       [ -i ignored-prefix ] [ -I ignored-suffix ]
       [ -W file-prefix ] [ -d array ]
       [ -J name ] [ -V name ] [ -X explanation ] [ -x message ]
       [ -r remove-chars ] [ -R remove-func ]
       [ -D array ] [ -O array ] [ -A array ]
       [ -M match-spec ] [ -- ] [ words ... ]

	      This builtin command can be used to  add	matches	 directly  and
	      control all the information the completion code stores with each
	      possible match. The return value is zero if at least  one	 match
	      was added and non-zero if no matches were added.

	      The  completion  code  breaks  the string to complete into seven
	      fields in the order:

		     <ipre><apre><hpre><word><hsuf><asuf><isuf>

	      The first field is an ignored  prefix  taken  from  the  command
	      line,  the  contents  of	the  IPREFIX parameter plus the string
	      given with the -i option. With the -U option,  only  the	string
	      from the -i option is used. The field <apre> is an optional pre‐
	      fix string given with the -P option.   The  <hpre>  field	 is  a
	      string  that is considered part of the match but that should not
	      be shown when listing completions, given with the -p option; for
	      example,	functions  that do filename generation might specify a
	      common path prefix this way.  <word> is the part	of  the	 match
	      that  should  appear in the list of completions, i.e. one of the
	      words given at the end of the compadd command line. The suffixes
	      <hsuf>,  <asuf>  and  <isuf>  correspond to the prefixes <hpre>,
	      <apre> and <ipre> and are given by the options -s,  -S  and  -I,
	      respectively.

	      The supported flags are:

	      -P prefix
		     This  gives  a  string  to	 be  inserted before the given
		     words.  The string given is not considered as part of the
		     match  and	 any  shell  metacharacters  in it will not be
		     quoted when the string is inserted.

	      -S suffix
		     Like -P, but gives a string  to  be  inserted  after  the
		     match.

	      -p hidden-prefix
		     This gives a string that should be inserted into the com‐
		     mand line before the match but that should not appear  in
		     the  list of matches. Unless the -U option is given, this
		     string must be matched as part of the string on the  com‐
		     mand line.

	      -s hidden-suffix
		     Like `-p', but gives a string to insert after the match.

	      -i ignored-prefix
		     This  gives a string to insert into the command line just
		     before any string given with the  `-P'  option.   Without
		     `-P'  the string is inserted before the string given with
		     `-p' or directly before the match.

	      -I ignored-suffix
		     Like -i, but gives an ignored suffix.

	      -a     With this flag the words are taken as names of arrays and
		     the possible matches are their values.  If only some ele‐
		     ments of the arrays are needed, the words may  also  con‐
		     tain subscripts, as in `foo[2,-1]'.

	      -k     With  this	 flag the words are taken as names of associa‐
		     tive arrays and the possible matches are their keys.   As
		     for  -a,  the  words  may	also contain subscripts, as in
		     `foo[(R)*bar*]'.

	      -d array
		     This adds per-match display  strings.  The	 array	should
		     contain  one  element per word given. The completion code
		     will then display the first element instead of the	 first
		     word, and so on. The array may be given as the name of an
		     array parameter or directly as a space-separated list  of
		     words in parentheses.

		     If	 there are fewer display strings than words, the left‐
		     over words will be displayed unchanged and if  there  are
		     more  display  strings  than  words, the leftover display
		     strings will be silently ignored.

	      -l     This option only has an effect if used together with  the
		     -d option. If it is given, the display strings are listed
		     one per line, not arrayed in columns.

	      -J name
		     Gives the name of the group of matches the	 words	should
		     be stored in.

	      -V name
		     Like  -J but naming a unsorted group. These are in a dif‐
		     ferent name space than groups created with the -J flag.

	      -1     If given together with the -V option, makes only consecu‐
		     tive duplicates in the group be removed. If combined with
		     the -J option, this has  no  visible  effect.  Note  that
		     groups  with  and without this flag are in different name
		     spaces.

	      -2     If given together with the -J or  -V  option,  makes  all
		     duplicates	 be  kept. Again, groups with and without this
		     flag are in different name spaces.

	      -X explanation
		     The explanation string will be printed with the  list  of
		     matches, above the group currently selected.

	      -x message
		     Like  -X,	but  the message will be printed even if there
		     are no matches in the group.

	      -q     The suffix given with -S will be automatically removed if
		     the  next	character  typed is a blank or does not insert
		     anything, or if the suffix consists of only one character
		     and the next character typed is the same character.

	      -r remove-chars
		     This is a more versatile form of the -q option.  The suf‐
		     fix given with -S or the slash automatically added	 after
		     completing	 directories  will be automatically removed if
		     the next character typed inserts one  of  the  characters
		     given  in	the  remove-chars.  This string is parsed as a
		     characters class and understands the backslash  sequences
		     used  by  the  print  command.  For example, `-r "a-z\t"'
		     removes the suffix if the next character typed inserts  a
		     lowercase character or a TAB, and `-r "^0-9"' removes the
		     suffix if the next character typed inserts anything but a
		     digit. One extra backslash sequence is understood in this
		     string: `\-' stands for all characters that insert	 noth‐
		     ing.  Thus	 `-S  "="  -q'	is  the	 same as `-S "=" -r "=
		     \t\n\-"'.

	      -R remove-func
		     This is another form of the -r option. When a suffix  has
		     been  inserted  and the completion accepted, the function
		     remove-func will  be  called  after  the  next  character
		     typed.  It is passed the length of the suffix as an argu‐
		     ment and can use  the  special  parameters	 available  in
		     ordinary  (non-completion) zle widgets (see zshzle(1)) to
		     analyse and modify the command line.

	      -f     If this flag is given, all	 of  the  matches  built  from
		     words  are	 marked as being the names of files.  They are
		     not required to be actual filenames, but if they are, and
		     the  option  LIST_TYPES is set, the characters describing
		     the types of the files in the completion  lists  will  be
		     shown. This also forces a slash to be added when the name
		     of a directory is completed.

	      -e     This flag can be used to tell the	completion  code  that
		     the  matches  added  are  parameter names for a parameter
		     expansion.	 This  will  make  the	AUTO_PARAM_SLASH   and
		     AUTO_PARAM_KEYS options be used for the matches.

	      -W file-prefix
		     This  string is a pathname that will be prepended to each
		     of the matches formed by the given	 words	together  with
		     any  prefix specified by the -p option to form a complete
		     filename for testing.  Hence it is only  useful  if  com‐
		     bined  with  the -f flag, as the tests will not otherwise
		     be performed.

	      -F array
		     Specifies an array containing  patterns.  Words  matching
		     one of these patterns are ignored, i.e. not considered to
		     be possible matches.

		     The array may be the name of an array parameter or a list
		     of	 literal  patterns enclosed in parentheses and quoted,
		     as in `-F "(*?.o *?.h)"'. If the  name  of	 an  array  is
		     given,  the  elements  of the array are taken as the pat‐
		     terns.

	      -Q     This flag instructs the completion code not to quote  any
		     metacharacters  in the words when inserting them into the
		     command line.

	      -M match-spec
		     This gives local match specifications as described	 below
		     in	 the  section  `Matching  Control'. This option may be
		     given more than once. In this case all match-specs	 given
		     are  concatenated	with  spaces  between them to form the
		     specification string to use.  Note that they will only be
		     used if the -U option is not given.

	      -n     Specifies that the words added are to be used as possible
		     matches, but are not to appear in the completion listing.

	      -U     If this flag is given, all words given will  be  accepted
		     and no matching will be done by the completion code. Nor‐
		     mally this is used in  functions  that  do	 the  matching
		     themselves.

	      -O array
		     If	 this  option is given, the words are not added to the
		     set of possible completions.  Instead, matching  is  done
		     as	 usual	and  all  of the words given as arguments that
		     match the string on the command line will	be  stored  in
		     the array parameter whose name is given as array.

	      -A array
		     As	 the  -O  option,  except that instead of those of the
		     words which match being stored in array, the strings gen‐
		     erated  internally by the completion code are stored. For
		     example, with a matching specification of `-M  "L:|no="',
		     the string `nof' on the command line and the string `foo'
		     as one of	the  words,  this  option  stores  the	string
		     `nofoo'  in  the  array, whereas the -O option stores the
		     `foo' originally given.

	      -D array
		     As with -O, the words are not added to the set of	possi‐
		     ble  completions.	 Instead,  the	completion  code tests
		     whether each word in turn matches what is	on  the	 line.
		     If	 the n'th word does not match, the n'th element of the
		     array is removed.	Elements for which  the	 corresponding
		     word is matched are retained.

	      -C     This  option  adds	 a  special match which expands to all
		     other matches when inserted into  the  line,  even	 those
		     that  are added after this option is used.	 Together with
		     the -d option it is possible to  specify  a  string  that
		     should  be	 displayed in the list for this special match.
		     If no string is given, it will be shown as a string  con‐
		     taining  the strings that would be inserted for the other
		     matches, truncated to the width of the screen.

	      -
	      --     This flag ends the list of flags and options.  All	 argu‐
		     ments  after  it  will  be	 taken	as the words to use as
		     matches even if they begin with hyphens.

	      Except for the -M flag, if any of these flags is given more than
	      once, the first one (and its argument) will be used.

       compset -p number
       compset -P [ number ] pattern
       compset -s number
       compset -S [ number ] pattern
       compset -n begin [ end ]
       compset -N beg-pat [ end-pat ]
       compset -q
	      This  command simplifies modification of the special parameters,
	      while its return value allows tests on them to be carried out.

	      The options are:

	      -p number
		     If the contents of the PREFIX parameter  is  longer  than
		     number   characters,  the	first  number  characters  are
		     removed from it and  appended  to	the  contents  of  the
		     IPREFIX parameter.

	      -P [ number ] pattern
		     If the value of the PREFIX parameter begins with anything
		     that matches the pattern, the matched portion is  removed
		     from PREFIX and appended to IPREFIX.

		     Without  the optional number, the longest match is taken,
		     but if number is given,  anything	up  to	the  number'th
		     match is moved.  If the number is negative, the number'th
		     longest match is moved. For example, if  PREFIX  contains
		     the  string  `a=b=c', then compset -P '*\=' will move the
		     string `a=b=' into the IPREFIX parameter, but compset  -P
		     1 '*\=' will move only the string `a='.

	      -s number
		     As	 -p,  but transfer the last number characters from the
		     value of SUFFIX to the front of the value of ISUFFIX.

	      -S [ number ] pattern
		     As -P, but match the last portion of SUFFIX and  transfer
		     the matched portion to the front of the value of ISUFFIX.

	      -n begin [ end ]
		     If	 the current word position as specified by the parame‐
		     ter CURRENT is greater than or equal to  begin,  anything
		     up	 to  the begin'th word is removed from the words array
		     and the value of the parameter CURRENT is decremented  by
		     begin.

		     If	 the  optional	end is given, the modification is done
		     only if the current word position is also	less  than  or
		     equal  to	end. In this case, the words from position end
		     onwards are also removed from the words array.

		     Both begin and end may be	negative  to  count  backwards
		     from the last element of the words array.

	      -N beg-pat [ end-pat ]
		     If	 one of the elements of the words array before the one
		     at the index given by the value of the parameter  CURRENT
		     matches  the  pattern  beg-pat,  all  elements  up to and
		     including the matching one are  removed  from  the	 words
		     array and the value of CURRENT is changed to point to the
		     same word in the changed array.

		     If the optional pattern end-pat is also given, and	 there
		     is	 an  element in the words array matching this pattern,
		     the parameters are modified only if  the  index  of  this
		     word  is higher than the one given by the CURRENT parame‐
		     ter (so that the matching word has to be after  the  cur‐
		     sor).  In	this  case,  the  words	 starting with the one
		     matching end-pat are also removed from the	 words	array.
		     If	 words	contains no word matching end-pat, the testing
		     and modification is performed as if it were not given.

	      -q     The word currently being completed	 is  split  on	spaces
		     into  separate  words, respecting the usual shell quoting
		     conventions.  The resulting words are stored in the words
		     array,  and CURRENT, PREFIX, SUFFIX, QIPREFIX, and QISUF‐
		     FIX are modified to reflect the word part	that  is  com‐
		     pleted.

	      In all the above cases the return value is zero if the test suc‐
	      ceeded and the parameters were modified and non-zero  otherwise.
	      This allows one to use this builtin in tests such as:

		     if compset -P '*\='; then ...

	      This  forces anything up to and including the last equal sign to
	      be ignored by the completion code.

       compcall [ -TD ]
	      This allows the use of  completions  defined  with  the  compctl
	      builtin  from  within  completion	 widgets.  The list of matches
	      will be generated as if one of the non-widget  completion	 func‐
	      tion  (complete-word,  etc.)   had been called, except that only
	      compctls given for specific commands are used. To force the code
	      to  try completions defined with the -T option of compctl and/or
	      the default completion (whether defined by  compctl  -D  or  the
	      builtin  default)	 in  the  appropriate places, the -T and/or -D
	      flags can be passed to compcall.

	      The return value can be used to test if a matching compctl defi‐
	      nition was found. It is non-zero if a compctl was found and zero
	      otherwise.

	      Note that this builtin is defined by the zsh/compctl module.

CONDITION CODES
       The following additional condition codes for use within the [[  ...  ]]
       construct  are available in completion widgets.	These work on the spe‐
       cial parameters.	 All of these tests  can  also	be  performed  by  the
       compset builtin, but in the case of the condition codes the contents of
       the special parameters are not modified.

       -prefix [ number ] pattern
	      true if the test for the -P option of compset would succeed.

       -suffix [ number ] pattern
	      true if the test for the -S option of compset would succeed.

       -after beg-pat
	      true if the test of the -N option with only  the	beg-pat	 given
	      would succeed.

       -between beg-pat end-pat
	      true if the test for the -N option with both patterns would suc‐
	      ceed.

MATCHING CONTROL
       It is possible by use of the -M option of the compadd  builtin  command
       to  specify  how the characters in the string to be completed (referred
       to here as the command line) map onto the characters  in	 the  list  of
       matches	produced by the completion code (referred to here as the trial
       completions). Note that this is not used if the command line contains a
       glob  pattern  and the GLOB_COMPLETE option is set or the pattern_match
       of the compstate special association is set to a non-empty string.

       The match-spec given as the argument to the  -M	option	(see  `Builtin
       Commands'  above)  consists  of one or more matching descriptions sepa‐
       rated by whitespace.  Each description consists of a letter followed by
       a  colon	 and then the patterns describing which character sequences on
       the line match which character sequences in the trial completion.   Any
       sequence	 of characters not handled in this fashion must match exactly,
       as usual.

       The forms of match-spec understood are as follows. In  each  case,  the
       form  with  an  uppercase  initial character retains the string already
       typed on the command line as the final result of completion, while with
       a lowercase initial character the string on the command line is changed
       into the corresponding part of the trial completion.

       m:lpat=tpat
       M:lpat=tpat
	      Here, lpat is a pattern that matches on the command line, corre‐
	      sponding to tpat which matches in the trial completion.

       l:lanchor|lpat=tpat
       L:lanchor|lpat=tpat
       l:lanchor||ranchor=tpat
       L:lanchor||ranchor=tpat
       b:lpat=tpat
       B:lpat=tpat
	      These letters are for patterns that are anchored by another pat‐
	      tern on the left side. Matching for lpat and tpat is  as	for  m
	      and  M, but the pattern lpat matched on the command line must be
	      preceded by the pattern lanchor.	The lanchor can	 be  blank  to
	      anchor the match to the start of the command line string; other‐
	      wise the anchor can occur anywhere, but must match in  both  the
	      command line and trial completion strings.

	      If  no  lpat  is	given  but  a ranchor is, this matches the gap
	      between substrings matched by lanchor and ranchor.  Unlike  lan‐
	      chor,  the  ranchor  only	 needs	to  match the trial completion
	      string.

	      The b and B forms are similar to l and L with an	empty  anchor,
	      but  need to match only the beginning of the trial completion or
	      the word on the command line, respectively.

       r:lpat|ranchor=tpat
       R:lpat|ranchor=tpat
       r:lanchor||ranchor=tpat
       R:lanchor||ranchor=tpat
       e:lpat=tpat
       E:lpat=tpat
	      As l, L, b and B, with the difference that the command line  and
	      trial  completion patterns are anchored on the right side.  Here
	      an empty ranchor and the e and E forms force the	match  to  the
	      end of the trial completion or command line string.

       Each  lpat,  tpat  or anchor is either an empty string or consists of a
       sequence of literal characters (which may be quoted with a  backslash),
       question marks, character classes, and correspondence classes; ordinary
       shell patterns are not used.  Literal characters match only themselves,
       question marks match any character, and character classes are formed as
       for globbing and match any character in the given set.

       Correspondence classes are defined like character classes, but with two
       differences:  they  are	delimited  by  a  pair	of braces, and negated
       classes are not allowed, so the characters !  and  ^  have  no  special
       meaning	directly  after the opening brace.  They indicate that a range
       of characters on the line match a range of characters in the trial com‐
       pletion,	 but  (unlike  ordinary character classes) paired according to
       the corresponding position in the sequence. For example,	 to  make  any
       lowercase  letter  on the line match the corresponding uppercase letter
       in the trial completion, you can use `m:{a-z}={A-Z}'.   More  than  one
       pair  of	 classes can occur, in which case the first class before the =
       corresponds to the first after it, and so on.  If  one  side  has  more
       such  classes  than the other side, the superfluous classes behave like
       normal character classes.  In anchor  patterns  correspondence  classes
       also behave like normal character classes.

       The  pattern tpat may also be one or two stars, `*' or `**'. This means
       that the pattern on the command line can match any number of characters
       in  the trial completion. In this case the pattern must be anchored (on
       either side); in the case of a single star, the anchor then  determines
       how much of the trial completion is to be included --- only the charac‐
       ters up to the next appearance of the anchor will be matched. With  two
       stars, substrings matched by the anchor can be matched, too.

       Examples:

       The keys of the options association defined by the parameter module are
       the option names in all-lowercase form, without underscores, and	 with‐
       out  the	 optional  no at the beginning even though the builtins setopt
       and unsetopt understand option names  with  uppercase  letters,	under‐
       scores,	and  the optional no.  The following alters the matching rules
       so that the prefix no and any underscore are  ignored  when  trying  to
       match the trial completions generated and uppercase letters on the line
       match the corresponding lowercase letters in the words:

	      compadd -M 'L:|[nN][oO]= M:_= M:{A-Z}={a-z}' - \
		${(k)options}

       The first part says that the pattern `[nN][oO]' at the  beginning  (the
       empty  anchor before the pipe symbol) of the string on the line matches
       the empty string in the list of words generated by  completion,	so  it
       will be ignored if present. The second part does the same for an under‐
       score anywhere in the command line string, and the third part uses cor‐
       respondence  classes  so	 that any uppercase letter on the line matches
       the corresponding lowercase letter in the word. The use of  the	upper‐
       case  forms  of	the specification characters (L and M) guarantees that
       what has already been typed on the command line (in particular the pre‐
       fix no) will not be deleted.

       Note  that  the	use  of L in the first part means that it matches only
       when at the beginning of both the command line  string  and  the	 trial
       completion.  I.e.,  the	string	`_NO_f'	 would	not  be	 completed  to
       `_NO_foo', nor would `NONO_f' be completed to `NONO_foo' because of the
       leading	underscore or the second `NO' on the line which makes the pat‐
       tern fail even though they are otherwise	 ignored.  To  fix  this,  one
       would  use `B:[nN][oO]=' instead of the first part. As described above,
       this matches at the beginning of the trial completion,  independent  of
       other  characters  or  substrings  at the beginning of the command line
       word which are ignored by the same or other match-specs.

       The second example makes completion case insensitive.  This is just the
       same  as in the option example, except here we wish to retain the char‐
       acters in the list of completions:

	      compadd -M 'm:{a-z}={A-Z}' ...

       This makes lowercase letters match their	 uppercase  counterparts.   To
       make uppercase letters match the lowercase forms as well:

	      compadd -M 'm:{a-zA-Z}={A-Za-z}' ...

       A  nice	example	 for the use of * patterns is partial word completion.
       Sometimes you would like to  make  strings  like	 `c.s.u'  complete  to
       strings like `comp.source.unix', i.e. the word on the command line con‐
       sists of multiple parts, separated by a dot in this example, where each
       part  should  be	 completed separately --- note, however, that the case
       where each part of the word, i.e. `comp', `source' and `unix'  in  this
       example,	 is to be completed from separate sets of matches is a differ‐
       ent problem to be solved by the implementation of the  completion  wid‐
       get.  The example can be handled by:

	      compadd -M 'r:|.=* r:|=*' \
		- comp.sources.unix comp.sources.misc ...

       The  first  specification  says	that  lpat  is the empty string, while
       anchor is a dot; tpat is *, so this can match anything except  for  the
       `.'  from  the anchor in the trial completion word.  So in `c.s.u', the
       matcher sees `c', followed by the empty string, followed by the	anchor
       `.',  and  likewise  for the second dot, and replaces the empty strings
       before the anchors, giving `c[omp].s[ources].u[nix]',  where  the  last
       part of the completion is just as normal.

       With  the  pattern shown above, the string `c.u' could not be completed
       to `comp.sources.unix' because  the  single  star  means	 that  no  dot
       (matched	 by  the  anchor)  can	be  skipped.  By using two stars as in
       `r:|.=**', however, `c.u' could be  completed  to  `comp.sources.unix'.
       This  also shows that in some cases, especially if the anchor is a real
       pattern, like a character class, the form with two stars may result  in
       more matches than one would like.

       The second specification is needed to make this work when the cursor is
       in the middle of the string on the command line	and  the  option  COM‐
       PLETE_IN_WORD  is  set. In this case the completion code would normally
       try to match trial completions that end with the	 string	 as  typed  so
       far,  i.e.  it  will  only insert new characters at the cursor position
       rather then at the end.	However in our example we would like the  code
       to recognise matches which contain extra characters after the string on
       the line (the `nix' in the example).   Hence  we	 say  that  the	 empty
       string  at  the end of the string on the line matches any characters at
       the end of the trial completion.

       More generally, the specification

	      compadd -M 'r:|[.,_-]=* r:|=*' ...

       allows one to complete words with abbreviations before any of the char‐
       acters  in the square brackets.	For example, to complete veryverylong‐
       file.c rather than veryverylongheader.h with the above in  effect,  you
       can just type very.c before attempting completion.

       The  specifications  with  both a left and a right anchor are useful to
       complete partial words whose parts are not separated  by	 some  special
       character.  For	example,  in  some places strings have to be completed
       that are formed `LikeThis' (i.e. the separate parts are determined by a
       leading	uppercase  letter)  or	maybe one has to complete strings with
       trailing numbers. Here one could use the	 simple	 form  with  only  one
       anchor as in:

	      compadd -M 'r:|[A-Z0-9]=* r:|=*' LikeTHIS FooHoo 5foo123 5bar234

       But with this, the string `H' would neither complete to `FooHoo' nor to
       `LikeTHIS' because in each case there is an uppercase letter before the
       `H'  and	 that  is  matched by the anchor. Likewise, a `2' would not be
       completed.  In  both   cases   this   could   be	  changed   by	 using
       `r:|[A-Z0-9]=**',  but  then  `H'  completes  to	 both  `LikeTHIS'  and
       `FooHoo' and a `2' matches the other strings because characters can  be
       inserted	 before	 every	uppercase  letter and digit. To avoid this one
       would use:

	      compadd -M 'r:[^A-Z0-9]||[A-Z0-9]=** r:|=*' \
		  LikeTHIS FooHoo foo123 bar234

       By using these two anchors, a `H' matches only uppercase `H's that  are
       immediately preceded by something matching the left anchor `[^A-Z0-9]'.
       The effect is, of course, that `H' matches only the string `FooHoo',  a
       `2' matches only `bar234' and so on.

       When  using the completion system (see zshcompsys(1)), users can define
       match specifications that are to be used for specific contexts by using
       the  matcher and matcher-list styles. The values for the latter will be
       used everywhere.

COMPLETION WIDGET EXAMPLE
       The first step is to define the widget:

	      zle -C complete complete-word complete-files

       Then the widget can be bound to a key using the	bindkey	 builtin  com‐
       mand:

	      bindkey '^X\t' complete

       After that the shell function complete-files will be invoked after typ‐
       ing control-X and TAB. The function should then generate	 the  matches,
       e.g.:

	      complete-files () { compadd - * }

       This function will complete files in the current directory matching the
       current word.

ZSHCOMPSYS(1)							 ZSHCOMPSYS(1)

NAME
       zshcompsys - zsh completion system

DESCRIPTION
       This describes the shell code for the new completion system.   It  con‐
       sists  of  various  shell  functions;  those beginning `comp' are to be
       called directly by the user, while those beginning `_'  are  called  by
       the  completion	code.	The  shell  functions  of the second set which
       implement completion behaviour and which may be	bound  to  keystrokes,
       are referred to as `widgets'.

INITIALIZATION
       If the system was installed completely, it should be enough to call the
       shell function compinit from your initialization	 file;	see  the  next
       section.	  However,  the	 function  compinstall can be run by a user to
       configure various aspects of the completion system.

       Usually, compinstall will insert code into .zshrc, although if that  is
       not  writable  it will save it in another file and tell you that file's
       location.  Note that it is up to you to make sure that the lines	 added
       to  .zshrc are actually run; you may, for example, need to move them to
       an earlier place in the file if .zshrc usually returns early.  So  long
       as you keep them all together (including the comment lines at the start
       and finish), you can rerun compinstall and it will correctly locate and
       modify  these lines.  Note, however, that any code you add to this sec‐
       tion by hand is likely to be lost if you	 rerun	compinstall,  although
       lines using the command `zstyle' should be gracefully handled.

       The  new	 code  will  take effect next time you start the shell, or run
       .zshrc by hand; there is also an option to make them take effect	 imme‐
       diately.	  However,  if	compinstall  has removed definitions, you will
       need to restart the shell to see the changes.

       To run compinstall you will need to make sure it is in a directory men‐
       tioned in your fpath parameter, which should already be the case if zsh
       was properly configured as long as your startup files do not remove the
       appropriate  directories	 from  fpath.	Then  it  must	be  autoloaded
       (`autoload -U compinstall' is recommended).  You can abort the  instal‐
       lation any time you are being prompted for information, and your .zshrc
       will not be altered at all; changes only take place right at  the  end,
       where you are specifically asked for confirmation.

   Use of compinit
       This section describes the use of compinit to initialize completion for
       the current session when run directly by the  user;  if	you  have  run
       compinstall it will be called automatically from your .zshrc.

       To  initialize  the system, the function compinit should be in a direc‐
       tory mentioned  in  the	fpath  parameter,  and	should	be  autoloaded
       (`autoload  -U  compinit'  is  recommended),  and  then	run  simply as
       `compinit'.  This will define a few utility functions, arrange for  all
       the necessary shell functions to be autoloaded, and will then re-define
       all widgets that do completion to use the new system.  If you  use  the
       menu-select  widget,  which  is	part  of  the zsh/complist module, you
       should make sure that that module is loaded before the call to compinit
       so  that	 that  widget  is  also re-defined.  If completion styles (see
       below) are set up  to  perform  expansion  as  well  as	completion  by
       default,	 and the TAB key is bound to expand-or-complete, compinit will
       rebind it to complete-word; this is necessary to use the	 correct  form
       of expansion.

       Should  you need to use the original completion commands, you can still
       bind keys to the old widgets by putting a `.' in front  of  the	widget
       name, e.g. `.expand-or-complete'.

       To speed up the running of compinit, it can be made to produce a dumped
       configuration which will be read in on future invocations; this is  the
       default,	 although  it  can  be turned off by calling compinit with the
       option -D.  The dumped file is .zcompdump in the same directory as  the
       startup files (i.e. $ZDOTDIR or $HOME); alternatively, an explicit file
       name can be given by `compinit -d  dumpfile'.   On  the	next  call  to
       compinit,  it  will  read  the dumped file instead of performing a full
       initialization.

       If the number of completion files changes, compinit will recognise this
       and produce a new dump file.  However, if the name of a function or the
       arguments in the first line of a #compdef function (as described below)
       change,	it is easiest to delete the dump file by hand so that compinit
       will re-create it the next time it is run.  The check performed to  see
       if  there are new functions can be omitted by giving the option -C.  In
       this case the dump file	will  only  be	created	 if  there  isn't  one
       already.

       The  dumping  is	 actually  done by another function, compdump, but you
       will only need to run this yourself if  you  change  the	 configuration
       (e.g.  using  compdef)  and then want to dump the new one.  The name of
       the old dumped file will be remembered for this purpose.

       If the parameter _compdir is set, compinit uses it as a directory where
       completion  functions  can be found; this is only necessary if they are
       not already in the function search path.

       For security reasons compinit also  checks  if  the  completion	system
       would  use  files not owned by root or by the current user, or files in
       directories that are world- or group-writable or that are not owned  by
       root  or	 by the current user.  If such files or directories are found,
       compinit will ask if the completion system should really be  used.   To
       avoid  these tests and make all files found be used without asking, use
       the option -u, and to make compinit silently ignore all insecure	 files
       and  directories	 use  the  option  -i.	This security check is skipped
       entirely when the -C option is given.

       The security check can be retried at any time by running	 the  function
       compaudit.   This  is  the  same check used by compinit, but when it is
       executed directly any changes to fpath are made local to	 the  function
       so they do not persist.	The directories to be checked may be passed as
       arguments; if none are given, compaudit uses fpath and _compdir to find
       completion  system  directories, adding missing ones to fpath as neces‐
       sary.  To force a check of exactly the directories currently  named  in
       fpath,  set  _compdir  to  an  empty string before calling compaudit or
       compinit.

   Autoloaded files
       The convention for autoloaded functions used in completion is that they
       start with an underscore; as already mentioned, the fpath/FPATH parame‐
       ter must contain the directory in which they are stored.	  If  zsh  was
       properly	 installed on your system, then fpath/FPATH automatically con‐
       tains the required directories for the standard functions.

       For incomplete installations, if compinit does not  find	 enough	 files
       beginning with an underscore (fewer than twenty) in the search path, it
       will try to find more by adding the directory _compdir  to  the	search
       path.  If that directory has a subdirectory named Base, all subdirecto‐
       ries will be added to the path.	Furthermore, if the subdirectory  Base
       has  a subdirectory named Core, compinit will add all subdirectories of
       the subdirectories is to the path: this allows the functions to	be  in
       the same format as in the zsh source distribution.

       When  compinit  is  run,	 it  searches  all  such  files accessible via
       fpath/FPATH and reads the first line of each of them.  This line should
       contain	one  of the tags described below.  Files whose first line does
       not start with one of these tags are not considered to be part  of  the
       completion system and will not be treated specially.

       The tags are:

       #compdef names...
	      The  file	 will be made autoloadable and the function defined in
	      it will be called when completing names, each of which is either
	      the name of a command whose arguments are to be completed or one
	      of a number of special contexts in the form -context-  described
	      below for the _complete function.

	      Each  name  may also be of the form `cmd=service'.  This is used
	      by functions that offer multiple services, i.e.  different  com‐
	      pletion  behaviour  for  multiple commands.  Such a string makes
	      the completion system call the function  when  completing	 argu‐
	      ments  for  the command `cmd', setting the parameter $service to
	      the string `service'.  The function can then use that  parameter
	      to decide what to complete.

       #compdef -p pattern
	      The  file	 will be made autoloadable and the function defined in
	      it will be called when  completing  for  a  command  whose  name
	      matches  the  given pattern (a standard globbing pattern).  Note
	      that only one pattern may be given.

       #compdef -P pattern
	      Like the previous one, but the function will be called  only  if
	      no  completion  function	for  the  command on the line could be
	      found.

       #compdef -k style key-sequences...
	      This can be used to bind special	completion  functions  to  the
	      key-sequences  specified.	 It creates a widget behaving like the
	      builtin widget style, which must be one of  those	 that  perform
	      completion,     namely	complete-word,	  delete-char-or-list,
	      expand-or-complete,   expand-or-complete-prefix,	 list-choices,
	      menu-complete,   menu-expand-or-complete,	 or  reverse-menu-com‐
	      plete.  If  the  zsh/complist  module  is	 loaded	 (see  zshmod‐
	      ules(1)), the same happens to the menu-select widget.

	      The widget is then bound to all the key-sequences given, if any:
	      when one of the key-sequences is typed, the function in the file
	      will  be	invoked to generate the matches.  Note that a key will
	      not be re-bound if if it already was  (that  is,	was  bound  to
	      something other than undefined-key).  The widget created has the
	      same name as the file and can be bound to any other  keys	 using
	      bindkey as usual.

       #compdef -K widget-name style key-sequences ...
	      This  is	similar	 to  -k, with the same style and key-sequences
	      arguments, preceded by a string giving the name of a widget.  In
	      this  case only one key-sequences argument may be given, but the
	      entire set of three arguments may be repeated with  a  different
	      set  of  arguments.  In particular, the widget-name must be dis‐
	      tinct in each set.  It should begin with `_', else one  will  be
	      added,  and  should not clash with the name of any existing wid‐
	      get: names based on the name of the function  are	 most  useful.
	      For example,

		     #compdef -K _foo_complete complete-word "^X^C" \
		       _foo_list list-choices "^X^D"

	      (all on one line) defines a widget _foo_complete for completion,
	      bound to `^X^C', and a widget _foo_list for  listing,  bound  to
	      `^X^D'.

       #autoload [ options ]
	      This  is	used for files defining utility functions that are not
	      to be called directly as	completion  functions  but  should  be
	      loaded  automatically  when  invoked.   Typically they are to be
	      called from within one of the completion functions.

	      The options will be given to the autoload builtin	 command  when
	      making  the function autoloaded.	Most often, this will be +X to
	      force the function to be loaded immediately.  Note that  the  -U
	      flag is always implicitly added.

       The  #  is part of the tag name and no white space is allowed after it.
       The #compdef tags use the compdef function described  below;  the  main
       difference is that the name of the function is supplied implicitly.

       Note  also that the functions for the completion system assume that the
       KSH_AUTOLOAD option is not set and cannot be loaded when it is set.  To
       avoid having to unset KSH_AUTOLOAD, you can instead use one or more zwc
       file(s) which have been created with the command zcompile  -z  to  load
       the  functions  for  the	 completion  system; see zshbuiltins(1).  This
       forces the functions to be autoloaded the way zsh normally loads	 func‐
       tions.

   Functions
       The  compinit  file  defines  the following function, which may also be
       called directly by the user.

       compdef [ -an ] function names...
       compdef -d names...
       compdef -p [ -a ] function pattern
       compdef -P [ -a ] function pattern
       compdef -k [ -an ] function style key-sequences...
       compdef -K [ -an ] function name style key-sequences ...
	      The first form tells the completion system  to  call  the	 given
	      function	when  completing  for  the  contexts or commands whose
	      names are given:	this is like the #compdef tag unless the first
	      word  contains an equal sign.  In this case all words have to be
	      of the form `cmd=service' where service is the name of a command
	      or of a service defined by an autoloaded function with the #com‐
	      pdef tag and an argument of the form `cmd=service'.   This  kind
	      of use makes the arguments of the cmds be completed as those for
	      the services.

	      If the -n option is given, any existing completion behaviour for
	      particular contexts or commands will not be altered.  These def‐
	      initions can be deleted by giving the -d option as in the second
	      form.

	      The  form	 with -p is similar to the first, but function will be
	      called for all commands whose name matches the pattern; this  is
	      like the #compdef -p function tag.

	      The  form	 with  -P  is like the third, but the function will be
	      called only if no function for the command itself was  found  or
	      if  one  was found and it set the _compskip parameter to a value
	      not containing the substring patterns.

	      The form with -k defines a widget with  the  same	 name  as  the
	      function	which  will  be	 called for each of the key-sequences;
	      this is like the #compdef -k tag.	 The function should  generate
	      the  completions	needed	and  will  otherwise  behave  like the
	      builtin widget whose name is given as the	 style	argument.  The
	      widgets usable for this are: complete-word, delete-char-or-list,
	      expand-or-complete,   expand-or-complete-prefix,	 list-choices,
	      menu-complete,  menu-expand-or-complete,	and  reverse-menu-com‐
	      plete, as well as menu-select  if	 the  zsh/complist  module  is
	      loaded.	The  option  -n	 prevents the key being bound if it is
	      already to bound to something other than undefined-key.

	      The form with -K is similar and defines multiple	widgets	 based
	      on  the  same  function, each of which requires the set of three
	      arguments name, style and key-sequences, where  the  latter  two
	      are  as for -k and the first must be a unique widget name begin‐
	      ning with an underscore.

	      In each of the forms supporting it the -a option makes the func‐
	      tion autoloadable (exactly equivalent to autoload -U function).

       The  compdef  function is the place to turn to when one wants to define
       what the completion system should complete for a certain command.   The
       function	 named	can  of course be one of the functions supplied or one
       written by the user.  For example, if one has a command foo  that  gets
       process identifiers as arguments, one could do:

	      compdef _pids foo

       using  the _pids function from the distribution to generate the process
       identifiers.  Not also the _gnu_generic function described below, which
       can  be	used  to  complete  options  for  commands that understand the
       `--help' option.

COMPLETION SYSTEM CONFIGURATION
       This section gives a short overview of how the completion system works,
       and  then  more	detail on how users can configure how and when matches
       are generated.

   Overview
       When completion is attempted somewhere on a command line the completion
       system  first tries to find out the context where completion was tried.
       The context depends on such things as the name of the command when com‐
       pleting	an argument, and possibly also the name of an option when com‐
       pleting an argument to that option.

       The `context' of a  completion  is  a  string  consisting  of  multiple
       fields.	This  is  used to look up styles that can be used to configure
       the completion system.  Since it is not possible	 to  build  the	 whole
       context	string in advance, completion functions may modify some of the
       fields and hence the context used for lookup may vary during  the  same
       call to the completion system.

       The  context  string always consists of the following fields, separated
       by colons and with a leading colon before the first:

       ·      The literal string completion, saying that this style is used by
	      the completion system.

       ·      The  function;  in many cases this field will be blank, but when
	      the completion system is called from other functions, like  pre‐
	      dict-on  or one of the functions in the Command directory of the
	      distribution, this field contains the  name  of  that  function,
	      often in an abbreviated form.

       ·      The  completer  currently active, which is the name of the func‐
	      tion without the leading underscore.  A `completer' is in	 over‐
	      all  control of how completion is to be performed; `complete' is
	      the basic one for ordinary completion, but completers  may  per‐
	      form various related tasks such as correction, or modify the be‐
	      haviour of a later completer (see	 the  section  `Control	 Func‐
	      tions' below for more information).

       ·      The  context or command.	This is either one of the special con‐
	      text names such as -condition- as explained  for	the  _complete
	      completer	 below,	 or  the name of the command we are completing
	      arguments for.  Completion  functions  for  commands  that  have
	      sub-commands  usually  modify  this field to contain the name of
	      the command followed by a minus sign and the  sub-command	 (e.g.
	      the  completion  function for the cvs command sets this field to
	      strings such as cvs-add when completing  for  the	 add  sub-com‐
	      mand).

       ·      The argument, describing which argument we are completing.  Nor‐
	      mally this is either a string of the form argument-n, where n is
	      the  number  of  the  argument  or  it  is  a string of the form
	      option-opt-n when completing the n'th  argument  of  the	option
	      opt.

       ·      The  tag.	  Tags	are  used to discriminate between the types of
	      matches a completion function can generate in a certain context.

       As an example, the context name

	      :completion::complete:dvips:option-o-1:files

       says that normal completion was attempted on an argument of  the	 dvips
       command (more precisely: completion was attempted on the first argument
       after the -o option) and the completion function	 will  generate	 file‐
       names for this context.

       In  many	 of  the  possible contexts the completion system can generate
       matches, often multiple types of matches.  These types are  represented
       as  simple  names  called  `tags'.   The	 completion system will decide
       internally what sort of tags are allowed; a list of the standard possi‐
       bilities	 is  given below.  To determine in which order the tags are to
       be used by the completion  function,  the  `tag-order'  style  for  the
       appropriate  context  may  be set, as described in the list of standard
       styles below.  Only those types of matches whose tags were selected  by
       this  style  will  be  produced,	 and  in the order given, although the
       default is to try all relevant tags in an order determined by the  par‐
       ticular completion in use.

       The  _complete_help bindable command described in the section `Bindable
       Commands' below can be invoked to find out the context  and  tag	 names
       and styles used at a particular point in completion.  It shows the list
       of contexts and tags that would be used in if completion were tried  at
       the  current  cursor  position.	 Hence one can easily find out all the
       information needed to change the behaviour of the tag-order style for a
       particular context.

       Completion  behaviour  can  be modified by various other styles defined
       with the zstyle builtin command (see zshmodules(1)).  When  looking  up
       styles  the  completion	system	uses full context names, including the
       tag.

       Styles determine such things as how the matches are generated; some  of
       them  correspond to shell options (for example, the use of menu comple‐
       tion), but styles provide more specific control.	  They	can  have  any
       number  of  strings  as	their  value.  Looking up the value of a style
       therefore consists of two things:  the context, which may be matched as
       a  pattern,  and	 the  name  of	the  style itself, which must be given
       exactly.

       For example, many completion functions can generate matches in a simple
       and  a  verbose	form  and  use	the verbose style to decide which form
       should be used.	To make all such functions use the verbose form, put

	      zstyle ':completion:*' verbose yes

       in one of the startup files like .zshrc; this sort of style can also be
       configured with the compinstall function.  This definition simply means
       that the verbose style has yes as its value in every context inside the
       completion  system.  If the context pattern were `*', the verbose style
       would have this value anywhere the style mechanism is used, not just in
       completion.

       As  a  more  specific  example,	the  completion	 function for the kill
       builtin command uses the verbose style to decide if jobs and  processes
       are  listed  only as job numbers and process identifiers or if they are
       listed with the full job texts and the command lines of	the  processes
       (the  latter  is	 achieved  by  calling	the ps command).  To make this
       builtin list the matches only as numbers one could call:

	      zstyle ':completion:*:*:kill:*' verbose no

       Furthermore, if one wanted to see the command lines for	processes  but
       not the job texts one could use the fact that the context name contains
       the tag name when styles are looked up.	As the function for  the  kill
       builtin command uses the tags jobs and processes, we can use:

	      zstyle ':completion:*:*:kill:*:jobs' verbose no

       To  have	 more control over when certain values for styles are used one
       can use the special parameters available in completion widgets (see see
       zshcompwid(1)))	and  the  -e  option to zstyle that makes the value be
       evaluated when looked up.  For example, to  make	 the  completer	 style
       have  a	different value when completing for the cvs command, one could
       use the words special array:

	      zstyle -e ':completion:*' completer '
		  if [[ $words[1] = cvs ]]; then
		    reply=(_complete)
		  else
		    reply=(_complete _approximate)
		  fi'

       One should be careful not to use too complicated code with this option,
       at  least  for  the  styles  that are looked up quite often.  These are
       basically those that define some global completion behaviour but	 allow
       that  to be different for all matches or groups of matches (such as the
       menu and list-rows-first styles).  Alternatively one can always	use  a
       less  general pattern for the context than in the example above and use
       a second call to zstyle with a generic pattern and without using the -e
       option to define the default behaviour.

       Note  that  the	order in which styles are defined does not matter; the
       style mechanism uses the most specific possible match for a  particular
       style to determine the set of values.  More precisely, strings are pre‐
       ferred over patterns (for example, `:completion::complete:foo' is  more
       specific	 than `:completion::complete:*'), and longer patterns are pre‐
       ferred over shorter patterns.

       As with tags, completion functions can use any style  they  choose,  so
       there  can't  be	 a complete list.  However, the following two sections
       list those tags and styles that are used in many places of the  comple‐
       tion system.

   Standard Tags
       Here  are  the  tags  currently used by the completion system.  Some of
       them are only used when looking up styles and do not refer to a partic‐
       ular type of match.

       accounts
	      used to look up the users-hosts style

       all-expansions
	      used by the _expand completer when adding the single string con‐
	      taining all possible expansions

       all-files
	      for the names of all files (as distinct from a  particular  sub‐
	      set, see the globbed-files tag).

       arguments
	      when an argument of a command may be completed

       arrays for names of array parameters

       association-keys
	      for  keys	 of  associative arrays; used when completing inside a
	      subscript of a parameter of this type

       bookmarks
	      when completing bookmarks (e.g. for URLs and the	zftp  function
	      suite)

       builtins
	      for names of builtin commands

       characters
	      used  for	 commands  like	 stty when completing characters; also
	      used when completing character classes after a opening bracket

       colormapids
	      for X colormap ids

       colors for color names

       commands
	      for names of external commands and names of  sub-commands	 (used
	      by some commands like cvs)

       contexts
	      for contexts used by the zstyle builtin command

       corrections
	      used  by the _approximate and _correct completers for the possi‐
	      ble corrections

       cursors
	      for cursor names used by X programs

       default
	      used to look up default values for various styles that may  also
	      be set for tags that are used when generating matches; note that
	      this tag is used when only the function  field  of  the  context
	      name is set up

       descriptions
	      used  when looking up the value of the format style for descrip‐
	      tions

       devices
	      for names of device special files

       directories
	      for names of directories

       directory-stack
	      for entries in the directory stack

       displays
	      for X display names

       domains
	      for network domains

       expansions
	      used by  the  _expand  completer	for  individual	 possibilities
	      resulting from expansion of a word

       extensions
	      for X server extensions

       file-descriptors
	      for the numbers of open file descriptors

       files  the  generic file-matching tag used by completion functions that
	      can complete the names of some kind of file

       fonts  used for X font names

       functions
	      names of functions, normally shell  functions  although  certain
	      commands may understand other kinds of function

       globbed-files
	      for  names of files matching the glob pattern used by completion
	      functions that expect a certain type of file

       groups used when completing names of user groups

       history-words
	      for words from the history

       hosts  for hostnames

       indexes
	      used for array indexes

       jobs   used for jobs

       keymaps
	      for names of zsh keymaps

       keysyms
	      for names of X keysyms

       libraries
	      for names of system libraries

       limits for system limits

       local-directories
	      for names of directories which are subdirectories of the current
	      working directory when completing for the cd and related builtin
	      commands

       manuals
	      for names of manual pages

       maps   for map names (e.g. NIS maps)

       messages
	      used to look up the format style for messages

       modifiers
	      for names of X modifiers

       modules
	      for modules (e.g. zsh modules)

       my-accounts
	      used to look up the users-hosts style

       named-directories
	      for named directories (you wouldn't  have	 guessed  that,	 would
	      you?)

       names  for all kinds of names

       nicknames
	      for nicknames of NIS maps

       options
	      for command options

       original
	      used  by	the _approximate, _correct and _expand completers when
	      adding the original string

       other-accounts
	      used to look up the users-hosts style

       packages
	      for packages (e.g. rpm or installed Debian packages)

       parameters
	      for names of parameters

       path-directories
	      for names of directories found by	 searching  the	 cdpath	 array
	      when completing for the cd and related builtin commands

       paths  used  to	look  up  the values of the expand, ambiguous and spe‐
	      cial-dirs styles

       pods   for perl pods (documentation files)

       ports  for communication ports

       prefixes
	      for prefixes (like those of a URL)

       printers
	      for printer names

       processes
	      for process identifiers

       processes-names
	      used to look up the command style when generating the  names  of
	      processes for killall

       sequences
	      for sequences (e.g. mh sequences)

       sessions
	      for sessions in the zftp function suite

       signals
	      for signal names

       strings
	      for  strings  (e.g.  the	replacement strings for the cd builtin
	      command)

       styles for styles used by the zstyle builtin command

       tags   for tags (e.g. rpm tags)

       targets
	      for makefile targets

       types  for types of whatever (e.g. address types for the xhost command)

       urls   used to look up the urls and local styles when completing URLs

       users  for usernames

       values when completing a value out of a set of values  (or  a  list  of
	      such values)

       version
	      used by _call_program to look up the command to run to determine
	      the installed version of various other commands  (such  as  diff
	      and make).

       warnings
	      used to look up the format style for warnings

       widgets
	      for zsh widget names

       windows
	      for IDs of X windows

       zsh-options
	      for shell options

   Standard Styles
       Here  are  the names of the styles used by the completion system.  Note
       that the values of several of these styles  represent  boolean  values;
       here,  any  of the strings `true', `on', `yes', and `1' can be used for
       the truth value `true' and the strings `false', `off',  `no',  and  `0'
       are  interpreted as `false'.  The behavior for any other value is unde‐
       fined unless the description for the particular	style  mentions	 other
       possible	 values;  in particular, the default value may be either on or
       off if the style is not set.

       Some of these styles are tested for every  tag  used  to	 add  possible
       matches and for the default tag (most notably menu, list-colors and the
       styles  controlling  the	 completion  listing  like   list-packed   and
       last-prompt).  When tested for the default tag, only the function field
       of the context will be set up, so the default value  will  normally  be
       set like:

	      zstyle ':completion:*:default' menu ...

       accept-exact
	      This is tested for the default tag and the tags used when gener‐
	      ating matches.  If it is set to `true' for at  least  one	 match
	      which  is	 the  same  as the string on the line, this match will
	      immediately be accepted.

	      When completing pathnames (where it is looked up for  the	 paths
	      tag),  this  style  also	accepts	 any number of patterns as the
	      value. If this is used, pathnames matching one of these patterns
	      will  be	accepted immediately even if the command line contains
	      some more partially typed pathname components and these match no
	      file under the directory accepted.

	      Note  that  this is also used by the _expand completer to decide
	      if words beginning with a tilde or parameter expansion should be
	      expanded.	 This means that if, for example, there are parameters
	      foo and foobar, the string  `$foo'  will	only  be  expanded  if
	      accept-exact is set to `true'.

       add-space
	      This  style  is  used by the _expand completer.  If it is `true'
	      (the default), a space will be inserted after all words  result‐
	      ing  from	 the expansion (except for directory names which get a
	      slash).  The value may also be the string	 `file'	 to  make  the
	      completer add a space only to names of existing files.  Finally,
	      the `true' values and `file' may be  combined  with  `subst'  to
	      keep  the completer from adding a space when the resulting words
	      were generated by expanding a substitution of the form  `$(...)'
	      or `${...}'.

	      It  is  also  used  by the _prefix completer as a simple boolean
	      value to decide if a space should be inserted before the suffix.

       ambiguous
	      This applies when completing non-final  components  of  filename
	      paths.  If it is set, the cursor is left after the first ambigu‐
	      ous component, even if menu completion is in use.	 It is	tested
	      with the paths tag.

       assign-list
	      When completing after an equals sign, the completion system nor‐
	      mally completes only one filename.  In some cases,  particularly
	      for  certain  parameters such as PATH, a list of filenames sepa‐
	      rated by colons is required.  This style can be set to a list of
	      patterns matching the names of such parameters.

	      The  default  is	to  complete  lists  when the word on the line
	      already contains a colon.

       auto-description
	      If set, this style's value will be used as the  description  for
	      options which are not described by the completion functions, but
	      that have exactly one argument.  The sequence `%d' in the	 value
	      will  be replaced by the description for this argument.  Depend‐
	      ing on personal preferences, it may be useful to set this	 style
	      to  something  like  `specify: %d'.  Note that this may not work
	      for some commands.

       avoid-completer
	      This is used by the _all_matches	completer  to  decide  if  the
	      string  consisting  of  all  matches should be added to the list
	      currently being generated.  Its value is a list of names of com‐
	      pleters.	If any of these is the name of the completer that gen‐
	      erated the matches in this completion, the string	 will  not  be
	      added.

	      The  default value for this style is `_expand _old_list _correct
	      _approximate', i.e. it  contains	the  completers	 for  which  a
	      string with all matches will almost never be wanted.

       cache-path
	      This  style  defines  the	 path where any cache files containing
	      dumped completion data are stored.  Defaults to `$ZDOTDIR/.zcom‐
	      pcache', or `$HOME/.zcompcache' if $ZDOTDIR is not defined.  The
	      completion layer will not be used unless the use-cache style  is
	      set.

       call-command
	      Currently this is only used by the function completing make tar‐
	      gets.  If it is set to `true' and the installed version  of  the
	      make  command allows it, make is called in a way to generate all
	      possible targets.	 The default value of this  style  is  `false'
	      because  calling	make can potentially take a very long time and
	      in some cases may even cause actions from the makefile  be  exe‐
	      cuted despite the options given to make.

       command
	      In  many places, completion functions need to call external com‐
	      mands to generate the list of completions.  This	style  can  be
	      used to override the command which is called in some such cases.
	      The elements of the value are joined with spaces to form a  com‐
	      mand  line  to execute.  The value can also start with a hyphen,
	      in which case the usual command will be added to the  end;  this
	      is  most	useful	for putting `builtin' or `command' in front to
	      make sure the appropriate version of a command  is  called,  for
	      example  to avoid calling a shell function with the same name as
	      an external command.

	      As an example, the function generating process  IDs  as  matches
	      uses  this  style	 with the processes tag to generate the IDs to
	      complete and the list of processes to display  (if  the  verbose
	      style  is `true').  The list produced by the command should look
	      like the output of the ps command.  The first line is  not  dis‐
	      played,  but is searched for the string `PID' (or `pid') to find
	      the position of the process IDs in the following lines.  If  the
	      line  does  not  contain `PID', the first numbers in each of the
	      other lines are taken as the process IDs to complete.

	      Note that the completion function generally has to call the com‐
	      mand  every  time	 it is called.	Because of that care should be
	      taken to specify only commands that take a  short	 time  to  run
	      (and that will eventually stop at all).

       commands
	      This  is	used  by  the function completing sub-commands for the
	      system initialisation scripts (residing in /etc/init.d or	 some‐
	      where not too far away from that).  It's values give the default
	      commands to complete for those commands for which the completion
	      function isn't able to find them out automatically.  The default
	      for this style are the two strings `start' and `stop'.

       complete
	      This is used by the _expand_alias function  when	invoked	 as  a
	      bindable	command.  If it set to `true' and the word on the com‐
	      mand line is not the name of an alias, matching alias names will
	      be completed.

       completer
	      The  strings  given as the value of this style provide the names
	      of the completer functions to use. The available completer func‐
	      tions are described in the section `Control Functions' below.

	      Each  string may be the name of a completer function or a string
	      of the form `function:name'. In the  first  case	the  completer
	      field  of	 the  context  will  contain the name of the completer
	      without the leading underscore and with  all  other  underscores
	      replaced	by  hyphens.   In  the second case the function is the
	      name of the completer to call, but the context will contain  the
	      name  in the completer field of the context.  If the name starts
	      with a hyphen, the string for the context will be build from the
	      name  of	the  completer	function as in the first case with the
	      name appended to it.  For example:

		     zstyle ':completion:*' completer _complete _complete:-foo

	      Here, completion will call the _complete completer  twice,  once
	      using  `complete' and once using `complete-foo' in the completer
	      field of the context.  Normally, using the same  completer  more
	      than  once  makes only sense when used with the `functions:name'
	      form, because otherwise the context name will be the same in all
	      calls to the completer; possible exceptions to this rule are the
	      _ignored and _prefix completers.

	      The default value for this style	is  _complete  _ignored,  i.e.
	      normally	 only	completion  will  be  done,  first  using  the
	      ignored-patterns style and the $fignore array and	 then  without
	      ignoring matches.

       condition
	      This  style is used by the _list completer function to decide if
	      insertion of matches  should  be	delayed	 unconditionally.  The
	      default is `true'.

       disabled
	      If  this is set to `true', the _expand_alias completer and bind‐
	      able command will try to	expand	disabled  aliases,  too.   The
	      default is `false'.

       disable-stat
	      This  is	used  with an empty tag by the function completing for
	      the cvs command to decide if the zsh/stat module should be  used
	      to  generate  names  of modified files in the appropriate places
	      (this is its only use).  If set, completion will use the ls com‐
	      mand.

       domains
	      If  set,	gives the names of network domains that should be com‐
	      pleted.  If this is not set by the user  domain  names  will  be
	      taken from the file /etc/resolv.conf.

       expand This  style is used when completing strings consisting of multi‐
	      ple parts, such as path names.  If one  of  its  values  is  the
	      string  `prefix', the partially typed word from the line will be
	      expanded as far as possible even if  trailing  parts  cannot  be
	      completed.   If one of its values is the string `suffix', match‐
	      ing names for components after the first ambiguous one will also
	      be  added.   This means that the resulting string is the longest
	      unambiguous string possible, but if menu completion  is  started
	      on  the list of matches generated this way, this will also cycle
	      through the names of the files in pathname components after  the
	      first ambiguous one.

       fake-files
	      This style is used when completing files and looked up without a
	      tag.  Its values are of the form `dir:names...'.	This will  add
	      the names (strings separated by spaces) as possible matches when
	      completing in the directory dir, even if no  such	 files	really
	      exist.

	      This  can	 be useful on systems that support special filesystems
	      whose top-level pathnames can not be listed  or  generated  with
	      glob  patterns.	It  can also be used for directories for which
	      one does not have read permission.

       fake-parameters
	      This is used by the  completion  function	 generating  parameter
	      names  as	 matches.   Its	 values	 are names of parameters which
	      might not yet be set, but which should be completed nonetheless.
	      Each  name may also be followed by a colon and a string specify‐
	      ing the type of the parameter (like `scalar', `array' or	`inte‐
	      ger').  If such a type is given, the name will only be completed
	      if parameters of that type are requested in the particular  con‐
	      text.   Names for which no type is specified will always be com‐
	      pleted.

       file-patterns
	      In most places  where  filenames	are  completed,	 the  function
	      _files  is used which can be configured with this style.	If the
	      style is unset, _files offers, one after another,	 up  to	 three
	      tags:  `globbed-files', `directories' and `all-files', depending
	      on the types of files expected by the caller of _files.

	      If the file-patterns style is set,  the  default	tags  are  not
	      used.  Instead, the value of the style says which tags and which
	      patterns are to be offered.  The strings in  the	value  contain
	      specifications  of  the form `pattern:tag'; each string may con‐
	      tain any number of such specifications.	The  pattern  gives  a
	      glob  pattern  that  is to be used to generate filenames.	 If it
	      contains the sequence `%p', that is replaced by  the  pattern(s)
	      given  by	 the  calling function.	 Colons in the pattern must be
	      preceded by a backslash to make them  distinguishable  from  the
	      colon  before  the tag.  If more than one pattern is needed, the
	      patterns can be given inside braces, separated by	 commas.   The
	      tags  of	all  strings  in  the  value will be offered by _files
	      (again, one after	 another)  and	used  when  looking  up	 other
	      styles.  For strings containing more than one specification, the
	      filenames for all specifications will be generated at  the  same
	      try.   If	 no `:tag' is given the `files' tag will be used.  The
	      tag may also be followed by  an  optional	 second	 colon	and  a
	      description.   If	 that  is given, this description will be used
	      for the `%d' in the value of the format style (if that  is  set)
	      instead  of  the	default description supplied by the completion
	      function.	 If the description given here contains itself a `%d',
	      that is replaced with the description supplied by the completion
	      function.

	      For example, to make the rm command first complete only names of
	      object  files  and  the  names  of  all  files if no object file
	      matches the string on the line, one would do:

		     zstyle ':completion:*:*:rm:*' file-patterns \
			 '*.o:object-files' '%p:all-files'

	      Another interesting example is to change the  default  behaviour
	      that  makes  completion  first offer files matching the patterns
	      given by the calling function, then  directories	and  then  all
	      files.   Many  people  prefer to get both the files matching the
	      given patterns and the directories in  the  first	 try  and  all
	      files at the second try.	To achieve this, one could do:

		     zstyle ':completion:*' file-patterns \
			 '%p:globbed-files *(-/):directories' '*:all-files'

	      This  works  even	 for contexts in which all files would be com‐
	      pleted, because _files will not try a pattern more than once and
	      it stops when the pattern `*' was tried.

	      Note also that during the execution of completion functions, the
	      EXTENDED_GLOB option is in effect, so the	 characters  `#',  `~'
	      and `^' have special meanings in the patterns.

       file-sort
	      The  completion  function	 that  generates filenames as possible
	      matches uses this style without a	 tag  to  determine  in	 which
	      order  the  names should be listed and completed when using menu
	      completion.  The value may be one of `size' to sort them by  the
	      size of the file, `links' to sort them by the number of links to
	      the file, `modification' (or `time' or `date') to sort  them  by
	      the  last	 modification  time, `access' to sort them by the last
	      access time, or `inode' (or `change') to sort them by  the  last
	      inode  change  time.  If the style is set to any other value, or
	      is unset, files will be sorted alphabetically by name.   If  the
	      value contains the string `reverse', sorting is done in decreas‐
	      ing order.

       force-list
	      This forces a list of completions to be shown at any point where
	      listing  is  done, even in cases where the list would usually be
	      suppressed.  For example, normally the list  is  only  shown  if
	      there are at least two different matches.	 By setting this style
	      to `always', the list will always be shown,  even	 if  there  is
	      only  a  single  match which is immediately accepted.  The style
	      may also be set to a number.  In this  case  the	list  will  be
	      shown  if	 there	are  at	 least that many matches, even if they
	      would all insert the same string.

	      This style is tested for the default tag and all tags used  when
	      generating  matches. This allows one to turn unconditional list‐
	      ing on for certain types of matches.

       format If this is set for the descriptions tag, its value is used as  a
	      string  to  display  above  matches  in  completion  lists.  The
	      sequence `%d' in this string  will  be  replaced	with  a	 short
	      description  of  what  these  matches are.  This string may also
	      contain the sequences to	specify	 output	 attributes,  such  as
	      `%B', `%S' and `%{...%}'.

	      For  the	same  purpose, this style is also tested with the tags
	      used when matches are generated before  it  is  tested  for  the
	      descriptions  tag.   This	 provides  the possibility of defining
	      different format strings for different types of matches.

	      Note  also  that	some  completer	 functions  define  additional
	      `%'-sequences.   These are described for the completer functions
	      that make use of them.

	      For the messages tag, this style defines a string used  by  some
	      completion  functions  to	 display  messages.  Here, the `%d' is
	      replaced with a message given by the completion function.

	      Finally, when set with the warnings tag, the  format  string  is
	      printed when no matches could be generated at all.  In this case
	      the `%d' is replaced with the descriptions for the matches  that
	      were  expected  separated	 by  spaces  and  the sequence `%D' is
	      replaced with those descriptions separated by newlines.

	      The `%' for the sequences that are replaced by strings  provided
	      by  the  completion  functions  like the `%d' may be followed by
	      field width specifications as  described for the zformat builtin
	      command from the zsh/zutil module, see zshmodules(1).

       glob   This  is	used by the _expand completer.	If it is set to `true'
	      (the default), globbing will be attempted on the words resulting
	      from  substitution  (see	the  substitute style) or the original
	      string from the line.

       global If this is set to `true' (the default), the  _expand_alias  com‐
	      pleter and bindable command will try to expand global aliases.

       group-name
	      The completion system can put different types of matches in dif‐
	      ferent groups which are then displayed separately in the list of
	      possible	completions.  This style can be used to give the names
	      for these groups for particular tags.  For example,  in  command
	      position	the  completion	 system generates names of builtin and
	      external commands, names of aliases, shell functions and parame‐
	      ters  and	 reserved  words as possible completions.  To have the
	      external commands and shell functions listed separately, one can
	      set:

		     zstyle ':completion:*:*:-command-:*:commands' group-name commands
		     zstyle ':completion:*:*:-command-:*:functions' group-name functions

	      This  also  means	 that  if  the same name is used for different
	      types of matches, then those matches will be displayed  together
	      in the same group.

	      If  the name given is the empty string, then the name of the tag
	      for the matches will be used as the name of the  group.  So,  to
	      have  all	 different  types of matches displayed separately, one
	      can just set:

		     zstyle ':completion:*' group-name ''

	      All matches for which no group name is defined will be put in  a
	      group named -default-.

       group-order
	      This  style  is  to  be used together with the group-name style.
	      Once different types of matches are put into  different  groups,
	      this  style  can	be  used to define in which order these groups
	      should appear when listing (compare tag-order, which  determines
	      which  completions appear at all).  The strings in the value are
	      taken as group names and the named groups will be shown  in  the
	      order  in	 which	their  names  appear in the value.  All groups
	      whose names are not given in the value of this style will appear
	      in the order defined by the function generating the matches.

	      For  example, to have names of builtin commands, shell functions
	      and external commands appear in this order  when	completing  in
	      command position one would set:

		     zstyle ':completion:*:*:-command-:*' group-order \
			    builtins functions commands

       groups A	 style	holding	 the  names  of the groups that should be com‐
	      pleted. If this is not set by the user, the group names from the
	      YP database or the file `/etc/group' will be used.

       hidden If  this is set to one of the `true' values, the matches for the
	      tags for which this is set will not appear in the list; only the
	      description for the matches as set with the format style will be
	      shown.  If this is set to `all', not even the  description  will
	      be displayed.

	      Note that the matches will still be completed; they are just not
	      shown in the list.  To avoid having matches considered as possi‐
	      ble  completions	at all, the tag-order style can be modified as
	      described below.

       hosts  A style holding the names of hosts that should be completed.  If
	      this  is	not set by the user the hostnames in `/etc/hosts' will
	      be used.

       hosts-ports
	      This style is used by commands that need or accept hostnames and
	      ports.   The  strings  in	 the  value  should  be	 of  the  form
	      `host:port'.  These hostnames and ports are completed  depending
	      on the information already on the line, so that if, for example,
	      the hostname is already typed, only those	 ports	specified  for
	      that  host  will be completed.  Multiple ports for the same host
	      may appear.

       ignore-line
	      This style is tested for the tags used when generating  matches.
	      If  it is set to `true', then none of the words that are already
	      on the line will be considered possible completions.  If	it  is
	      set  to `current', the word the cursor is on will not be consid‐
	      ered a possible completion.  The same happens if	the  value  is
	      `current-shown',	but  only  if  the list of completions is cur‐
	      rently shown on the screen.  Finally, if it is  set  to  `other'
	      all  words except the current one will not be considered to be a
	      possible completion.

	      The values `current' and `current-shown'	are  a	bit  like  the
	      opposite of accept-exact. They mean that only strings with miss‐
	      ing characters will be completed.

	      Note that you almost certainly don't want to set this to	`true'
	      or  `other' for a general context such as `:completion:*'.  This
	      is because it would disallow completion of, for example, options
	      multiple	times  even  if	 the  command  in question accepts the
	      option more than once.

       ignore-parents
	      The style is tested by the function completing pathnames without
	      a	 tag  to  determine whether to ignore the names of directories
	      already mentioned in the current word, or the name of  the  cur‐
	      rent  working  directory.	 The value must include one or both of
	      the following strings:

	      parent The name of any directory whose path is already contained
		     in	 the  word  on the line is ignored.  For example, when
		     completing after foo/../, the directory foo will  not  be
		     considered a valid completion.

	      pwd    The  name	of  the	 current working directory will not be
		     completed, so that, for  example,	completion  after  ../
		     will not use the name of the current directory.

	      In addition, the value may include one or both of:

	      ..     Ignore  the  specified  directories only when the word on
		     the line contains the substring `../'.

	      directory
		     Ignore only when names of directories are completed,  not
		     when completing names of files.

	      Note  that  names	 of  directories ignored because of one of the
	      tests will be ignored in the same way  as	 the  matches  ignored
	      because  of  the	ignored-patterns  style.   I.e.,  by using the
	      _ignored completer it is possible to complete these  directories
	      nonetheless.

       ignored-patterns
	      This  style  can be used to specify a list of patterns which are
	      tested against against the trial completions in a given context;
	      any matching completions will be removed from the list of possi‐
	      bilities.	 The _ignored completer can appear in the list of com‐
	      pleters  to  produce  a  list  which includes these matches once
	      more.  This is a more configurable version of the shell  parame‐
	      ter $fignore.

	      Note  that  during  the  execution  of completion functions, the
	      EXTENDED_GLOB option is in effect, so the	 characters  `#',  `~'
	      and `^' have special meanings in the patterns.

       insert-ids
	      When  completing	process	 IDs,  for example as arguments to the
	      kill and wait builtins, completion allows the user to  type  the
	      name  of	a  command, which will be converted to the appropriate
	      process ID.  A problem arises when the process name typed is not
	      unique.	By  default  (or  if  this  style is set explicitly to
	      `menu') the name will be converted immediately to a set of  pos‐
	      sible  IDs, and menu completion will be started to cycle through
	      them.  If the value of the style is `single', however, the shell
	      will  wait  until	 the user has typed enough to make the command
	      unique before converting the name to an ID; the user  must  type
	      any  additional  characters required.  If the value is any other
	      string, menu completion will be started when the string typed by
	      the  user	 is longer than the common prefix of the corresponding
	      IDs.

       insert-tab
	      If this has one of the `true' values, the completion system will
	      insert  a	 TAB  character (assuming it was used to start comple‐
	      tion)  instead  of  performing  completion  when	there  is   no
	      non-blank	 character  to	the  left  of  the  cursor.  If set to
	      `false', completion will be done even there.

	      The value may also contain the substrings	 `pending'  or	`pend‐
	      ing=val'	to  make  the  character  typed to start completion be
	      inserted instead of completion being tried when there  is	 input
	      pending  which has not yet been processed by the shell. If a val
	      is given, completion will not be done if there are at least that
	      many  characters	of  unprocessed input. This is often useful to
	      have set when pasting characters into a terminal. Note  however,
	      that  it	relies	on  the	 $PENDING  special  parameter from the
	      zsh/zle module being set properly which is not guaranteed on all
	      platforms.

	      The default value of this style is `true' unless when completing
	      inside the vared builtin command, where it defaults to `false'.

       insert-unambiguous
	      This is used by the _match and _approximate completer functions,
	      where  the  possible completions may not have a common prefix so
	      that menu completion is often the most useful  may  of  choosing
	      completions.   If the style is set to `true', the completer will
	      start menu completion only if no	unambiguous  string  could  be
	      generated	 that is at least as long as the original string typed
	      by the user.  Note that the _approximate completer uses it after
	      setting  the  completer field in the context name to one of cor‐
	      rect-num or approximate-num, where num is the number  of	errors
	      that were accepted.

	      When used for the _match completer, the style may also be set to
	      the string `pattern'.  This makes the pattern  on	 the  line  be
	      left unchanged if it didn't match unambiguously.

       keep-prefix
	      This  style  is used by the _expand completer.  If it is `true',
	      the completer will try to keep a prefix containing  a  tilde  or
	      parameter	 expansion.  I.e., the string `~/f*' would be expanded
	      to `~/foo' instead of `/home/user/foo'.  If the style is set  to
	      `changed'	 (the default), the prefix will only be left unchanged
	      if there were other changes between the expanded words  and  the
	      original	word from the command line.  Any other value makes the
	      prefix be expanded unconditionally.

	      Note that with one of the `true' values, the  _expand  completer
	      returns  if  there  is  only  one	 expansion  and that is, after
	      restoring the original prefix, the same as  the  original	 word.
	      This  means  that	 other	completers  will be called immediately
	      after _expand.

       last-prompt
	      This is used to determine if the completion code should  try  to
	      put the cursor back onto the previous command line after showing
	      a completion listing (as for the ALWAYS_LAST_PROMPT option).  As
	      with  several  other styles, it is tested for the default tag as
	      well as all the possible tags when generating matches.  The cur‐
	      sor  will	 be  moved  back to the previous line if this style is
	      `true' for all types of matches added.  Note also that  this  is
	      independent    of	   the	  numeric    argument,	  unlike   the
	      ALWAYS_LAST_PROMPT option.

       list   This style is used by the _history_complete_word	bindable  com‐
	      mand.  If it is set to `true' it has no effect, but if it is set
	      to `false' the matches will not be listed, overriding  the  set‐
	      ting  of	the options that control listing behaviour, especially
	      AUTO_LIST. Use the context prefix `:completion:history-words'.

       list-colors
	      If the zsh/complist module is used, this style can  be  used  to
	      set  color specifications as with the ZLS_COLORS and ZLS_COLOURS
	      parameters, which will not be honored under this completion sys‐
	      tem  (see	 the  section  `The  zsh/complist  Module'  in zshmod‐
	      ules(1)).

	      If this style is set for the default tag,	 the  strings  in  the
	      value  are  taken	 as  specifications that are to be used every‐
	      where.  If it is set for other tags, the specifications are used
	      only  for matches of the type described by the tag.  For this to
	      work best, the group-name style must be set to an empty  string.
	      If  the  group-name tag specifies other names for the groups the
	      matches in these groups can be  colored  by  using  these	 names
	      together	 with  the  `(group)...'   syntax  described  for  the
	      ZLS_COLORS and ZLS_COLOURS parameters and adding the  specifica‐
	      tions to the value for this style with the default tag (although
	      in most cases it should work  by	setting	 this  style  for  the
	      appropriate tags).

	      It is possible to use the same specifications set up for the GNU
	      version of the ls command:

		     zstyle ':completion:*:default' list-colors ${(s.:.)LS_COLORS}

	      The default colors are the same as for the GNU  ls  command  and
	      can  be  obtained	 by setting the style to an empty string (i.e.
	      '').

       list-packed
	      Like the list-colors style, this is tested with the default  tag
	      and  all	tags  used  when  generating matches.  If it is set to
	      `true' for a tag, the matches added for it will be listed as  if
	      the  LIST_PACKED option were set.	 If it is set to `false', they
	      are listed normally.

       list-prompt
	      If this style is set for the default tag, completion lists  that
	      don't  fit on the screen can be scrolled (see the description of
	      the zsh/complist module in zshmodules(1)).  The  value,  if  not
	      the  empty  string,  will be displayed after every screenful and
	      the shell will prompt for a key press; if the style  is  set  to
	      the  empty string, a default prompt will be used.	 The value may
	      contain the  escape  sequences  `%l'  or	`%L',  which  will  be
	      replaced	by the number of the last line displayed and the total
	      number of lines; `%m' or `%M', which will	 be  replaced  by  the
	      number of the  last match shown and the total number of matches;
	      and `%p' and `%P', which will be replaced by `Top' when  at  the
	      beginning of the list, `Bottom' when at the end and the position
	      shown in percent of the total  length  otherwise.	  In  each  of
	      these  cases the form with the uppercase letter is replaced by a
	      string of fixed width, padded to the  right with spaces.	As  in
	      other  prompt  strings,  the  escape sequences `%S', `%s', `%B',
	      `%b', `%U', `%u', and `%{...%}' for  entering  and  leaving  the
	      display modes standout, bold and underline are also available.

       list-rows-first
	      This  style  is  tested in the same way as the list-packed style
	      and determines if matches are to be listed in a rows-first fash‐
	      ion, as for the LIST_ROWS_FIRST option.

       list-suffixes
	      This  style  is used by the function used to complete filenames.
	      If completion is attempted on a string containing multiple  par‐
	      tially  typed  pathname  components  and	this  style  is set to
	      `true', all components starting with the	first  one  for	 which
	      more than one match could be generated will be shown.

       local  This  style  is used by completion functions which generate URLs
	      as possible matches to add suitable matches when a URL points to
	      a	 local	web  server,  that  is,	 one whose files are available
	      directly on the local file system.  Its value should consist  of
	      three strings: a hostname, the path to the default web pages for
	      the server and the directory name used by	 a  user  placing  web
	      pages  within  their  home  area.	 For example, completion after
	      `http://toast/~yousir/' will attempt to match the	 name  `toast'
	      against  the first argument to the style, and if successful will
	      look in the directory under ~yousir given by the third  argument
	      to the style for possible completions.

       match-original
	      This  is	used  by  the _match completer.	 If it is set to only,
	      _match will try to generate matches without inserting a  `*'  at
	      the  cursor  position.   If set to any other non-empty value, it
	      will first try to generate matches without inserting the `*' and
	      if  that	yields	no  matches,  it  will	try again with the `*'
	      inserted.	 If it is unset or set to the empty  string,  matching
	      will only be done with the `*' inserted.

       matcher
	      This style is tested for tags used when generating matches.  Its
	      value is used as an match specification additional to any	 given
	      by  the matcher-list style which should be in the form described
	      in the section `Matching Control' in zshcompwid(1).

       matcher-list
	      This style is used by the main completion function  to  retrieve
	      match  specifications that are to be used everywhere.  Its value
	      should be a list of such specifications.	The completion	system
	      will try them one after another for each completer selected. For
	      example, to first try simple completion and, if  that  generates
	      no matches, case-insensitive completion one would do:

		     zstyle ':completion:*' matcher-list '' 'm:{a-zA-Z}={A-Za-z}'

	      By default every specification replaces previous ones. If speci‐
	      fication is prefixed with +, it is added to the  existing	 list.
	      This  allows testing more general patterns without repeating the
	      whole list every time, as in:

		     zstyle ':completion:*' matcher-list '' '+m{a-Z}={A-Z}' '+m{A-Z}={a-z}'

	      The style allows even finer control by specifying	 a  particular
	      completer, without the leading underscore, in the third field of
	      the completion context.  For example, if one uses the completers
	      _complete	 and _prefix but wants to try case-insensitive comple‐
	      tion only when using the _complete completer, one would do:

		     zstyle ':completion:*' completer _complete _prefix
		     zstyle ':completion:*:complete:*' matcher-list \
			    '' 'm:{a-zA-Z}={A-Za-z}'

	      Note that the completer style allows user-defined	 names	to  be
	      used  in the context instead of the name of the completer.  This
	      is useful if, for example, one wants to  try  normal  completion
	      without a match specification and with case-insensitive matching
	      first, correction if that doesn't generate any matches and  par‐
	      tial-word	 completion  if that doesn't yield any matches either.
	      In this case one can give the _complete completer more than once
	      in the completer style and define different match specifications
	      for each occurrence, as in:

		     zstyle ':completion:*' completer _complete _correct _complete:foo
		     zstyle ':completion:*:complete:*' matcher-list \
			 '' 'm:{a-zA-Z}={A-Za-z}'
		     zstyle ':completion:*:foo:*' matcher-list \
			 'm:{a-zA-Z}={A-Za-z} r:|[-_./]=* r:|=*'

	      If the style is unset in any context no match  specification  is
	      applied; further, some completers such as _correct and _approxi‐
	      mate do not use the match specifications at all.	However, it is
	      always  safe  to	use  the simple form for this style (as in the
	      first example above), since any  completers  which  do  not  use
	      match  specifications will only ever be called once, rather than
	      once per specification.

	      Since the specification-strings in this style have to  be	 tried
	      one  after  another, it is a good idea to keep their number low.
	      In most cases one to three strings (each of which	 may,  without
	      to  large	 a  performance	 hit,  consist of more than one single
	      match specification) will give acceptable performance.

       max-errors
	      This is used by the _approximate and  _correct  completer	 func‐
	      tions  to	 determine the maximum number of errors to allow.  The
	      completer will try to generate completions by first allowing one
	      error,  then  two	 errors,  and  so  on, until either a match or
	      matches were found or the maximum number of errors given by this
	      style has been reached.

	      If  the  value for this style contains the string `numeric', the
	      completer function will take any numeric argument as the maximum
	      number of errors allowed. For example, with

		     zstyle ':completion:*:approximate:::' max-errors 2 numeric

	      two errors are allowed if no numeric argument is given, but with
	      a numeric argument of six (as in `ESC-6 TAB'), up to six	errors
	      are  accepted.  Hence with a value of `0 numeric', no correcting
	      completion will be attempted unless a numeric argument is given.

	      If the value contains the string	`not-numeric',	the  completer
	      will  not	 try  to  generate  corrected completions when given a
	      numeric argument, so in this case the  number  given  should  be
	      greater  than zero.  For example, `2 not-numeric' specifies that
	      correcting completion with two errors will usually be performed,
	      but  if  a numeric argument is given, correcting completion will
	      not be performed.

	      The default value for this style is `2 numeric'.

       menu   If this is set to true in a given context, using any of the tags
	      defined  for  a  given completion, menu completion will be used.
	      The tag `default' can be used to set the default	value,	but  a
	      specific	tag will take precedence.  If none of the values found
	      in this way is true but at least one is set to `auto' the behav‐
	      iour  will  be  as for the AUTO_MENU option.  Finally, if one of
	      the values is explicitly set to false, menu completion  will  be
	      turned  off  even	 if it would otherwise be active (for example,
	      with the MENU_COMPLETE option).

	      Using the form `yes=num', where `yes' may be  any	 of  the  true
	      values (`yes', `true', `on' and `1') turns on menu completion if
	      there at least num matches.  Using this for one of  the  `false'
	      values  (as  in  `no=10')	 makes	menu completion not be used if
	      there are num or more matches.  Of course, this is  only	useful
	      when  menu  completion  is  normally  used,  e.g. by setting the
	      MENU_COMPLETE option.  The `true' values may also be used in the
	      form  `yes=long' to turn on menu completion if the list does not
	      fit onto the screen.  This will start menu  completion  only  if
	      normal  completion was attempted, not when only the list of pos‐
	      sible completions was requested.	To start menu completion  even
	      then, the value `yes=long-list' can be used.

	      In  addition  to	(or  instead  of) the above possibilities, the
	      value may contain the string `select', optionally followed by an
	      equals  sign  and	 a  number.   In  this case menu selection (as
	      defined by the zsh/complist module) will	be  started.   Without
	      the optional number, it will be started unconditionally and with
	      a number it will be started only if at least that	 many  matches
	      are  generated;  if  the	values for more than one tag provide a
	      number, the smallest number is taken.   Menu  selection  can  be
	      turned  off explicitly by defining a value containing the string
	      `no-select'.

	      It is also possible to start menu selection only if the list  of
	      matches	does  not  fit	on  the	 screen	 by  using  the	 value
	      `select=long'.  This will only start menu selection if the  wid‐
	      get  invoked  does  completion,  not  simply  listing as done by
	      delete-char-or-list; to start menu selection even here, use  the
	      value `select=long-list'.

	      To turn on menu completion or menu selection when a certain num‐
	      ber of matches is generated or the list of matches does not  fit
	      onto  the	 screen,  both	of  `yes='  and `select=' can be given
	      twice, once with a number and once with `long' or `long-list'.

       numbers
	      This is used with the jobs tag.  If it is `true', the shell will
	      complete	the  job  numbers  instead of the shortest unambiguous
	      strings of the jobs' command lines.  If the value is  a  number,
	      job  numbers  will  only be used if that many words from the job
	      descriptions are required to resolve ambiguities.	 For  example,
	      if  the value is `1', strings will only be used if all jobs dif‐
	      fer in the first word on their command lines.

       old-list
	      This is used by  the  _oldlist  completer.   If  it  is  set  to
	      `always',	 then  standard	 widgets  which	 perform  listing will
	      retain the current list of matches, however they were generated;
	      this can be turned off explicitly with the value `never', giving
	      the behaviour without the _oldlist completer.  If the  style  is
	      unset, or any other value, then the existing list of completions
	      is displayed if it is not already; otherwise, the standard  com‐
	      pletion  list  is	 generated;  this  is the default behaviour of
	      _oldlist.	 However, if there is an old list and this style  con‐
	      tains  the  name	of  the	 completer function that generated the
	      list, then the old list will be used even if it was generated by
	      a widget which does not do listing.

	      For  example, suppose you type ^Xc to use the _correct_word wid‐
	      get, which generates a list of corrections for  the  word	 under
	      the  cursor.   Usually, typing ^D would generate a standard list
	      of completions for the word on the command line, and show	 that.
	      With  _oldlist,  it  will	 instead  show the list of corrections
	      already generated.

	      As another example  consider  the	 _match	 completer:  with  the
	      insert-unambiguous  style set to `true' it inserts only a common
	      prefix string, if there is any.  However, this may remove	 parts
	      of  the  original pattern, so that further completion could pro‐
	      duce more matches than on	 the  first  attempt.	By  using  the
	      _oldlist completer and setting this style to _match, the list of
	      matches generated on the first attempt will be used again.

       old-matches
	      This is used by the _all_matches completer to decide if  an  old
	      list  of matches should be used if one exists.  It may be set to
	      one of the `true' values or to the string `only' to use  such  a
	      list.  If it is set to `only', _all_matches will only use an old
	      list and won't have any effect on the list of matches  currently
	      being generated.

       old-menu
	      This  is	used  by the _oldlist completer.  It controls how menu
	      completion behaves when a completion has already	been  inserted
	      and  the	user types a standard completion key type such as TAB.
	      The default behaviour of _oldlist is that menu completion always
	      continues	 with the existing list of completions.	 If this style
	      is set to `false', however, a new completion is started  if  the
	      old  list	 was generated by a different completion command; this
	      is the behaviour without the  _oldlist completer.

	      For example, suppose you type ^Xc to generate a list of  correc‐
	      tions,  and menu completion is started in one of the usual ways.
	      Usually, or with this style set to false,	 typing	 TAB  at  this
	      point would start trying to complete the line as it now appears.
	      With _oldlist, it instead continues to cycle through the list of
	      corrections.

       original
	      This  is	used  by  the  _approximate and _correct completers to
	      decide if the original string should be added  as	 one  possible
	      completion.   Normally,  this is done only if there are at least
	      two possible corrections, but if this style is set to `true', it
	      is  always  added.   Note	 that  these completers use this style
	      after setting the completer field in the context	name  to  cor‐
	      rect-num	or  approximate-num, where num is the number of errors
	      that were accepted.

       packageset
	      This style is used  when	completing  arguments  of  the	Debian
	      `dpkg' program.  It contains an override for the default package
	      set for a given context.	For example,

		     zstyle ':completion:*:complete:dpkg:option--status-1:*' \
				    packageset avail

	      causes available packages, rather than only installed  packages,
	      to be completed for `dpkg --status'.

       path   The function that completes color names uses this style with the
	      colors tag.  The value should be the pathname of a file contain‐
	      ing  color  names	 in the format of an X11 rgb.txt file.	If the
	      style is not set but this file is found in one of various	 stan‐
	      dard locations it will be used as the default.

       ports  A style holding the service names of ports to complete.  If this
	      is not set by the user, the service names	 from  `/etc/services'
	      will be used.

       prefix-hidden
	      This  is	used when matches with a common prefix are added (e.g.
	      option names).  If it is `true', this prefix will not  be	 shown
	      in the list of matches.

	      The default value for this style is `false'.

       prefix-needed
	      This,  too,  is used for matches with a common prefix.  If it is
	      set to `true' this common prefix has to be typed by the user  to
	      generate the matches.  E.g. for options this means that the `-',
	      `+', or `--' has to be on the line to make option names be  com‐
	      pleted at all.

	      The default style for this style is `true'.

       preserve-prefix
	      This style is used when completing path names.  Its value should
	      be a pattern matching an initial prefix of the word to  complete
	      that  should  be	left  unchanged	 under all circumstances.  For
	      example, on some Unices an initial `//'  (double	slash)	has  a
	      special  meaning	and  hence should be kept.  For that one could
	      set this style to the string `//'.  As another example,  setting
	      this  style  to  `?:/' under Cygwin would allow completion after
	      `a:/...' and the like.

       range  This is used by the _history  completer  and  the	 _history_com‐
	      plete_word bindable command to decide which words should be com‐
	      pleted.  It may be set to a number, N, to say that only the last
	      N	 words	from  the  history should be completed.	 The value may
	      also be of the form `max:slice'.	This means that first the last
	      slice  words  will be completed.	If that yields no matches, the
	      slice words before those will be tried and so on,	 until	either
	      at  least	 one  match is generated or max words have been tried.
	      The default is to complete all words from the history at once.

       regular
	      This style is used by the _expand_alias completer	 and  bindable
	      command.	 If  set to `true' (the default), regular aliases will
	      be expanded but only in command  position.   If  it  is  set  to
	      `false', regular aliases will never be expanded and if it is set
	      to the string `always', regular aliases will be expanded even if
	      not in command position.

       remove-all-dups
	      The  _history_complete_word  bindable  command  and the _history
	      completer use this to decide if all duplicate matches should  be
	      removed, rather than just consecutive duplicates.

       select-prompt
	      If  this is set for the default tag, its value will be displayed
	      during menu selection (see the menu style above) when  the  com‐
	      pletion  list  does  not fit on the screen as a whole.  The same
	      escapes as for the list-prompt style are	understood,  but  give
	      the  number  of  the  match  or  line the mark is on.  A default
	      prompt is used when the value is the empty string.

       select-scroll
	      This style is tested for the default tag and  determines	how  a
	      completion  list	is  scrolled  during a menu selection (see the
	      menu style above) when the completion list does not fit  on  the
	      screen  as a whole.  Its value should be `0' (zero) to scroll by
	      half-screenfuls, a positive integer to scroll by that many lines
	      and  a  negative	number to scroll by the number of lines of the
	      screen minus that number (or plus the number, since it is	 nega‐
	      tive).  The default is to scroll by single lines.

       single-ignored
	      This  is	used  by  the  _ignored	 completer.  It specifies what
	      should be done if it can generate only one match, which is often
	      a	 special  case.	 If its value is `show', the single match will
	      be displayed but not inserted.  If the value is `menu', then the
	      single  match  and the original string are both added as matches
	      and menu completion is started so that  one  can	easily	select
	      either of them.

       sort   If  set to `true', completion functions that generate words from
	      the history as possible matches sort these words	alphabetically
	      instead of keeping them in the order in which they appear in the
	      history (from youngest to oldest).

	      This is also used by the _expand completer.  Here, if it is  set
	      to  `true',  the expansions generated will always be sorted.  If
	      it is set to `menu', then the expansions are  only  sorted  when
	      they are offered as single strings (not in the string containing
	      all possible expansions).

       special-dirs
	      Normally, the completion code will  not  produce	the  directory
	      names  `.'  and  `..' as possible completions.  If this style is
	      set to `true', it will add both `.' and `..' as possible comple‐
	      tions; if it is set to `..', only `..' will be added.

       squeeze-slashes
	      If  set  to `true', sequences of slashes (as in `foo//bar') will
	      be treated as if they were only one slash when completing	 path‐
	      names.   This is the usual behaviour of UNIX paths.  However, by
	      default the file completion function behaves as if there were  a
	      `*' between the slashes.

       stop   If  set  to  `true', the _history_complete_word bindable command
	      will stop once when reaching the beginning or end	 of  the  his‐
	      tory.   Invoking _history_complete_word will then wrap around to
	      the opposite end of the  history.	  If  this  style  is  set  to
	      `false'  (the default), _history_complete_word will loop immedi‐
	      ately as in a menu completion.

       subst-globs-only
	      This is used by the _expand completer.  If it is set to  `true',
	      the  expansion  will  only be used if it resulted from globbing;
	      hence, if expansions resulted from the  use  of  the  substitute
	      style  described	below,	but  these were not further changed by
	      globbing, the expansions will be rejected.

	      The default for this style is `false'.

       substitute
	      This boolean style controls whether the _expand  completer  will
	      first  try  to  expand  all substitutions in the string (such as
	      `$(...)' and `${...}').

	      The default is `true'.

       suffix This is used by the _expand completer if the word starts with  a
	      tilde or contains a parameter expansion. If it is set to `true',
	      the word will only be expanded if it doesn't have a suffix, i.e.
	      if  it  is  something  like  `~foo'  or `$foo', but not if it is
	      `~foo/' or `$foo/bar', unless that suffix itself contains	 char‐
	      acters  eligible	for  expansion.	 The default for this style is
	      `true'.

       tag-order
	      This provides a mechanism for sorting how the tags available  in
	      a particular context will be used.

	      The  values  for	the style are sets of space-separated lists of
	      tags.  The tags in each value will be tried at the same time; if
	      no  match	 is found, the next value is used.  (See the file-pat‐
	      terns style for an exception to this behavior.)

	      For example:

		     zstyle ':completion:*:complete:-command-:*' tag-order \
			 'commands functions'

	      specifies that completion in command position should offer  only
	      completions  for	external  commands and shell functions immedi‐
	      ately.

	      In addition to tag names, each string in the value may take  one
	      of the following forms:

	      -	     If	 any  string  in  the value consists of only a hyphen,
		     then only the tags specified by the other strings in  the
		     value  are	 generated.   Normally all tags not explicitly
		     selected are tried last if the  specified	tags  fail  to
		     generate any matches.  This means that a value consisting
		     only of a single hyphen turns off completion.

	      ! tags...
		     A string starting	with  an  exclamation  mark  specifies
		     names of tags that are not to be used.  The effect is the
		     same as if all other possible tags for  the  context  had
		     been listed.

	      tag:label ...
		     In	 strings  not starting with an exclamation mark, it is
		     also possible to specify tag labels instead of only tags,
		     where  tag	 is  one of the tags offered by the completion
		     function for the current context and  label  is  a	 name.
		     For  this,	 the completion function will generate matches
		     in the same way as for the tag but it will use the	 label
		     in	 place of the tag in the context names used to look up
		     styles.  If the label starts with a hyphen,  the  tag  is
		     prepended	to the label to form the name used for lookup.
		     This can be used to make the completion system try a cer‐
		     tain  tag	more than once, supplying different style set‐
		     tings for each attempt, see below for an example.

		     The label may optionally be followed by  a	 second	 colon
		     and  a  description.   This description will then be used
		     for the `%d' in the value of the format style instead  of
		     the  default description supplied by the completion func‐
		     tion.  Spaces in the description have  to	be  quoted  by
		     preceding	them  with a backslash and a `%d' appearing in
		     the description is replaced with the description given by
		     the completion function.

       In  each of the cases above, the tag may also be a pattern or more than
       one pattern inside braces and separated by commas.  In this case all of
       the  offered tags matching the pattern(s) will be used except for those
       that are given explicitly in the same string.  There are	 probably  two
       main  uses  of this.  One is the case where one wants to try one of the
       tags more than once, setting other styles differently for each try, but
       still  wants  to	 use  all the other tags without having to repeat them
       all.  For example, to make completion  of  function  names  in  command
       position	 ignore	 all  the completion functions starting with an under‐
       score the first time completion is tried, one could do:

	      zstyle ':completion:*:*:-command-:*' tag-order \
		  'functions:-non-comp *' functions
	      zstyle ':completion:*:functions-non-comp' ignored-patterns '_*'

       Here, the completion system will first try all tags offered,  but  will
       use  the	 tag  label  functions-non-comp when looking up styles for the
       function names completed.  For this, the ignored-patterns style is  set
       to exclude functions starting with an underscore from the set of possi‐
       ble matches.  If none of the generated matches match the string on  the
       line,  the completion system will use the second value of the tag-order
       style and complete functions names again, but this time using the  name
       functions  to look up styles, so that the ignored-patterns style is not
       used and all function names are considered.

       Of course, this can also be used to split the matches for one tag  into
       different groups. For example:

	      zstyle ':completion:*' tag-order \
		  'options:-long:long\ options
		   options:-short:short\ options
		   options:-single-letter:single\ letter\ options'

	      zstyle ':completion:*:options-long' ignored-patterns '[-+](|-|[^-]*)'
	      zstyle ':completion:*:options-short' ignored-patterns '--*' '[-+]?'
	      zstyle ':completion:*:options-single-letter' ignored-patterns '???*'

       With the group-names style set, this makes options beginning with `--',
       options beginning with a single `-'  or	`+'  but  containing  multiple
       characters,  and	 single-letter options be displayed in separate groups
       with different descriptions.

       The second interesting use of patterns is the case where one  wants  to
       try  multiple match specifications one after another.  The matcher-list
       style offers something similar, but it is tested very early in the com‐
       pletion	system and hence can't be set for single commands nor for more
       specific contexts.  Here is how to try normal  completion  without  any
       match  specification  and, if that generates no matches, try again with
       case-insensitive matching, restricting the effect to arguments  of  the
       command foo:
	      zstyle ':completion:*:*:foo:*' tag-order '*' '*:-case'
	      zstyle ':completion:*-case' matcher 'm:{a-z}={A-Z}'

       First,  all  the tags offered when completing after foo are tried using
       the normal tag name.  If that generates no matches, the second value of
       tag-order  is  used,  which  tries all tags again except that this time
       each has -case appended to its name for lookup of styles.   Hence  this
       time  the value for the matcher style from the second call to zstyle in
       the example is used to make completion case-insensitive.

       Using the -e option of the zstyle builtin command, it  is  possible  to
       specify	conditions  saying when certain tags are to be used. For exam‐
       ple:

	      zstyle -e '*:-command-:*' tag-order '
		  if [[ -n $PREFIX ]]; then
		    reply=( )
		  else
		    reply=( - )
		  fi'

       Makes completion in command position happen only if the string  on  the
       line  is not empty.  This is tested using the PREFIX parameter which is
       special in completion widgets; see  zshcompwid  for  a  description  of
       these special parameters.  Setting reply to an empty array ensures that
       only the default behaviour of trying all tags at once is used and  set‐
       ting  it to an array containing only a hyphen disables that default be‐
       haviour -- thus keeping all tags from being tried.

       If no style has been defined for a  context,  the  strings  `(|*-)argu‐
       ment-* (|*-)option-* values' and `options' plus all tags offered by the
       completion function will be used to provide a sensible default behavior
       that causes arguments (whether normal command arguments or arguments of
       options) to be completed before option names for most commands.

       urls   This is used together with the the urls tag by completion	 func‐
	      tions that generate URLs as possible matches.  If the value con‐
	      sists of more than one string or if the  only  string  does  not
	      name  a  file  or directory, the strings are used as the URLs to
	      complete.

	      If the value contains only one string and that is the name of  a
	      normal  file,  the URLs are taken from that file (where the URLs
	      may be separated by white space or newlines).

	      Finally, if the only string in the value names a directory, that
	      should contain sub-directories named after the retrieval methods
	      which occur as the first part of a  URL,	i.e.   `http',	`ftp',
	      `bookmark',  and	so  on.	  These sub-directories should contain
	      files and other sub-directories  whose  pathnames	 are  possible
	      completions  after the initial `http://', `ftp://', etc. See the
	      description in the file _urls in the User sub-directory  of  the
	      completion system for more information.

       use-cache
	      If  this	is  set, the completion caching layer is activated for
	      any  completions	 which	 use   it   (via   the	 _store_cache,
	      _retrieve_cache,	and  _cache_invalid functions).	 The directory
	      containing the cache files can be changed	 with  the  cache-path
	      style.

       use-compctl
	      If  this style is set to a string not equal to false, 0, no, and
	      off, the completion system may use any completion specifications
	      defined  with  the  compctl  builtin  command.   If the style is
	      unset, this is done only if the zsh/compctl  module  is  loaded.
	      The  string  may	also contain the substring `first' to make the
	      definition for `compctl -T' be used, and the substring `default'
	      to make the one for `compctl -D' be used.

	      Note  that  this	is only intended to smooth the transition from
	      compctl to the new completion system and may  disappear  in  the
	      future.

	      Note also that the definitions from compctl will only be used if
	      there is no specific completion  function	 for  the  command  in
	      question.	  For  example, while completing arguments to the com‐
	      mand foo, if this was handled by a command function  _foo,  com‐
	      pctl  would never be tried, while if it was handled by _default,
	      compctl would be tried.

       users  This may be set to a list of  names  that	 should	 be  completed
	      whenever a username is needed. If it is not set or the string on
	      the line doesn't match any of the	 strings  in  this  list,  all
	      usernames will be completed.

       users-hosts
	      The  values  of  this style should be of the form `user@host' or
	      `user:host'. It is used for commands that need  pairs  of	 user-
	      and  hostnames.	For  such  commands,  only the pairs from this
	      style are used and if, for  example,  the	 username  is  already
	      typed,  then  only  the hostnames for which there is a pair with
	      that username is defined.

	      If set for the my-accounts tag, this is used for	commands  such
	      as  rlogin  and  ssh;  in this case the style should contain the
	      names of the user's own accounts on remote hosts.	  If  set  for
	      the other-accounts tag, it is used for commands such as talk and
	      finger and should contain other people's accounts.  Finally,  it
	      may also be used by some commands with the accounts tag.

       users-hosts-ports
	      Like  users-hosts but used for commands like telnet and contain‐
	      ing strings of the form `user@host:port'.

       verbose
	      This is used in several contexts to decide if only a simple or a
	      verbose  list  of	 matches should be generated. For example some
	      commands show descriptions for option names  if  this  style  is
	      `true'.

	      The default value for this style is `true'.

       word   This  is	used by the _list completer, which prevents the inser‐
	      tion of completions until a second completion attempt  when  the
	      line has not changed.  The normal way of finding out if the line
	      has changed is to compare its entire contents  between  the  two
	      occasions.   If  this  style  is true, the comparison is instead
	      performed only on the current word.  Hence if completion is per‐
	      formed  on  another word with the same contents, completion will
	      not be delayed.

CONTROL FUNCTIONS
       The initialization script compinit redefines all the widgets which per‐
       form  completion	 to  call the supplied widget function _main_complete.
       This function acts as a wrapper calling the so-called `completer' func‐
       tions  that  generate  matches.	If _main_complete is called with argu‐
       ments, these are taken as the names of completer functions to be called
       in the order given.  If no arguments are given, the set of functions to
       try is taken from the completer style.  For example, to use normal com‐
       pletion and correction if that doesn't generate any matches:

	      zstyle ':completion:*' completer _complete _correct

       after  calling compinit. The default value for this style is `_complete
       _ignored', i.e. normally only ordinary completion is tried, first  with
       the  effect  of	the  ignored-patterns  style and then without it.  The
       _main_complete function uses the return value of	 the  completer	 func‐
       tions  to  decide  if other completers should be called.	 If the return
       value is zero, no other completers are  tried  and  the	_main_complete
       function returns.

       If  the	first argument to _main_complete is a single hyphen, the argu‐
       ments will not be taken as names of  completers.	 Instead,  the	second
       argument	 gives a name to use in the completer field of the context and
       the other arguments give a command name and arguments to call to gener‐
       ate the matches.

       The  following  completer  functions  are contained in the distribution
       (users may write their own):

       _all_matches
	      This completer can be used to add a  string  consisting  of  all
	      other  matches.	To  ensure,  that this string is always added,
	      this completer has to be used as	the  first  completer  in  the
	      list.  The avoid-completer style is used to decide if the string
	      should be added.	This will only be done	if  the	 matches  were
	      generated	 by  a completer not named by one of the values of the
	      style.

	      This function also uses the style old-matches.  If it is set  to
	      `true'  or  to  the string `only' and there is a list of matches
	      from a previous completion, those matches will  be  inserted  in
	      the  command  line.   If	it is set to the the string `only', it
	      will only insert an old list and won't add the  string  for  all
	      matches of the list currently being generated.

	      With  the	 old-matches style set, this completer should probably
	      not be called unconditionally.  Instead one  could  use  the  -e
	      option  of  the zstyle builtin command to add a condition to the
	      completer or to the old-matches style.  Alternatively, one could
	      use the _generic function to bind _all_matches to a separate key
	      binding, for example:

		     zle -C all-matches complete-word _generic
		     bindkey '^Xa' all-matches
		     zstyle ':completion:all-matches:*' old-matches only
		     zstyle ':completion:all-matches:*' completer _all_matches

       _approximate
	      This completer function uses the _complete completer to generate
	      a	 list  of  strings for the context the cursor is currently in,
	      allowing you to specify a maximum number	of  errors:   see  the
	      description of approximate matching in zshexpn(1) for how errors
	      are counted.  The resulting  list	 of  corrected	and  completed
	      strings is then presented to the user.  The intended use of this
	      completer function is to try after  the  normal  _complete  com‐
	      pleter by setting:

		     zstyle ':completion:*' completer _complete _approximate

	      This  will give correcting completion if and only if normal com‐
	      pletion yields no possible completions.  When corrected  comple‐
	      tions  are found, the completer will normally start menu comple‐
	      tion allowing you to cycle through these strings.

	      This completer uses the tags corrections and original when  gen‐
	      erating  the  possible corrections and the original string.  The
	      format style for the former may contain the additional sequences
	      `%e'  and	 `%o'  which  will be replaced by the number of errors
	      accepted to generate the corrections and	the  original  string,
	      respectively.

	      As  with	all completers, _approximate uses its name without the
	      underscore in the completer field of the context name.  Once  it
	      has  started  trying to generate matches, it will append a minus
	      sign and the number of errors accepted to its  name.   _approxi‐
	      mate  will  first look for completions with one error, then two,
	      and on so up to the limit on the number of  errors  set  by  the
	      max-errors style.	 Hence on the first try the completer field of
	      the context contains `approximate-1', on the second try `approx‐
	      imate-2', and so on.

	      When _approximate is called from another function, the number of
	      errors to accept may be given with the -a option.	 Its  argument
	      should  be the same as the value of the max-errors style, all in
	      one string.

	      Note that this completer (and the _correct  completer  mentioned
	      below)  can  be quite expensive to call, especially when a large
	      number of errors are allowed.  One way to avoid this is  to  set
	      up  the  completer  style	 using the -e option to zstyle so that
	      some completers are only used when  completion  is  attempted  a
	      second time on the same string, e.g.:

		     zstyle ':completion:*' completer '
		       if [[ $_last_try != "$HISTNO$BUFFER$CURSOR" ]]; then
			 _last_try="$HISTNO$BUFFER$CURSOR"
			 reply=(_complete _match _prefix)
		       else
			 reply=(_ignored _correct _approximate)
		       fi'

	      This uses the HISTNO parameter and the BUFFER and CURSOR special
	      parameters that are available inside zle and completion  widgets
	      to  find	out  if the command line hasn't changed since the last
	      time completion was tried.  Only then are the _ignored, _correct
	      and _approximate completers called.

       _complete
	      This  completer  generates  all  possible	 completions in a con‐
	      text-sensitive manner, i.e. using the settings defined with  the
	      compdef function explained above and the current settings of all
	      special parameters.  This gives the normal completion behaviour.

	      To complete arguments of commands, _complete  uses  the  utility
	      function	_normal,  which is in turn responsible for finding the
	      particular function; it is described below.  Various contexts of
	      the form -context-, as mentioned above for the #compdef tag, are
	      handled specially.  These are:

	      -array-value-
		     for completion on the right hand side of an array-assign‐
		     ment (`foo=(...)').

	      -brace-parameter-
		     for  completing  the name of a parameter expansion within
		     braces (`${...}').

	      -command-
		     for completing in a command position.

	      -condition-
		     for completion inside conditions (`[[...]]').

	      -default-
		     for generating completions	 when  no  special  completion
		     function is used.

	      -equal-
		     for completion of words beginning with an equals sign

	      -first-
		     for  adding completions before any other completion func‐
		     tions are tried; if  this	function  sets	the  _compskip
		     parameter	to  all, no other completion functions will be
		     called, if it is set to a string containing the substring
		     patterns, no pattern completion functions will be called,
		     and if it is set to a string containing default the func‐
		     tion  for the `-default-' context will not be called, but
		     functions defined for commands will.

	      -math- for completion  inside  mathematical  contexts,  such  as
		     `((...))'.

	      -parameter-
		     for   completing	the  name  of  a  parameter  expansion
		     (`$...').

	      -redirect-
		     for completion after a redirection operator.

	      -subscript-
		     for completion inside subscripts.

	      -tilde-
		     for completion after a tilde (`~') character, but	before
		     a slash.

	      -value-
		     for completion on the right hand side of an assignment.

	      Default implementations are supplied for each of these contexts,
	      in most cases named after the context  itself  (e.g.  completion
	      for  the	`-tilde-'  context  is	done  by  the  function	 named
	      `_tilde').

	      Before trying to find a function for a specific  context,	 _com‐
	      plete  checks  if	 the parameter `compcontext' is set.  If it is
	      set to an array, the elements  are  taken	 to  be	 the  possible
	      matches  which  will be completed using the tag `values' and the
	      description `value'.   If it is set to an associative array, the
	      keys  are	 used  as  the possible completions and the values (if
	      non-empty) are used as descriptions for the matches.  If	`comp‐
	      context'	is  set to a string containing colons, it should be of
	      the form `tag:descr:action'.  In this case  the  tag  and	 descr
	      give  the	 tag  and  description to use and the action says what
	      should be completed in one of the forms described for the _argu‐
	      ments utility function below.

	      Finally, if `compcontext' is set to a string without colons, the
	      value is taken as the name of the context to use and  the	 func‐
	      tion defined for that context will be called.  For this purpose,
	      there is a special context named -command-line-  that  completes
	      whole  command  lines  (commands and their arguments) and is not
	      used by the completion system itself, but has  a	function  han‐
	      dling completion for it.

       _correct
	      Generate corrections, but not completions, for the current word;
	      this is similar to _approximate but will not allow any number of
	      extra  characters	 at  the  cursor as that completer does, hence
	      this is similar to spell-checking.  It  calls  _approximate  but
	      uses a different completer field in the context name.

	      For example, with:

		     zstyle ':completion:::::' completer _complete _correct _approximate
		     zstyle ':completion:*:correct:::' max-errors 2 not-numeric
		     zstyle ':completion:*:approximate:::' max-errors 3 numeric

	      correction  will accept up to two errors.	 If a numeric argument
	      is given, correction will not be performed, but correcting  com‐
	      pletion  will be, and will accept as many errors as given by the
	      numeric argument.	 Without a numeric argument, first  correction
	      and then correcting completion will be tried, with the first one
	      accepting two errors and the second one accepting three errors.

	      When _correct is called as a function, the number of  errors  to
	      accept  may  be  given  following	 the  -a option.  The argument
	      should be the same as the value of the accept style, all in  one
	      string.

	      This  completer  function	 is  intended  to  be used without the
	      _approximate completer or, as in the example,  just  before  it.
	      Using  it	 after	the  _approximate  completer  is useless since
	      _approximate will at least generate the corrected strings gener‐
	      ated by the _correct completer -- and probably more.

       _expand
	      This  completer  function	 does  not  really  do completion, but
	      instead checks if the word on the command line is	 eligible  for
	      expansion	 and,  if  it is, gives detailed control over how this
	      expansion is done.  When using this,  one	 should	 not  use  the
	      expand-or-complete  widget,  but	instead	 use complete-word, as
	      expand-or-complete will expand the string on the line before the
	      completion  widget  is  called.	Also, this completer should be
	      called before the _complete completer function.

	      The tags used when generating expansions are all-expansions  for
	      the  string  containing all possible expansions, expansions when
	      adding the possible expansions as single	matches	 and  original
	      when  adding  the original string from the line.	In which order
	      these strings are generated and which of these strings are  gen‐
	      erated  at  all can be controlled by using the group-order style
	      and by modifying the tag-order style, as usual.

	      The format string for all-expansions and for expansions may con‐
	      tain  the	 sequence  `%o' which will be replaced by the original
	      string from the line.

	      Which kind of expansion is tried is controlled  by  the  substi‐
	      tute, glob and subst-globs-only styles.

	      When _expand is called as a function, the different modes may be
	      selected with options.  The -s to substitute, -g to glob and  -o
	      to subst-globs-only.

       _expand_alias
	      If  the word the cursor is on is an alias, it is expanded and no
	      other completers are called.  The types of aliases which are  to
	      be  expanded can be controlled with the regular, global and dis‐
	      abled styles.

	      This function is also a bindable command, see the section `Bind‐
	      able Commands' below.

       _history
	      Complete	words  from  the  shell's command  history.  This com‐
	      pleter uses the remove-all-dups, and sort styles	also  used  by
	      the  _history_complete_word  bindable  command,  see the section
	      `Bindable Commands' below and  the  section  `Completion	System
	      Configuration' above.

       _ignored
	      The  ignored-patterns  style  can	 be  set to a list of patterns
	      which are compared against possible completions;	matching  ones
	      are  removed.   With  this  completer those matches can be rein‐
	      stated, as if no ignored-patterns style were set.	 The completer
	      actually generates its own list of matches; which completers are
	      used for this is determined in the same way as for  the  _prefix
	      completer.

	      The single-ignored style is used if only one match could be gen‐
	      erated.  It can be set to show to prevent that match from	 being
	      displayed	 or  inserted into the line, or it can be set to menu,
	      in which case the single match and the original string from  the
	      line will be offered in a menu completion.

       _list  This  completer  allows  one  to	delay the insertion of matches
	      until completion is attempted a second time without the word  on
	      the  line being changed.	On the first attempt, only the list of
	      matches will be shown.  It is affected by the  styles  condition
	      and  word,  see  the  section  `Completion System Configuration'
	      above.

       _match This completer is intended to be used after the  _complete  com‐
	      pleter.  It  allows one to give patterns on the command line and
	      to complete all strings matching these patterns from the set  of
	      possible	completions  for the context the cursor is in, without
	      having to set the GLOB_COMPLETE option.

	      Normally this will be done by taking the pattern from the	 line,
	      inserting a `*' at the cursor position and comparing the result‐
	      ing pattern with the possible completions	 generated.   However,
	      if  the match-original style has a value of only, no `*' will be
	      inserted.	 If match-original has any other non-empty  string  as
	      its  value,  this	 completer  will first try to generate matches
	      without, then with a `*' inserted at the cursor position.

	      The generated matches will  be  offered  in  a  menu  completion
	      unless  the  insert-unambiguous style is set to `true'.  In this
	      case menu completion will only  be  started  if  no  unambiguous
	      string could be generated that is at least as long as the origi‐
	      nal string.  The style may also be set to the string  `pattern'.
	      This  will  keep the pattern on the line intact as long as there
	      isn't an unambiguous completion with which it could be replaced.

	      Note that the matcher specifications defined globally or used by
	      the completion functions will not be used.

       _menu  This  completer is a simple example function implemented to show
	      how menu completion can be done in shell	code.	It  should  be
	      used  as	the  first  completer and has the effect of making the
	      code perform menu completion.  Note that this is independent  of
	      the  setting  of the MENU_COMPLETE option and does not work with
	      the other menu completion widgets such as reverse-menu-complete,
	      or accept-and-menu-complete.

       _oldlist
	      This  completer  controls	 how  the  standard completion widgets
	      behave when there is an existing list of completions  which  may
	      have  been  generated  by	 a  special  completion	 (i.e. a sepa‐
	      rately-bound completion command).	 It allows the	ordinary  com‐
	      pletion  keys  to	 continue  to use the list of completions thus
	      generated, instead of producing a new list of  ordinary  contex‐
	      tual  completions.   It  should appear in the list of completers
	      before any of the widgets which generate matches.	 It  uses  two
	      styles:  old-list and old-menu, see the section `Completion Sys‐
	      tem Configuration' above.

       _prefix
	      This completer can be used to try	 completion  with  the	suffix
	      (everything after the cursor) ignored.  In other words, the suf‐
	      fix will not be considered to be part of the  word  to  complete
	      and  hence  does	not need to be matched.	 It uses the completer
	      style to decide which other completers to call to try to	gener‐
	      ate matches.  If this style is unset, the list of completers set
	      for the current context is used -- except, of course, the	 _pre‐
	      fix  completer  itself.	Furthermore, if this completer appears
	      more than once in the list of completers only  those  completers
	      not  already  tried  by  the  last invocation of _prefix will be
	      called.

	      For example, consider this global completer style:

		     zstyle ':completion:*' completer \
			 _complete _prefix _correct _prefix:foo

	      Here, the _prefix completer tries normal completion but ignoring
	      the  suffix.   If that doesn't generate any matches, and neither
	      does the call to the _correct completer after it,	 _prefix  will
	      be called a second time and, now only trying correction with the
	      suffix ignored.  If you want to use _prefix as the  last	resort
	      and try only normal completion, you can use:

		     zstyle ':completion:*' completer _complete ... _prefix
		     zstyle ':completion::prefix:*' completer _complete

	      The  add-space  style is also used.  If it is set to `true' then
	      _prefix will insert a space between the  matches	generated  (if
	      any) and the suffix.

	      Note  that this completer is only useful if the COMPLETE_IN_WORD
	      option is set; otherwise, the cursor will be moved to the end of
	      the  current word before the completion code is called and hence
	      there will be no suffix.

BINDABLE COMMANDS
       In addition to the context-dependent completions	 provided,  which  are
       expected to work in an intuitively obvious way, there are a few widgets
       implementing special behaviour which can be bound separately  to	 keys.
       The following is a list of these and their default bindings.

       _bash_completions
	      This  function  is  used by two widgets, _bash_complete-word and
	      _bash_list-choices.  It exists  to  provide  compatibility  with
	      completion  bindings in bash.  The last character of the binding
	      determines what is completed: `!', command names; `$',  environ‐
	      ment  variables;	`@',  host  names;  `/',  file names; `~' user
	      names.  In bash, the binding preceded by `\e' gives  completion,
	      and  preceded  by `^X' lists options.  As some of these bindings
	      clash with standard zsh bindings, only `\e~' and `^X~' are bound
	      by  default.   To add the rest, the following should be added to
	      .zshrc after compinit has been run:

		     for key in '!' '$' '@' '/' '~'; do
		       bindkey "\e$key" _bash_complete-word
		       bindkey "^X$key" _bash_list-choices
		     done

	      This includes the bindings for `~' in  case  they	 were  already
	      bound  to	 something else; the completion code does not override
	      user bindings.

       _correct_filename (^XC)
	      Correct the filename path at the cursor position.	 Allows up  to
	      six  errors in the name.	Can also be called with an argument to
	      correct a filename path, independently of zle; the correction is
	      printed on standard output.

       _correct_word (^Xc)
	      Performs correction of the current argument using the usual con‐
	      textual completions as possible choices. This stores the	string
	      `correct-word'  in  the  function	 field of the context name and
	      then calls the _correct completer.

       _expand_alias (^Xa)
	      This function can be used as a completer and as a bindable  com‐
	      mand.   It  expands the word the cursor is on if it is an alias.
	      The types of aliases expanded can be controlled with  the	 regu‐
	      lar, global and disabled styles.

	      When  used as a bindable command there is one additional feature
	      that can be selected by setting the complete  style  to  `true'.
	      In  this	case,  if  the	word  isn't  the  name	of  an	alias,
	      _expand_alias tries to complete the word to a  full  alias  name
	      without  expanding it (but leaving the cursor directly after the
	      completed word so that invoking  _expand_alias  once  more  will
	      expand the now-complete alias name).

       _expand_word (^Xe)
	      Performs expansion on the current word:  equivalent to the stan‐
	      dard expand-word	command,  but  using  the  _expand  completer.
	      Before calling it, the function field is set to `expand-word'.

       _generic
	      This  function  is  not  defined	as  a  widget and not bound by
	      default. However, it can be used to define  a  widget  and  will
	      then  store  the name of the widget in the function field of the
	      context and call the completion system. This allows custom  com‐
	      pletion  widgets with their own set of style settings to be eas‐
	      ily defined. For example, to define a widget  that  does	normal
	      completion and starts menu selection, one could do:

		     zle -C foo complete-word _generic
		     bindkey '...' foo
		     zstyle ':completion:foo:*' menu yes select=1

       _history_complete_word (\e/)
	      Complete	words  from the shell's command history. This uses the
	      list, remove-all-dups, sort, and stop styles.

       _most_recent_file (^Xm)
	      Complete the name of the most recently  modified	file  matching
	      the  pattern on the command line (which may be blank).  If given
	      a numeric argument N, complete the Nth  most  recently  modified
	      file.  Note the completion, if any, is always unique.

       _next_tags (^Xn)
	      This command alters the set of matches used to that for the next
	      tag, or set of tags, either as given by the tag-order  style  or
	      as  set  by default; these matches would otherwise not be avail‐
	      able.  Successive invocations of the command cycle  through  all
	      possible sets of tags.

       _read_comp (^X^R)
	      Prompt the user for a string, and use that to perform completion
	      on the current  word.   There  are  two  possibilities  for  the
	      string.	First,	it  can	 be  a set of words beginning `_', for
	      example `_files -/', in which case the function with  any	 argu‐
	      ments  will  be called to generate the completions.  Unambiguous
	      parts of the function name will be completed automatically (nor‐
	      mal  completion is not available at this point) until a space is
	      typed.

	      Second, any other string will be passed as a set of arguments to
	      compadd and should hence be an expression specifying what should
	      be completed.

	      A very restricted set of	editing	 commands  is  available  when
	      reading  the  string:  `DEL' and `^H' delete the last character;
	      `^U' deletes the line, and `^C' and  `^G'	 abort	the  function,
	      while  `RET'  accepts  the  completion.  Note the string is used
	      verbatim as a command line,  so  arguments  must	be  quoted  in
	      accordance with standard shell rules.

	      Once  a  string  has been read, the next call to _read_comp will
	      use the existing string instead of reading a new one.  To	 force
	      a	 new  string  to be read, call _read_comp with a numeric argu‐
	      ment.

       _complete_debug (^X?)
	      This widget performs ordinary completion, but captures in a tem‐
	      porary  file  a trace of the shell commands executed by the com‐
	      pletion system.  Each completion attempt gets its own  file.   A
	      command  to  view	 each of these files is pushed onto the editor
	      buffer stack.

       _complete_help (^Xh)
	      This widget displays information about the  context  names,  the
	      tags,  and  the completion functions used when completing at the
	      current cursor position. If given a numeric argument other  than
	      1 (as in `ESC-2 ^Xh'), then the styles used and the contexts for
	      which they are used will be shown, too.

	      Note that the information about styles  may  be  incomplete;  it
	      depends  on  the information available from the completion func‐
	      tions called, which in turn is  determined  by  the  user's  own
	      styles and other settings.

       _complete_tag (^Xt)
	      This  widget completes symbol tags created by the etags or ctags
	      programmes (note there is no connection with the completion sys‐
	      tem's  tags) stored in a file TAGS, in the format used by etags,
	      or tags, in the format created by ctags.	It will look  back  up
	      the  path	 hierarchy for the first occurrence of either file; if
	      both exist, the file TAGS is preferred.	You  can  specify  the
	      full path to a TAGS or tags file by setting the parameter $TAGS‐
	      FILE or $tagsfile respectively.	The  corresponding  completion
	      tags used are etags and vtags, after emacs and vi respectively.

UTILITY FUNCTIONS
       Descriptions follow for utility functions that may be useful when writ‐
       ing completion functions.  Most of these reside in the  Base  subdirec‐
       tory.  Like the example functions for commands in the distribution, the
       utility functions generating  matches  all  follow  the	convention  of
       returning  zero if they generated completions and non-zero if no match‐
       ing completions could be added.

       When writing completion functions or other ZLE widgets that  call  com‐
       pletion,	 it  might  be	interesting  to	 know  about two more features
       offered by the _main_complete function.	The  arrays  compprefuncs  and
       comppostfuncs  may  be set to contain names of functions that are to be
       called immediately before or after completion has been tried. The func‐
       tions  will  only  be  called once, unless they put themselves into the
       arrays again.

       _all_labels [ -12VJ ] tag name descr [ command args ... ]
	      This is a	 convenient  interface	to  the	 _next_label  function
	      below,  implementing  the loop shown in the _next_label example.
	      The command is the one that should be  called  to	 generate  the
	      matches. The options stored in the parameter name will automati‐
	      cally be inserted into the args given to the command.  Normally,
	      they  are put directly after the command, but if one of the args
	      is a single hyphen, they are inserted directly before  that.  If
	      the  hyphen  is the last argument, that will be removed from the
	      argument	list  before  the  command  is	called.	 This	allows
	      _all_labels to be used in almost all cases where the matches can
	      be generated by a single call to the compadd builtin command  or
	      by a call to one of the utility functions.

	      For example:

		     local expl
		     ...
		     if _requested foo; then
		       ...
		       _all_labels foo expl '...' compadd ... - $matches
		     fi

	      Will complete the strings from the matches parameter, using com‐
	      padd with additional options which  will	take  precedence  over
	      those generated by _all_labels.

       _alternative [ -C name ] specs ...
	      This  function is useful in simple cases where multiple tags are
	      available.  Essentially, it  implements  a  loop	like  the  one
	      described for the _tags function above.

	      The  tags to use and the action to perform if a tag is requested
	      are  described  using  the  specs	 which	are   of   the	 form:
	      `tag:descr:action'.  The tags are offered using _tags and if the
	      tag is requested, the action is executed with the given descrip‐
	      tion  descr.  The actions supported are those used by the _argu‐
	      ments function (described	 below),  without  the	`->state'  and
	      `=...' forms.

	      For example, the action may be a simple function call. With that
	      one could do:

		     _alternative \
			 'users:user:_users' \
			 'hosts:host:_hosts'

	      to offer usernames and hostnames as possible matches (which  are
	      generated by the _users and _hosts functions respectively).

	      Note  that,  like	 _arguments  this will also use _all_labels to
	      execute the actions, so one doesn't need to call that explicitly
	      unless  another  tag  is	to  be used, for example in a function
	      called from _alternative.

	      Like _tags this function supports the -C option to give  a  dif‐
	      ferent name for the argument context field.

       _arguments spec ...
	      This  function  can  be  used  to	 complete words on the line by
	      describing the options and arguments which may be passed to  the
	      command  for  which completion is being performed.  The descrip‐
	      tion is given as arguments to  this  function,  with  each  spec
	      describing  one  option  or normal argument of the command.  The
	      forms of spec understood are:

	      n:message:action
	      n::message:action
		     This describes the n'th  normal  argument.	  The  message
		     will  be  printed	above  the  matches  generated and the
		     action says what can be completed in this	position  (see
		     below).  If there are two colons before the message, this
		     describes an optional argument.  If the message  contains
		     only  white  space,  nothing  will	 be  printed above the
		     matches unless the	 action	 adds  an  explanation	string
		     itself.

	      :message:action
	      ::message:action
		     Like  the previous one, but describing the next argument.
		     I.e. if you want to describe all arguments a command  can
		     get, you can leave out the numbers in the description and
		     just use this form to describe them one after another  in
		     the order they have to appear on the line.

	      *:message:action
	      *::message:action
	      *:::message:action
		     This  describes  how  arguments (usually non-option argu‐
		     ments, those not beginning with - or +) are  to  be  com‐
		     pleted  when  no  description  with  one of the first two
		     forms was given. This also means that any number of argu‐
		     ments can be completed.

		     With  two	colons	before	the message, the words special
		     array and the CURRENT special parameter are  modified  to
		     refer  only  to  the  normal arguments when the action is
		     executed or evaluated.  With three colons before the mes‐
		     sage  they are modified to refer only to the normal argu‐
		     ments covered by this description.

	      optspec[description ...]
		     This describes an option and (if  description  is	given)
		     the  arguments that have to come after the option.	 If no
		     description is given, this means to offer only the option
		     name as a possible completion in the right places.	 (Note
		     that the brackets, above,	around	description,  indicate
		     that zero or more descriptions may appear; but the brack‐
		     ets are not themselves part of this format.  If  brackets
		     are used, they are part of the optspec; see below.)

		     In	 the  descriptions below, the option names represented
		     by optname	 are  normally	taken  to  be  multi-character
		     names,  and a word from the line is considered to contain
		     only one option (or none).	 By giving the	-s  option  to
		     _arguments before the first spec, each optname is consid‐
		     ered to be a single character and each word from the line
		     may  contain  more than one such option letter.  However,
		     words beginning with two hyphens  (like  `--prefix')  are
		     still  considered	to contain only one option name.  This
		     allows the use of the `-s' option to describe single-let‐
		     ter options together with such long option names.

		     The  -s  option may be combined with the option -w to say
		     that more option characters are to be expected even after
		     an option that takes an argument.	For example, if a com‐
		     mand takes the options `a' and `b', where	`a'  takes  an
		     argument  in the next word, _arguments would normally not
		     complete the other option directly	 after	`-a',  but  it
		     would allow that if given the -w option.

		     Similarly, the option -W may be given together with -s to
		     force completion  of  single-letter  options  even	 after
		     options that get an argument in the same word.  For exam‐
		     ple, if a command takes the options `a'  and  `b',	 where
		     `a'  needs	 an  argument in the same word, directly after
		     the option character, _arguments would normally only exe‐
		     cute  the	action	for  that argument and not offer other
		     single-letter options as possible completions.  If	 given
		     the  -W  option,  it will offer other options as possible
		     completions after executing the action for the  argument.
		     Note  that,  depending  on the action, this may mean that
		     the other options can't really be completed, but at least
		     they  will	 be  listed.  For more control, use an utility
		     function like _guard in the argument's action.

		     The forms of optspec are:

		     *optspec
			    If the option may be given more than once, a  star
			    (`*') must be added in front of one of the follow‐
			    ing forms of optspec.  Otherwise, if the option is
			    already on the line and to the left of the cursor,
			    it is not offered as a possible completion again.

		     -optname
		     +optname
			    In the simplest  form  the	optspec	 is  just  the
			    option name beginning with a minus or a plus sign,
			    such as `-foo'.  The first argument for the option
			    (if	 any)  must follow as a separate word directly
			    after the option.

			    If the command accepts the option  with  either  a
			    leading  minus  or a leading plus sign, use either
			    `-+optname' or `+-optname' to define both variants
			    at once.

			    In all the following forms, the leading `-' may be
			    replaced or paired with `+' in this way.

		     -optname-
			    The	 first	argument  of  the  option  must	  come
			    directly  after  the option name in the same word,
			    as in `-foo-:...'.

		     -optname+
			    The first argument may  appear  immediately	 after
			    optname in the same word, or may instead appear as
			    a separate word after the option.

		     -optname=
			    The argument may appear as the next	 word,	or  in
			    same  word	as the option name provided that it is
			    separated from it by an equals sign.

		     -optname=-
			    The argument to the option must  appear  after  an
			    equals sign in the same word, and may not be given
			    in the next argument.

		     optspec[explanation]
			    An explanation string may be appended  to  any  of
			    the	 preceding forms of optspec by enclosing it in
			    brackets, as in `-q[query operation]'.

			    The verbose style  is  used	 to  decide  if	 these
			    explanation	 strings  should be displayed with the
			    option in a completion listing.

			    If no bracketed explanation string	is  given  but
			    the	 auto-description  style  is  set and only one
			    argument is described for this optspec, the	 value
			    of	the style is displayed, with any appearance of
			    the sequence `%d' in it replaced by the message of
			    the	 first	description  that follows the optspec;
			    see below.

	      Note that the special meaning of a leading or trailing - or + in
	      optspec  means  that  when  the  command to be completed accepts
	      options like `-+' or `-=', the second character has to be quoted
	      with a backslash, as in `-\+'.

	      Each  description following an optspec must take one of the fol‐
	      lowing forms:

	      :message:action
	      ::message:action
		     Describes a mandatory argument  with  one	colon,	or  an
		     optional  argument with two colons.  As in other forms of
		     spec, the message will be printed above the matches  gen‐
		     erated  (unless  it contains only white space, see above)
		     and the action says what can be completed in  this	 posi‐
		     tion.

	      :*pattern:message:action
	      :*pattern::message:action
	      :*pattern:::message:action
		     This   describes	multiple  arguments.   Only  the  last
		     description may be given in this form.  If the pattern is
		     empty (i.e., :*:), all following words on the line are to
		     be completed as described by the action;  otherwise,  all
		     words  up	to  a word matching the pattern are to be com‐
		     pleted using the action.

		     When the message is preceded by  two  colons,  the	 words
		     special array and the CURRENT special parameter are modi‐
		     fied during the execution or evaluation of the action  to
		     refer  only to the words after the option.	 When preceded
		     by three colons, they are modified to refer only  to  the
		     words covered by this description.

		     Note  that only one such `:*'-specification is useful and
		     no other argument specification may be given after it.

       To include a colon in any optname, message, or action  anywhere	above,
       it has to be preceded by a backslash, as `\:'.

       Each  of	 the  six forms of spec (yes, there are six, keep track of the
       nestings) may be preceded by a list of option names and	argument  num‐
       bers with which the option or argument described is mutually exclusive.
       This list is given in parentheses, as in `(-two -three  1)-one:...'  or
       `(-foo):...'.   In  the	first example, the options `-two' and `-three'
       and the first argument will not be offered as possible  completions  if
       the  option  `-one' is on the line before the cursor, and in the second
       example the option `-foo' will not be offered if the argument described
       by the specification is on the line.

       The  list  may also contain a single star (*) as one of its elements to
       specify that the description for the rest arguments (i.e. a  specifica‐
       tion  of	 the  form `*:...') should not be used, a colon (:) to specify
       that the descriptions for all normal (non-option-) arguments should not
       be  used	 and  a	 hyphen	 (-)  to specify that the descriptions for all
       options should not be used.  This paragraph desperately	needs  rewrit‐
       ing.

       To  simplify  writing  writing functions that call _arguments more than
       once, the specs may also start with  the	 character  `!'	  (exclamation
       mark) to make the spec not be completed.	 However, if this is used with
       one of the forms describing options, the option (and its arguments,  if
       it takes any) will be understood and skipped if they appear on the com‐
       mand line.  It's just that the option itself  will  not	be  completed.
       This  is	 intended to be used with an array containing the options used
       in the  first  call  to	arguments.   The  second  call	can  then  use
       `\!${^global_options}'  to  ignore  those options and complete only the
       ones understood in the current context.

       In every case above, the action determines how the possible completions
       should be generated.  In places where no sensible matches can be gener‐
       ated, the action should consist of only a space.	 This  will  make  the
       message be displayed but no possible completions listed. Note that even
       in this case the colon at the end of the message is  needed.  The  only
       case  where  it	can be left is when neither a message, nor a action is
       given.

       Except for the `->string' form below, the action will  be  executed  by
       calling	the  _all_labels  function  to	process all tag labels, so one
       doesn't need to call that explicitly unless another tag is to be	 used,
       for example in a function called in the action.

       When  only  one	of a fixed set of strings can be completed, the action
       can consist of these strings as a list in parentheses, as in:

	      :foo:(foo bar baz)

       Such a list in doubled parentheses should contain strings consisting of
       the string to complete followed by `\:' and a description, as in:

	      :foo:((a\:bar b\:baz))

       The  matches  will  be  listed  together with their descriptions if the
       description style for the values tag is set.

       An action of the form `->string' is used by functions that implement  a
       state machine. In this case, the `string's (with all leading and trail‐
       ing spaces and tabs removed) of all actions that have to be  used  will
       be  stored  in  the  global  array  state.  The function returns with a
       non-zero return value if the cursor is not in a position where  options
       can  be	completed  or if the current word could not be completed to an
       option.	But if the -R option is given to _arguments, the function will
       instead	return	with a return value of 300 (to make it distinguishable
       from other return values) after setting the  global  `context',	`line'
       and `opt_args' parameters as described below, and without resetting any
       changes made to the special parameters such as PREFIX and words.	  This
       enables	wrapper	 functions around _arguments to be able to find out if
       they have to make sure that the special completion parameters  are  not
       reset when they return.

       Note  that  this means that a function calling _arguments with at least
       one action containing such a  `->string'	 has  to  declare  appropriate
       local parameters as in:

	      local context state line
	      typeset -A opt_args

       This  will ensure that _arguments does not create unused global parame‐
       ters.

       A string in braces is evaluated to generate  the	 matches  and  if  the
       action  does not begin with an opening parentheses or brace, it is also
       split into separate words and executed. If the  action  starts  with  a
       space,  this list of words will be invoked unchanged, otherwise it will
       be invoked with some extra strings placed after the  first  word	 which
       can be given as arguments to the compadd builtin command and which make
       sure that the message given in the description will be shown above  the
       matches.	 These	arguments  are	taken  from the array parameter `expl'
       which will be set up before executing the action and hence may be  used
       in it (normally in an expansion like `$expl[@]').

       If  the	action	starts with `= ' (an equals sign followed by a space),
       _arguments will insert the contents of the argument field of  the  cur‐
       rent  context  as  the new first element in the words special array and
       increments the value of the CURRENT special parameter. In other	words,
       it  inserts  a dummy element in the words array and makes CURRENT still
       point to the word in that array where  the  cursor  is.	This  is  only
       really useful when used with one of the forms that make _arguments mod‐
       ify the words array to contain only some of the words  from  the	 line,
       i.e.  one  of  the argument description forms where the message is pre‐
       ceded by two or three colons. For example, when the function called  in
       the  action for such an argument itself uses _arguments, the dummy ele‐
       ment is needed to make that second call to  _arguments  use  all	 words
       from  the  restricted  range for argument parsing. Without the inserted
       dummy element, the first word in the range would be taken (by the  sec‐
       ond _arguments) to be the command name and hence ignored.

       During  the evaluation or execution of the action the array `line' will
       be set to the command name and normal arguments from the command	 line,
       i.e. to the words from the command line excluding all options and their
       arguments. These are stored in the associative array `opt_args',	 using
       the option names as keys and their arguments as the values. For options
       that have more than one argument these are given as one	string,	 sepa‐
       rated by colons. All colons in the original arguments are preceded with
       backslashes.

       The parameter `context' (set only in the calling function when using an
       action  of  the	form  `->string',  not	during the evaluation of other
       actions) is set to the automatically created context names.  These  are
       either  strings of the form `option-opt-n' for the n'th argument of the
       option -opt, or strings of the form `argument-n' for the n'th  argument
       (for rest arguments the n is the string `rest'). For example, when com‐
       pleting the argument of the -o option, the name is `option-o-1' and for
       the second normal (non-option-) argument it is `argument-2'.

       Also, during the evaluation of the action, the context name in the cur‐
       context parameter is changed by	appending  the	same  string  that  is
       stored in the context parameter.

       It  is  also possible to specify multiple sets of options and arguments
       with the sets separated by single hyphens.  The	specifications	before
       the  first  hyphen are shared by all sets given after the first hyphen.
       The first word in every other set gives the name of the set. This  name
       may  appear  in	exclusion lists in the specifications, either alone or
       before one of the possible values described above (with a  `-'  between
       the name and the rest).

       For example:

	      _arguments \
		  -a \
		- set1 \
		  -c \
		- set2 \
		  -d \
		  ':arg:(x2 y2)'

       This  defines two sets. When the command line contains the option `-c',
       the `-d' option and the argument will not be considered	possible  com‐
       pletions.  When	it  contains `-d' or an argument, the option `-c' will
       not be completed any more, but if `-a' is given, both sets  will	 still
       be  considered  valid,  because	it appears before the first hyphen, so
       both sets contain this option.

       If the name-string is of the form `(name)' then all  specifications  in
       the set have an implicit exclusion list containing the name of the set,
       i.e. all specifications are mutual exclusive with all other  specifica‐
       tions  in  the  same  set. This is useful for defining multiple sets of
       options which are mutually exclusive  and  in  which  the  options  are
       aliases for each other. E.g.:

	      _arguments \
		  -a -b \
		- '(compress)' \
		  {-c,--compress}'[compress]' \
		- '(uncompress)' \
		  {-d,--decompress}'[decompress]'

       Note  that  using  multiple sets will be slower than using only one set
       because the completion code has to parse	 the  command  line  once  for
       every set. So more than one set should only be used if the command syn‐
       tax is too complicated. Note also that  an  option  specification  with
       rest-arguments  (as  in	`-foo:*:...') often allows the use of multiple
       sets to be avoided.

       To simplify the specifications for commands with standard option	 pars‐
       ing,  the  options  -S and -A may be given.  With -S, no option will be
       completed after a `--' on the line and this argument will otherwise  be
       ignored.	 With  -A,  no	options	 will  be  completed  after  the first
       non-option argument on the line.	 The -A has to be followed by  a  pat‐
       tern  matching  all strings which are not to be taken as arguments. For
       example, to make _arguments stop completing  options  after  the	 first
       normal  argument,  but ignoring all strings starting with a hyphen even
       if they are not described by one of the optspecs, one  would  use:  `-A
       "-*"'.

       Another	option	supported  is `-O name'. The name will be taken as the
       name of an array and its elements will be given to functions called  to
       generate	 matches  when executing the actions. For example, this allows
       one to give options for the compadd builtin that should be used for all
       actions.

       Also,  the -M option followed by a string may be given before the first
       description. The string will be used as the  match  specification  when
       completing  option  names  and values instead of the default `r:|[_-]=*
       r:|=*'.

       Finally, the option -C can be given to make _arguments modify the  cur‐
       context	parameter  when	 an action of the form `->state' is used. This
       parameter is used to keep track of the current context and in this case
       it  (and	 not  the parameter context as explained above) has to be made
       local to make sure that calling functions don't use the modified value.
       Also,  the  local  version of curcontext has to be initialised with the
       old value as in:

	      local curcontext="$curcontext"

       The function can also be made to automatically  complete	 long  options
       for  commands that support the `--help' option as, for example, most of
       the GNU commands do. For this, the string `--' must  be	given  as  one
       argument	 and  if  it is, the command from the line is invoked with the
       `--help' option and its output is parsed to find possible option names.
       Note  that this means that you should be careful to make sure that this
       feature is not used for a command that does not support this option.

       For such automatically found options that get an argument after an `=',
       the  function  also tries to automatically find out what should be com‐
       pleted as the argument.	The possible completions for  option-arguments
       can  be described with the arguments after the `--' (which are not used
       as described above). Each argument contains one description of the form
       `pattern:message:action'. The message and the action have the same for‐
       mat as for the normal option descriptions described above.  The	action
       will  be executed to complete arguments of options whose description in
       the output of the command  from	the  line  with	 the  `--help'	option
       matches the pattern. For example:

	      _arguments -- '*\*:toggle:(yes no)' \
			    '*=FILE*:file:_files' \
			    '*=DIR*:directory:_files -/'

       Here, `yes' and `no' will be completed as the argument of options whose
       description ends in a star, file names for  options  that  contain  the
       substring  `=FILE'  in  the  description,  and  paths for options whose
       description contains `=DIR'. In fact, the last  two  patterns  are  not
       needed  since  this function always completes files for option descrip‐
       tions containing `=FILE' and paths for option descriptions that contain
       `=DIR' or `=PATH'. These builtin patterns can be overridden by patterns
       given as arguments, however.

       Note also that _arguments tries to find out automatically if the	 argu‐
       ment  for  an  option  is optional. If it fails to automatically detect
       this, the colon before the message can be doubled to tell it about this
       as described for the normal option descriptions above.

       If  the	pattern	 ends in `(-)', this will removed from the pattern and
       the action will be used only directly after the `=', not	 in  the  next
       word.  I.e.,  this  is  like  a normal specification as described above
       using `=-'.

       The option `-i patterns' (which must be given after the	`--')  can  be
       used  to	 give  patterns for options which should not be completed. The
       patterns can be given as the name of an array parameter or as a literal
       list  in	 parentheses.  E.g. `-i "(--(en|dis)able-FEATURE*)"' will make
       the options `--enable-FEATURE' and `--disable-FEATURE' be ignored.  The
       option  `-s  pairs'  (again,  after  the	 `--') can be used to describe
       option aliases. Each pair consists of a pattern and a replacement. E.g.
       some  configure-scripts	describe  options  only as `--enable-foo', but
       also accept `--disable-foo'. To allow completion of  the	 second	 form,
       one would use `-s "(#--enable- --disable-)"'.

       Example:

	      _arguments '-l+:left border:' \
			 '-format:paper size:(letter A4)' \
			 '*-copy:output file:_files::resolution:(300 600)' \
			 ':postscript file:_files -g \*.\(ps\|eps\)' \
			 '*:page number:'

       This  describes	three options: `-l', `-format', and `-copy'. The first
       one gets one argument described as `left border' for which  no  comple‐
       tion will be offered because of the empty action. The argument may come
       directly after the `-l' or it may be given as  the  next	 word  on  the
       line.  The  `-format'  option  gets  one	 argument  (in	the next word)
       described as `paper size' for which only the strings `letter' and  `A4'
       will  be	 completed.  The  `-copy' option differs from the first two in
       that it may appear more than once on the command line and  in  that  it
       accepts two arguments. The first one is mandatory and will be completed
       as a filename. The second one is optional (because of the second	 colon
       before  the  description	 `resolution')	and will be completed from the
       strings `300' and `600'.

       The last two descriptions say what should be  completed	as  arguments.
       The  first  one describes the first argument as a `postscript file' and
       makes files ending in `ps' or `eps' be completed. The last  description
       says that all other arguments are `page numbers' but does not give pos‐
       sible completions.

       _cache_invalid cache_identifier
	      This function returns 0 if the completions  cache	 corresponding
	      to  the  given cache identifier needs rebuilding.	 It determines
	      this by looking up the cache-policy style for the	 current  con‐
	      text, and if it exists, runs the function of the same name, sup‐
	      plying the full path to the relevant  cache  file	 as  the  only
	      argument.

	      Example:

		     _example_caching_policy () {
			 # rebuild if cache is more than a week old
			 oldp=( "$1"(Nmw+1) )
			 (( $#oldp ))
		     }

       _call_function return name [ args ... ]
	      If a function name exists, it is called with the arguments args.
	      Unless it is the empty string or	a  single  hyphen,  return  is
	      taken  as the name of a parameter and the return status from the
	      called  function	is  stored  in	it.   The  return   value   of
	      _call_function  itself  is  zero if the function name exists and
	      was called and non-zero otherwise.

       _call_program tag string ...
	      This function is used in places where a command is called,  mak‐
	      ing  it  possible	 for  the user to override the default command
	      call.  It looks up the command style with the supplied tag.   If
	      the style is set, its value is used as the command to execute.

	      In  any case, the strings from the call to _call_program or from
	      the style are concatenated with  spaces  between	them  and  the
	      resulting	 string	 is evaluated.	The return value is the return
	      value of the command called.

       _combination [ -s pattern ] tag style specs ... field opts ...
	      This function is used to complete combinations of values such as
	      pairs  of	 hostnames and usernames.  The possible values will be
	      taken from the style whose name is given as the second argument.
	      The first argument is the tag to use to do the lookup.

	      The  style  name	should	consist of multiple parts separated by
	      hyphens which are then used as field names.   Known  values  for
	      such  fields can be given after the second argument in arguments
	      of the form `field=pattern'.   The  first	 argument  without  an
	      equals  sign is taken as the name of the field for which comple‐
	      tions should be generated.

	      The matches generated will be taken from the value of the style.
	      These values should contain the possible values for the combina‐
	      tions where the values for the different fields are separated by
	      colons  or  characters  matching	the pattern given after the -s
	      option to _combination; normally this is used to define  charac‐
	      ter classes like the `-s "[:@]"' used for the users-hosts style.

	      Only  the values for the requested fields for which the patterns
	      given in the `field=pattern' match the respective fields in  the
	      strings from the style value are generated as possible matches.

	      If no style with the given name is defined for the given tag but
	      a function named with the name of the requested  field  preceded
	      by  an  underscore  is  defined, that function will be called to
	      generate the matches.  This is also done if none of the  strings
	      in  the value of the style match all the patterns given as argu‐
	      ments.

	      If the same name is used for more than one field,	 in  both  the
	      `field=pattern'  and  the	 argument that gives the field name to
	      complete for, the number of the field (starting with one) may be
	      given after the fieldname, separated from it by a colon.

	      All  arguments after the requested field name are passed to com‐
	      padd when generating matches from the style  value,  or  to  the
	      functions for the fields if they are called.

       _contexts names ...
	      This  function looks up the definitions for the context and com‐
	      mand names given as arguments and calls  the  handler  functions
	      for  them if there is a definition (given with the compdef func‐
	      tion).  For example, the function completing  inside  subscripts
	      might  use  `_contexts -math-' to include the completions gener‐
	      ated for mathematical environments.

       _describe [ -o ] descr name1 [ name2 ] opts ... -- ...
	      This function is useful for preparing a list of command  options
	      or   arguments,  together	 with  their  descriptions  descr,  as
	      matches.	Multiple groups	 separated  by	--  can	 be  supplied,
	      potentially with different completion options opts.

	      The  descr  is taken as a string to display above the matches if
	      the format style for the descriptions tag is  set.   After  this
	      come  one	 or two names of arrays followed by options to pass to
	      compadd.	The first array contains the possible completions with
	      their  descriptions  in the form `completion:description'.  If a
	      second array is given, it should have the same  number  of  ele‐
	      ments  as the first one and the corresponding elements are added
	      as possible completions instead of the completion	 strings  from
	      the  first  array.  The completion list will retain the descrip‐
	      tions from the  first  array.   Finally,	a  set	of  completion
	      options can appear.

	      If  the  option  `-o'  appears  before  the  first argument, the
	      matches added will be treated as option names (typically follow‐
	      ing  a  `-',  `--'  or  `+'  on  the  command line).  This makes
	      _describe	 use  the  prefix-hidden,  prefix-needed  and  verbose
	      styles  to find out if the strings should be added at all and if
	      the descriptions should be shown.	 Without the `-o' option, only
	      the verbose style is used.

	      _describe uses the _all_labels function to generate the matches,
	      so it does not need to appear inside a loop over tag labels.

       _description [ -12VJ ] tag name descr [ specs ... ]
	      This function is called before completions are added  (typically
	      by  a call to compadd); it tests various styles and arranges for
	      any necessary options to be passed on to	compadd.   The	styles
	      are  tested  in the current context using the given tag; options
	      are put into the array called name for passing  on  to  compadd;
	      the  description	for  the  current  set of matches is passed in
	      descr.  The styles tested are: format (which is first tested for
	      the  given  tag  and then for the descriptions tag if that isn't
	      defined), hidden, matcher, ignored-patterns and group-name  (the
	      last  are	 tested only for the tag given as the first argument).
	      This function also calls the _setup function  which  tests  some
	      more styles.

	      The  string  returned by the format style (if any) will be modi‐
	      fied so that the sequence `%d' is replaced by the descr given as
	      the  third argument without any leading or trailing white space.
	      If, after removing the white  space,  the	 descr	is  the	 empty
	      string,  the  format  style will not be used and the options put
	      into the name array will not contain an explanation string to be
	      displayed	 above	the  matches.	If _description is called with
	      more than three arguments, the additional specs should be of the
	      form  `char:str'	and  every appearance of `%char' in the format
	      string will be replaced by string.

	      The options placed in the array will also	 make  sure  that  the
	      matches  are  placed in a separate group, depending on the value
	      of the group-name style.	Normally a sorted group will  be  used
	      for  this (with the `-J' option), but if an option starting with
	      `-V', `-J', `-1', or `-2' is given, that option will be included
	      in  the array, so that it is possible to make the group unsorted
	      by giving the option `-V', `-1V', or `-2V'.

	      In most cases, the function will be used like this:

		     local expl
		     _description files expl file
		     compadd "$expl[@]" - "$files[@]"

	      Note the use of the parameter expl, the hyphen, and the list  of
	      matches.	Almost all calls to compadd within the completion sys‐
	      tem use a	 similar  format;  this	 ensures  that	user-specified
	      styles are correctly passed down to the builtins which implement
	      the internals of completion.

       _files The function _files  uses	 the  file-patterns  style  and	 calls
	      _path_files  with	 all the arguments it was passed except for -g
	      and -/.  These two options are used depending on the setting  of
	      the file-patterns style.

	      See  _path_files	below  for  a  description  of the full set of
	      options accepted by _files.

       _gnu_generic
	      This function is a simple wrapper around the _arguments function
	      described	 above.	 It can be used to automatically complete long
	      options for commands that understand the `--help' option.	 It is
	      not  intended  to	 be  used  from	 completion functions but as a
	      top-level completion function in its own right.  For example, to
	      enable option completion for the commands foo and bar, one would
	      call:

		     compdef _gnu_generic foo bar

	      in one of the initialization files after the call to compinit.

	      The default installation uses this  function  only  to  generate
	      completions  for	some  GNU-commands  because  to	 complete  the
	      options, the command has to be called and hence it shouldn't  be
	      used  if	one  can't  be	sure  that the command understands the
	      `--help' option.

       _guard [ options ] pattern [ descr ]
	      This function is intended to be used in an action	 of  functions
	      like  _arguments.	 It returns immediately with a non-zero return
	      value if the string to be completed does not match the  pattern.
	      If  the pattern matches, the descr is displayed and the function
	      returns zero if the word to complete is not empty	 and  non-zero
	      otherwise.

	      The  pattern may be preceded by those options understood by com‐
	      padd that are passed down from _description, namely -M, -J,  -V,
	      -1, -2, -n, -F and -X.  All of these options, except -X, will be
	      ignored.	If the -X option appears, the description following it
	      will  be	used  as the string to display if the pattern matches,
	      unless the option descr is given to _guard  itself,  which  will
	      then take precedence.

	      As  an  example,	consider  a  command taking the options -n and
	      -none, where -n has to be followed by a  numeric	value  in  the
	      same word.  By using either of:

		     _argument '-n-:numeric value:_guard "[0-9]#"' '-none'

	      or

		     _argument '-n-: :_guard "[0-9]#" "numeric value"' '-none'

	      _arguments  can  be  made	 to  both display the message `numeric
	      value' and complete options after `-n<TAB>'.   If	 the  `-n'  is
	      already  followed	 by  one  or more digits (matching the pattern
	      given to _guard), only the message will be displayed and if  the
	      `-n'  is	followed  by  another character, only options are com‐
	      pleted.

       _message [ -r ] descr
	      The descr is used like the third argument	 to  the  _description
	      function.	 However,  the	resulting  string will always be shown
	      whether or not matches were generated. This is useful to display
	      help texts in places where no completions can be generated auto‐
	      matically.

	      This function also uses the format style for the messages tag in
	      preference  to  the  format  style for the descriptions tag. The
	      latter is used only if the former is unset.

	      If the -r option is given, no style is used  and	the  descr  is
	      used  literally  as  the string to display. This is only used in
	      cases where that string is taken from some  pre-processed	 argu‐
	      ment list containing an expanded description.

       _multi_parts sep array
	      This  function receives two arguments: a separator character and
	      an array.	 As usual, the array may be  either  the  name	of  an
	      array parameter or a literal array in the form `(foo bar)' (i.e.
	      a list of words separated by white space in parentheses).	  With
	      these arguments, this function will complete to strings from the
	      array where the parts separated by the separator	character  are
	      completed	 independently.	  For  example, the _tar function from
	      the distribution caches the pathnames from the tar  file	in  an
	      array,  and  then calls this function to complete these names in
	      the way normal filenames are completed by the _path_files	 func‐
	      tion, by using `_multi_parts / patharray'.

	      If  the  -i  option  is present, then any time there is a unique
	      match it will immediately be  inserted  even  if	that  requires
	      additional  separators  to be inserted as well.  When completing
	      from a fixed set of possible completions which are really words,
	      this  is	often the expected behaviour; however, if _multi_parts
	      should behave like completing pathnames, the  -i	option	should
	      not be used.

	      Like  other  utility  functions, this function accepts the `-V',
	      `-J', `-1', `-2', `-n', `-f',  `-X',  `-M',  `-P',  `-S',	 `-r',
	      `-R', and `-q' options and passes them to the compadd builtin.

       _next_label [ -12VJ ] tag name descr [ options ... ]
	      This  function  should  be called repeatedly to generate the tag
	      labels. On each call it will check if another tag label is to be
	      used and, if there is at least one, zero is returned. If no more
	      tag labels are to be used, a non-zero status is returned.

	      The -12JV options and the first three arguments are given to the
	      _description  function  using the tag label instead of the first
	      argument as appropriate.	The  options  given  after  the	 descr
	      should be other options to be used for compadd or whatever func‐
	      tion is to be called to add the matches. _next_label will	 store
	      these options in the parameter whose name is given as the second
	      argument. This is done in such a way that the description	 given
	      by  the  user  to	 the tag-order style is preferred over the one
	      given to _next_label.

	      Note that this function must not be called  without  a  previous
	      call  to	_tags  or _requested because it uses the tag label for
	      the current tag found by these functions.

	      A normal use of this function for the tag labels of the tag  foo
	      looks like this:

		     local expl ret=1
		     ...
		     if _requested foo; then
		       ...
		       while _next_label foo expl '...'; do
			 compadd "$expl[@]" ... && ret=0
		       done
		       ...
		     fi
		     return ret

       _normal
	      This function is used for normal command completion.  It has two
	      tasks: completing the first word on the command line as the name
	      of  a command, and completing the arguments to this command.  In
	      the second case, the name of the command is looked up to see  if
	      special  completions  exists,  including completions defined for
	      patterns which match the name.  If none is found, completion  is
	      performed for the context -default-.

	      The  function  can  also be called by other completion functions
	      which need to treat a range of words as  a  command  line.   For
	      example,	the  function to complete after the pre-command speci‐
	      fiers such as nohup removes the first word from the words array,
	      decrements the CURRENT parameter, then calls _normal again, with
	      the effect that `nohup cmd ...'  is treated  the	same  way  was
	      `cmd ...'.

	      If  the  command name matches a pattern, the parameter _compskip
	      is checked after the call to the corresponding completion	 func‐
	      tion.   This has the same effect here as in the -first- context:
	      if it is set, no more completion functions are  called  even  if
	      there are no matches so far.

       _options
	      This  can	 be used to complete option names.  It uses a matching
	      specification that ignores a leading `no',  ignores  underscores
	      and  allows the user to type upper-case letters which will match
	      their lower-case counterparts.  All  arguments  passed  to  this
	      function are propagated unchanged to the compadd builtin.

       _options_set and _options_unset
	      These  functions	complete  only	set or unset options, with the
	      same matching specification used in the _options function.

	      Note that you need to uncomment a few lines  in  the  _main_com‐
	      plete  function for these functions to work properly.  The lines
	      in question are used to store  the  option  settings  in	effect
	      before  the completion widget locally sets the options it needs.
	      Hence these options are not generally  used  by  the  completion
	      system.

       _parameters
	      This  should  be	used to complete parameter names.  _parameters
	      can take a -g pattern option which specifies that	 only  parame‐
	      ters  whose  type	 matches  the  pattern	should	be  completed.
	      Strings of the same form as those returned by  the  t  parameter
	      expansion	 flag are used here when matching the type.  All other
	      arguments are passed unchanged to the compadd builtin.

       _path_files
	      The function _path_files is used throughout the completion  sys‐
	      tem  to  complete	 filenames.   It  allows completion of partial
	      paths.  For example, the string `/u/i/s/sig' may be completed to
	      `/usr/include/sys/signal.h'.

	      The options accepted by both _path_files and _files are:

	      -f     Complete all filenames.  This is the default.

	      -/     Specifies that only directories should be completed.

	      -g pattern
		     Specifies	that only files matching the pattern should be
		     completed.

	      -W paths
		     Specifies path prefixes that are to be prepended  to  the
		     string  from  the line to generate the filenames but that
		     should not be inserted in the line or shown in a  comple‐
		     tion  listing.   Here,  paths may be the name of an array
		     parameter, a literal list of paths enclosed in  parenthe‐
		     ses or an absolute pathname.

	      -F     This option from the compadd builtin gives direct control
		     over which filenames should be ignored.  If the option is
		     not present, the ignored-patterns style is used.

	      These  functions	also  accept the `-J', `-V', `-1', `-2', `-n',
	      `-X', `-M', `-P', `-S', `-q', `-r', and `-R'  options  from  the
	      compadd builtin.

	      Finally,	the  _path_files  function   uses  the	styles expand,
	      ambiguous, special-dirs, list-suffixes and file-sort.

       _regex_arguments name specs ...
	      This function is a compiler to generate a	 completion  function.
	      The  first argument specifies the name of the generated function
	      while the remaining arguments specify a completion as a  set  of
	      regular  expressions  with  actions.  The generated function has
	      the structure of a finite-state machine whose states  correspond
	      to  the  state  (i.e. the context) of the completion. This state
	      machine uses a command line, which comes from the	 concatenation
	      of  the words array up to the current cursor position using null
	      characters as separators with no extra quotation.	 This is  ana‐
	      lysed and at the end the appropriate action is executed.

	      Specification  arguments	take  one of following forms, in which
	      metacharacters such as `(', `)', `#' and `|' should be quoted.

	      /pattern/ [%lookahead%] [-guard] [:tag:descr:action]
		     This is a primitive element, corresponding to  one	 state
		     of	 the  compiled state machine.  The state is entered if
		     `(#b)((#B)pattern)(#B)lookahead*'	matches	 the   command
		     line string.  If it matches, `guard' is evaluated and its
		     return status is examined; if  this  is  successful,  the
		     state is entered, otherwise the test fails and other can‐
		     didates are tried.	 The pattern string `[]' is guaranteed
		     never to match.

		     If	 the  test succeeds and the state is entered, the left
		     part of the command line string  matched  as  pattern  is
		     removed  and  the	next  state  is tried, proceeding from
		     inside to outside and from left to right.

		     If no test succeeds and the remaining command line string
		     contains  no  null	 character,  the  completion target is
		     restricted to the remainder of the	 command  line	string
		     and  actions  for the target are executed.	 In this case,
		     nothing is actually removed from the command line	string
		     so	 that any previous or neighbouring state may also have
		     actionss.	 actionss  evaluation  are  ordered   by   the
		     tag-order	style  and specified tag by _alternative.  So,
		     the various formats supported by _alternative can be used
		     in action.	 descr is used for setting up the array param‐
		     eter expl.

	      /pattern/+ [%lookahead%] [-guard] [:tag:descr:action]
		     This is similar to `/pattern/ ...' but the left  part  of
		     the command line string is also considered as part of the
		     completion target.

	      /pattern/- [%lookahead%] [-guard] [:tag:descr:action]
		     This is similar to `/pattern/ ...' but the actions of the
		     current  and previous states are ignored even if the fol‐
		     lowing state's `pattern' matches the empty string.

	      ( spec )
		     This groups specs.

	      spec # This allows any number of repetitions of spec.

	      spec spec
		     This represents the concatenation of two specs.

	      spec | spec
		     Either of the two specs can be matched.

       _requested [ -12VJ ] tag [ name descr [ command args ... ] ]
	      This function is called to decide whether a tag  already	regis‐
	      tered by a call to _tags (see below) is requested and hence com‐
	      pletion should be performed for it; it returns  status  zero  if
	      the  tag is requested and non-zero otherwise.  This will usually
	      be done in a loop such as the following:

		     _tags foo bar baz
		     while _tags; do
		       if _requested foo; then
			 ... # perform completion for foo
		       fi
		       ... # test the tags bar and baz in the same way
		       ... # exit loop if matches were generated
		     done

	      Note that the test for whether matches  were  generated  is  not
	      performed	 until the end of the _tags loop.  This is so that the
	      user can specify a set of tags to be tested at the same time  in
	      the tag-order parameter.

	      If  the  name  and  the  descr  are  given, _requested calls the
	      _description  function  with  these  arguments,  including   the
	      options.

	      If the command is given, the _all_labels function will be called
	      immediately with the same arguments.  This is often useful to do
	      both  the	 testing  of  the tag, getting the description for the
	      matches and adding the matches at once.  For example:

		     local expl ret=1
		     _tags foo bar baz
		     while _tags; do
		       _requested foo expl 'description' \
			   compadd foobar foobaz && ret=0
		       ...
		       (( ret )) || break
		     done

	      Note that this means that the command has to accept the  options
	      that have to be passed down to compadd.

       _retrieve_cache cache_identifier
	      This  function  retrieves	 completion  information from the file
	      given by cache_identifier, stored in a  directory	 specified  by
	      the  cache-path  style  (defaults	 to ~/.zsh/cache).  The return
	      value is zero if retrieval was successful.  It will only attempt
	      retrieval	 if  the  use-cache style is set, so you can call this
	      function without worrying about whether the user wanted  to  use
	      the caching layer.

	      See _store_cache below for more details.

       _sep_parts
	      This  function  is  passed  alternating arrays and separators as
	      arguments.  The arrays specify completions for parts of  strings
	      to  be separated by the separators.  The arrays may be the names
	      of array parameters or a quoted list of  words  in  parentheses.
	      For   example,  with  the	 array	`hosts=(ftp  news)'  the  call
	      `_sep_parts '(foo bar)' @ hosts' will complete the  string   `f'
	      to `foo' and the string `b@n' to `bar@news'.

	      This  function  passes  the  `-V', `-J', `-1', `-2', `-n', `-X',
	      `-M', `-P', `-S', `-r', `-R', and `-q' options and  their	 argu‐
	      ments to the compadd builtin used to add the matches.

       _setup tag [ group ]
	      This function expects a tag as its argument and sets up the spe‐
	      cial parameters used by the completion system appropriately  for
	      the tag, using styles such as list-colors and last-prompt.

	      The  optional  group  gives  the	name of the group in which the
	      matches will be placed. If it is not given, the tag is  used  as
	      the group name.

	      Note  that  this function is called automatically from _descrip‐
	      tion so that one normally doesn't have to call it explicitly.

       _store_cache cache_identifier vars ...
	      This  function,	when   combined	  with	 _retrieve_cache   and
	      _cache_invalid,  makes  it easy to implement a caching layer for
	      your completion functions.  If a completion  function  needs  to
	      perform  a  costly  operation in order to generate data which is
	      used to calculate completions, you can store that data in	 vari‐
	      ables,  and  use this function to dump the values of those vari‐
	      ables to a file.	Then, if they are needed in  subsequent	 shell
	      invocations,  they  can  be retrieved quickly from that file via
	      _retrieve_cache, avoiding the  need  for	repeating  the	costly
	      operation.

	      The cache_identifier specifies the file which the data should be
	      dumped to, and  is  stored  in  a	 directory  specified  by  the
	      cache-path style (defaults to ~/.zsh/cache).  The remaining vars
	      arguments are the variables to dump to the file.

	      The return value is zero if storage was successful.   The	 func‐
	      tion will only attempt storage if the use-cache style is set, so
	      you can call this function without worrying  about  whether  the
	      user wanted to use the caching layer.

	      If  your completion function avoids calling _retrieve_cache when
	      it already has the completion data in the environment, it should
	      probably at least call _cache_invalid to check whether this data
	      and the data cached on disk is still valid.

	      See the _perl_modules completion function for a  simple  example
	      of usage of this caching layer.

       _tags [ -C name [ tags ... ] ]
	      If  called  with	arguments, these are taken as the names of the
	      tags for the types of matches the	 calling  completion  function
	      can  generate  in	 the  current  context.	 These tags are stored
	      internally and sorted by using the tag-order  style.   Following
	      calls  to this function without arguments from the same function
	      will then select the first, second, etc. set of  tags  requested
	      by  the  user.   To  test	 if a certain tag should be tried, the
	      _requested function has to be called (see above).

	      The return value is  zero	 if  at	 least	one  of	 the  tags  is
	      requested and non-zero otherwise.

	      This  function  also  accepts  the -C option followed by a name.
	      This name is temporarily (i.e. not visible outside _tags) stored
	      in  the  argument	 field	of  the context name in the curcontext
	      parameter. This allows _tags to be made to use a	more  specific
	      context  name  without having to change and reset the curcontext
	      parameter (which would otherwise have the same effect).

       _values specs ...
	      This is used to complete values (strings) and their arguments or
	      lists of such values.  It can be used in two ways.

	      If the first argument is the option `-O name', this will be used
	      in the same way as by the _arguments function,  in  other	 words
	      the elements of the name array will be given to calls to compadd
	      and when executing an action.

	      Otherwise, if the first argument (or the	first  argument	 after
	      the  `-O	name'  option if that is used) is the option `-s', the
	      next argument is used as the character that  separates  multiple
	      values.	Thus  the  values completed appear in the same word on
	      the command line, unlike completion using _arguments.

	      The first argument (after the options and separator character if
	      they  are	 given)	 is used as a string to print as a description
	      before listing the values.

	      All other arguments describe the possible values and their argu‐
	      ments  in the same format used for the description of options by
	      the _arguments function (see above).  The only  differences  are
	      that  no	minus  or plus sign is required at the beginning, that
	      values can have only  one	 argument  and	that  those  forms  of
	      actions beginning with an equal sign are not supported.

	      The  character  separating  a value from its argument can be set
	      using the option -S (like -s, followed by the character  to  use
	      as  the  separator in the next argument).	 If this option is not
	      used, the equal sign will be used as the separator.

	      Example:

		     _values -s , 'description' \
			     '*foo[bar]' \
			     '(two)*one[number]:first count:' \
			     'two[another number]::second count:(1 2 3)'

	      This describes three possible values: `foo', `one',  and	`two'.
	      The  first  is  described	 as  `bar',  takes no argument and may
	      appear more than once.  The second is described as `number', may
	      appear   more  than  once,  and  takes  one  mandatory  argument
	      described as `first count' for which no action is	 specified  so
	      that it will not be completed automatically.  The `(two)' at the
	      beginning says that if the value `one' is on the line, the value
	      `two'  will  not	be considered to be a possible completion any‐
	      more.  Finally, the last value (`two') is described as  `another
	      number'  and  takes  an  optional	 argument described as `second
	      count' which will be completed from the strings  `1',  `2',  and
	      `3'.  The	 _values  function will complete lists of these values
	      separated by commas.

	      Like _arguments this function temporarily adds  another  context
	      name  component  to the current context name while executing the
	      action.  Here this name is just the name of the value for	 which
	      the argument is completed.

	      To  decide if the descriptions for the values (not those for the
	      arguments) should be printed, the style verbose is used.

	      One last difference from _arguments is that this	function  uses
	      the  associative array val_args to report values and their argu‐
	      ments, although otherwise this is the same as the opt_args asso‐
	      ciation  used  by _arguments.  This also means that the function
	      calling _values should declare  the  state,  line,  context  and
	      val_args parameters as in:

		     local context state line
		     typeset -A val_args

	      when using an action of the form `->string'.  With this function
	      the context parameter will be set to the name of the value whose
	      argument is to be completed.

	      Note  also  that _values normally adds the character used as the
	      separator between values as  a  auto-removable  suffix  so  that
	      users  don't  have  to  type  it	themselves.   But when using a
	      `->string' action _values can't do that because the matches  for
	      the  argument will be generated by the calling function.	To get
	      the usual behaviour, the implementor of the calling function has
	      to add the suffix directly by passing the options `-qS x' (where
	      x is the separator character specified with  the	-s  option  of
	      _values)	to  the function generating the matches or to the com‐
	      padd builtin.

	      Like _arguments, _values supports the -C option  in  which  case
	      you  have to make the parameter curcontext local instead of con‐
	      text (as described above).

       _wanted [ -C name ]  [ -12VJ ] tag name descr command args ...
	      In many contexts, completion will generate one particular set of
	      matches  (usually corresponding to a single tag); however, it is
	      still necessary to decide whether the user requires  matches  of
	      this type.  This function is useful in such a case.

	      Like  _requested, it should be passed arguments as for _descrip‐
	      tion.  It calls _tags with the given tag	and  if	 that  returns
	      zero  (so	 that  the  tag	 is  requested	by  the user) it calls
	      _description.  Hence to offer only one tag and  immediately  use
	      the description generated:

		     _wanted tag expl 'description' \
			 compadd matches...

	      Unlike _requested, however, _wanted cannot be called without the
	      command.	This is because _wanted also implements the loop  over
	      the tags, not just the one for the labels; conversely, it should
	      not be called in the middle of a _tags loop.

	      Note that, as for _requested, the	 command  has  to  accept  the
	      options that have to be passed down to compadd.

	      Like  _tags  this function supports the -C option to give a dif‐
	      ferent name for the argument context field.

COMPLETION DIRECTORIES
       In the source distribution, the files are contained in  various	subdi‐
       rectories of the Completion directory.  They may have been installed in
       the same structure, or into one single function directory.  The follow‐
       ing  is	a  description	of  the	 files found in the original directory
       structure.  If you wish to alter an installed file, you	will  need  to
       copy  it to some directory which appears earlier in your fpath than the
       standard directory where it appears.

       Base   The core functions and special completion widgets	 automatically
	      bound  to	 keys.	 You will certainly need most of these, though
	      will probably not need to alter them.  Many of these  are	 docu‐
	      mented above.

       Zsh    Functions for completing arguments of shell builtin commands and
	      utility functions for this.  Some of  these  are	also  used  by
	      functions from the Unix directory.

       Unix   Functions	 for  completing  arguments  of	 external commands and
	      suites of commands.  They may need modifying  for	 your  system,
	      although in many cases some attempt is made to decide which ver‐
	      sion of a command is present.  For example, completion  for  the
	      mount  command  tries  to determine the system it is running on,
	      while completion for many other utilities try to decide  whether
	      the  GNU version of the command is in use, and hence whether the
	      --help option is supported..

       X, AIX, BSD, ...
	      Completion and utility function for commands available  only  on
	      some systems.

ZSHCOMPCTL(1)							 ZSHCOMPCTL(1)

NAME
       zshcompctl - zsh programmable completion

SYNOPSIS
       This  version  of zsh has two ways of performing completion of words on
       the command line.  New users of the shell may prefer to use  the	 newer
       and more powerful system based on shell functions; this is described in
       zshcompsys(1), and the basic shell  mechanisms  which  support  it  are
       described in zshcompwid(1).  This manual entry describes the older com‐
       pctl command.

DESCRIPTION
       compctl [ -CDT ] options [ command ... ]
       compctl [ -CDT ] options [ -x pattern options - ... -- ] [ + options  [
       -x ... -- ] ... [+] ] [ command ... ]
       compctl -M match-specs ...
       compctl -L [ -CDTM ] [ command ... ]
       compctl + command ...

       Control	the editor's completion behavior according to the supplied set
       of options.  Various editing commands, notably expand-or-complete-word,
       usually	bound  to  tab,	 will  attempt to complete a word typed by the
       user, while others, notably delete-char-or-list, usually bound to ^D in
       EMACS editing mode, list the possibilities; compctl controls what those
       possibilities are.  They may for example be filenames (the most	common
       case,  and  hence  the  default),  shell	 variables,  or	 words	from a
       user-specified list.

COMMAND FLAGS
       Completion of the arguments of a command may be different for each com‐
       mand  or may use the default.  The behavior when completing the command
       word itself may also be separately specified.  These correspond to  the
       following flags and arguments, all of which (except for -L) may be com‐
       bined with any combination of the options described subsequently in the
       section `Option Flags':

       command ...
	      controls completion for the named commands, which must be listed
	      last on the command line.	 If completion is attempted for a com‐
	      mand  with a pathname containing slashes and no completion defi‐
	      nition is found, the search is retried with  the	last  pathname
	      component.  If  the command starts with a =, completion is tried
	      with the pathname of the command.

	      Any of the command strings may be patterns of the form  normally
	      used for filename generation.  These should be be quoted to pro‐
	      tect them from immediate	expansion;  for	 example  the  command
	      string  'foo*'  arranges for completion of the words of any com‐
	      mand beginning with foo.	When completion is attempted, all pat‐
	      tern completions are tried in the reverse order of their defini‐
	      tion until one matches.  By default, completion then proceeds as
	      normal, i.e. the shell will try to generate more matches for the
	      specific command on the command line; this can be overridden  by
	      including -tn in the flags for the pattern completion.

	      Note that aliases are expanded before the command name is deter‐
	      mined unless the COMPLETE_ALIASES option is set.	 Commands  may
	      not be combined with the -C, -D or -T flags.

       -C     controls	completion  when the command word itself is being com‐
	      pleted.  If no compctl -C command has been issued,  the names of
	      any  executable  command (whether in the path or specific to the
	      shell, such as aliases or functions) are completed.

       -D     controls default completion behavior for the arguments  of  com‐
	      mands  not assigned any special behavior.	 If no compctl -D com‐
	      mand has been issued, filenames are completed.

       -T     supplies completion flags to be used before any other processing
	      is  done,	 even  before processing for compctls defined for spe‐
	      cific commands.  This is especially useful  when	combined  with
	      extended completion (the -x flag, see the section `Extended Com‐
	      pletion' below).	Using this flag you can define default	behav‐
	      ior  which  will apply to all commands without exception, or you
	      can alter the standard behavior for all commands.	 For  example,
	      if  your	access to the user database is too slow and/or it con‐
	      tains too many users (so that completion after `~' is  too  slow
	      to be usable), you can use

		     compctl -T -x 's[~] C[0,[^/]#]' -k friends -S/ -tn

	      to  complete  the strings in the array friends after a `~'.  The
	      C[...] argument is necessary so that this form  of  ~-completion
	      is not tried after the directory name is finished.

       -L     lists  the existing completion behavior in a manner suitable for
	      putting into a start-up script; the  existing  behavior  is  not
	      changed.	 Any  combination  of  the above forms, or the -M flag
	      (which must follow the -L flag), may be specified, otherwise all
	      defined  completions  are	 listed.  Any other flags supplied are
	      ignored.

       no argument
	      If no argument is given, compctl lists all  defined  completions
	      in an abbreviated form;  with a list of options, all completions
	      with those flags set  (not  counting  extended  completion)  are
	      listed.

       If  the	+  flag is alone and followed immediately by the command list,
       the completion behavior for all the commands in the list	 is  reset  to
       the  default.   In  other  words,  completion will subsequently use the
       options specified by the -D flag.

       The form with -M as the first and only option defines  global  matching
       specifications (see zshcompwid). The match specifications given will be
       used for every completion attempt (only when using  compctl,  not  with
       the new completion system) and are tried in the order in which they are
       defined until one generates at least one match. E.g.:

	      compctl -M '' 'm:{a-zA-Z}={A-Za-z}'

       This will first try completion without any global match	specifications
       (the  empty  string)  and,  if that generates no matches, will try case
       insensitive completion.

OPTION FLAGS
       [ -fcFBdeaRGovNAIOPZEnbjrzu/12 ]
       [ -k array ] [ -g globstring ] [ -s subststring ]
       [ -K function ]
       [ -Q ] [ -P prefix ] [ -S suffix ]
       [ -W file-prefix ] [ -H num pattern ]
       [ -q ] [ -X explanation ] [ -Y explanation ]
       [ -y func-or-var ] [ -l cmd ] [ -h cmd ] [ -U ]
       [ -t continue ] [ -J name ] [ -V name ]
       [ -M match-spec ]

       The remaining options specify the type of command arguments to look for
       during  completion.   Any  combination of these flags may be specified;
       the result is a sorted list of all the possibilities.  The options  are
       as follows.

   Simple Flags
       These produce completion lists made up by the shell itself:

       -f     Filenames and filesystem paths.

       -/     Just filesystem paths.

       -c     Command  names, including aliases, shell functions, builtins and
	      reserved words.

       -F     Function names.

       -B     Names of builtin commands.

       -m     Names of external commands.

       -w     Reserved words.

       -a     Alias names.

       -R     Names of regular (non-global) aliases.

       -G     Names of global aliases.

       -d     This can be combined with -F, -B, -w, -a, -R and -G to get names
	      of disabled functions, builtins, reserved words or aliases.

       -e     This  option (to show enabled commands) is in effect by default,
	      but may be combined with -d; -de in combination with -F, -B, -w,
	      -a,  -R  and  -G	will  complete	names  of functions, builtins,
	      reserved words or aliases whether or not they are disabled.

       -o     Names of shell options (see zshoptions(1)).

       -v     Names of any variable defined in the shell.

       -N     Names of scalar (non-array) parameters.

       -A     Array names.

       -I     Names of integer variables.

       -O     Names of read-only variables.

       -p     Names of parameters used by the shell (including special parame‐
	      ters).

       -Z     Names of shell special parameters.

       -E     Names of environment variables.

       -n     Named directories.

       -b     Key binding names.

       -j     Job  names:   the	 first	word of the job leader's command line.
	      This is useful with the kill builtin.

       -r     Names of running jobs.

       -z     Names of suspended jobs.

       -u     User names.

   Flags with Arguments
       These have user supplied arguments to determine how the list of comple‐
       tions is to be made up:

       -k array
	      Names  taken from the elements of $array (note that the `$' does
	      not appear on the command line).	 Alternatively,	 the  argument
	      array itself may be a set of space- or comma-separated values in
	      parentheses, in which any delimiter may be escaped with a	 back‐
	      slash; in this case the argument should be quoted.  For example,

		     compctl -k "(cputime filesize datasize stacksize
				 coredumpsize resident descriptors)" limit

       -g globstring
	      The globstring is expanded using filename globbing; it should be
	      quoted to protect it from	 immediate  expansion.	The  resulting
	      filenames	 are  taken  as	 the possible completions.  Use `*(/)'
	      instead of `*/' for directories.	The fignore special  parameter
	      is  not  applied	to the resulting files.	 More than one pattern
	      may be given separated by blanks. (Note that brace expansion  is
	      not  part	 of  globbing.	 Use the syntax `(either|or)' to match
	      alternatives.)

       -s subststring
	      The subststring is split into words and  these  words  are  than
	      expanded	using all shell expansion mechanisms (see zshexpn(1)).
	      The resulting words are taken as possible completions.  The fig‐
	      nore  special  parameter	is not applied to the resulting files.
	      Note that -g is faster for filenames.

       -K function
	      Call the given function to get the completions.  Unless the name
	      starts with an underscore, the function is passed two arguments:
	      the prefix and the suffix of the word on which completion is  to
	      be  attempted, in other words those characters before the cursor
	      position, and those from the cursor position onwards.  The whole
	      command  line  can  be  accessed with the -c and -l flags of the
	      read builtin. The function should set the variable reply	to  an
	      array  containing	 the completions (one completion per element);
	      note that reply should not be made local to the function.	  From
	      such a function the command line can be accessed with the -c and
	      -l flags to the read builtin.  For example,

		     function whoson { reply=(`users`); }
		     compctl -K whoson talk

	      completes only logged-on users after `talk'.  Note that `whoson'
	      must return an array, so `reply=`users`' would be incorrect.

       -H num pattern
	      The  possible  completions  are  taken from the last num history
	      lines.  Only words matching pattern are taken.  If num  is  zero
	      or  negative the whole history is searched and if pattern is the
	      empty string all words are taken (as with `*').  A  typical  use
	      is

		     compctl -D -f + -H 0 ''

	      which  forces  completion to look back in the history list for a
	      word if no filename matches.

   Control Flags
       These do not directly specify types of name to be completed, but manip‐
       ulate the options that do:

       -Q     This  instructs the shell not to quote any metacharacters in the
	      possible completions.  Normally the results of a completion  are
	      inserted into the command line with any metacharacters quoted so
	      that they are interpreted as normal characters.  This is	appro‐
	      priate for filenames and ordinary strings.  However, for special
	      effects, such as inserting a backquoted expression from  a  com‐
	      pletion  array (-k) so that the expression will not be evaluated
	      until the complete line is executed, this option must be used.

       -P prefix
	      The prefix is inserted just before  the  completed  string;  any
	      initial  part already typed will be completed and the whole pre‐
	      fix ignored for completion purposes.  For example,

		     compctl -j -P "%" kill

	      inserts a `%' after the kill  command  and  then	completes  job
	      names.

       -S suffix
	      When a completion is found the suffix is inserted after the com‐
	      pleted string.  In the case of menu  completion  the  suffix  is
	      inserted	immediately, but it is still possible to cycle through
	      the list of completions by repeatedly hitting the same key.

       -W file-prefix
	      With directory file-prefix:  for command,	 file,	directory  and
	      globbing completion (options -c, -f, -/, -g), the file prefix is
	      implicitly added in front of the completion.  For example,

		     compctl -/ -W ~/Mail maildirs

	      completes any subdirectories to any depth beneath the  directory
	      ~/Mail,  although	 that  prefix  does  not appear on the command
	      line.  The file-prefix may also be of the form accepted  by  the
	      -k  flag,	 i.e. the name of an array or a literal list in paren‐
	      thesis. In this case all the directories in  the	list  will  be
	      searched for possible completions.

       -q     If used with a suffix as specified by the -S option, this causes
	      the suffix to be removed if the next character typed is a	 blank
	      or  does	not  insert anything or if the suffix consists of only
	      one character and the next character typed is the	 same  charac‐
	      ter;  this  the same rule used for the AUTO_REMOVE_SLASH option.
	      The option is most useful for  list  separators  (comma,	colon,
	      etc.).

       -l cmd This  option  restricts the range of command line words that are
	      considered to  be	 arguments.   If  combined  with  one  of  the
	      extended	completion  patterns  `p[...]',	 `r[...]', or `R[...]'
	      (see the section	`Extended  Completion'	below)	the  range  is
	      restricted  to the range of arguments specified in the brackets.
	      Completion is then performed as if these had been given as argu‐
	      ments  to the cmd supplied with the option. If the cmd string is
	      empty the first word in the range is instead taken as  the  com‐
	      mand  name,  and	command name completion performed on the first
	      word in the range.  For example,

		     compctl -x 'r[-exec,;]' -l '' -- find

	      completes arguments between `-exec' and the  following  `;'  (or
	      the  end	of  the command line if there is no such string) as if
	      they were a separate command line.

       -h cmd Normally zsh completes quoted strings  as	 a  whole.  With  this
	      option,  completion can be done separately on different parts of
	      such strings. It works like the -l option but makes the  comple‐
	      tion  code  work on the parts of the current word that are sepa‐
	      rated by spaces. These parts are completed as if they were argu‐
	      ments  to	 the  given cmd. If cmd is the empty string, the first
	      part is completed as a command name, as with -l.

       -U     Use the whole list of possible completions, whether or not  they
	      actually	match the word on the command line.  The word typed so
	      far will be deleted.  This is most useful with a function (given
	      by  the  -K option) which can examine the word components passed
	      to it (or via the read builtin's -c and -l flags)	 and  use  its
	      own criteria to decide what matches.  If there is no completion,
	      the original word is retained.  Since the produced possible com‐
	      pletions	seldom	have interesting common prefixes and suffixes,
	      menu completion is started immediately if AUTO_MENU is  set  and
	      this flag is used.

       -y func-or-var
	      The  list	 provided  by  func-or-var is displayed instead of the
	      list of completions whenever a listing is required;  the	actual
	      completions to be inserted are not affected.  It can be provided
	      in two ways. Firstly, if func-or-var begins with a $ it  defines
	      a	 variable,  or	if it begins with a left parenthesis a literal
	      array, which contains the list.  A variable may have been set by
	      a call to a function using the -K option.	 Otherwise it contains
	      the name of a function which will	 be  executed  to  create  the
	      list.   The  function  will  be  passed  as an argument list all
	      matching completions, including prefixes and  suffixes  expanded
	      in  full, and should set the array reply to the result.  In both
	      cases, the display list will only be retrieved after a  complete
	      list of matches has been created.

	      Note that the returned list does not have to correspond, even in
	      length, to the original set of matches, and may be passed	 as  a
	      scalar instead of an array.  No special formatting of characters
	      is performed on the output in this case; in particular, newlines
	      are  printed  literally  and if they appear output in columns is
	      suppressed.

       -X explanation
	      Print explanation when trying completion on the current  set  of
	      options.	A  `%n'	 in  this  string is replaced by the number of
	      matches that were added for this explanation string.  The expla‐
	      nation  only  appears  if	 completion was tried and there was no
	      unique match, or when listing completions.  Explanation  strings
	      will  be listed together with the matches of the group specified
	      together with the -X option (using the -J or -V option). If  the
	      same  explanation	 string	 is  given to multiple -X options, the
	      string appears only once (for each  group)  and  the  number  of
	      matches  shown  for  the `%n' is the total number of all matches
	      for each of these uses. In any case, the explanation string will
	      only  be	shown  if  there  was at least one match added for the
	      explanation string.

	      The sequences  %B,  %b,  %S,  %s,	 %U,  and  %u  specify	output
	      attributes  (bold,  standout,  and underline) and %{...%} can be
	      used to include literal escape sequences as in prompts.

       -Y explanation
	      Identical to -X, except that  the	 explanation  first  undergoes
	      expansion	 following  the	 usual	rules  for  strings  in double
	      quotes.  The expansion will be carried out after	any  functions
	      are  called for the -K or -y options, allowing them to set vari‐
	      ables.

       -t continue
	      The continue-string contains a character	that  specifies	 which
	      set of completion flags should be used next.  It is useful:

	      (i)  With -T, or when trying a list of pattern completions, when
	      compctl would usually continue with  ordinary  processing	 after
	      finding matches; this can be suppressed with `-tn'.

	      (ii)  With  a  list of alternatives separated by +, when compctl
	      would normally stop  when	 one  of  the  alternatives  generates
	      matches.	 It  can be forced to consider the next set of comple‐
	      tions by adding `-t+' to the flags of the alternative before the
	      `+'.

	      (iii)  In	 an extended completion list (see below), when compctl
	      would normally continue until a  set  of	conditions  succeeded,
	      then use only the immediately following flags.  With `-t-', com‐
	      pctl will continue trying extended completions  after  the  next
	      `-';  with  `-tx'	 it  will  attempt completion with the default
	      flags, in other words those before the `-x'.

       -J name
	      This gives the name of the group the matches  should  be	placed
	      in. Groups are listed and sorted separately; likewise, menu com‐
	      pletion will offer the matches in the groups  in	the  order  in
	      which  the  groups  were defined. If no group name is explicitly
	      given, the matches are stored in	a  group  named	 default.  The
	      first  time  a group name is encountered, a group with that name
	      is created. After that all matches with the same group name  are
	      stored in that group.

	      This  can	 be useful with non-exclusive alternative completions.
	      For example, in

		     compctl -f -J files -t+ + -v -J variables foo

	      both files and variables are possible completions,  as  the  -t+
	      forces  both  sets  of alternatives before and after the + to be
	      considered at once.  Because of the  -J  options,	 however,  all
	      files are listed before all variables.

       -V name
	      Like  -J,	 but  matches  within  the group will not be sorted in
	      listings nor in menu completion. These unsorted groups are in  a
	      different	 name space from the sorted ones, so groups defined as
	      -J files and -V files are distinct.

       -1     If given together with the -V  option,  makes  only  consecutive
	      duplicates  in  the  group be removed. Note that groups with and
	      without this flag are in different name spaces.

       -2     If given together with the -J or -V option, makes all duplicates
	      be kept. Again, groups with and without this flag are in differ‐
	      ent name spaces.

       -M match-spec
	      This defines additional  matching	 control  specifications  that
	      should  be  used	only  when testing words for the list of flags
	      this flag appears in. The format of  the	match-spec  string  is
	      described in zshcompwid.

ALTERNATIVE COMPLETION
       compctl [ -CDT ] options + options [ + ... ] [ + ] command ...

       The  form  with	`+' specifies alternative options. Completion is tried
       with the options before the first `+'. If this produces no matches com‐
       pletion	is  tried with the flags after the `+' and so on. If there are
       no flags after the last `+' and a match has not been found up  to  that
       point, default completion is tried.  If the list of flags contains a -t
       with a + character, the next list of flags is used even if the  current
       list produced matches.

EXTENDED COMPLETION
       compctl [ -CDT ] options -x pattern options - ... --
		[ command ... ]
       compctl [ -CDT ] options [ -x pattern options - ... -- ]
		[ + options [ -x ... -- ] ... [+] ] [ command ... ]

       The  form  with	`-x'  specifies	 extended  completion for the commands
       given; as shown, it may be combined with alternative  completion	 using
       `+'.  Each pattern is examined in turn; when a match is found, the cor‐
       responding options, as described in the section `Option	Flags'	above,
       are  used to generate possible completions.  If no pattern matches, the
       options given before the -x are used.

       Note that each pattern should be supplied  as  a	 single	 argument  and
       should be quoted to prevent expansion of metacharacters by the shell.

       A  pattern  is built of sub-patterns separated by commas; it matches if
       at least one of these sub-patterns matches  (they  are  `or'ed).	 These
       sub-patterns  are  in  turn composed of other sub-patterns separated by
       white spaces which match if all of the  sub-patterns  match  (they  are
       `and'ed).  An element of the sub-patterns is of the form `c[...][...]',
       where the pairs of brackets may be repeated as often as necessary,  and
       matches	if  any	 of the sets of brackets match (an `or').  The example
       below makes this clearer.

       The elements may be any of the following:

       s[string]...
	      Matches if the current word on the command line starts with  one
	      of the strings given in brackets.	 The string is not removed and
	      is not part of the completion.

       S[string]...
	      Like s[string] except that the string is part of the completion.

       p[from,to]...
	      Matches if the number of the current word is between one of  the
	      from  and	 to pairs inclusive. The comma and to are optional; to
	      defaults to the same value as from.  The numbers	may  be	 nega‐
	      tive: -n refers to the n'th last word on the line.

       c[offset,string]...
	      Matches if the string matches the word offset by offset from the
	      current word position.  Usually offset will be negative.

       C[offset,pattern]...
	      Like c but using pattern matching instead.

       w[index,string]...
	      Matches if the word in position index is	equal  to  the	corre‐
	      sponding	string.	  Note	that  the word count is made after any
	      alias expansion.

       W[index,pattern]...
	      Like w but using pattern matching instead.

       n[index,string]...
	      Matches if the current word contains string.  Anything up to and
	      including the indexth occurrence of this string will not be con‐
	      sidered part of the completion, but the rest will.  index may be
	      negative	to  count from the end: in most cases, index will be 1
	      or -1.  For example,

		     compctl -s '`users`' -x 'n[1,@]' -k hosts -- talk

	      will usually complete usernames, but if you insert  an  @	 after
	      the  name,  names from the array hosts (assumed to contain host‐
	      names, though you must make the array  yourself)	will  be  com‐
	      pleted.  Other commands such as rcp can be handled similarly.

       N[index,string]...
	      Like  n  except  that  the  string  will be taken as a character
	      class.  Anything up to and including the indexth	occurrence  of
	      any  of  the characters in string will not be considered part of
	      the completion.

       m[min,max]...
	      Matches if the total number of words lies between	 min  and  max
	      inclusive.

       r[str1,str2]...
	      Matches  if  the	cursor	is  after a word with prefix str1.  If
	      there is also a word with prefix str2 on the command line	 after
	      the  one matched by str1 it matches only if the cursor is before
	      this word. If the comma and str2 are omitted, it matches if  the
	      cursor is after a word with prefix str1.

       R[str1,str2]...
	      Like r but using pattern matching instead.

       q[str]...
	      Matches  the  word currently being completed is in single quotes
	      and the str begins with the letter `s', or if completion is done
	      in  double quotes and str starts with the letter `d', or if com‐
	      pletion is done in backticks and str starts with a `b'.

EXAMPLE
	      compctl -u -x 's[+] c[-1,-f],s[-f+]' \
		-g '~/Mail/*(:t)' - 's[-f],c[-1,-f]' -f -- mail

       This is to be interpreted as follows:

       If the current command is mail, then

	      if ((the current word begins with + and the previous word is -f)
	      or (the current word begins with -f+)), then complete the
	      non-directory part (the `:t' glob modifier) of files in the directory
	      ~/Mail; else

	      if the current word begins with -f or the previous word was -f, then
	      complete any file; else

	      complete user names.

ZSHMODULES(1)							 ZSHMODULES(1)

NAME
       zshmodules - zsh loadable modules

DESCRIPTION
       Some optional parts of zsh are in modules, separate from	 the  core  of
       the  shell.   Each  of  these  modules may be linked in to the shell at
       build time, or can be dynamically linked while the shell is running  if
       the  installation  supports this feature.  The modules that are bundled
       with the zsh distribution are:

       zsh/cap
	      Builtins for manipulating POSIX.1e (POSIX.6) capability  (privi‐
	      lege) sets.

       zsh/clone
	      A builtin that can clone a running shell onto another terminal.

       zsh/compctl
	      The compctl builtin for controlling completion.

       zsh/complete
	      The basic completion code.

       zsh/complist
	      Completion listing extensions.

       zsh/computil
	      A	 module	 with  utility	builtins needed for the shell function
	      based completion system.

       zsh/deltochar
	      A ZLE function duplicating EMACS' zap-to-char.

       zsh/example
	      An example of how to write a module.

       zsh/files
	      Some basic file manipulation commands as builtins.

       zsh/mapfile
	      Access to external files via a special associative array.

       zsh/mathfunc
	      Standard scientific functions for use  in	 mathematical  evalua‐
	      tions.

       zsh/parameter
	      Access to internal hash tables via special associative arrays.

       zsh/sched
	      A	 builtin  that	provides a timed execution facility within the
	      shell.

       zsh/stat
	      A builtin command interface to the stat system call.

       zsh/termcap
	      Interface to the termcap database.

       zsh/terminfo
	      Interface to the terminfo database.

       zsh/zftp
	      A builtin FTP client.

       zsh/zle
	      The Zsh Line Editor, including the bindkey and vared builtins.

       zsh/zleparameter
	      Access to internals of the Zsh Line Editor via parameters.

       zsh/zprof
	      A module allowing profiling for shell functions.

       zsh/zpty
	      A builtin for starting a command in a pseudo-terminal.

       zsh/zutil
	      Some utility builtins, e.g. the one for supporting configuration
	      via styles.

THE ZSH/CAP MODULE
       The zsh/cap module is used for manipulating POSIX.1e (POSIX.6) capabil‐
       ity sets.  If the operating system does not support this interface, the
       builtins	 defined by this module will do nothing.  The builtins in this
       module are:

       cap [ capabilities ]
	      Change the shell's process  capability  sets  to	the  specified
	      capabilities,  otherwise	display	 the shell's current capabili‐
	      ties.

       getcap filename ...
	      This is a built-in implementation of the POSIX standard utility.
	      It displays the capability sets on each specified filename.

       setcap capabilities filename ...
	      This is a built-in implementation of the POSIX standard utility.
	      It sets the capability sets on each specified  filename  to  the
	      specified capabilities.

THE ZSH/CLONE MODULE
       The zsh/clone module makes available one builtin command:

       clone tty
	      Creates  a forked instance of the current shell, attached to the
	      specified tty.  In the new shell, the PID, PPID and TTY  special
	      parameters  are changed appropriately.  $! is set to zero in the
	      new shell, and to the new shell's PID in the original shell.

	      The return value of the builtin is zero in both shells  if  suc‐
	      cessful, and non-zero on error.

THE ZSH/COMPCTL MODULE
       The  zsh/compctl	 module makes available two builtin commands. compctl,
       is the old, deprecated way to control completions for ZLE.  See zshcom‐
       pctl(1).	   The	 other	builtin	 command,  compcall  can  be  used  in
       user-defined completion widgets, see zshcompwid(1).

THE ZSH/COMPLETE MODULE
       The zsh/complete module makes available several builtin commands	 which
       can be used in user-defined completion widgets, see zshcompwid(1).

THE ZSH/COMPLIST MODULE
       The zsh/complist module offers three extensions to completion listings:
       the ability to highlight matches in such a list, the ability to	scroll
       through long lists and a different style of menu completion.

   Colored completion listings
       Whenever one of the parameters ZLS_COLORS or ZLS_COLOURS is set and the
       zsh/complist module is loaded or	 linked	 into  the  shell,  completion
       lists will be colored.  Note, however, that complist will not automati‐
       cally be loaded if it is not linked in:	on systems with dynamic	 load‐
       ing, `zmodload zsh/complist' is required.

       The  parameters	ZLS_COLORS  and	 ZLS_COLOURS  describe how matches are
       highlighted.  To turn on highlighting an empty value suffices, in which
       case  all  the  default values given below will be used.	 The format of
       the value of these parameters is the same as used by the GNU version of
       the  ls	command:  a colon-separated list of specifications of the form
       `name=value'.  The name may be one of the following  strings,  most  of
       which specify file types for which the value will be used.  The strings
       and their default values are:

       no 0   for normal text (i.e. when displaying  something	other  than  a
	      matched file)

       fi 0   for regular files

       di 32  for directories

       ln 36  for symbolic links

       pi 31  for named pipes (FIFOs)

       so 33  for sockets

       bd 44;37
	      for block devices

       cd 44;37
	      for character devices

       ex 35  for executable files

       mi none
	      for a non-existent file (default is the value defined for fi)

       lc \e[ for the left code (see below)

       rc m   for the right code

       tc 0   for  the character indicating the file type  printed after file‐
	      names if the LIST_TYPES option is set

       sp 0   for the spaces printed after matches to align the next column

       ec none
	      for the end code

       Apart from these strings, the name may also be an asterisk  (`*')  fol‐
       lowed by any string. The value given for such a string will be used for
       all files whose name ends with the string.  The name  may  also	be  an
       equals sign (`=') followed by a pattern.	 The value given for this pat‐
       tern will be used for all matches (not just  filenames)	whose  display
       string  are matched by the pattern.  Definitions for both of these take
       precedence over the values defined for file types and the form with the
       leading	asterisk takes precedence over the form with the leading equal
       sign.

       The last form also allows different parts of the displayed  strings  to
       be  colored  differently.   For this, the pattern has to use the `(#b)'
       globbing flag and pairs of parentheses surrounding  the	parts  of  the
       strings that are to be colored differently.  In this case the value may
       consist of more than one color code  separated  by  equal  signs.   The
       first  code  will  be  used for all parts for which no explicit code is
       specified and the following codes will be used for the parts matched by
       the  sub-patterns  in  parentheses.   For  example,  the	 specification
       `=(#b)(?)*(?)=0=3=7' will be used for all matches which	are  at	 least
       two  characters long and will use the code `3' for the first character,
       `7' for the last character and `0' for the rest.

       All three forms of name may be preceded by a  pattern  in  parentheses.
       If  this	 is  given,  the value will be used only for matches in groups
       whose names are matched by the pattern given in the  parentheses.   For
       example,	 `(g*)m*=43'  highlights  all  matches	beginning  with `m' in
       groups whose names  begin with `g' using the color code `43'.  In  case
       of the `lc', `rc', and `ec' codes, the group pattern is ignored.

       Note also that all patterns are tried in the order in which they appear
       in the parameter value until the first one matches which is then used.

       When printing a match, the code prints the value of lc, the  value  for
       the  file-type or the last matching specification with a `*', the value
       of rc, the string to display for the match itself, and then  the	 value
       of  ec  if that is defined or the values of lc, no, and rc if ec is not
       defined.

       The default values are ISO 6429 (ANSI) compliant and  can  be  used  on
       vt100 compatible terminals such as xterms.  On monochrome terminals the
       default values will have no visible effect.  The colors	function  from
       the  contribution  can be used to get associative arrays containing the
       codes for ANSI terminals (see the section `Other Functions' in  zshcon‐
       trib(1)).   For	example,  after	 loading  colors, one could use `$col‐
       ors[red]'  to  get  the	code  for  foreground  color  red  and	`$col‐
       ors[bg-green]' for the code for background color green.

       If  the completion system invoked by compinit is used, these parameters
       should not be set directly because the  system  controls	 them  itself.
       Instead, the list-colors style should be used (see the section `Comple‐
       tion System Configuration' in zshcompsys(1)).

   Scrolling in completion listings
       To enable scrolling through a completion list, the LISTPROMPT parameter
       must  be set.  Its value will be used as the prompt; if it is the empty
       string, a default prompt will be used.  The value may  contain  escapes
       of  the	form  `%x'.   It  supports the escapes `%B', `%b', `%S', `%s',
       `%U', `%u' and `%{...%}' used also in shell prompts as  well  as	 three
       pairs of additional sequences: a `%l' or `%L' is replaced by the number
       of the last line shown and the total number of lines in the form	 `num‐
       ber/total';  a  `%m'  or	 `%M'  is replaced with the number of the last
       match shown and the total number	 of  matches;  and  `%p'  or  `%P'  is
       replaced	 with  `Top', `Bottom' or the position of the first line shown
       in percent of the total number of  lines,  respectively.	  In  each  of
       these  cases the form with the uppercase letter will be replaced with a
       string of fixed width, padded to the right with spaces, while the  low‐
       ercase form will not be padded.

       If the parameter LISTPROMPT is set, the completion code will not ask if
       the list should be shown.  Instead it immediately starts displaying the
       list,  stopping	after  the  first screenful, showing the prompt at the
       bottom, waiting for a  keypress	after  temporarily  switching  to  the
       listscroll  keymap.   Some  of the zle functions have a special meaning
       while scrolling lists:

       send-break
	      stops listing discarding the key pressed

       accept-line, down-history, down-line-or-history
       down-line-or-search, vi-down-line-or-history
	      scrolls forward one line

       complete-word, menu-complete, expand-or-complete
       expand-or-complete-prefix, menu-complete-or-expand
	      scrolls forward one screenful

       Every other character stops listing and immediately processes  the  key
       as  usual.   Any key that is not bound in the listscroll keymap or that
       is bound	 to  undefined-key  is	looked	up  in	the  keymap  currently
       selected.

       As for the ZLS_COLORS and ZLS_COLOURS parameters, LISTPROMPT should not
       be set directly when using the shell function based completion  system.
       Instead, the list-prompt style should be used.

   Menu selection
       The  zsh/complist  module also offers an alternative style of selecting
       matches from a list, called menu selection, which can be	 used  if  the
       shell is set up to return to the last prompt after showing a completion
       list (see the ALWAYS_LAST_PROMPT option in zshoptions(1)).  It  can  be
       invoked	directly  by  the  widget  menu-select	defined by the module.
       Alternatively, the parameter MENUSELECT can be set to an integer, which
       gives  the  minimum  number of matches that must be present before menu
       selection is automatically turned on.  This second method requires that
       menu  completion	 be  started,  either  directly	 from a widget such as
       menu-complete, or due to one of the options MENU_COMPLETE or  AUTO_MENU
       being  set.  If MENUSELECT is set, but is 0, 1 or empty, menu selection
       will always be started during an ambiguous menu completion.

       When using the completion system based on shell functions, the  MENUSE‐
       LECT  parameter should not be used (like the ZLS_COLORS and ZLS_COLOURS
       parameters described above).  Instead, the menu style  should  be  used
       with the select=... keyword.

       After  menu  selection is started, the matches will be listed. If there
       are more matches than fit on the screen, only the  first	 screenful  is
       shown.	The  matches  to  insert into the command line can be selected
       from this list.	In the list one match is highlighted using  the	 value
       for ma from the ZLS_COLORS or ZLS_COLOURS parameter.  The default value
       for this is `7' which forces the selected match to be highlighted using
       standout	 mode  on  a vt100-compatible terminal.	 If neither ZLS_COLORS
       nor ZLS_COLOURS is set, the same terminal control sequence as  for  the
       `%S' escape in prompts is used.

       If  there  are  more  matches  than fit on the screen and the parameter
       MENUPROMPT is set, its value will be shown below the matches.  It  sup‐
       ports  the  same	 escape sequences as LISTPROMPT, but the number of the
       match or line shown will be that of the one where the mark  is  placed.
       If its value is the empty string, a default prompt will be used.

       The  MENUSCROLL	parameter  can	be  used  to  specify  how the list is
       scrolled.  If the parameter is unset, this is done line by line, if  it
       is  set to `0' (zero), the list will scroll half the number of lines of
       the screen.  If the value is positive, it gives the number of lines  to
       scroll  and  if it is negative, the list will be scrolled the number of
       lines of the screen minus the (absolute) value.

       As for the ZLS_COLORS, ZLS_COLOURS and LISTPROMPT  parameters,  neither
       MENUPROMPT  nor	MENUSCROLL should be set directly when using the shell
       function based  completion  system.   Instead,  the  select-prompt  and
       select-scroll styles should be used.

       The completion code sometimes decides not to show all of the matches in
       the list.  These hidden matches are either matches for which  the  com‐
       pletion	function  which	 added them explicitly requested that they not
       appear in the list (using the -n option of the compadd builtin command)
       or  they	 are  matches  which  duplicate	 a  string already in the list
       (because they differ only in things like prefixes or suffixes that  are
       not  displayed).	  In  the  list used for menu selection, however, even
       these matches are shown so that it is  possible	to  select  them.   To
       highlight such matches the hi and du capabilities in the ZLS_COLORS and
       ZLS_COLOURS parameters are supported for hidden matches	of  the	 first
       and second kind, respectively.

       Selecting matches is done by moving the mark around using the zle move‐
       ment functions.	When not all matches can be shown on the screen at the
       same  time,  the	 list will scroll up and down when crossing the top or
       bottom line.  The following zle functions have special  meaning	during
       menu selection:

       accept-line
	      accepts the current match and leaves menu selection

       send-break
	      leaves  menu selection and restores the previous contents of the
	      command line

       redisplay, clear-screen
	      execute their normal function without leaving menu selection

       accept-and-hold, accept-and-menu-complete
	      accept the  currently  inserted  match  and  continue  selection
	      allowing to select the next match to insert into the line

       accept-and-infer-next-history
	      accepts  the  current  match and then tries completion with menu
	      selection again;	in the case of files this allows one to select
	      a directory and immediately attempt to complete files in it;  if
	      there are no matches, a message is shown and one can use undo to
	      go  back	to  completion	on the previous level, every other key
	      leaves menu selection (including the other zle  functions	 which
	      are otherwise special during menu selection)

       undo   removes matches inserted during the menu selection by one of the
	      three functions before

       down-history, down-line-or-history
       vi-down-line-or-history,	 down-line-or-search
	      moves the mark one line down

       up-history, up-line-or-history
       vi-up-line-or-history, up-line-or-search
	      moves the mark one line up

       forward-char, vi-forward-char
	      moves the mark one column right

       backward-char, vi-backward-char
	      moves the mark one column left

       forward-word, vi-forward-word
       vi-forward-word-end, emacs-forward-word
	      moves the mark one screenful down

       backward-word, vi-backward-word, emacs-backward-word
	      moves the mark one screenful up

       vi-forward-blank-word, vi-forward-blank-word-end
	      moves the mark to the first line of the next group of matches

       vi-backward-blank-word
	      moves the mark to the last line of the previous group of matches

       beginning-of-history
	      moves the mark to the first line

       end-of-history
	      moves the mark to the last line

       beginning-of-buffer-or-history, beginning-of-line
       beginning-of-line-hist, vi-beginning-of-line
	      moves the mark to the leftmost column

       end-of-buffer-or-history, end-of-line
       end-of-line-hist, vi-end-of-line
	      moves the mark to the rightmost column

       complete-word, menu-complete, expand-or-complete
       expand-or-complete-prefix, menu-expand-or-complete
	      moves the mark to the next match

       reverse-menu-complete
	      moves the mark to the previous match

       All movement functions wrap around at the edges; any other zle function
       not  listed  leaves  menu  selection and executes that function.	 It is
       possible to make widgets in the above list do the  same	by  using  the
       form  of	 the  widget  with  a  `.'  in front.  For example, the widget
       `.accept-line' has the effect of leaving menu selection	and  accepting
       the entire command line.

       During  this  selection the widget uses the keymap menuselect.  Any key
       that is not defined in this keymap or that is bound to undefined-key is
       looked  up  in  the  keymap currently selected.	This is used to ensure
       that the most important keys used during selection (namely  the	cursor
       keys,  return,  and  TAB) have sensible defaults.  However, keys in the
       menuselect keymap can be modified directly using	 the  bindkey  builtin
       command	(see zshmodules(1)). For example, to make the return key leave
       menu selection without accepting the match currently selected one could
       call

	      bindkey -M menuselect '^M' send-break

       after loading the zsh/complist module.

THE ZSH/COMPUTIL MODULE
       The  zsh/computil module adds several builtin commands that are used by
       some of the completion functions in  the	 completion  system  based  on
       shell  functions	 (see  zshcompsys(1)  ).   Except  for compquote these
       builtin commands are very specialised and  thus	not  very  interesting
       when  writing your own completion functions.  In summary, these builtin
       commands are:

       comparguments
	      This is used by the _arguments function to do the	 argument  and
	      command  line parsing.  Like compdescribe it has an option -i to
	      do the parsing and initialize some internal  state  and  various
	      options to access the state information to decide what should be
	      completed.

       compdescribe
	      This is used by the _describe function to build the displays for
	      the  matches and to get the strings to add as matches with their
	      options.	On the first call one of the options -i or  -I	should
	      be  supplied  as the first argument.  In the first case, display
	      strings without the descriptions will be generated, in the  sec‐
	      ond  case,  the  string  used to separate the matches from their
	      descriptions must be  given  as  the  second  argument  and  the
	      descriptions  (if	 any)  will be shown.  All other arguments are
	      like the definition arguments to _describe itself.

	      Once compdescribe has been called with either the -i or  the  -I
	      option,  it  can be repeatedly called with the -g option and the
	      names of five arrays as its arguments.  This will	 step  through
	      the different sets of matches and store the options in the first
	      array, the strings with descriptions in the second, the  matches
	      for  these in the third, the strings without descriptions in the
	      fourth, and the matches for them in the fifth array.  These  are
	      then  directly given to compadd to register the matches with the
	      completion code.

       compfiles
	      Used by the _path_files function to optimize  complex  recursive
	      filename generation (globbing).  It does three things.  With the
	      -p and -P options it builds the glob patterns to use,  including
	      the  paths  already  handled and trying to optimize the patterns
	      with respect to the prefix and suffix  from  the	line  and  the
	      match  specification  currently  used.   The  -i option does the
	      directory tests for the ignore-parents style and the  -r	option
	      tests  if	 a  component for some of the matches are equal to the
	      string on the line and removes all  other	 matches  if  that  is
	      true.

       compgroups
	      Used  by	the  _tags  function to implement the internals of the
	      group-order style.  This only takes its arguments	 as  names  of
	      completion  groups and creates the groups for it (all six types:
	      sorted and unsorted,  both  without  removing  duplicates,  with
	      removing	all  duplicates	 and  with removing consecutive dupli‐
	      cates).

       compquote [ -p ] names ...
	      There may be reasons to write completion functions that have  to
	      add the matches using the -Q option to compadd and perform quot‐
	      ing themselves.  Instead of interpreting the first character  of
	      the  all_quotes  key  of	the  compstate special association and
	      using the q flag for parameter  expansions,  one	can  use  this
	      builtin command.	The arguments are the names of scalar or array
	      parameters and the values of  these  parameters  are  quoted  as
	      needed  for  the	innermost  quoting level.  If the -p option is
	      given, quoting is done as if there is  some  prefix  before  the
	      values  of the parameters, so that a leading equal sign will not
	      be quoted.

	      The return value is non-zero in case of an error and zero other‐
	      wise.

       comptags
       comptry
	      These implement the internals of the tags mechanism.

       compvalues
	      Like comparguments, but for the _values function.

THE ZSH/DELTOCHAR MODULE
       The zsh/deltochar module makes available two ZLE functions:

       delete-to-char
	      Read  a  character from the keyboard, and delete from the cursor
	      position up to and including the next (or, with repeat count  n,
	      the  nth)	 instance  of  that character.	Negative repeat counts
	      mean delete backwards.

       zap-to-char
	      This behaves like delete-to-char, except that the	 final	occur‐
	      rence of the character itself is not deleted.

THE ZSH/EXAMPLE MODULE
       The zsh/example module makes available one builtin command:

       example [ -flags ] [ args ... ]
	      Displays the flags and arguments it is invoked with.

       The  purpose  of the module is to serve as an example of how to write a
       module.

THE ZSH/FILES MODULE
       The  zsh/files  module  makes  some  standard  commands	available   as
       builtins:

       chgrp [ -Rs ] group filename ...
	      Changes  group  of files specified.  This is equivalent to chown
	      with a user-spec argument of `:group'.

       chown [ -Rs ] user-spec filename ...
	      Changes ownership and group of files specified.

	      The user-spec can be in four forms:

	      user   change owner to user; do not change group
	      user:: change owner to user; do not change group
	      user:  change owner to user;  change  group  to  user's  primary
		     group
	      user:group
		     change owner to user; change group to group
	      :group do not change owner; change group to group

	      In each case, the `:' may instead be a `.'.  The rule is that if
	      there is a `:' then the separator is `:', otherwise if there  is
	      a	 `.'  then the separator is `.', otherwise there is no separa‐
	      tor.

	      Each of user and group may be either a username (or group	 name,
	      as appropriate) or a decimal user ID (group ID).	Interpretation
	      as a name takes precedence, if there is an all-numeric  username
	      (or group name).

	      The  -R option causes chown to recursively descend into directo‐
	      ries, changing the ownership of all files in the directory after
	      changing the ownership of the directory itself.

	      The  -s  option  is  a zsh extension to chown functionality.  It
	      enables paranoid behaviour, intended to avoid security  problems
	      involving	 a chown being tricked into affecting files other than
	      the ones intended.  It will refuse to follow symbolic links,  so
	      that  (for  example) ``chown luser /tmp/foo/passwd'' can't acci‐
	      dentally chown /etc/passwd if /tmp/foo happens to be a  link  to
	      /etc.  It will also check where it is after leaving directories,
	      so that a recursive chown of a deep directory tree can't end  up
	      recursively chowning /usr as a result of directories being moved
	      up the tree.

       ln [ -dfis ] filename dest
       ln [ -dfis ] filename ... dir
	      Creates hard (or, with -s, symbolic) links.  In the first	 form,
	      the specified destination is created, as a link to the specified
	      filename.	 In the second form, each of the filenames is taken in
	      turn,  and  linked to a pathname in the specified directory that
	      has the same last pathname component.

	      Normally, ln will not attempt to create hard links  to  directo‐
	      ries.   This check can be overridden using the -d option.	 Typi‐
	      cally only the super-user can actually succeed in creating  hard
	      links  to directories.  This does not apply to symbolic links in
	      any case.

	      By default, existing files cannot be replaced by links.  The  -i
	      option  causes  the  user to be queried about replacing existing
	      files.  The -f option  causes  existing  files  to  be  silently
	      deleted, without querying.  -f takes precedence.

       mkdir [ -p ] [ -m mode ] dir ...
	      Creates  directories.   With  the -p option, non-existing parent
	      directories are first created if necessary, and there will be no
	      complaint if the directory already exists.  The -m option can be
	      used to specify (in octal) a set of  file	 permissions  for  the
	      created  directories, otherwise mode 777 modified by the current
	      umask (see umask(2)) is used.

       mv [ -fi ] filename dest
       mv [ -fi ] filename ... dir
	      Moves files.  In the first form, the specified filename is moved
	      to  the  specified destination.  In the second form, each of the
	      filenames is taken in turn, and moved to a pathname in the spec‐
	      ified directory that has the same last pathname component.

	      By  default,  the user will be queried before replacing any file
	      that the user cannot  write  to,	but  writable  files  will  be
	      silently	removed.   The -i option causes the user to be queried
	      about replacing any existing files.  The -f  option  causes  any
	      existing	files  to  be  silently deleted, without querying.  -f
	      takes precedence.

	      Note that this mv will not move files across devices.   Histori‐
	      cal  versions  of	 mv,  when actual renaming is impossible, fall
	      back on  copying	and  removing  files;  if  this	 behaviour  is
	      desired,	use  cp	 and rm manually.  This may change in a future
	      version.

       rm [ -dfirs ] filename ...
	      Removes files and directories specified.

	      Normally, rm will not remove directories	(except	 with  the  -r
	      option).	 The  -d  option causes rm to try removing directories
	      with unlink (see unlink(2)), the same  method  used  for	files.
	      Typically	 only the super-user can actually succeed in unlinking
	      directories in this way.	-d takes precedence over -r.

	      By default, the user will be queried before  removing  any  file
	      that  the	 user  cannot  write  to,  but	writable files will be
	      silently removed.	 The -i option causes the user to  be  queried
	      about  removing  any  files.   The  -f option causes files to be
	      silently deleted, without querying,  and	suppresses  all	 error
	      indications.  -f takes precedence.

	      The -r option causes rm to recursively descend into directories,
	      deleting all files in the directory before removing  the	direc‐
	      tory with the rmdir system call (see rmdir(2)).

	      The  -s  option  is  a  zsh  extension  to rm functionality.  It
	      enables paranoid behaviour, intended to  avoid  common  security
	      problems	involving  a  root-run	rm being tricked into removing
	      files other than the ones intended.  It will  refuse  to	follow
	      symbolic	links,	so  that  (for example) ``rm /tmp/foo/passwd''
	      can't accidentally remove /etc/passwd if /tmp/foo happens to  be
	      a	 link  to  /etc.  It will also check where it is after leaving
	      directories, so that a recursive removal	of  a  deep  directory
	      tree  can't  end	up  recursively	 removing  /usr as a result of
	      directories being moved up the tree.

       rmdir dir ...
	      Removes empty directories specified.

       sync   Calls the system call of the  same  name	(see  sync(2)),	 which
	      flushes  dirty  buffers to disk.	It might return before the I/O
	      has actually been completed.

THE ZSH/MAPFILE MODULE
       The zsh/mapfile module provides one special associative array parameter
       of the same name.

       mapfile
	      This  associative	 array	takes  as keys the names of files; the
	      resulting value is the  content  of  the	file.	The  value  is
	      treated  identically  to any other text coming from a parameter.
	      The value may also be assigned to, in which  case	 the  file  in
	      question	is  written (whether or not it originally existed); or
	      an element may be unset, which will delete the file in question.
	      For  example, `vared mapfile[myfile]' works as expected, editing
	      the file `myfile'.

	      When the array is accessed as a whole, the keys are the names of
	      files  in	 the  current  directory, and the values are empty (to
	      save a huge overhead in memory).	 Thus  ${(k)mapfile}  has  the
	      same  affect  as	the  glob operator *(D), since files beginning
	      with a dot are not special.  Care must be taken with expressions
	      such  as	rm  ${(k)mapfile}, which will delete every file in the
	      current directory without the usual `rm *' test.

	      The parameter mapfile may be made read-only; in that case, files
	      referenced may not be written or deleted.

   Limitations
       Although	 reading  and  writing	of the file in question is efficiently
       handled, zsh's internal memory management may be	 arbitrarily  baroque.
       Thus  it should not automatically be assumed that use of mapfile repre‐
       sents a gain in efficiency over use of other mechanisms.	 Note in  par‐
       ticular	that  the whole contents of the file will always reside physi‐
       cally in memory when accessed (possibly multiple times, due to standard
       parameter substitution operations).  In particular, this means handling
       of sufficiently long files (greater than the machine's swap  space,  or
       than the range of the pointer type) will be incorrect.

       No  errors  are	printed	 or  flagged  for non-existent, unreadable, or
       unwritable files, as the parameter mechanism is too low	in  the	 shell
       execution hierarchy to make this convenient.

       It  is  unfortunate that the mechanism for loading modules does not yet
       allow the user to specify the name of the shell parameter to  be	 given
       the special behaviour.

THE ZSH/MATHFUNC MODULE
       The  zsh/mathfunc  module  provides standard mathematical functions for
       use when evaluating mathematical formulae.  The syntax agrees with nor‐
       mal C and FORTRAN conventions, for example,

	      (( f = sin(0.3) ))

       assigns the sine of 0.3 to the parameter f.

       Most  functions	take  floating	point  arguments and return a floating
       point value.  However, any necessary conversions	 from  or  to  integer
       type  will  be  performed  automatically by the shell.  Apart from atan
       with a second argument and the abs, int and float functions, all	 func‐
       tions  behave as noted in the manual page for the corresponding C func‐
       tion, except that any arguments out of range for the function in	 ques‐
       tion will be detected by the shell and an error reported.

       The  following  functions  take a single floating point argument: acos,
       acosh, asin, asinh, atan, atanh, cbrt, ceil, cos, cosh, erf, erfc, exp,
       expm1,  fabs,  floor,  gamma,  j0, j1, lgamma, log, log10, log1p, logb,
       sin, sinh, sqrt, tan, tanh, y0, y1.  The atan function  can  optionally
       take  a	second	argument, in which case it behaves like the C function
       atan2.  The ilogb function takes a single floating point argument,  but
       returns an integer.

       The  function signgam takes no arguments, and returns an integer, which
       is the C variable of the same name, as  described  in  gamma(3).	  Note
       that  it	 is therefore only useful immediately after a call to gamma or
       lgamma.	Note also that `signgam()' and `signgam' are distinct  expres‐
       sions.

       The  following  functions  take two floating point arguments: copysign,
       fmod, hypot, nextafter.

       The following take an integer first argument and a floating point  sec‐
       ond argument: jn, yn.

       The  following take a floating point first argument and an integer sec‐
       ond argument: ldexp, scalb.

       The function abs does not convert the type of its single	 argument;  it
       returns	the  absolute  value  of  either a floating point number or an
       integer.	 The functions float and int convert their  arguments  into  a
       floating point or integer value (by truncation) respectively.

       Note  that  the C pow function is available in ordinary math evaluation
       as the `**' operator and is not provided here.

THE ZSH/PARAMETER MODULE
       The zsh/parameter module gives access to	 some  of  the	internal  hash
       tables used by the shell by defining some special parameters.

       options
	      The keys for this associative array are the names of the options
	      that can	be  set	 and  unset  using  the	 setopt	 and  unsetopt
	      builtins.	 The  value of each key is either the string on if the
	      option is currently set, or the string  off  if  the  option  is
	      unset.  Setting a key to one of these strings is like setting or
	      unsetting the option, respectively.  Unsetting  a	 key  in  this
	      array is like setting it to the value off.

       commands
	      This  array gives access to the command hash table. The keys are
	      the names of external commands, the values are the pathnames  of
	      the  files  that	would  be  executed  when the command would be
	      invoked. Setting a key in this array defines a new entry in this
	      table  in the same way as with the hash builtin. Unsetting a key
	      as in `unset "commands[foo]"' removes the entry  for  the	 given
	      key from the command hash table.

       functions
	      This  associative array maps names of enabled functions to their
	      definitions. Setting a key in it is  like	 defining  a  function
	      with  the name given by the key and the body given by the value.
	      Unsetting a key removes the definition for the function named by
	      the key.

       dis_functions
	      Like functions but for disabled functions.

       builtins
	      This  associative array gives information about the builtin com‐
	      mands currently enabled. The keys are the names of  the  builtin
	      commands	and the values are either `undefined' for builtin com‐
	      mands that will automatically be loaded from a module if invoked
	      or `defined' for builtin commands that are already loaded.

       dis_builtins
	      Like builtins but for disabled builtin commands.

       reswords
	      This array contains the enabled reserved words.

       dis_reswords
	      Like reswords but for disabled reserved words.

       aliases
	      This  maps the names of the regular aliases currently enabled to
	      their expansions.

       dis_aliases
	      Like raliases but for disabled regular aliases.

       galiases
	      Like raliases, but for global aliases.

       dis_galiases
	      Like galiases but for disabled global aliases.

       parameters
	      The keys in this associative array are the names of the  parame‐
	      ters  currently  defined.	 The values are strings describing the
	      type of the parameter, in the same format used by the t  parame‐
	      ter  flag,  see  zshexpn(1) .  Setting or unsetting keys in this
	      array is not possible.

       modules
	      An associative array giving information about modules. The  keys
	      are   the	  names	 of  the  modules  loaded,  registered	to  be
	      autoloaded, or aliased. The value says  which  state  the	 named
	      module  is  in and is one of the strings `loaded', `autoloaded',
	      or `alias:name', where name is the name the  module  is  aliased
	      to.

	      Setting or unsetting keys in this array is not possible.

       dirstack
	      A normal array holding the elements of the directory stack. Note
	      that the output of the dirs builtin command  includes  one  more
	      directory, the current working directory.

       history
	      This  associative	 array	maps history event numbers to the full
	      history lines.

       historywords
	      A special array containing the words stored in the history.

       jobdirs
	      This associative array maps job numbers to the directories  from
	      which  the  job was started (which may not be the current direc‐
	      tory of the job).

       jobtexts
	      This associative array maps job numbers to the texts of the com‐
	      mand lines that were used to start the jobs.

       jobstates
	      This associative array gives information about the states of the
	      jobs currently known. The keys are the job numbers and the  val‐
	      ues  are	strings of the form `job-state:mark:pid=state...'. The
	      job-state gives the state the whole job is currently in, one  of
	      `running',  `suspended', or `done'. The mark is `+' for the cur‐
	      rent job, `-' for the previous job and empty otherwise. This  is
	      followed	by  one	 `pid=state' for every process in the job. The
	      pids are, of course, the process IDs and the state describes the
	      state of that process.

       nameddirs
	      This  associative	 array	maps the names of named directories to
	      the pathnames they stand for.

       userdirs
	      This associative array maps user names to the pathnames of their
	      home directories.

       funcstack
	      This  array  contains the names of the functions currently being
	      executed. The first element is the name of  the  function	 using
	      the parameter.

THE ZSH/SCHED MODULE
       The zsh/sched module makes available one builtin command:

       sched [+]hh:mm command ...
       sched [ -item ]
	      Make an entry in the scheduled list of commands to execute.  The
	      time may be specified in either absolute or relative time.  With
	      no  arguments,  prints the list of scheduled commands.  With the
	      argument `-item', removes the given item from the list.

THE ZSH/STAT MODULE
       The zsh/stat module makes available one builtin command:

       stat [ -gnNolLtTrs ] [ -f fd ] [ -H hash ] [ -A array ] [ -F  fmt  ]  [
       +element ] [ file ... ]
	      The  command  acts  as  a front end to the stat system call (see
	      stat(2)).	 If the stat call fails, the appropriate system	 error
	      message  printed and status 1 is returned.  The fields of struct
	      stat give information about the files provided as	 arguments  to
	      the command.  In addition to those available from the stat call,
	      an extra element `link' is provided.  These elements are:

	      device The number of the device on which the file resides.

	      inode  The unique number of the file  on	this  device  (`inode'
		     number).

	      mode   The mode of the file; that is, the file's type and access
		     permissions.  With the -s option, this will  be  returned
		     as a string corresponding to the first column in the dis‐
		     play of the ls -l command.

	      nlink  The number of hard links to the file.

	      uid    The user ID of the	 owner	of  the	 file.	 With  the  -s
		     option, this is displayed as a user name.

	      gid    The  group	 ID  of the file.  With the -s option, this is
		     displayed as a group name.

	      rdev   The raw device number.  This is only useful  for  special
		     devices.

	      size   The size of the file in bytes.

	      atime
	      mtime
	      ctime  The  last	access, modification and inode change times of
		     the file, respectively, as the number  of	seconds	 since
		     midnight  GMT  on 1st January, 1970.  With the -s option,
		     these are printed as strings for the local time zone; the
		     format can be altered with the -F option, and with the -g
		     option the times are in GMT.

	      blksize
		     The number of bytes in one allocation block on the device
		     on which the file resides.

	      block  The number of disk blocks used by the file.

	      link   If	 the  file  is	a link and the -L option is in effect,
		     this contains the name of the file linked	to,  otherwise
		     it	 is  empty.   Note  that  if  this element is selected
		     (``stat +link'') then  the	 -L  option  is	 automatically
		     used.

	      A	 particular element may be selected by including its name pre‐
	      ceded by a `+' in the option list; only one element is  allowed.
	      The  element may be shortened to any unique set of leading char‐
	      acters.  Otherwise, all elements will be shown for all files.

	      Options:

	      -A array
		     Instead of displaying the	results	 on  standard  output,
		     assign  them  to  an  array,  one struct stat element per
		     array element for each file in order.  In this case  nei‐
		     ther  the	name  of the element nor the name of the files
		     appears in array unless the -t or -n options were	given,
		     respectively.   If	 -t is given, the element name appears
		     as a prefix to the appropriate array element;  if	-n  is
		     given,  the file name appears as a separate array element
		     preceding all the others.	Other formatting  options  are
		     respected.

	      -H hash
		     Similar  to  -A,  but  instead assign the values to hash.
		     The keys are the elements listed above.  If the -n option
		     is	 provided then the name of the file is included in the
		     hash with key name.

	      -f fd  Use the file on  file  descriptor	fd  instead  of	 named
		     files; no list of file names is allowed in this case.

	      -F fmt Supplies a strftime (see strftime(3)) string for the for‐
		     matting of the time elements.  The -s option is implied.

	      -g     Show the time elements in the  GMT	 time  zone.   The  -s
		     option is implied.

	      -l     List  the	names of the type elements (to standard output
		     or an  array  as  appropriate)  and  return  immediately;
		     options other than -A and arguments are ignored.

	      -L     Perform an lstat (see lstat(2)) rather than a stat system
		     call.  In this case, if the file is a  link,  information
		     about  the	 link  itself  rather  than the target file is
		     returned.	This option is required to make the link  ele‐
		     ment useful.

	      -n     Always  show  the names of files.	Usually these are only
		     shown when output is to standard output and there is more
		     than one file in the list.

	      -N     Never show the names of files.

	      -o     If a raw file mode is printed, show it in octal, which is
		     more useful for human consumption	than  the  default  of
		     decimal.	A  leading  zero will be printed in this case.
		     Note that this does not affect whether a raw or formatted
		     file  mode is shown, which is controlled by the -r and -s
		     options, nor whether a mode is shown at all.

	      -r     Print raw data (the default format) alongside string data
		     (the  -s  format); the string data appears in parentheses
		     after the raw data.

	      -s     Print mode, uid, gid  and	the  three  time  elements  as
		     strings  instead  of numbers.  In each case the format is
		     like that of ls -l.

	      -t     Always show the type names for  the  elements  of	struct
		     stat.   Usually  these  are  only shown when output is to
		     standard  output  and  no	individual  element  has  been
		     selected.

	      -T     Never show the type names of the struct stat elements.

THE ZSH/TERMCAP MODULE
       The zsh/termcap module makes available one builtin command:

       echotc cap [ arg ... ]
	      Output  the  termcap  value corresponding to the capability cap,
	      with optional arguments.

       The zsh/termcap module makes available one parameter:

       termcap
	      An associative array that maps termcap capability codes to their
	      values.

THE ZSH/TERMINFO MODULE
       The zsh/terminfo module makes available one builtin command:

       echoti cap
	      Output the terminfo value corresponding to the capability cap.

       The zsh/terminfo module makes available one parameter:

       terminfo
	      An  associative  array  that  maps  terminfo capability names to
	      their values.

THE ZSH/ZFTP MODULE
       The zsh/zftp module makes available one builtin command:

       zftp subcommand [ args ]
	      The zsh/zftp module is a client for FTP  (file  transfer	proto‐
	      col).  It is implemented as a builtin to allow full use of shell
	      command line editing, file  I/O,	and  job  control  mechanisms.
	      Often, users will access it via shell functions providing a more
	      powerful interface; a set is provided with the zsh  distribution
	      and is described in zshzftpsys(1).  However, the zftp command is
	      entirely usable in its own right.

	      All commands consist of the command name zftp  followed  by  the
	      name  of a subcommand.  These are listed below.  The return sta‐
	      tus of each subcommand is supposed to  reflect  the  success  or
	      failure of the remote operation.	See a description of the vari‐
	      able ZFTP_VERBOSE for more information on how responses from the
	      server may be printed.

   Subcommands
       open host [ user [ password [ account ] ] ]
	      Open  a  new  FTP	 session  to  host, which may be the name of a
	      TCP/IP connected host or an IP number in the standard dot	 nota‐
	      tion.   Remaining	 arguments are passed to the login subcommand.
	      Note that if no arguments beyond host are	 supplied,  open  will
	      not  automatically  call login.  If no arguments at all are sup‐
	      plied, open will use the parameters set by  the  params  subcom‐
	      mand.

	      After  a successful open, the shell variables ZFTP_HOST, ZFTP_IP
	      and ZFTP_SYSTEM are available; see `Variables' below.

       login [ name [ password [ account ] ] ]
       user [ name [ password [ account ] ] ]
	      Login the user name with parameters password and	account.   Any
	      of the parameters can be omitted, and will be read from standard
	      input if needed (name is always needed).	If standard input is a
	      terminal,	 a  prompt  for	 each  one will be printed on standard
	      error and password will not be echoed.  If any of the parameters
	      are not used, a warning message is printed.

	      After   a	 successful  login,  the  shell	 variables  ZFTP_USER,
	      ZFTP_ACCOUNT and ZFTP_PWD are available; see `Variables' below.

	      This command may be re-issued when a user is already logged  in,
	      and the server will first be reinitialized for a new user.

       params [ host [ user [ password [ account ] ] ] ]
       params -
	      Store  the  given	 parameters  for  a later open command with no
	      arguments.  Only those given on the command line will be	remem‐
	      bered.   If no arguments are given, the parameters currently set
	      are printed, although the password will  appear  as  a  line  of
	      stars;  the  return value is one if no parameters were set, zero
	      otherwise.

	      Any of the parameters may be specified as a `?', which may  need
	      to  be quoted to protect it from shell expansion.	 In this case,
	      the appropriate parameter will be read from stdin	 as  with  the
	      login  subcommand,  including  special handling of password.  If
	      the `?' is followed by a string, that is used as the prompt  for
	      reading the parameter instead of the default message (any neces‐
	      sary punctuation and whitespace should be included at the end of
	      the  prompt).   The  first letter of the parameter (only) may be
	      quoted with a `\'; hence an argument "\\$word"  guarantees  that
	      the string from the shell parameter $word will be treated liter‐
	      ally, whether or not it begins with a `?'.

	      If instead a single `-' is given, the  existing  parameters,  if
	      any,  are deleted.  In that case, calling open with no arguments
	      will cause an error.

	      The list of parameters is not deleted after a close, however  it
	      will be deleted if the zsh/zftp module is unloaded.

	      For example,

		     zftp params ftp.elsewhere.xx juser '?Password for juser: '

	      will store the host ftp.elsewhere.xx and the user juser and then
	      prompt the user for the corresponding password  with  the	 given
	      prompt.

       test   Test  the	 connection;  if  the  server has reported that it has
	      closed the connection (maybe due to a timeout), return status 2;
	      if  no  connection was open anyway, return status 1; else return
	      status 0.	 The test subcommand is silent,	 apart	from  messages
	      printed by the $ZFTP_VERBOSE mechanism, or error messages if the
	      connection closes.  There is no network overhead for this test.

	      The test is only supported on systems with either the  select(2)
	      or poll(2) system calls; otherwise the message `not supported on
	      this system' is printed instead.

	      The test subcommand will automatically be called at the start of
	      any  other  subcommand for the current session when a connection
	      is open.

       cd directory
	      Change the remote directory to directory.	 Also alters the shell
	      variable ZFTP_PWD.

       cdup   Change  the  remote directory to the one higher in the directory
	      tree.  Note that cd .. will also work correctly on non-UNIX sys‐
	      tems.

       dir [ args... ]
	      Give  a (verbose) listing of the remote directory.  The args are
	      passed directly to the server. The command's behaviour is imple‐
	      mentation	 dependent, but a UNIX server will typically interpret
	      args as arguments to the ls command and with no arguments return
	      the  result of `ls -l'. The directory is listed to standard out‐
	      put.

       ls [ args ]
	      Give a (short) listing of the remote directory.  With  no	 args,
	      produces a raw list of the files in the directory, one per line.
	      Otherwise, up to vagaries of the server implementation,  behaves
	      similar to dir.

       type [ type ]
	      Change  the  type for the transfer to type, or print the current
	      type if type is absent.  The allowed values are `A' (ASCII), `I'
	      (Image, i.e. binary), or `B' (a synonym for `I').

	      The FTP default for a transfer is ASCII.	However, if zftp finds
	      that the remote host is a UNIX machine with 8-bit byes, it  will
	      automatically  switch  to	 using	binary for file transfers upon
	      open.  This can subsequently be overridden.

	      The transfer type is only passed to the remote host when a  data
	      connection  is  established;  this  command  involves no network
	      overhead.

       ascii  The same as type A.

       binary The same as type I.

       mode [ S | B ]
	      Set the mode type to stream (S) or block (B).   Stream  mode  is
	      the default; block mode is not widely supported.

       remote files...
       local [ files... ]
	      Print the size and last modification time of the remote or local
	      files.  If there is more than one item on the list, the name  of
	      the  file	 is printed first.  The first number is the file size,
	      the second is the last modification time of the file in the for‐
	      mat  CCYYMMDDhhmmSS  consisting of year, month, date, hour, min‐
	      utes and seconds in GMT.	Note that this format,	including  the
	      length, is guaranteed, so that time strings can be directly com‐
	      pared via the [[ builtin's < and > operators, even if  they  are
	      too long to be represented as integers.

	      Not  all servers support the commands for retrieving this infor‐
	      mation.  In that case, the remote command will print nothing and
	      return status 2, compared with status 1 for a file not found.

	      The  local  command  (but	 not remote) may be used with no argu‐
	      ments, in which case the information comes from  examining  file
	      descriptor zero.	This is the same file as seen by a put command
	      with no further redirection.

       get file [...]
	      Retrieve all files from the server, concatenating them and send‐
	      ing them to standard output.

       put file [...]
	      For  each file, read a file from standard input and send that to
	      the remote host with the given name.

       append file [...]
	      As put, but if the remote file already exists, data is  appended
	      to it instead of overwriting it.

       getat file point
       putat file point
       appendat file point
	      Versions of get, put and append which will start the transfer at
	      the given point in the remote file.  This is useful for  append‐
	      ing  to an incomplete local file.	 However, note that this abil‐
	      ity is not universally supported by servers (and	is  not	 quite
	      the behaviour specified by the standard).

       delete file [...]
	      Delete the list of files on the server.

       mkdir directory
	      Create a new directory directory on the server.

       rmdir directory
	      Delete the directory directory  on the server.

       rename old-name new-name
	      Rename file old-name to new-name on the server.

       site args...
	      Send  a  host-specific command to the server.  You will probably
	      only need this if instructed by the server to use it.

       quote args...
	      Send the raw FTP command sequence to the server.	You should  be
	      familiar	with  the  FTP command set as defined in RFC959 before
	      doing this.  Useful commands may include STAT  and  HELP.	  Note
	      also  the	 mechanism for returning messages as described for the
	      variable ZFTP_VERBOSE below, in  particular  that	 all  messages
	      from the control connection are sent to standard error.

       close
       quit   Close the current data connection.  This unsets the shell param‐
	      eters ZFTP_HOST, ZFTP_IP, ZFTP_SYSTEM, ZFTP_USER,	 ZFTP_ACCOUNT,
	      ZFTP_PWD, ZFTP_TYPE and ZFTP_MODE.

       session [ sessname ]
	      Allows  multiple	FTP  sessions to be used at once.  The name of
	      the session is an arbitrary string of  characters;  the  default
	      session  is called `default'.  If this command is called without
	      an argument, it will list all  the  current  sessions;  with  an
	      argument,	 it  will either switch to the existing session called
	      sessname, or create a new session of that name.

	      Each session remembers the status of the connection, the set  of
	      connection-specific  shell parameters (the same set as are unset
	      when a connection closes, as given in the description of close),
	      and  any	user  parameters specified with the params subcommand.
	      Changing to a previous session restores those  values;  changing
	      to a new session initialises them in the same way as if zftp had
	      just been loaded.	 The name of the current session is  given  by
	      the parameter ZFTP_SESSION.

       rmsession [ sessname ]
	      Delete a session; if a name is not given, the current session is
	      deleted.	If the current session is deleted, the earliest exist‐
	      ing  session becomes the new current session, otherwise the cur‐
	      rent session is not changed.  If the session  being  deleted  is
	      the  only	 one,  a  new  session called `default' is created and
	      becomes the current session; note that this  is  a  new  session
	      even  if	the session being deleted is also called `default'. It
	      is recommended that sessions not	be  deleted  while  background
	      commands which use zftp are still active.

   Parameters
       The  following  shell  parameters  are used by zftp.  Currently none of
       them are special.

       ZFTP_TMOUT
	      Integer.	The time in seconds to wait for a network operation to
	      complete before returning an error.  If this is not set when the
	      module is loaded, it will be given  the  default	value  60.   A
	      value  of	 zero  turns off timeouts.  If a timeout occurs on the
	      control connection it will be closed.  Use  a  larger  value  if
	      this occurs too frequently.

       ZFTP_IP
	      Readonly.	 The IP address of the current connection in dot nota‐
	      tion.

       ZFTP_HOST
	      Readonly.	 The hostname of the current remote  server.   If  the
	      host  was	 opened	 as  an	 IP  number,  ZFTP_HOST	 contains that
	      instead; this saves the overhead for a name lookup, as  IP  num‐
	      bers are most commonly used when a nameserver is unavailable.

       ZFTP_SYSTEM
	      Readonly.	  The  system  type  string  returned by the server in
	      response to an FTP SYST request.	The most interesting case is a
	      string beginning "UNIX Type: L8", which ensures maximum compati‐
	      bility with a local UNIX host.

       ZFTP_TYPE
	      Readonly.	 The type to be used for data transfers ,  either  `A'
	      or `I'.	Use the type subcommand to change this.

       ZFTP_USER
	      Readonly.	 The username currently logged in, if any.

       ZFTP_ACCOUNT
	      Readonly.	  The  account name of the current user, if any.  Most
	      servers do not require an account name.

       ZFTP_PWD
	      Readonly.	 The current directory on the server.

       ZFTP_CODE
	      Readonly.	 The three digit code of the last FTP reply  from  the
	      server as a string.  This can still be read after the connection
	      is closed, and is not changed when the current session changes.

       ZFTP_REPLY
	      Readonly.	 The last line of the last reply sent by  the  server.
	      This  can	 still	be read after the connection is closed, and is
	      not changed when the current session changes.

       ZFTP_SESSION
	      Readonly.	 The name of the current FTP session; see the descrip‐
	      tion of the session subcommand.

       ZFTP_PREFS
	      A	 string	 of  preferences for altering aspects of zftp's behav‐
	      iour.  Each preference is a single character.  The following are
	      defined:

	      P	     Passive:  attempt to make the remote server initiate data
		     transfers.	 This is slightly more efficient than sendport
		     mode.   If	 the letter S occurs later in the string, zftp
		     will use sendport mode if passive mode is not available.

	      S	     Sendport:	initiate transfers by the  FTP	PORT  command.
		     If	 this  occurs before any P in the string, passive mode
		     will never be attempted.

	      D	     Dumb:  use only the bare minimum of FTP  commands.	  This
		     prevents  the  variables  ZFTP_SYSTEM  and	 ZFTP_PWD from
		     being set, and will mean all connections default to ASCII
		     type.   It	 may prevent ZFTP_SIZE from being set during a
		     transfer if the server does  not  send  it	 anyway	 (many
		     servers do).

	      If  ZFTP_PREFS is not set when zftp is loaded, it will be set to
	      a default of `PS', i.e. use passive mode if available, otherwise
	      fall back to sendport mode.

       ZFTP_VERBOSE
	      A	 string	 of digits between 0 and 5 inclusive, specifying which
	      responses from the server should be printed.  All	 responses  go
	      to  standard  error.  If any of the numbers 1 to 5 appear in the
	      string, raw responses from the server with reply codes beginning
	      with  that  digit	 will be printed to standard error.  The first
	      digit of the three digit reply code is defined by RFC959 to cor‐
	      respond to:

	      1.     A positive preliminary reply.

	      2.     A positive completion reply.

	      3.     A positive intermediate reply.

	      4.     A transient negative completion reply.

	      5.     A permanent negative completion reply.

	      It should be noted that, for unknown reasons, the reply `Service
	      not available', which forces termination	of  a  connection,  is
	      classified  as  421,  i.e.  `transient negative', an interesting
	      interpretation of the word `transient'.

	      The code 0 is special:  it indicates that all but the last  line
	      of  multiline  replies  read  from the server will be printed to
	      standard error in a processed format.   By  convention,  servers
	      use this mechanism for sending information for the user to read.
	      The appropriate reply code, if it	 matches  the  same  response,
	      takes priority.

	      If  ZFTP_VERBOSE	is not set when zftp is loaded, it will be set
	      to the default value 450, i.e., messages destined for  the  user
	      and  all	errors	will  be  printed.  A null string is valid and
	      specifies that no messages should be printed.

   Functions
       zftp_chpwd
	      If this function is set by the user, it is called every time the
	      directory changes on the server, including when a user is logged
	      in, or when a connection is closed.  In the last case, $ZFTP_PWD
	      will be unset; otherwise it will reflect the new directory.

       zftp_progress
	      If  this function is set by the user, it will be called during a
	      get, put or append operation each time sufficient data has  been
	      received from the host.  During a get, the data is sent to stan‐
	      dard output, so it is vital that this function should  write  to
	      standard error or directly to the terminal, not to standard out‐
	      put.

	      When it is called with a transfer	 in  progress,	the  following
	      additional shell parameters are set:

	      ZFTP_FILE
		     The name of the remote file being transferred from or to.

	      ZFTP_TRANSFER
		     A G for a get operation and a P for a put operation.

	      ZFTP_SIZE
		     The  total	 size  of the complete file being transferred:
		     the same as the first value provided by  the  remote  and
		     local  subcommands	 for a particular file.	 If the server
		     cannot  supply  this  value  for  a  remote  file	 being
		     retrieved,	 it  will not be set.  If input is from a pipe
		     the value may be incorrect and  correspond	 simply	 to  a
		     full pipe buffer.

	      ZFTP_COUNT
		     The  amount  of data so far transferred; a number between
		     zero and $ZFTP_SIZE, if that  is  set.   This  number  is
		     always available.

	      The  function  is initially called with ZFTP_TRANSFER set appro‐
	      priately and ZFTP_COUNT set to zero.  After the transfer is fin‐
	      ished,   the   function  will  be	 called	 one  more  time  with
	      ZFTP_TRANSFER set to GF or PF, in case it wishes to tidy up.  It
	      is   otherwise  never  called  twice  with  the  same  value  of
	      ZFTP_COUNT.

	      Sometimes the progress meter may cause disruption.  It is up  to
	      the user to decide whether the function should be defined and to
	      use unfunction when necessary.

   Problems
       A connection may not be opened in the left hand side of a pipe as  this
       occurs  in  a  subshell	and the file information is not updated in the
       main shell.  In the case of type or mode changes or closing the connec‐
       tion  in	 a subshell, the information is returned but variables are not
       updated until the next call to zftp.  Other status changes in subshells
       will not be reflected by changes to the variables (but should be other‐
       wise harmless).

       Deleting sessions while a zftp command is active in the background  can
       have  unexpected	 effects,  even	 if  it does not use the session being
       deleted.	 This is because all shell subprocesses share  information  on
       the state of all connections, and deleting a session changes the order‐
       ing of that information.

       On some operating systems, the control connection is not valid after  a
       fork(),	so  that  operations  in subshells, on the left hand side of a
       pipeline, or in the background are not possible,	 as  they  should  be.
       This is presumably a bug in the operating system.

THE ZSH/ZLE MODULE
       The zsh/zle module contains the Zsh Line Editor.	 See zshzle(1).

THE ZSH/ZLEPARAMETER MODULE
       The  zsh/zleparameter module defines two special parameters that can be
       used to access internal information of the Zsh Line  Editor  (see  zsh‐
       zle(1)).

       keymaps
	      This array contains the names of the keymaps currently defined.

       widgets
	      This  associative	 array	contains one entry per widget defined.
	      The name of the widget is the key and the value  gives  informa‐
	      tion  about  the	widget.	 It is either the string `builtin' for
	      builtin  widgets,	 a  string  of	the   form   `user:name'   for
	      user-defined  widgets, where name is the name of the shell func‐
	      tion implementing the widget, or it is  a	 string	 of  the  form
	      `completion:type:name', for completion widgets. In the last case
	      type is the name of the builtin widgets  the  completion	widget
	      imitates in its behavior and name is the name of the shell func‐
	      tion implementing the completion widget.

THE ZSH/ZPROF MODULE
       When loaded, the zsh/zprof causes shell functions to be profiled.   The
       profiling  results  can be obtained with the zprof builtin command made
       available by this module.  There is no way to turn profiling off	 other
       than unloading the module.

       zprof [ -c ]
	      Without the -c option, zprof lists profiling results to standard
	      output.  The format is  comparable  to  that  of	commands  like
	      gprof.

	      At  the  top  there is a summary listing all functions that were
	      called at least once.  This  summary  is	sorted	in  decreasing
	      order  of	 the  amount of time spent in each.  The lines contain
	      the number of the function in order,  which  is  used  in	 other
	      parts  of	 the list in suffixes of the form `[num]'.RE, then the
	      number of calls made to the function.  The  next	three  columns
	      list  the	 time  in  milliseconds	 spent in the function and its
	      descendents, the average time in milliseconds spent in the func‐
	      tion  and	 its  descendents  per call and the percentage of time
	      spent in all shell functions  used  in  this  function  and  its
	      descendents.  The following three columns give the same informa‐
	      tion, but counting only the time spent in the  function  itself.
	      The final column shows the name of the function.

	      After  the  summary,  detailed  information about every function
	      that was invoked is listed, sorted in decreasing	order  of  the
	      amount of time spent in each function and its descendents.  Each
	      of these entries consists of descriptions for the functions that
	      called  the  function  described,	 the  function itself, and the
	      functions that were called from it.   The	 description  for  the
	      function itself has the same format as in the summary (and shows
	      the same information).  The other lines don't show the number of
	      the  function  at	 the  beginning	 and have their function named
	      indented to make it easier to distinguish the line  showing  the
	      function described in the section from the surrounding lines.

	      The  information shown in this case is almost the same as in the
	      summary, but only refers to the call hierarchy being  displayed.
	      For example, for a calling function the column showing the total
	      running time lists the time spent in the described function  and
	      its  descendents only for the times when it was called from that
	      particular calling function.  Likewise, for a  called  function,
	      this  columns  lists the total time spent in the called function
	      and its descendents only for the times when it was  called  from
	      the function described.

	      Also  in	this case, the column showing the number of calls to a
	      function also shows a slash and then the total number of invoca‐
	      tions made to the called function.

	      As  long	as  the	 zsh/zprof module is loaded, profiling will be
	      done and multiple invocations of the zprof builtin command  will
	      show the times and numbers of calls since the module was loaded.
	      With the -c option, the zprof builtin  command  will  reset  its
	      internal counters and will not show the listing.	)

THE ZSH/ZPTY MODULE
       The zsh/zpty module offers one builtin:

       zpty [ -e ] [ -b ] name [ arg ... ]
	      The  arguments  following	 name  are  concatenated  with	spaces
	      between, then executed as a command, as if passed	 to  the  eval
	      builtin.	 The command runs under a newly assigned pseudo-termi‐
	      nal; this is useful for running commands non-interactively which
	      expect  an interactive environment.  The name is not part of the
	      command, but is used to refer to this command in later calls  to
	      zpty.

	      With  the -e option, the pseudo-terminal is set up so that input
	      characters are echoed.

	      With the -b option, input to and output from the pseudo-terminal
	      are made non-blocking.

       zpty -d [ names ... ]
	      The  second form, with the -d option, is used to delete commands
	      previously started, by supplying a list of their names.	If  no
	      names  are  given, all commands are deleted.  Deleting a command
	      causes the HUP signal to be sent to the corresponding process.

       zpty -w [ -n ] name [ strings ... ]
	      The -w option can be used to send the to command name the	 given
	      strings as input (separated by spaces).  If the -n option is not
	      given, a newline is added at the end.

	      If no strings are provided, the standard input is copied to  the
	      pseudo-terminal;	this may stop before copying the full input if
	      the pseudo-terminal is non-blocking.

	      Note that the command under the pseudo-terminal sees this	 input
	      as  if  it were typed, so beware when sending special tty driver
	      characters such as word-erase, line-kill, and end-of-file.

       zpty -r [ -t ] name [ param [ pattern ] ]
	      The -r option can be used to read	 the  output  of  the  command
	      name.   With  only a name argument, the output read is copied to
	      the standard output.  Unless the pseudo-terminal	is  non-block‐
	      ing, copying continues until the command under the pseudo-termi‐
	      nal exits; when non-blocking, only as much output as is  immedi‐
	      ately available is copied.  The return value is zero if any out‐
	      put is copied.

	      When also given a param argument, at most one line is  read  and
	      stored  in the parameter named param.  Less than a full line may
	      be read if the  pseudo-terminal  is  non-blocking.   The	return
	      value is zero if at least one character is stored in param.

	      If  a  pattern  is given as well, output is read until the whole
	      string read matches the pattern, even in the non-blocking	 case.
	      The return value is zero if the string read matches the pattern,
	      or if the command has exited but at least	 one  character	 could
	      still be read.  As of this writing, a maximum of one megabyte of
	      output can be consumed this way; if  a  full  megabyte  is  read
	      without matching the pattern, the return value is non-zero.

	      In  all  cases, the return value is non-zero if nothing could be
	      read, and is 2 if this is because the command has finished.

	      If the -r option is combined with	 the  -t  option,  zpty	 tests
	      whether output is available before trying to read.  If no output
	      is available, zpty immediately returns the value 1.

       zpty -t name
	      The -t option without the -r option can be used to test  whether
	      the  command  name is still running.  It returns a zero value if
	      the command is running and a non-zero value otherwise.

       zpty [ -L ]
	      The last form, without any arguments, is used to list  the  com‐
	      mands  currently	defined.   If  the -L option is given, this is
	      done in the form of calls to the zpty builtin.

THE ZSH/ZUTIL MODULE
       The zsh/zutil module only adds some builtins:

       zstyle [ -L ]
       zstyle [ -e | - | -- ] pattern style strings ...
       zstyle -d [ pattern [ styles ... ] ]
       zstyle -g name [ pattern [ style ] ]
       zstyle -abs context style name [ sep ]
       zstyle -Tt context style [ strings ...]
       zstyle -m context style pattern
	      This builtin command  is	used  to  define  and  lookup  styles.
	      Styles  are  pairs of names and values, where the values consist
	      of any number of strings.	 They are stored  together  with  pat‐
	      terns  and  lookup  is done by giving a string, called the `con‐
	      text', which is compared to the patterns.	 The definition stored
	      for the first matching pattern will be returned.

	      For  ordering  of	 comparisons,  patterns are searched from most
	      specific to least specific, and patterns that are	 equally  spe‐
	      cific  keep  the order in which they were defined.  A pattern is
	      considered to be more specific than another if it contains  more
	      components  (substrings  separated by colons) or if the patterns
	      for the components are more specific, where simple  strings  are
	      considered  to  be  more specific than patterns and complex pat‐
	      terns are considered to be more specific than the pattern `*'.

	      The first form (without arguments) lists the definitions in  the
	      order  zstyle will test them. If the -L option is given, listing
	      is done in the form of calls to zstyle.  Forms with arguments:

	      zstyle [ - | -- | -e ] pattern style strings ...
		     Defines the given style for the pattern with the  strings
		     as	 the  value.   If  the -e option is given, the strings
		     will  be  concatenated  (separated	 by  spaces)  and  the
		     resulting string will be evaluated (in the same way as it
		     is done by the eval builtin command) when	the  style  is
		     looked  up.   In  this case the parameter `reply' must be
		     assigned to set the strings returned  after  the  evalua‐
		     tion.   Before  evaluating the value, reply is unset, and
		     if it is still unset after the evaluation, the  style  is
		     treated as if it were not set.

	      zstyle -d [ pattern [ styles ... ] ]
		     Delete  style  definitions. Without arguments all defini‐
		     tions are deleted, with a	pattern	 all  definitions  for
		     that  pattern  are	 deleted  and if any styles are given,
		     then only those styles are deleted for the pattern.

	      zstyle -g name [ pattern [ style ] ]
		     Retrieve a style definition. The name is used as the name
		     of	 an array in which the results are stored. Without any
		     further arguments, all  patterns  defined	are  returned.
		     With  a  pattern  the styles defined for that pattern are
		     returned and with both a pattern and a style,  the	 value
		     strings of that combination is returned.

	      The other forms can be used to look up or test patterns.

	      zstyle -s context style name [ sep ]
		     The  parameter  name  is  set  to	the value of the style
		     interpreted as a string.  If the value  contains  several
		     strings  they  are	 concatenated with spaces (or with the
		     sep string if that is given) between them.

	      zstyle -b context style name
		     The value is stored in name as a  boolean,	 i.e.  as  the
		     string  `yes'  if	the value has only one string and that
		     string is equal to one of `yes', `true', `on', or `1'. If
		     the  value	 is  any  other	 string	 or  has more than one
		     string, the parameter is set to `no'.

	      zstyle -a context style name
		     The value is stored in name  as  an  array.  If  name  is
		     declared as an associative array,	the first, third, etc.
		     strings are used as the keys and the  other  strings  are
		     used as the values.

	      zstyle -t context style [ strings ...]
	      zstyle -T context style [ strings ...]
		     Test  the	value  of  a  style,  i.e.  the -t option only
		     returns a status (sets  $?).   Without  any  strings  the
		     return  status  is	 zero  if  the style is defined for at
		     least one matching pattern, has only one  string  in  its
		     value, and that is equal to one of `true', `yes', `on' or
		     `1'. If any strings are given the status is zero  if  and
		     only  if at least one of the strings is equal to at least
		     one of the strings in the value.  If  the	style  is  not
		     defined, the status is 2.

		     The  -T option tests the values of the style like -t, but
		     it returns zero (rather than  2)  if  the	style  is  not
		     defined for any matching pattern.

	      zstyle -m context style pattern
		     Match a value. Returns status zero if the pattern matches
		     at least one of the strings in the value.

       zformat -f param format specs ...
       zformat -a array sep specs ...
	      This builtin provides two different  forms  of  formatting.  The
	      first form is selected with the -f option. In this case the for‐
	      mat string will be modified by replacing sequences starting with
	      a	 percent  sign	in  it with strings from the specs.  Each spec
	      should be of the	form  `char:string'  which  will  cause	 every
	      appearance  of  the sequence `%char' in format to be replaced by
	      the string.  The `%' sequence may also contain optional  minimum
	      and  maximum  field width specifications between the `%' and the
	      `char' in the form `%min.maxc', i.e. the minimum field width  is
	      given first and if the maximum field width is used, it has to be
	      preceded by a dot.  Specifying a minimum field width  makes  the
	      result  be  padded  with	spaces	to  the right if the string is
	      shorter than the requested width.	 Padding to the	 left  can  be
	      achieved by giving a negative minimum field width.  If a maximum
	      field width is specified, the string  will  be  truncated	 after
	      that  many  characters.	After  all `%' sequences for the given
	      specs have been processed, the resulting string is stored in the
	      parameter param.

	      The  second  form, using the -a option, can be used for aligning
	      strings.	Here, the specs are of	the  form  `left:right'	 where
	      `left'  and  `right'  are	 arbitrary strings.  These strings are
	      modified by replacing the colons by the sep string  and  padding
	      the  left	 strings  with	spaces	to  the	 right so that the sep
	      strings in the result (and hence the right strings  after	 them)
	      are  all	aligned	 if  the strings are printed below each other.
	      All strings without a colon are left unchanged and  all  strings
	      with  an empty right string have the trailing colon removed.  In
	      both cases the lengths of the strings are not used to  determine
	      how  the other strings are to be aligned.	 The resulting strings
	      are stored in the array.

       zregexparse
	      This implements some internals of the _regex_arguments function.

       zparseopts [ -D ] [ -K ] [ -E ] [ -a array ] [ -A assoc ] specs
	      This builtin simplifies the parsing  of  options	in  positional
	      parameters,  i.e.	 the  set of arguments given by $*.  Each spec
	      describes one option and must be of the form `opt[=array]'.   If
	      an option described by opt is found in the positional parameters
	      it is copied into the array specified with the -a option; if the
	      optional	`=array'  is  given,  it  is  instead copied into that
	      array.

	      Note that it is an error to give any spec	 without  an  `=array'
	      unless one of the -a or -A options is used.

	      Unless the -E option is given, parsing stops at the first string
	      that isn't described by one of the specs.	 Even with -E, parsing
	      always stops at a positional parameter equal to `-' or `--'.

	      The  opt	description  must be one of the following.  Any of the
	      special characters can appear in the option name provided it  is
	      preceded by a backslash.

	      name
	      name+  The  name	is  the name of the option without the leading
		     `-'.  To specify a GNU-style  long	 option,  one  of  the
		     usual two leading `-' must be included in name; for exam‐
		     ple, a `--file'  option  is  represented  by  a  name  of
		     `-file'.

		     If	 a  `+'	 appears after name, the option is appended to
		     array each time it is found in the positional parameters;
		     without the `+' only the last occurrence of the option is
		     preserved.

		     If one of these forms is used, the option takes no	 argu‐
		     ment,  so	parsing stops if the next positional parameter
		     does not also begin with `-' (unless  the	-E  option  is
		     used).

	      name:
	      name:-
	      name:: If one or two colons are given, the option takes an argu‐
		     ment; with one colon, the argument is mandatory and  with
		     two  colons  it is optional.  The argument is appended to
		     the array after the option itself.

		     An optional argument is put into the same	array  element
		     as the option name (note that this makes empty strings as
		     arguments indistinguishable).  A  mandatory  argument  is
		     added as a separate element unless the `:-' form is used,
		     in which case the argument is put into the same element.

		     A `+' as described above may appear between the name  and
		     the first colon.

       The options of zparseopts itself are:

       -a array
	      As  described  above,  this  names the default array in which to
	      store the recognised options.

       -A assoc
	      If this is given, the options and their values are also put into
	      an associative array with the option names as keys and the argu‐
	      ments (if any) as the values.

       -D     If this option is given, all options found are removed from  the
	      positional parameters of the calling shell or shell function, up
	      to but not including any not described by the  specs.   This  is
	      similar to using the shift builtin.

       -K     With  this  option,  the	arrays	specified  with	 the -a and -A
	      options and with the `=array' forms are kept unchanged when none
	      of  the  specs  for  them	 is  used.   This allows assignment of
	      default values to them before calling zparseopts.

       -E     This changes the parsing rules to not stop at the	 first	string
	      that  isn't  described  by  one of the specs.  It can be used to
	      test for or (if used together with -D) extract options and their
	      arguments,  ignoring all other options and arguments that may be
	      in the positional parameters.

       For example,

	      set -- -a -bx -c y -cz baz -cend
	      zparseopts a=foo b:=bar c+:=bar

       will have the effect of

	      foo=(-a)
	      bar=(-b x -c y -c z)

       The arguments from `baz' on will not be used.

       As an example for the -E option, consider:

	      set -- -a x -b y -c z arg1 arg2
	      zparseopts -E -D b:=bar

       will have the effect of

	      bar=(-b y)
	      set -- -a x -c z arg1 arg2

       I.e., the option -b and its arguments are  taken	 from  the  positional
       parameters and put into the array bar.

ZSHZFTPSYS(1)							 ZSHZFTPSYS(1)

NAME
       zshzftpsys - zftp function front-end

DESCRIPTION
       This describes the set of shell functions supplied with the source dis‐
       tribution as an interface to the zftp builtin command, allowing you  to
       perform	FTP operations from the shell command line or within functions
       or scripts.  The interface is similar to a traditional FTP client (e.g.
       the  ftp command itself, see ftp(1)), but as it is entirely done within
       the shell all the familiar completion, editing and  globbing  features,
       and  so on, are present, and macros are particularly simple to write as
       they are just ordinary shell functions.

       The prerequisite is that the zftp  command,  as	described  in  zshmod‐
       ules(1)	,  must	 be  available in the version of zsh installed at your
       site.  If the shell is configured to load new commands at run time,  it
       probably	 is:  typing  `zmodload zsh/zftp' will make sure (if that runs
       silently, it has worked).  If this is not the case, it is possible zftp
       was  linked  into the shell anyway: to test this, type `which zftp' and
       if zftp is available you will get the  message  `zftp:  shell  built-in
       command'.

       Commands	 given	directly with zftp builtin may be interspersed between
       the functions in this suite; in a few cases, using  zftp	 directly  may
       cause  some  of	the  status  information stored in shell parameters to
       become invalid.	Note in particular the description  of	the  variables
       $ZFTP_TMOUT, $ZFTP_PREFS and $ZFTP_VERBOSE for zftp.

INSTALLATION
       You  should  make sure all the functions from the Functions/Zftp direc‐
       tory of the source distribution are available; they all begin with  the
       two letters `zf'.  They may already have been installed on your system;
       otherwise, you will need to find them and  copy	them.	The  directory
       should  appear  as one of the elements of the $fpath array (this should
       already be the case if they were installed), and at least the  function
       zfinit  should  be  autoloaded; it will autoload the rest.  Finally, to
       initialize the use of the system you need to call the zfinit  function.
       The  following  code  in	 your .zshrc will arrange for this; assume the
       functions are stored in the directory ~/myfns:

	      fpath=(~/myfns $fpath)
	      autoload -U zfinit
	      zfinit

       Note that zfinit assumes you are using the zmodload method to load  the
       zftp  command.  If it is already built into the shell, change zfinit to
       zfinit -n.  It is helpful (though not essential) if the call to	zfinit
       appears	after  any  code to initialize the new completion system, else
       unnecessary compctl commands will be given.

FUNCTIONS
       The sequence of operations in performing a file transfer is essentially
       the  same  as that in a standard FTP client.  Note that, due to a quirk
       of the shell's getopts builtin, for those functions that handle options
       you must use `--' rather than `-' to ensure the remaining arguments are
       treated literally (a single `-' is treated as an argument).

   Opening a connection
       zfparams [ host [ user [ password ... ] ] ]
	      Set or show the parameters for a future  zfopen  with  no	 argu‐
	      ments.   If  no  arguments are given, the current parameters are
	      displayed (the password will be shown as a line  of  asterisks).
	      If a host is given, and either the user or password is not, they
	      will be prompted for; also, any parameter given as `?'  will  be
	      prompted	for, and if the `?' is followed by a string, that will
	      be used as the prompt.  As zfopen calls zfparams	to  store  the
	      parameters, this usually need not be called directly.

	      A	 single	 argument `-' will delete the stored parameters.  This
	      will also cause the memory of the last directory (and so on)  on
	      the other host to be deleted.

       zfopen [ -1 ] [ host [ user [ password [ account ] ] ] ]
	      If  host	is present, open a connection to that host under user‐
	      name user with password password (and,  on  the  rare  occasions
	      when  it is necessary, account account).	If a necessary parame‐
	      ter is missing or given as `?' it will be prompted for.  If host
	      is not present, use a previously stored set of parameters.

	      If  the  command	was successful, and the terminal is compatible
	      with xterm or is sun-cmd, a summary will	appear	in  the	 title
	      bar,  giving the local host:directory and the remote host:direc‐
	      tory; this is handled  by	 the  function	zftp_chpwd,  described
	      below.

	      Normally,	 the  host,  user and password are internally recorded
	      for later re-opening, either by a zfopen with no	arguments,  or
	      automatically (see below).  With the option `-1', no information
	      is stored.  Also, if an open command with arguments failed,  the
	      parameters  will	not  be	 retained (and any previous parameters
	      will also be deleted).  A zfopen on its own,  or	a  zfopen  -1,
	      never alters the stored parameters.

	      Both zfopen and zfanon (but not zfparams) understand URLs of the
	      form ftp://host/path... as meaning to connect to the host,  then
	      change  directory	 to  path  (which  must	 be a directory, not a
	      file).  The `ftp://' can be omitted; the trailing `/' is	enough
	      to  trigger  recognition	of the path.  Note prefixes other than
	      `ftp:' are not recognized, and that  all	characters  after  the
	      first slash beyond host are significant in path.

       zfanon [ -1 ] host
	      Open  a connection host for anonymous FTP.  The username used is
	      `anonymous'.  The password (which will  be  reported  the	 first
	      time)  is	 generated  as	user@host;  this is then stored in the
	      shell parameter $EMAIL_ADDR which can alternatively be set manu‐
	      ally to a suitable string.

   Directory management
       zfcd [ dir ]
       zfcd -
       zfcd old new
	      Change  the  current  directory  on  the remote server:  this is
	      implemented to have many of the features of  the	shell  builtin
	      cd.

	      In the first form with dir present, change to the directory dir.
	      The command `zfcd ..' is treated specially, so is guaranteed  to
	      work  on	non-UNIX  servers  (note this is handled internally by
	      zftp).  If dir is omitted, has the effect of `zfcd ~'.

	      The second form changes to the directory previously current.

	      The third form attempts  to  change  the	current	 directory  by
	      replacing the first occurrence of the string old with the string
	      new in the current directory.

	      Note that in this command, and indeed anywhere a remote filename
	      is  expected,  the string which on the local host corresponds to
	      `~' is converted back to a `~' before being passed to the remote
	      machine.	 This  is  convenient  because of the way expansion is
	      performed on the command line before  zfcd  receives  a  string.
	      For  example,  suppose  the  command is `zfcd ~/foo'.  The shell
	      will   expand   this   to	  a   full   path   such   as	 `zfcd
	      /home/user2/pws/foo'.   At  this stage, zfcd recognises the ini‐
	      tial path as corresponding to `~' and will send the directory to
	      the  remote  host	 as ~/foo, so that the `~' will be expanded by
	      the server to the correct remote host  directory.	  Other	 named
	      directories of the form `~name' are not treated in this fashion.

       zfhere Change  directory	 on the remote server to the one corresponding
	      to the current local directory, with special handling of `~'  as
	      in  zfcd.	  For  example,	 if  the  current  local  directory is
	      ~/foo/bar, then zfhere performs the effect of `zfcd ~/foo/bar'.

       zfdir [ -rfd ] [ - ] [ dir-options ] [ dir ]
	      Produce a long directory listing.	 The arguments dir-options and
	      dir are passed directly to the server and their effect is imple‐
	      mentation dependent, but specifying a particular	remote	direc‐
	      tory  dir	 is  usually possible.	The output is passed through a
	      pager given by the environment variable $PAGER or defaulting  to
	      `more'.

	      The directory is usually cached for re-use.  In fact, two caches
	      are maintained.  One is for use when there is no dir-options  or
	      dir,  i.e. a full listing of the current remote directory; it is
	      flushed when the current remote directory changes.  The other is
	      kept  for	 repeated  use	of  zfdir with the same arguments; for
	      example, repeated use of `zfdir /pub/gnu' will only require  the
	      directory	 to  be	 retrieved  on the first call.	Alternatively,
	      this cache can be re-viewed with the  -r	option.	  As  relative
	      directories  will	 confuse  zfdir,  the -f option can be used to
	      force the cache to be flushed before the	directory  is  listed.
	      The  option  -d will delete both caches without showing a direc‐
	      tory listing; it will also delete the cache of file names in the
	      current remote directory, if any.

       zfls [ ls-options ] [ dir ]
	      List  files  on the remote server.  With no arguments, this will
	      produce a simple list of	file  names  for  the  current	remote
	      directory.  Any arguments are passed directly to the server.  No
	      pager and no caching is used.

   Status commands
       zftype [ type ]
	      With no arguments, show the type of data to be transferred, usu‐
	      ally  ASCII  or  binary.	With an argument, change the type: the
	      types `A' or `ASCII' for ASCII data and `B' or `BINARY', `I'  or
	      `IMAGE' for binary data are understood case-insensitively.

       zfstat [ -v ]
	      Show  the	 status	 of the current or last connection, as well as
	      the status of some of zftp's  status  variables.	 With  the  -v
	      option,  a  more	verbose	 listing  is  produced by querying the
	      server for its version of events, too.

   Retrieving files
       The commands for retrieving files all take at  least  two  options.  -G
       suppresses remote filename expansion which would otherwise be performed
       (see below for a more detailed description of that).   -t  attempts  to
       set the modification time of the local file to that of the remote file:
       this requires version 5 of perl, see the description  of	 the  function
       zfrtime below for more information.

       zfget [ -Gtc ] file1 ...
	      Retrieve	all  the listed files file1 ... one at a time from the
	      remote server.  If a file contains  a  `/',  the	full  name  is
	      passed  to  the  remote  server,	but the file is stored locally
	      under the name given by the  part	 after	the  final  `/'.   The
	      option  -c  (cat) forces all files to be sent as a single stream
	      to standard output; in this case the -t option has no effect.

       zfuget [ -Gvst ] file1 ...
	      As zfget, but only retrieve  files  where	 the  version  on  the
	      remote server is newer (has a later modification time), or where
	      the local file does not exist.  If the remote file is older  but
	      the files have different sizes, or if the sizes are the same but
	      the remote file is newer, the  user  will	 usually  be  queried.
	      With  the	 option	 -s, the command runs silently and will always
	      retrieve the file in either of those two cases.  With the option
	      -v, the command prints more information about the files while it
	      is working out whether or not to transfer them.

       zfcget [ -Gt ] file1 ...
	      As zfget, but if any of the local files exists, and  is  shorter
	      than  the corresponding remote file, the command assumes that it
	      is the result of a partially completed transfer and attempts  to
	      transfer the rest of the file.  This is useful on a poor connec‐
	      tion which keeps failing.

	      Note that this requires a commonly  implemented,	but  non-stan‐
	      dard,  version of the FTP protocol, so is not guaranteed to work
	      on all servers.

       zfgcp [ -Gt ] remote-file local-file
       zfgcp [ -Gt ] rfile1 ... ldir
	      This retrieves files  from  the  remote  server  with  arguments
	      behaving similarly to the cp command.

	      In the first form, copy remote-file from the server to the local
	      file local-file.

	      In the second form, copy all the remote files  rfile1  ...  into
	      the  local  directory  ldir  retaining the same basenames.  This
	      assumes UNIX directory semantics.

   Sending files
       zfput [ -r ] file1 ...
	      Send all the file1 ... given separately to  the  remote  server.
	      If  a filename contains a `/', the full filename is used locally
	      to find the file, but only the basename is used for  the	remote
	      file name.

	      With the option -r, if any of the files are directories they are
	      sent recursively with all their subdirectories, including	 files
	      beginning	 with  `.'.   This  requires  that  the remote machine
	      understand UNIX file semantics, since `/' is used as a directory
	      separator.

       zfuput [ -vs ] file1 ...
	      As  zfput,  but only send files which are newer than their local
	      equivalents, or if the remote file does not exist.  The logic is
	      the  same	 as  for zfuget, but reversed between local and remote
	      files.

       zfcput file1 ...
	      As zfput, but if any remote file already exists and  is  shorter
	      than  the local equivalent, assume it is the result of an incom‐
	      plete transfer and send the rest of the file to  append  to  the
	      existing	part.	As the FTP append command is part of the stan‐
	      dard set, this is in principle more likely to work than zfcget.

       zfpcp local-file remote-file
       zfpcp lfile1 ... rdir
	      This sends files to the remote server  with  arguments  behaving
	      similarly to the cp command.

	      With   two   arguments,	copy   local-file  to  the  server  as
	      remote-file.

	      With more than two arguments, copy all the  local	 files	lfile1
	      ...  into	 the existing remote directory rdir retaining the same
	      basenames.  This assumes UNIX directory semantics.

	      A problem arises if you attempt to use zfpcp lfile1  rdir,  i.e.
	      the  second  form of copying but with two arguments, as the com‐
	      mand has no simple way of	 knowing  if  rdir  corresponds	 to  a
	      directory or a filename.	It attempts to resolve this in various
	      ways.  First, if the rdir argument is `.' or `..' or ends	 in  a
	      slash, it is assumed to be a directory.  Secondly, if the opera‐
	      tion of copying to a remote file in the first form  failed,  and
	      the remote server sends back the expected failure code 553 and a
	      reply including the string `Is a	directory',  then  zfpcp  will
	      retry using the second form.

   Closing the connection
       zfclose
	      Close the connection.

   Session management
       zfsession [ -lvod ] [ sessname ]
	      Allows you to manage multiple FTP sessions at once.  By default,
	      connections take place in a session called `default'; by	giving
	      the  command  `zfsession	sessname'  you	can change to a new or
	      existing session with a name of your choice.   The  new  session
	      remembers its own connection, as well as associated shell param‐
	      eters, and also the host/user parameters set by zfparams.	 Hence
	      you  can	have different sessions set up to connect to different
	      hosts, each remembering the appropriate host, user and password.

	      With no arguments, zfsession prints the name of the current ses‐
	      sion;  with  the option -l it lists all sessions which currently
	      exist, and with the option -v it gives a	verbose	 list  showing
	      the  host and directory for each session, where the current ses‐
	      sion is marked with an asterisk.	With -o, it will switch to the
	      most recent previous session.

	      With -d, the given session (or else the current one) is removed;
	      everything to do with it is completely forgotten.	 If it was the
	      only session, a new session called `default' is created and made
	      current.	It is safest not to delete sessions  while  background
	      commands using zftp are active.

       zftransfer sess1:file1 sess2:file2
	      Transfer files between two sessions; no local copy is made.  The
	      file is read from the session sess1 as file1 and written to ses‐
	      sion sess1 as file file2; file1 and file2 may be relative to the
	      current directories of the session.  Either sess1 or  sess2  may
	      be  omitted  (though  the colon should be retained if there is a
	      possibility of a colon appearing in the file name) and  defaults
	      to  the  current session; file2 may be omitted or may end with a
	      slash, in which case the basename of file1 will be  added.   The
	      sessions sess1 and sess2 must be distinct.

	      The  operation  is performed using pipes, so it is required that
	      the connections still be valid in a subshell, which is  not  the
	      case  under some versions operating systems, presumably due to a
	      system bug.

   Bookmarks
       The two functions zfmark and zfgoto allow you to `bookmark' the present
       location	 (host,	 user and directory) of the current FTP connection for
       later use.  The file to be used for storing and retrieving bookmarks is
       given  by  the  parameter  $ZFTP_BMFILE; if not set when one of the two
       functions is called, it will be set  to	the  file  .zfbkmarks  in  the
       directory where your zsh startup files live (usually ~).

       zfmark [ bookmark ]
	      If  given an argument, mark the current host, user and directory
	      under the name bookmark for later use by zfgoto.	If there is no
	      connection  open, use the values for the last connection immedi‐
	      ately before it was closed; it is an error  if  there  is	 none.
	      Any  existing  bookmark  under  the  same	 name will be silently
	      replaced.

	      If not given an argument, list the existing  bookmarks  and  the
	      points to which they refer in the form user@host:directory; this
	      is the format in which they are stored,  and  the	 file  may  be
	      edited directly.

       zfgoto [ -n ] bookmark
	      Return  to  the location given by bookmark, as previously set by
	      zfmark.  If the location has user `ftp' or `anonymous', open the
	      connection with zfanon, so that no password is required.	If the
	      user and host parameters match those stored for the current ses‐
	      sion,  if	 any,  those  will  be	used, and again no password is
	      required.	 Otherwise a password will be prompted for.

	      With the option -n, the bookmark	is  taken  to  be  a  nickname
	      stored  by  the  ncftp  program  in  its bookmark file, which is
	      assumed to be ~/.ncftp/bookmarks.	 The  function	works  identi‐
	      cally in other ways.  Note that there is no mechanism for adding
	      or modifying ncftp bookmarks from the zftp functions.

   Other functions
       Mostly, these  functions	 will  not  be	called	directly  (apart  from
       zfinit),	 but  are  described  here  for completeness.  You may wish to
       alter zftp_chpwd and zftp_progress, in particular.

       zfinit [ -n ]
	      As described above, this is used to initialize the zftp function
	      system.	The  -n	 option	 should be used if the zftp command is
	      already built into the shell.

       zfautocheck [ -dn ]
	      This function is called to implement automatic reopening	behav‐
	      iour,  as	 described  in	more  detail  below.  The options must
	      appear in the first  argument;  -n  prevents  the	 command  from
	      changing to the old directory, while -d prevents it from setting
	      the variable do_close, which it otherwise does  as  a  flag  for
	      automatically closing the connection after a transfer.  The host
	      and directory for the last session are stored  in	 the  variable
	      $zflastsession,  but  the internal host/user/password parameters
	      must also be correctly set.

       zfcd_match prefix suffix
	      This performs matching for completion of remote directory names.
	      If  the  remote  server is UNIX, it will attempt to persuade the
	      server to list the remote directory with subdirectories  marked,
	      which  usually  works  but is not guaranteed.  On other hosts it
	      simply calls zfget_match and hence completes all files, not just
	      directories.   On	 some  systems,	 directories may not even look
	      like filenames.

       zfget_match prefix suffix
	      This performs matching for completion of remote  filenames.   It
	      caches  files  for  the  current	directory  (only) in the shell
	      parameter $zftp_fcache.  It is in the form to be called  by  the
	      -K  option  of  compctl,	but also works when called from a wid‐
	      get-style completion function with prefix and suffix set	appro‐
	      priately.

       zfrglob varname
	      Perform  remote  globbing,  as  describes	 in more detail below.
	      varname is the name of a variable containing the pattern	to  be
	      expanded;	 if  there were any matches, the same variable will be
	      set to the expanded set of filenames on return.

       zfrtime lfile rfile [ time ]
	      Set the local file lfile to have the same modification  time  as
	      the  remote  file rfile, or the explicit time time in FTP format
	      CCYYMMDDhhmmSS for the GMT timezone.

	      Currently this requires perl version 5 to perform the conversion
	      from  GMT	 to local time.	 This is unfortunately difficult to do
	      using shell code alone.

       zftp_chpwd
	      This function is called every time a connection  is  opened,  or
	      closed,  or  the	remote directory changes.  This version alters
	      the title bar of an xterm-compatible or sun-cmd terminal	emula‐
	      tor to reflect the local and remote hostnames and current direc‐
	      tories.  It works best when combined with	 the  function	chpwd.
	      In particular, a function of the form

		     chpwd() {
		       if [[ -n $ZFTP_USER ]]; then
			 zftp_chpwd
		       else
			 # usual chpwd e.g put host:directory in title bar
		       fi
		     }

	      fits in well.

       zftp_progress
	      This  function  shows  the  status of the transfer.  It will not
	      write anything unless the output is going to  a  terminal;  how‐
	      ever,  if	 you transfer files in the background, you should turn
	      off progress reports by hand using  `zstyle  ':zftp:*'  progress
	      none'.   Note  also  that if you alter it, any output must be to
	      standard error, as standard output may be a file being received.
	      The  form	 of  the progress meter, or whether it is used at all,
	      can be configured without altering the function, as described in
	      the next section.

       zffcache
	      This is used to implement caching of files in the current direc‐
	      tory for each session separately.	 It is used by zfget_match and
	      zfrglob.

MISCELLANEOUS FEATURES
   Configuration
       Various	styles are available using the standard shell style mechanism,
       described in zshmodules(1).  Briefly,  the  command  `zstyle  ':zftp:*'
       style value ...'.  defines the style to have value value (more than one
       may be given, although that is not useful in the cases described here).
       These  values  will  then  be used throughout the zftp function system.
       For more precise control, the first argument, which gives a context  in
       which  the style applies, can be modified to include a particular func‐
       tion, as for example `:zftp:zfget': the style will then have the	 given
       value only in the zfget function.  Values for the same style in differ‐
       ent contexts may be set; the most specific function will be used, where
       strings are held to be more specific than patterns, and longer patterns
       and shorter patterns.  Note that only the top level function  name,  as
       called by the user, is used; calling of lower level functions is trans‐
       parent to the user.  Hence modifications to the title bar in zftp_chpwd
       use the contexts :zftp:zfopen, :zftp:zfcd, etc., depending where it was
       called from.  The following styles are understood:

       progress
	      Controls the way that zftp_progress reports on the progress of a
	      transfer.	  If  empty,  unset,  or `none', no progress report is
	      made; if `bar' a growing bar of inverse video is shown; if `per‐
	      cent'  (or  any other string, though this may change in future),
	      the percentage of the file transferred is shown.	The bar	 meter
	      requires	that  the  width  of the terminal be available via the
	      $COLUMNS parameter (normally this is set automatically).	If the
	      size  of	the  file  being transferred is not available, bar and
	      percent meters will simply show the number of bytes  transferred
	      so far.

	      When zfinit is run, if this style is not defined for the context
	      :zftp:*, it will be set to `bar'.

       update Specifies the minimum  time  interval  between  updates  of  the
	      progress	meter  in  seconds.  No update is made unless new data
	      has been received, so the actual time interval is	 limited  only
	      by $ZFTP_TIMEOUT.

	      As  described for progress, zfinit will force this to default to
	      1.

       remote-glob
	      If set to `1', `yes' or `true', filename	generation  (globbing)
	      is performed on the remote machine instead of by zsh itself; see
	      below.

       titlebar
	      If set to `1', `yes' or `true', zftp_chpwd will put  the	remote
	      host  and	 remote directory into the titlebar of terminal emula‐
	      tors such as xterm or sun-cmd that allow this.

	      As described for progress, zfinit will force this to default  to
	      1.

       chpwd  If set to `1' `yes' or `true', zftp_chpwd will call the function
	      chpwd when a connection is closed.  This is useful if the remote
	      host  details were put into the terminal title bar by zftp_chpwd
	      and your usual chpwd also modifies the title bar.

	      When zfinit is run, it will determine whether chpwd  exists  and
	      if  so  it will set the default value for the style to 1 if none
	      exists already.

       Note that there is also an associative array  zfconfig  which  contains
       values  used  by	 the  function system.	This should not be modified or
       overwritten.

   Remote globbing
       The commands for retrieving files usually perform  filename  generation
       (globbing)  on  their  arguments; this can be turned off by passing the
       option -G to each of the commands.  Normally this operates by  retriev‐
       ing a complete list of files for the directory in question, then match‐
       ing these locally against the pattern supplied.	This has the advantage
       that  the  full	range  of  zsh patterns (respecting the setting of the
       option EXTENDED_GLOB) can be used.  However, it means that  the	direc‐
       tory part of a filename will not be expanded and must be given exactly.
       If the remote server does not support  the  UNIX	 directory  semantics,
       directory  handling  is problematic and it is recommended that globbing
       only be used within the current directory.  The list of	files  in  the
       current	directory,  if	retrieved,  will be cached, so that subsequent
       globs in the same  directory  without  an  intervening  zfcd  are  much
       faster.

       If  the	remote-glob style (see above) is set, globbing is instead per‐
       formed on the remote host: the server is asked for a list  of  matching
       files.	This  is  highly  dependent  on how the server is implemented,
       though typically UNIX servers will provide support for basic glob  pat‐
       terns.	This  may in some cases be faster, as it avoids retrieving the
       entire list of directory contents.

   Automatic and temporary reopening
       As described for the zfopen command, a subsequent zfopen with no param‐
       eters  will  reopen the connection to the last host (this includes con‐
       nections made with the zfanon command).	Opened in  this	 fashion,  the
       connection  starts in the default remote directory and will remain open
       until explicitly closed.

       Automatic re-opening is also available.	If a connection	 is  not  cur‐
       rently  open  and  a  command requiring a connection is given, the last
       connection is implicitly reopened.  In this case	 the  directory	 which
       was  current  when  the connection was closed again becomes the current
       directory (unless, of course, the command given changes it).  Automatic
       reopening  will	also  take  place  if  the connection was close by the
       remote server for whatever reason (e.g. a timeout).  It is  not	avail‐
       able if the -1 option to zfopen or zfanon was used.

       Furthermore,  if	 the command issued is a file transfer, the connection
       will be closed after  the  transfer  is	finished,  hence  providing  a
       one-shot mode for transfers.  This does not apply to directory changing
       or listing commands; for example a zfdir may reopen  a  connection  but
       will  leave  it open.  Also, automatic closure will only ever happen in
       the same command as automatic opening, i.e a zfdir directly followed by
       a zfget will never close the connection automatically.

       Information  about the previous connection is given by the zfstat func‐
       tion.  So, for example, if that reports:

	      Session:	      default
	      Not connected.
	      Last session:   ftp.bar.com:/pub/textfiles

       then the command zfget file.txt will attempt to reopen a connection  to
       ftp.bar.com, retrieve the file /pub/textfiles/file.txt, and immediately
       close the connection again.  On the other hand, zfcd ..	will open  the
       connection in the directory /pub and leave it open.

       Note  that  all	the above is local to each session; if you return to a
       previous session, the connection for that session is the one which will
       be reopened.

   Completion
       Completion  of  local and remote files, directories, sessions and book‐
       marks is supported.  The older,	compctl-style  completion  is  defined
       when zfinit is called; support for the new widget-based completion sys‐
       tem is provided in  the	function  Completion/Zsh/Command/_zftp,	 which
       should  be  installed with the other functions of the completion system
       and hence should automatically be available.

ZSHCONTRIB(1)							 ZSHCONTRIB(1)

NAME
       zshcontrib - user contributions to zsh

DESCRIPTION
       The Zsh source distribution includes a number of items  contributed  by
       the  user community.  These are not inherently a part of the shell, and
       some may not be available in every zsh installation.  The most signifi‐
       cant of these are documented here.  For documentation on other contrib‐
       uted items such as shell functions, look for comments in	 the  function
       source files.

UTILITIES
   Accessing On-Line Help
       The key sequence ESC h is normally bound by ZLE to execute the run-help
       widget (see zshzle(1)).	This invokes the  run-help  command  with  the
       command	word from the current input line as its argument.  By default,
       run-help is an alias for the man command, so this often fails when  the
       command	word  is  a  shell  builtin  or	 a  user-defined function.  By
       redefining the run-help alias, one can improve the  on-line  help  pro‐
       vided by the shell.

       The helpfiles utility, found in the Util directory of the distribution,
       is a Perl program that can be used to process the zsh manual to produce
       a  separate  help  file for each shell builtin and for many other shell
       features as well.  The autoloadable run-help function, found  in	 Func‐
       tions/Misc,  searches  for  these  helpfiles and performs several other
       tests to produce the most complete help possible for the command.

       There may already be a directory of help files on your system; look  in
       /usr/share/zsh  or /usr/local/share/zsh and subdirectories below those,
       or ask your system administrator.

       To create your own help files with helpfiles, choose or create a direc‐
       tory where the individual command help files will reside.  For example,
       you might choose ~/zsh_help.  If you unpacked the zsh  distribution  in
       your home directory, you would use the commands:

	      mkdir ~/zsh_help
	      cd ~/zsh_help
	      man zshall | colcrt - | \
	      perl ~/zsh-4.0.4/Util/helpfiles

       Next,  to  use  the  run-help function, you need to add lines something
       like the following to your .zshrc or equivalent startup file:

	      unalias run-help
	      autoload run-help
	      HELPDIR=~/zsh_help

       The HELPDIR parameter tells run-help where to look for the help	files.
       If your system already has a help file directory installed, set HELPDIR
       to the path of that directory instead.

       Note that in order for `autoload run-help' to work, the	run-help  file
       must  be	 in one of the directories named in your fpath array (see zsh‐
       param(1)).  This should already be the case if you have a standard  zsh
       installation;  if  it is not, copy Functions/Misc/run-help to an appro‐
       priate directory.

   Recompiling Functions
       If you frequently edit your zsh functions, or periodically update  your
       zsh  installation  to  track the latest developments, you may find that
       function digests compiled with the zcompile builtin are frequently  out
       of date with respect to the function source files.  This is not usually
       a problem, because zsh always looks for the newest file when loading  a
       function,  but  it may cause slower shell startup and function loading.
       Also, if a digest file is explicitly used as an element of  fpath,  zsh
       won't check whether any of its source files has changed.

       The  zrecompile	autoloadable function, found in Functions/Misc, can be
       used to keep function digests up to date.

       zrecompile [ -qt ] [ name ... ]
       zrecompile [ -qt ] -p args [ -- args ... ]
	      This tries to find *.zwc files and automatically re-compile them
	      if at least one of the original files is newer than the compiled
	      file.  This works only if the names stored in the compiled files
	      are  full	 paths	or are relative to the directory that contains
	      the .zwc file.

	      In the first form, each name is the name of a compiled file or a
	      directory	 containing *.zwc files that should be checked.	 If no
	      arguments are given, the directories and *.zwc  files  in	 fpath
	      are used.

	      When -t is given, no compilation is performed, but a return sta‐
	      tus of zero (true) is set if there are files  that  need	to  be
	      re-compiled  and non-zero (false) otherwise.  The -q option qui‐
	      ets the chatty output that describes what zrecompile is doing.

	      Without the -t option, the return status is zero	if  all	 files
	      that  needed  re-compilation  could  be compiled and non-zero if
	      compilation for at least one of the files failed.

	      If the -p option is given, the args are interpreted  as  one  or
	      more  sets  of  arguments	 for zcompile, separated by `--'.  For
	      example:

		     zrecompile -p \
				-R ~/.zshrc -- \
				-M ~/.zcompdump -- \
				~/zsh/comp.zwc ~/zsh/Completion/*/_*

	      This compiles ~/.zshrc into ~/.zshrc.zwc if that	doesn't	 exist
	      or  if  it  is  older  than  ~/.zshrc. The compiled file will be
	      marked for reading instead of mapping.  The  same	 is  done  for
	      ~/.zcompdump  and	 ~/.zcompdump.zwc,  but	 this compiled file is
	      marked  for  mapping.  The  last	line   re-creates   the	  file
	      ~/zsh/comp.zwc if any of the files matching the given pattern is
	      newer than it.

	      Without the -p  option,  zrecompile  does	 not  create  function
	      digests that do not already exist, nor does it add new functions
	      to the digest.

       The following shell loop is an example of a method for  creating	 func‐
       tion  digests  for  all functions in your fpath, assuming that you have
       write permission to the directories:

	      for ((i=1; i <= $#fpath; ++i)); do
		dir=$fpath[i]
		zwc=${dir:t}.zwc
		if [[ $dir == (.|..) || $dir == (.|..)/* ]]; then
		  continue
		fi
		files=($dir/*(N-.))
		if [[ -w $dir:h && -n $files ]]; then
		  files=(${${(M)files%/*/*}#/})
		  if ( cd $dir:h &&
		       zrecompile -p -U -z $zwc $files ); then
		    fpath[i]=$fpath[i].zwc
		  fi
		fi
	      done

       The -U and -z options are appropriate for functions in the default  zsh
       installation fpath; you may need to use different options for your per‐
       sonal function directories.

       Once the digests have been created and your fpath modified to refer  to
       them,  you can keep them up to date by running zrecompile with no argu‐
       ments.

   Keyboard Definition
       The large number of possible combinations of  keyboards,	 workstations,
       terminals, emulators, and window systems makes it impossible for zsh to
       have built-in key bindings for  every  situation.   The	zkbd  utility,
       found  in  Functions/Misc, can help you quickly create key bindings for
       your configuration.

       Run zkbd either as an autoloaded function, or as a shell script:

	      zsh -f ~/zsh-4.0.4/Functions/Misc/zkbd

       When you run zkbd, it first asks you to enter your  terminal  type;  if
       the  default it offers is correct, just press return.  It then asks you
       to press a number of different keys  to	determine  characteristics  of
       your  keyboard and terminal; zkbd warns you if it finds anything out of
       the ordinary, such as a Delete key that sends neither ^H nor ^?.

       The keystrokes read by zkbd are recorded as a definition for  an	 asso‐
       ciative	array  named  key, written to a file in the subdirectory .zkbd
       within either your HOME or ZDOTDIR directory.  The name of the file  is
       composed	 from  the  TERM,  VENDOR  and	OSTYPE	parameters,  joined by
       hyphens.

       You may read this file into your .zshrc or another  startup  file  with
       the "source" or "." commands, then reference the key parameter in bind‐
       key commands, like this:

	      source ${ZDOTDIR:-$HOME}/.zkbd/$TERM-$VENDOR-$OSTYPE
	      [[ -n ${key[Left]} ]] && bindkey "${key[Left]}" backward-char
	      [[ -n ${key[Right]} ]] && bindkey "${key[Right]}" forward-char
	      # etc.

       Note that in order for `autoload zkbd' to work, the zkdb file  must  be
       in  one of the directories named in your fpath array (see zshparam(1)).
       This should already be the case if you have a  standard	zsh  installa‐
       tion;  if  it is not, copy Functions/Misc/zkbd to an appropriate direc‐
       tory.

   Dumping Shell State
       Occasionally you may encounter what appears to be a bug in  the	shell,
       particularly  if	 you  are using a beta version of zsh or a development
       release.	 Usually it is sufficient to send a description of the problem
       to  one of the zsh mailing lists (see zsh(1)), but sometimes one of the
       zsh developers will need to recreate your environment in order to track
       the problem down.

       The script named reporter, found in the Util directory of the distribu‐
       tion, is provided for this purpose.  (It is also possible  to  autoload
       reporter,  but  reporter	 is  not installed in fpath by default.)  This
       script outputs a detailed dump of the  shell  state,  in	 the  form  of
       another script that can be read with `zsh -f' to recreate that state.

       To  use reporter, read the script into your shell with the `.'  command
       and redirect the output into a file:

	      . ~/zsh-4.0.4/Util/reporter > zsh.report

       You should check the zsh.report file for any sensitive information such
       as  passwords  and delete them by hand before sending the script to the
       developers.  Also, as the output can be voluminous, it's best  to  wait
       for the developers to ask for this information before sending it.

       You  can	 also  use  reporter to dump only a subset of the shell state.
       This is sometimes useful for creating startup files for the first time.
       Most  of	 the output from reporter is far more detailed than usually is
       necessary for a startup file, but the  aliases,	options,  and  zstyles
       states  may  be	useful	because	 they  include	only  changes from the
       defaults.  The bindings state may be useful if you have created any  of
       your own keymaps, because reporter arranges to dump the keymap creation
       commands as well as the bindings for every keymap.

       As is usual with automated tools, if you create	a  startup  file  with
       reporter,  you  should edit the results to remove unnecessary commands.
       Note that if you're using the new completion  system,  you  should  not
       dump  the  functions state to your startup files with reporter; use the
       compdump function instead (see zshcompsys(1)).

       reporter [ state ... ]
	      Print to standard output the indicated  subset  of  the  current
	      shell state.  The state arguments may be one or more of:

	      all    Output everything listed below.
	      aliases
		     Output alias definitions.
	      bindings
		     Output ZLE key maps and bindings.
	      completion
		     Output  old-style	compctl	 commands.   New completion is
		     covered by functions and zstyles.
	      functions
		     Output autoloads and function definitions.
	      limits Output limit commands.
	      options
		     Output setopt commands.
	      styles Same as zstyles.
	      variables
		     Output shell parameter assignments, plus export  commands
		     for any environment variables.
	      zstyles
		     Output zstyle commands.

	      If the state is omitted, all is assumed.

       With the exception of `all', every state can be abbreviated by any pre‐
       fix, even a single letter; thus a is the same as aliases, z is the same
       as zstyles, etc.

PROMPT THEMES
   Installation
       You  should  make  sure	all  the  functions from the Functions/Prompts
       directory of the source distribution are available; they all begin with
       the  string `prompt_' except for the special function`promptinit'.  You
       also need the `colors' function	from  Functions/Misc.	All  of	 these
       functions  may  already have been installed on your system; if not, you
       will need to find them and copy them.  The directory should  appear  as
       one of the elements of the fpath array (this should already be the case
       if they were installed), and at least the function promptinit should be
       autoloaded;  it will autoload the rest.	Finally, to initialize the use
       of the system you need to call the promptinit function.	The  following
       code  in	 your  .zshrc  will arrange for this; assume the functions are
       stored in the directory ~/myfns:

	      fpath=(~/myfns $fpath)
	      autoload -U promptinit
	      promptinit

   Theme Selection
       Use the prompt command to select your preferred	theme.	 This  command
       may  be	added to your .zshrc following the call to promptinit in order
       to start zsh with a theme already selected.

       prompt [ -c | -l ]
       prompt [ -p | -h ] [ theme ... ]
       prompt [ -s ] theme [ arg ... ]
	      Set or examine the prompt theme.	With no options	 and  a	 theme
	      argument,	 the theme with that name is set as the current theme.
	      The available themes are determined at  run  time;  use  the  -l
	      option  to  see  a  list.	 The special theme `random' selects at
	      random one of the available themes and sets your prompt to that.

	      In some cases the theme may be modified by  one  or  more	 argu‐
	      ments, which should be given after the theme name.  See the help
	      for each theme for descriptions of these arguments.

	      Options are:

	      -c     Show the currently selected theme and its parameters,  if
		     any.
	      -l     List all available prompt themes.
	      -p     Preview  the  theme  named	 by theme, or all themes if no
		     theme is given.
	      -h     Show help for the theme named by theme, or for the prompt
		     function if no theme is given.
	      -s     Set theme as the current theme and save state.

       prompt_theme_setup
	      Each available theme has a setup function which is called by the
	      prompt function to install that theme.  This function may define
	      other  functions	as necessary to maintain the prompt, including
	      functions used to preview the prompt or  provide	help  for  its
	      use.   You  should  not  normally	 call a theme's setup function
	      directly.

ZLE FUNCTIONS
   Widgets
       These functions all implement user-defined ZLE widgets (see  zshzle(1))
       which  can  be bound to keystrokes in interactive shells.  To use them,
       your .zshrc should contain lines of the form

	      autoload function
	      zle -N function

       followed by an appropriate bindkey command to  associate	 the  function
       with a key sequence.  Suggested bindings are described below.

       cycle-completion-positions
	      After inserting an unambiguous string into the command line, the
	      new function based completion system  may	 know  about  multiple
	      places  in  this	string	where characters are missing or differ
	      from at least one of the possible matches.  It will  then	 place
	      the cursor on the position it considers to be the most interest‐
	      ing one, i.e. the one where one can disambiguate between as many
	      matches as possible with as little typing as possible.

	      This  widget  allows  the cursor to be easily moved to the other
	      interesting spots.   It  can  be	invoked	 repeatedly  to	 cycle
	      between all positions reported by the completion system.

       edit-command-line
	      Edit the command line using your visual editor, as in ksh.

		     bindkey -M vicmd v edit-command-line

       history-search-end
	      This    function	  implements	the   widgets	history-begin‐
	      ning-search-backward-end	  and	 history-beginning-search-for‐
	      ward-end.	  These commands work by first calling the correspond‐
	      ing builtin widget (see `History Control' in zshzle(1)) and then
	      moving  the  cursor to the end of the line.  The original cursor
	      position is remembered and restored before calling  the  builtin
	      widget  a	 second	 time,	so that the same search is repeated to
	      look farther through the history.

	      Although you autoload only one function, the commands to use  it
	      are slightly different because it implements two widgets.

		     zle -N history-beginning-search-backward-end \
			    history-search-end
		     zle -N history-beginning-search-forward-end \
			    history-search-end
		     bindkey '\e^P' history-beginning-search-backward-end
		     bindkey '\e^N' history-beginning-search-forward-end

       incarg Typing  the keystrokes for this widget with the cursor placed on
	      or to the left of an integer causes that integer	to  be	incre‐
	      mented  by  one.	 With a numeric prefix argument, the number is
	      incremented by the amount of the argument	 (decremented  if  the
	      prefix argument is negative).  The shell parameter incarg may be
	      set to change the default increment something other than one.

		     bindkey '^X+' incarg

       incremental-complete-word
	      This allows incremental completion of a  word.   After  starting
	      this  command,  a	 list of completion choices can be shown after
	      every character you type, which you can delete with ^H  or  DEL.
	      Pressing return accepts the completion so far and returns you to
	      normal editing (that is, the command  line  is  not  immediately
	      executed).  You can hit TAB to do normal completion, ^G to abort
	      back to the state when you started, and ^D to list the matches.

	      This works only with the new function based completion system.

		     bindkey '^Xi' incremental-complete-word

       insert-files
	      This function allows you	type  a	 file  pattern,	 and  see  the
	      results of the expansion at each step.  When you hit return, all
	      expansions are inserted into the command line.

		     bindkey '^Xf' insert-files

       predict-on
	      This set of functions implements predictive typing using history
	      search.	After  predict-on, typing characters causes the editor
	      to look backward in the history for  the	first  line  beginning
	      with  what  you  have  typed so far.  After predict-off, editing
	      returns to normal for the line found.  In fact, you often	 don't
	      even  need to use predict-off, because if the line doesn't match
	      something in the history, adding a key performs standard comple‐
	      tion,  and  then	inserts	 itself	 if no completions were found.
	      However, editing in the middle of a line is  liable  to  confuse
	      prediction; see the toggle style below.

	      With  the	 function based completion system (which is needed for
	      this), you should be able to type TAB at	almost	any  point  to
	      advance  the  cursor to the next ``interesting'' character posi‐
	      tion (usually the end of the current word, but  sometimes	 some‐
	      where  in the middle of the word).  And of course as soon as the
	      entire line is what you want, you can accept with return,	 with‐
	      out needing to move the cursor to the end first.

	      The first time predict-on is used, it creates several additional
	      widget functions:

	      delete-backward-and-predict
		     Replaces the backward-delete-char	widget.	  You  do  not
		     need to bind this yourself.
	      insert-and-predict
		     Implements predictive typing by replacing the self-insert
		     widget.  You do not need to bind this yourself.
	      predict-off
		     Turns off predictive typing.

	      Although you autoload only the predict-on function, it is neces‐
	      sary to create a keybinding for predict-off as well.

		     zle -N predict-on
		     zle -N predict-off
		     bindkey '^X^Z' predict-on
		     bindkey '^Z' predict-off

       smart-insert-last-word
	      This function may replace the insert-last-word widget, like so:

		     zle -N insert-last-word smart-insert-last-word

	      With  a numeric prefix, it behaves like insert-last-word, except
	      that words in comments are ignored when INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS  is
	      set.

	      Otherwise,  the rightmost ``interesting'' word from the previous
	      command is  found	 and  inserted.	  The  default	definition  of
	      ``interesting''  is  that	 the word contains at least one alpha‐
	      betic character, slash, or backslash.  This  definition  may  be
	      overridden  by use of the match style.  The context used to look
	      up the style is the widget  name,	 so  usually  the  context  is
	      :insert-last-word.   However, you can bind this function to dif‐
	      ferent widgets to use different patterns:

		     zle -N insert-last-assignment smart-insert-last-word
		     zstyle :insert-last-assignment match '[[:alpha:]][][[:alnum:]]#=*'
		     bindkey '\e=' insert-last-assignment

   Styles
       The behavior of several of the above widgets can be controlled  by  the
       use of the zstyle mechanism.  In particular, widgets that interact with
       the completion system pass along their context to any completions  that
       they invoke.

       break-keys
	      This  style is used by the incremental-complete-word widget. Its
	      value should be a pattern, and all keys  matching	 this  pattern
	      will cause the widget to stop incremental completion without the
	      key having any further effect. Like all styles used directly  by
	      incremental-complete-word,  this	style  is  looked up using the
	      context `:incremental'.

       completer
	      The incremental-complete-word and insert-and-predict widgets set
	      up their top-level context name before calling completion.  This
	      allows one to define different sets of completer	functions  for
	      normal  completion  and  for these widgets.  For example, to use
	      completion, approximation and correction for normal  completion,
	      completion  and  correction  for incremental completion and only
	      completion for prediction one could use:

		     zstyle ':completion:*' completer \
			     _complete _correct _approximate
		     zstyle ':completion:incremental:*' completer \
			     _complete _correct
		     zstyle ':completion:predict:*' completer \
			     _complete

	      It is a good idea to restrict the completers used in prediction,
	      because  they  may  be  automatically  invoked as you type.  The
	      _list and _menu completers should never be used with prediction.
	      The  _approximate,  _correct, _expand, and _match completers may
	      be used, but be aware that they may change  characters  anywhere
	      in  the  word  behind the cursor, so you need to watch carefully
	      that the result is what you intended.

       cursor The insert-and-predict widget uses this style,  in  the  context
	      `:predict', to decide where to place the cursor after completion
	      has been tried.  Values are:

	      complete
		     The cursor is left where it was when completion finished,
		     but only if it is after a character equal to the one just
		     inserted by the user.  If it is after another  character,
		     this value is the same as `key'.

	      key    The  cursor is left after the nth occurrence of the char‐
		     acter just inserted, where n is the number of times  that
		     character	appeared  in  the  word	 before completion was
		     attempted.	 In short, this has the effect of leaving  the
		     cursor after the character just typed even if the comple‐
		     tion code found out that no other characters need	to  be
		     inserted at that position.

	      Any other value for this style unconditionally leaves the cursor
	      at the position where the completion code left it.

       list   When using the incremental-complete-word widget, this style says
	      if  the matches should be listed on every key press (if they fit
	      on the screen).  Use the context	prefix	`:completion:incremen‐
	      tal'.

	      The  insert-and-predict  widget uses this style to decide if the
	      completion should be shown even if there is  only	 one  possible
	      completion.   This  is  done  if	the value of this style is the
	      string always.  In this case  the	 context  is  `:predict'  (not
	      `:completion:predict').

       match  This  style  is used by smart-insert-last-word to provide a pat‐
	      tern (using full EXTENDED_GLOB syntax) that matches an interest‐
	      ing  word.   The	context	 is  the  name	of the widget to which
	      smart-insert-last-word is bound (see above).  The default behav‐
	      ior of smart-insert-last-word is equivalent to:

		     zstyle :insert-last-word match '*[[:alpha:]/\\]*'

	      However, you might want to include words that contain spaces:

		     zstyle :insert-last-word match '*[[:alpha:][:space:]/\\]*'

	      Or  include  numbers as long as the word is at least two charac‐
	      ters long:

		     zstyle :insert-last-word match '*([[:digit:]]?|[[:alpha:]/\\])*'

	      The above example causes redirections like "2>" to be included.

       prompt The incremental-complete-word widget shows  the  value  of  this
	      style  in	 the  status  line during incremental completion.  The
	      string value may contain any of the following substrings in  the
	      manner of the PS1 and other prompt parameters:

	      %c     Replaced  by the name of the completer function that gen‐
		     erated the matches (without the leading underscore).

	      %l     When the list style is set, replaced by `...' if the list
		     of	 matches  is too long to fit on the screen and with an
		     empty string otherwise.  If the list style is `false'  or
		     not set, `%l' is always removed.

	      %n     Replaced by the number of matches generated.

	      %s     Replaced  by  `-no	 match-',  `-no	 prefix-', or an empty
		     string if there is no completion matching the word on the
		     line, if the matches have no common prefix different from
		     the word on the line, or if there is such a  common  pre‐
		     fix, respectively.

	      %u     Replaced by the unambiguous part of all matches, if there
		     is any, and if it is different from the word on the line.

	      Like `break-keys', this uses the `:incremental' context.

       stop-keys
	      This style is used by the incremental-complete-word widget.  Its
	      value  is	 treated similarly to the one for the break-keys style
	      (and uses the same context: `:incremental').  However,  in  this
	      case  all keys matching the pattern given as its value will stop
	      incremental completion and will then execute their  usual	 func‐
	      tion.

       toggle This boolean style is used by predict-on and its related widgets
	      in the context `:predict'.  If set to one of the standard `true'
	      values, predictive typing is automatically toggled off in situa‐
	      tions where it is unlikely to be useful, such as when editing  a
	      multi-line  buffer or after moving into the middle of a line and
	      then deleting a character.  The default is to  leave  prediction
	      turned on until an explicit call to predict-off.

       verbose
	      This boolean style is used by predict-on and its related widgets
	      in the context `:predict'.  If set to one of the standard `true'
	      values,  these  widgets  display a message below the prompt when
	      the predictive state is toggled.	This is most useful in	combi‐
	      nation  with  the	 toggle	 style.	  The default does not display
	      these messages.

OTHER FUNCTIONS
       There are a large number of helpful  functions  in  the	Functions/Misc
       directory  of  the  zsh	distribution.  Most are very simple and do not
       require documentation here, but a few are worthy of special mention.

   Descriptions
       colors This function initializes	 several  associative  arrays  to  map
	      color names to (and from) the ANSI standard eight-color terminal
	      codes.  These are used by the prompt theme system	 (see  above).
	      You seldom should need to run colors more than once.

	      The  eight  base	colors	are:  black, red, green, yellow, blue,
	      magenta, cyan, and white.	 Each of these	has  codes  for	 fore‐
	      ground  and  background.	 In addition there are eight intensity
	      attributes: bold, faint, standout,  underline,  blink,  reverse,
	      and  conceal.   Finally,	there  are  six	 codes	used to negate
	      attributes: none (reset all attributes to the defaults),	normal
	      (neither	bold  nor faint), no-standout, no-underline, no-blink,
	      and no-reverse.

	      Some terminals do not support all	 combinations  of  colors  and
	      intensities.

	      The associative arrays are:

	      color
	      colour Map all the color names to their integer codes, and inte‐
		     ger codes to the color names.  The eight base  names  map
		     to	 the foreground color codes, as do names prefixed with
		     `fg-', such as `fg-red'.  Names prefixed with `bg-', such
		     as `bg-blue', refer to the background codes.  The reverse
		     mapping from code to color yields	base  name  for	 fore‐
		     ground codes and the bg- form for backgrounds.

		     Although  it  is  a misnomer to call them `colors', these
		     arrays also map the other fourteen attributes from	 names
		     to codes and codes to names.

	      fg
	      fg_bold
	      fg_no_bold
		     Map  the  eight basic color names to ANSI terminal escape
		     sequences that  set  the  corresponding  foreground  text
		     properties.   The	fg  sequences change the color without
		     changing the eight intensity attributes.

	      bg
	      bg_bold
	      bg_no_bold
		     Map the eight basic color names to ANSI  terminal	escape
		     sequences	that  set the corresponding background proper‐
		     ties.  The bg sequences change the color without changing
		     the eight intensity attributes.

	      In  addition,  the  scalar parameters reset_color and bold_color
	      are  set	to  the	 ANSI  terminal	 escapes  that	turn  off  all
	      attributes and turn on bold intensity, respectively.

       fned name
	      Same  as	zed -f.	 This function does not appear in the zsh dis‐
	      tribution, but can be created by linking zed to the name fned in
	      some directory in your fpath.

       is-at-least needed [ present ]
	      Perform  a  greater-than-or-equal-to  comparison	of two strings
	      having the format of a zsh version number; that is, a string  of
	      numbers  and text with segments separated by dots or dashes.  If
	      the present string is not provided, $ZSH_VERSION is used.	  Seg‐
	      ments  are  paired left-to-right in the two strings with leading
	      non-number parts ignored.	 If one string has fewer segments than
	      the other, the missing segments are considered zero.

	      This  is	useful in startup files to set options and other state
	      that are not available in all versions of zsh.

		     is-at-least 3.1.6-15 && setopt NO_GLOBAL_RCS
		     is-at-least 3.1.0 && setopt HIST_REDUCE_BLANKS
		     is-at-least 2.6-17 || print "You can't use is-at-least here."

       nslookup [ arg ... ]
	      This wrapper function for	 the  nslookup	command	 requires  the
	      zsh/zpty	module	(see  zshmodules(1)).  It behaves exactly like
	      the standard  nslookup  except  that  it	provides  customizable
	      prompts  (including  a  right-side  prompt)  and	completion  of
	      nslookup commands, host  names,  etc.  (if  you  use  the	 func‐
	      tion-based  completion  system).	 Completion  styles may be set
	      with the context prefix `:completion:nslookup'.

	      See also the pager, prompt and rprompt styles below.

       run-help
	      See `Accessing On-Line Help' above.

       zed [ -f ] name
	      This function uses the ZLE editor to edit a  file	 or  function.
	      It rebinds the return key to insert a line break, and adds bind‐
	      ings for `^X^W' in the emacs keymap and `ZZ' in the vicmd keymap
	      to  accept  (and	therefore  write,  in  the case of a file) the
	      edited file or function.	Keybindings are otherwise the standard
	      ones;  completion	 is  available, and styles may be set with the
	      context prefix `:completion:zed'.

	      Only one name argument is recognized (additional	arguments  are
	      ignored).	  If  the  -f option is given, the name is taken to be
	      that of a function; if the function is marked  for  autoloading,
	      zed  searches for it in the fpath and loads it.  Note that func‐
	      tions edited this way are installed into the current shell,  but
	      not written back to the autoload file.

	      Without  -f,  name  is  the path name of the file to edit, which
	      need not exist; it is created on write, if necessary.

       zcp [ -finqQvw ] srcpat dest
       zln [ -finqQsvw ] srcpat dest
	      Same as zmv -C and zmv -L, respectively.	These functions do not
	      appear  in  the  zsh distribution, but can be created by linking
	      zmv to the names zcp and zln in some directory in your fpath.

       zkbd   See `Keyboard Definition' above.

       zmv [ -finqQsvw ] [ -C | -L | -M | -p program ] [ -o optstring ] srcpat
       dest
	      Move (usually, rename) files matching the pattern srcpat to cor‐
	      responding files having names of the form given by  dest,	 where
	      srcpat  contains	parentheses surrounding patterns which will be
	      replaced in turn by $1, $2, ... in dest.	For example,

		     zmv '(*).lis' '$1.txt'

	      renames	`foo.lis'   to	 `foo.txt',   `my.old.stuff.lis'    to
	      `my.old.stuff.txt', and so on.

	      The  pattern is always treated as an EXTENDED_GLOB pattern.  Any
	      file whose name is not changed by	 the  substitution  is	simply
	      ignored.	Any error (a substitution resulted in an empty string,
	      two substitutions gave the same result, the destination  was  an
	      existing	regular	 file  and -f was not given) causes the entire
	      function to abort without doing anything.

	      Options:

	      -f     Force overwriting of destination  files.	Not  currently
		     passed  down  to  the mv/cp/ln command due to vagaries of
		     implementations (but you can use -o-f to do that).
	      -i     Interactive: show each line to be executed	 and  ask  the
		     user  whether to execute it.  `Y' or `y' will execute it,
		     anything else will skip it.  Note that you just  need  to
		     type one character.
	      -n     No execution: print what would happen, but don't do it.
	      -q     Turn bare glob qualifiers off: now assumed by default, so
		     this has no effect.
	      -Q     Force bare glob qualifiers on.  Don't turn this on unless
		     you are actually using glob qualifiers in a pattern.
	      -s     Symbolic, passed down to ln; only works with -L.
	      -v     Verbose: print each command as it's being executed.
	      -w     Pick  out	wildcard  parts	 of  the pattern, as described
		     above, and implicitly add parentheses  for	 referring  to
		     them.
	      -C
	      -L
	      -M     Force  cp, ln or mv, respectively, regardless of the name
		     of the function.
	      -p program
		     Call program instead of cp, ln or mv.  Whatever it	 does,
		     it	 should	 at least understand the form `program -- old‐
		     name newname' where oldname  and  newname	are  filenames
		     generated by zmv.
	      -o optstring
		     The  optstring is split into words and passed down verba‐
		     tim to the cp, ln or mv command  called  to  perform  the
		     work.  It should probably begin with a `-'.

	      For more complete examples and other implementation details, see
	      the zmv source file, usually located in one of  the  directories
	      named in your fpath, or in Functions/Misc/zmv in the zsh distri‐
	      bution.

       zrecompile
	      See `Recompiling Functions' above.

       zstyle+ context style value [ + subcontext style value ... ]
	      This makes defining styles a bit simpler by using a  single  `+'
	      as  a  special token that allows you to append a context name to
	      the previously used context name.	 Like this:

		     zstyle+ ':foo:bar' style1 value1 \
			   + ':baz'	style2 value2 \
			   + ':frob'	style3 value3

	      This defines `style1' with `value1' for the context :foo:bar  as
	      usual,  but  it also defines `style2' with `value2' for the con‐
	      text :foo:bar:baz and `style3' with `value3' for	:foo:bar:frob.
	      Any  subcontext may be the empty string to re-use the first con‐
	      text unchanged.

   Styles
       insert-tab
	      The zed function sets this style in context  `:completion:zed:*'
	      to  turn	off completion when TAB is typed at the beginning of a
	      line.  You may override this by setting your own value for  this
	      context and style.

       pager  The  nslookup  function  looks  up  this	style  in  the context
	      `:nslookup' to determine the program used to display output that
	      does not fit on a single screen.

       prompt
       rprompt
	      The  nslookup  function  looks  up  this	style  in  the context
	      `:nslookup' to set the prompt and the right-side prompt, respec‐
	      tively.	The  usual  expansions for the PS1 and RPS1 parameters
	      may be used (see zshmisc(1)).

ZSHALL(1)							     ZSHALL(1)

FILES
       $ZDOTDIR/.zshenv
       $ZDOTDIR/.zprofile
       $ZDOTDIR/.zshrc
       $ZDOTDIR/.zlogin
       $ZDOTDIR/.zlogout
       ${TMPPREFIX}*   (default is /tmp/zsh*)
       /etc/zshenv
       /etc/zprofile
       /etc/zshrc
       /etc/zlogin
       /etc/zlogout    (installation-specific - /etc is the default)

SEE ALSO
       sh(1), csh(1), tcsh(1), rc(1), bash(1), ksh(1)

       IEEE Standard for information Technology -  Portable  Operating	System
       Interface  (POSIX)  - Part 2: Shell and Utilities, IEEE Inc, 1993, ISBN
       1-55937-255-9.

zsh 4.0.4		       October 26, 2001			     ZSHALL(1)
[top]
                             _         _         _ 
                            | |       | |       | |     
                            | |       | |       | |     
                         __ | | __ __ | | __ __ | | __  
                         \ \| |/ / \ \| |/ / \ \| |/ /  
                          \ \ / /   \ \ / /   \ \ / /   
                           \   /     \   /     \   /    
                            \_/       \_/       \_/ 
More information is available in HTML format for server UnixWare

List of man pages available for UnixWare

Copyright (c) for man pages and the logo by the respective OS vendor.

For those who want to learn more, the polarhome community provides shell access and support.

[legal] [privacy] [GNU] [policy] [cookies] [netiquette] [sponsors] [FAQ]
Tweet
Polarhome, production since 1999.
Member of Polarhome portal.
Based on Fawad Halim's script.
....................................................................
Vote for polarhome
Free Shell Accounts :: the biggest list on the net